gdb: New maint info line-table command.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1239 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1240 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1241 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1242 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1243 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1244
1245 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1246 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1247 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1248 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1249 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1250 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1251
1252 @item -write
1253 @cindex @code{--write}
1254 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1255 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1256 (@pxref{Patching}).
1257
1258 @item -statistics
1259 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1260 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1261 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1262
1263 @item -version
1264 @cindex @code{--version}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1266 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1267
1268 @item -configuration
1269 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1271 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1272 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1273
1274 @end table
1275
1276 @node Startup
1277 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1278 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1279
1280 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1281
1282 @enumerate
1283 @item
1284 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1285 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1286
1287 @item
1288 @cindex init file
1289 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1290 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1292 that file.
1293
1294 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1295 @item
1296 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1297 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1298 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1302 @item
1303 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1304 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1305 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1306 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1307 gets loaded.
1308
1309 @item
1310 Processes command line options and operands.
1311
1312 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1313 @item
1314 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1315 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1316 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1317 This is only done if the current directory is
1318 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1319 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1320 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1321 @value{GDBN}.
1322
1323 @item
1324 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1325 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1326 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1327 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1328
1329 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1330 you must do something like the following:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1334 @end smallexample
1335
1336 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1337 off too late.
1338
1339 @item
1340 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1341 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1342 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1346 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1347 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1348 @end enumerate
1349
1350 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1351 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1352 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1353 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1354 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1355 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1356
1357 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1358 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1359
1360 @cindex init file name
1361 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1362 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1363 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1364 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1365 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1366 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1367 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1368 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1369
1370
1371 @node Quitting GDB
1372 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1373 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1374 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1375
1376 @table @code
1377 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1378 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1379 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1380 @itemx q
1381 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1382 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1383 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1384 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1385 error code.
1386 @end table
1387
1388 @cindex interrupt
1389 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1390 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1391 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1392 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1393 until a time when it is safe.
1394
1395 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1396 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1397 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1398
1399 @node Shell Commands
1400 @section Shell Commands
1401
1402 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1403 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1404 just use the @code{shell} command.
1405
1406 @table @code
1407 @kindex shell
1408 @kindex !
1409 @cindex shell escape
1410 @item shell @var{command-string}
1411 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1412 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1413 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1414 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1415 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1416 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1417 @end table
1418
1419 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1420 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1421 @value{GDBN}:
1422
1423 @table @code
1424 @kindex make
1425 @cindex calling make
1426 @item make @var{make-args}
1427 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1428 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1429 @end table
1430
1431 @node Logging Output
1432 @section Logging Output
1433 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1434 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1435
1436 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1437 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1438
1439 @table @code
1440 @kindex set logging
1441 @item set logging on
1442 Enable logging.
1443 @item set logging off
1444 Disable logging.
1445 @cindex logging file name
1446 @item set logging file @var{file}
1447 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1448 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1449 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1450 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1451 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1453 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1454 @kindex show logging
1455 @item show logging
1456 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1457 @end table
1458
1459 @node Commands
1460 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1461
1462 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1463 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1464 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1465 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1466 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1467
1468 @menu
1469 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1470 * Completion:: Command completion
1471 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1472 @end menu
1473
1474 @node Command Syntax
1475 @section Command Syntax
1476
1477 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1478 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1479 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1480 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1481 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1482 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1483
1484 @cindex abbreviation
1485 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1486 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1487 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1488 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1489 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1490 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1491 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1492
1493 @cindex repeating commands
1494 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1495 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1496 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1497 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1498 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1499 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1500 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1501
1502 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1503 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1504 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1505
1506 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1507 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1508 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1509 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1510 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1511
1512 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1513 @cindex comment
1514 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1515 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1516 Files,,Command Files}).
1517
1518 @cindex repeating command sequences
1519 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1520 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1521 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1522 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1523 for editing.
1524
1525 @node Completion
1526 @section Command Completion
1527
1528 @cindex completion
1529 @cindex word completion
1530 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1531 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1532 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1533 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1534
1535 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1536 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1537 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1538 enter it). For example, if you type
1539
1540 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1541 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1542 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1543 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1544 @smallexample
1545 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1546 @end smallexample
1547
1548 @noindent
1549 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1550 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1551
1552 @smallexample
1553 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1554 @end smallexample
1555
1556 @noindent
1557 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1558 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1559 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1560 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1561 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1562 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1563
1564 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1565 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1566 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1567 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1568 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1569 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1570 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1571 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1572 example:
1573
1574 @smallexample
1575 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1576 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1577 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1578 make_abs_section make_function_type
1579 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1580 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1581 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1583 @end smallexample
1584
1585 @noindent
1586 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1587 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1588 command.
1589
1590 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1591 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1592 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1593 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1594 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1595
1596 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1597 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1598 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1602 main
1603 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1604 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1605 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1610
1611 @table @code
1612 @kindex set max-completions
1613 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1614 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1615 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1616 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1617 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1618 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1619 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1620 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1621 completion slow.
1622 @kindex show max-completions
1623 @item show max-completions
1624 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1625 during completion.
1626 @end table
1627
1628 @cindex quotes in commands
1629 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1630 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1631 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1632 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1633 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1634 @value{GDBN} commands.
1635
1636 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1637 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1638 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1639 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1640 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1641 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1642 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1643 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1644 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1645 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1646 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1650 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1651 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1652 @end smallexample
1653
1654 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1655 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1656 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1657 place:
1658
1659 @smallexample
1660 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1661 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1662 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @noindent
1666 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1667 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1668 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1669
1670 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1671 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1672 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1673 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1674
1675 @cindex completion of structure field names
1676 @cindex structure field name completion
1677 @cindex completion of union field names
1678 @cindex union field name completion
1679 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1680 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1681 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1682 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1683 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1684 left-hand-side:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1688 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1689 to_data to_isatty to_write
1690 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1691 to_flush to_read
1692 @end smallexample
1693
1694 @noindent
1695 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1696 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1697 follows:
1698
1699 @smallexample
1700 struct ui_file
1701 @{
1702 int *magic;
1703 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1704 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1705 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1706 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1707 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1708 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1709 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1710 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1711 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1712 void *to_data;
1713 @}
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716
1717 @node Help
1718 @section Getting Help
1719 @cindex online documentation
1720 @kindex help
1721
1722 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1723 using the command @code{help}.
1724
1725 @table @code
1726 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1727 @item help
1728 @itemx h
1729 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1730 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1731
1732 @smallexample
1733 (@value{GDBP}) help
1734 List of classes of commands:
1735
1736 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1737 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1738 data -- Examining data
1739 files -- Specifying and examining files
1740 internals -- Maintenance commands
1741 obscure -- Obscure features
1742 running -- Running the program
1743 stack -- Examining the stack
1744 status -- Status inquiries
1745 support -- Support facilities
1746 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1747 stopping the program
1748 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1749
1750 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1751 commands in that class.
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1758
1759 @item help @var{class}
1760 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1761 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1762 help display for the class @code{status}:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1766 Status inquiries.
1767
1768 List of commands:
1769
1770 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1771 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1772 info -- Generic command for showing things
1773 about the program being debugged
1774 show -- Generic command for showing things
1775 about the debugger
1776
1777 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1778 documentation.
1779 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1780 (@value{GDBP})
1781 @end smallexample
1782
1783 @item help @var{command}
1784 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1785 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1786
1787 @kindex apropos
1788 @item apropos @var{args}
1789 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1790 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1791 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1792
1793 @smallexample
1794 apropos alias
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 results in:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 @c @group
1802 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1803 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1804 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1805 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1806 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1807 @c @end group
1808 @end smallexample
1809
1810 @kindex complete
1811 @item complete @var{args}
1812 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1813 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1814 command you want completed. For example:
1815
1816 @smallexample
1817 complete i
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @noindent results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @group
1824 if
1825 ignore
1826 info
1827 inspect
1828 @end group
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1832 @end table
1833
1834 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1835 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1836 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1837 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1838 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1839 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1840 Index}.
1841
1842 @c @group
1843 @table @code
1844 @kindex info
1845 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1846 @item info
1847 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1848 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1849 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1850 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1851 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1852 @w{@code{help info}}.
1853
1854 @kindex set
1855 @item set
1856 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1857 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1858 @code{set prompt $}.
1859
1860 @kindex show
1861 @item show
1862 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1863 @value{GDBN} itself.
1864 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1865 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1866 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1867 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1868
1869 @kindex info set
1870 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1871 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1872 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1873 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1874 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1875 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1876 @end table
1877 @c @end group
1878
1879 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1880 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1881
1882 @table @code
1883 @kindex show version
1884 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1885 @item show version
1886 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1887 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1888 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1889 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1890 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1891 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1892 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1893 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1894 @value{GDBN}.
1895
1896 @kindex show copying
1897 @kindex info copying
1898 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1899 @item show copying
1900 @itemx info copying
1901 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show warranty
1904 @kindex info warranty
1905 @item show warranty
1906 @itemx info warranty
1907 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1908 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1909
1910 @kindex show configuration
1911 @item show configuration
1912 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1913 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1914 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1915 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1916 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1917 your report.
1918
1919 @end table
1920
1921 @node Running
1922 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1923
1924 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it.
1926
1927 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1928 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1929 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1930 kill a child process.
1931
1932 @menu
1933 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1934 * Starting:: Starting your program
1935 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1936 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1937
1938 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1939 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1940 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1941 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1942
1943 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1944 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1945 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1946 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1947 @end menu
1948
1949 @node Compilation
1950 @section Compiling for Debugging
1951
1952 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1953 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1954 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1955 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1956 and addresses in the executable code.
1957
1958 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1959 the compiler.
1960
1961 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1962 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1963 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1964 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1965 executables containing debugging information.
1966
1967 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1968 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1969 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1970 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1971 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1972
1973 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1974 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1975 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1976
1977 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1978 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1979 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1980 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1981 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1982 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1983
1984 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1985 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1986 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1987
1988 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1989 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1990 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1991 format in @value{GDBN}.
1992
1993 @need 2000
1994 @node Starting
1995 @section Starting your Program
1996 @cindex starting
1997 @cindex running
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex run
2001 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2002 @item run
2003 @itemx r
2004 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2005 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2006 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2007 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2008 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2009
2010 @end table
2011
2012 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2013 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2014 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2015 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2016 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2017 message like this one:
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2021 Try "help target" or "continue".
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2026 first (@pxref{load}).
2027
2028 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2029 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2030 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2031 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2032 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2033 divided into four categories:
2034
2035 @table @asis
2036 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2037 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2038 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2039 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2040 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2041 the arguments.
2042 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2043 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2044 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2045 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2046 below for details).
2047
2048 @item The @emph{environment.}
2049 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2050 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2051 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2052 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2053
2054 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2055 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2056 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2057 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2060 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2061 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2062 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2063 set a different device for your program.
2064 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2065
2066 @cindex pipes
2067 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2068 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2069 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2070 wrong program.
2071 @end table
2072
2073 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2074 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2075 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2076 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2077 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2078
2079 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2080 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2081 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2082 your current breakpoints.
2083
2084 @table @code
2085 @kindex start
2086 @item start
2087 @cindex run to main procedure
2088 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2089 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2090 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2091 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2092 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2093 procedure, depending on the language used.
2094
2095 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2096 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2097 the @samp{run} command.
2098
2099 @cindex elaboration phase
2100 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2101 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2102 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2103 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2104 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2105 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2106 will remain to halt execution.
2107
2108 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2109 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2110 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2111 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2112 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2113
2114 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2115 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2116 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2117 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2118 elaboration code before running your program.
2119
2120 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2121 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2122 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2123 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2124 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2125 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2126 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2127 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2128 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2129 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2130 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2131 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2132
2133 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2134 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2135 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2136 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2137
2138 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2139 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2140 environment:
2141
2142 @smallexample
2143 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2144 (@value{GDBP}) run
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2148 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2149
2150 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2151 @item set startup-with-shell
2152 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2153 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2154 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2155 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2156 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2157 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2158 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2159 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2160 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2161 startup failures such as:
2162
2163 @smallexample
2164 (@value{GDBP}) run
2165 Starting program: ./a.out
2166 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2171 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2172 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2173 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2174 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2175 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2176
2177 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2178 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2179 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2180 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2181 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2182 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2183
2184 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2185 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2186 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2187 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2188 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2189 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2190
2191 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2192 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2193 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2194
2195 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2196 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) run
2200 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2204 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2205
2206 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2207 @code{target native} command. For example,
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2211 (@value{GDBP}) run
2212 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2213 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2214 (@value{GDBP}) run
2215 Starting program: ./a.out
2216 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2220 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2221 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2222 disconnect.
2223
2224 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2225 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2226 proc}, @code{info os}.
2227
2228 @kindex set disable-randomization
2229 @item set disable-randomization
2230 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2231 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2232 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2233 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2234 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2235
2236 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2237 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2238
2239 @smallexample
2240 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2241 @end smallexample
2242
2243 @item set disable-randomization off
2244 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2245 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2246 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2247 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2248 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2249 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2250
2251 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2252 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2253 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2254 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2255 a code at its expected addresses.
2256
2257 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2258 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2259 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2260 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2261 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2262 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2263 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2264 a randomly chosen address.
2265
2266 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2267 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2268 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2269 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2270 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2271
2272 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2273 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2274
2275 @item show disable-randomization
2276 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2277 the virtual address space of the started program.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Arguments
2282 @section Your Program's Arguments
2283
2284 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2285 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2286 @code{run} command.
2287 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2288 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2289 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2290 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2291 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2292
2293 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2294 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2295 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2296 the program, not by the shell.
2297
2298 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2299 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set args
2303 @item set args
2304 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2305 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2306 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2307 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2308 it again without arguments.
2309
2310 @kindex show args
2311 @item show args
2312 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2313 @end table
2314
2315 @node Environment
2316 @section Your Program's Environment
2317
2318 @cindex environment (of your program)
2319 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2320 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2321 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2322 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2323 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2324 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2325 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex path
2329 @item path @var{directory}
2330 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2331 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2332 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2333 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2334 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2335 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2336 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2337
2338 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2339 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2340 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2341 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2342 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2343 @var{directory} to the search path.
2344 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2345 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2346
2347 @kindex show paths
2348 @item show paths
2349 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2350 environment variable).
2351
2352 @kindex show environment
2353 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2354 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2355 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2356 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2357 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2358
2359 @kindex set environment
2360 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2361 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2362 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2363 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2364 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2365 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2366 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2367 null value.
2368 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2369 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2370
2371 For example, this command:
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 set env USER = foo
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2379 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2380 are not actually required.)
2381
2382 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2383 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2384 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2385 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2386 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2387
2388 @kindex unset environment
2389 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2390 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2391 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2392 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2393 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2394 @end table
2395
2396 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2397 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2398 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2399 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2400 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2401 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2402 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2403 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2404 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2405 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2406
2407 @node Working Directory
2408 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2409
2410 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2411 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2412 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2413 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2414 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2415 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2416
2417 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2418 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2419 Specify Files}.
2420
2421 @table @code
2422 @kindex cd
2423 @cindex change working directory
2424 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2425 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2426 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2427
2428 @kindex pwd
2429 @item pwd
2430 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2434 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2435 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2436 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2437 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2438 current working directory of the debuggee.
2439
2440 @node Input/Output
2441 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2442
2443 @cindex redirection
2444 @cindex i/o
2445 @cindex terminal
2446 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2447 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2448 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2449 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2450 running your program.
2451
2452 @table @code
2453 @kindex info terminal
2454 @item info terminal
2455 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2456 program is using.
2457 @end table
2458
2459 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2460 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2461
2462 @smallexample
2463 run > outfile
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2468
2469 @kindex tty
2470 @cindex controlling terminal
2471 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2472 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2473 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2474 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2475 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2476
2477 @smallexample
2478 tty /dev/ttyb
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2483 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2484 that as their controlling terminal.
2485
2486 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2487 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2488 terminal.
2489
2490 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2491 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2492 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2493 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2494
2495 @cindex inferior tty
2496 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2497 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2498 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2499 program.
2500
2501 @table @code
2502 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2503 @kindex set inferior-tty
2504 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2505
2506 @item show inferior-tty
2507 @kindex show inferior-tty
2508 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2509 @end table
2510
2511 @node Attach
2512 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2513 @kindex attach
2514 @cindex attach
2515
2516 @table @code
2517 @item attach @var{process-id}
2518 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2519 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2520 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2521 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2522 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2523
2524 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2525 executing the command.
2526 @end table
2527
2528 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2529 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2530 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2531 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2532
2533 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2534 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2535 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2536 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2537 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2538 Specify Files}.
2539
2540 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2541 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2542 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2543 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2544 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2545 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2546 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2547
2548 @table @code
2549 @kindex detach
2550 @item detach
2551 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2552 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2553 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2554 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2555 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2556 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2557 executing the command.
2558 @end table
2559
2560 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2561 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2562 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2563 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2564 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2565 Messages}).
2566
2567 @node Kill Process
2568 @section Killing the Child Process
2569
2570 @table @code
2571 @kindex kill
2572 @item kill
2573 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2574 @end table
2575
2576 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2577 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2578 is running.
2579
2580 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2581 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2582 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2583 outside the debugger.
2584
2585 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2586 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2587 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2588 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2589 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2590 breakpoint settings).
2591
2592 @node Inferiors and Programs
2593 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2594
2595 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2596 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2597 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2598 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2599 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2600 from multiple executables.
2601
2602 @cindex inferior
2603 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2604 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2605 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2606 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2607 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2608 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2609 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2610 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2611 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2612 threads running in it.
2613
2614 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2615 inferiors}}:
2616
2617 @table @code
2618 @kindex info inferiors
2619 @item info inferiors
2620 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2621
2622 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2623
2624 @enumerate
2625 @item
2626 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2627
2628 @item
2629 the target system's inferior identifier
2630
2631 @item
2632 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2633
2634 @end enumerate
2635
2636 @noindent
2637 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2638 indicates the current inferior.
2639
2640 For example,
2641 @end table
2642 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2643
2644 @smallexample
2645 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2646 Num Description Executable
2647 2 process 2307 hello
2648 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2649 @end smallexample
2650
2651 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2652
2653 @table @code
2654 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2655 @item inferior @var{infno}
2656 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2657 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2658 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2659 @end table
2660
2661 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2662 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2663 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2664 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2665 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2666 information on convenience variables.
2667
2668 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2669 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2670 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2671 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2672 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2673 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2674
2675 @table @code
2676 @kindex add-inferior
2677 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2678 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2679 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2680 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2681 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2682 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2683
2684 @kindex clone-inferior
2685 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2686 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2687 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2688 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2689 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2690
2691 @smallexample
2692 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2693 Num Description Executable
2694 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2695 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2696 Added inferior 2.
2697 1 inferiors added.
2698 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2699 Num Description Executable
2700 2 <null> helloworld
2701 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2702 @end smallexample
2703
2704 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2705
2706 @kindex remove-inferiors
2707 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2708 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2709 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2710 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2711
2712 @end table
2713
2714 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2715 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2716 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2717 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2718
2719 @table @code
2720 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2721 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2722 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2723 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2724 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2725 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2726
2727 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2728 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2729 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2730 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2731 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2732 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2733 @end table
2734
2735 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2736 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2737 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2738 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2739
2740
2741 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2742 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2743
2744 @table @code
2745 @kindex set print inferior-events
2746 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2747 @item set print inferior-events
2748 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2749 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2750 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2751 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2752 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2753 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2754
2755 @kindex show print inferior-events
2756 @item show print inferior-events
2757 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2758 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2759 @end table
2760
2761 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2762 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2763 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2764
2765
2766 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2767 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2768 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2769 info program-spaces}} command.
2770
2771 @table @code
2772 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2773 @item maint info program-spaces
2774 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2775 @value{GDBN}.
2776
2777 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2778
2779 @enumerate
2780 @item
2781 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2782
2783 @item
2784 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2785 the @code{file} command.
2786
2787 @end enumerate
2788
2789 @noindent
2790 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2791 indicates the current program space.
2792
2793 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2794 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2795 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2796
2797 @smallexample
2798 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2799 Id Executable
2800 * 1 hello
2801 2 goodbye
2802 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2803 @end smallexample
2804
2805 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2806 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2807 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2808 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2809 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2810
2811 @smallexample
2812 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2813 Id Executable
2814 * 1 vfork-test
2815 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2816 @end smallexample
2817
2818 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2819 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2820 @end table
2821
2822 @node Threads
2823 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2824
2825 @cindex threads of execution
2826 @cindex multiple threads
2827 @cindex switching threads
2828 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2829 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2830 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2831 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2832 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2833 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2834 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2835
2836 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2837 programs:
2838
2839 @itemize @bullet
2840 @item automatic notification of new threads
2841 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2842 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2843 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2844 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2845 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2846 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2847 messages on thread start and exit.
2848 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2849 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2850 isn't compatible with the program.
2851 @end itemize
2852
2853 @cindex focus of debugging
2854 @cindex current thread
2855 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2856 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2857 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2858 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2859 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2860
2861 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2862 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2863 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2864 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2865 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2866 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2867 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2868 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2869 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2870 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2871
2872 @smallexample
2873 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2874 @end smallexample
2875
2876 @noindent
2877 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2878 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2879 further qualifier.
2880
2881 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2882 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2883 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2884 @c program?
2885 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2886 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2887 @c threads ab initio?
2888
2889 @anchor{thread numbers}
2890 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2891 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2892 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2893 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2894 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2895 between threads of different inferiors.
2896
2897 @cindex qualified thread ID
2898 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2899 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2900 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2901 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2902 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2903 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2904 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2905 inferior.
2906
2907 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2908 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2909 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2910 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2911
2912 @anchor{thread ID lists}
2913 @cindex thread ID lists
2914 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2915 argument. A list element can be:
2916
2917 @enumerate
2918 @item
2919 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2920 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2921 @samp{1}.
2922
2923 @item
2924 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
2925 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
2926 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
2927
2928 @item
2929 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
2930 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
2931 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
2932 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
2933 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
2934
2935 @end enumerate
2936
2937 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
2938 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
2939 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
2940 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
2941 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
2942 7.1}.
2943
2944
2945 @anchor{global thread numbers}
2946 @cindex global thread number
2947 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
2948 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
2949 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
2950 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
2951 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
2952 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
2953
2954 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
2955 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
2956 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
2957
2958 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2959 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
2960 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
2961 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
2962 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
2963 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
2964 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
2965 general information on convenience variables.
2966
2967 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
2968 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
2969 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
2970
2971 @smallexample
2972 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
2973 @end smallexample
2974
2975 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
2976
2977 @smallexample
2978 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
2979 @end smallexample
2980
2981 @table @code
2982 @kindex info threads
2983 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
2984
2985 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
2986 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
2987 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
2988 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
2989
2990 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2991
2992 @enumerate
2993 @item
2994 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2995
2996 @item
2997 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
2998 option was specified
2999
3000 @item
3001 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3002
3003 @item
3004 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3005 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3006 program itself.
3007
3008 @item
3009 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3010 @end enumerate
3011
3012 @noindent
3013 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3014 indicates the current thread.
3015
3016 For example,
3017 @end table
3018 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3019
3020 @smallexample
3021 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3022 Id Target Id Frame
3023 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3024 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3025 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3026 at threadtest.c:68
3027 @end smallexample
3028
3029 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3030 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3031 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3032
3033 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3034 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3035
3036 @smallexample
3037 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3038 Id GId Target Id Frame
3039 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3040 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3041 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3042 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3043 @end smallexample
3044
3045 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3046 Solaris-specific command:
3047
3048 @table @code
3049 @item maint info sol-threads
3050 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3051 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3052 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3053 @end table
3054
3055 @table @code
3056 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3057 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3058 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3059 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3060 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3061 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3062
3063 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3064 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3065
3066 @smallexample
3067 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3068 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3069 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3070 8 printf ("hello\n");
3071 @end smallexample
3072
3073 @noindent
3074 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3075 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3076 threads.
3077
3078 @kindex thread apply
3079 @cindex apply command to several threads
3080 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3081 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3082 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3083 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3084 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3085 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3086 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3087 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3088
3089
3090 @kindex thread name
3091 @cindex name a thread
3092 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3093 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3094 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3095 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3096
3097 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3098 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3099 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3100 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3101 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3102
3103 @kindex thread find
3104 @cindex search for a thread
3105 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3106 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3107 matches the supplied regular expression.
3108
3109 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3110 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3111 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3112 is the LWP id.
3113
3114 @smallexample
3115 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3116 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3117 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3118 Id Target Id Frame
3119 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3120 @end smallexample
3121
3122 @kindex set print thread-events
3123 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3124 @item set print thread-events
3125 @itemx set print thread-events on
3126 @itemx set print thread-events off
3127 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3128 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3129 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3130 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3131 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3132
3133 @kindex show print thread-events
3134 @item show print thread-events
3135 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3136 have started and exited.
3137 @end table
3138
3139 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3140 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3141 programs with multiple threads.
3142
3143 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3144 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3145
3146 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3147 @table @code
3148 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3149 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3150 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3151 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3152 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3153 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3154 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3155 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3156 macro.
3157
3158 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3159 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3160 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3161 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3162 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3163 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3164
3165 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3166 refers to the default system directories that are
3167 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3168 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3169 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3170
3171 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3172 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3173 was loaded in the inferior process.
3174
3175 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3176 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3177 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3178 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3179 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3180 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3181 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3182
3183 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3184 only on some platforms.
3185
3186 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3187 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3188 Display current libthread_db search path.
3189
3190 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3191 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3192 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3193 @item set debug libthread-db
3194 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3195 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3196 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3197 @end table
3198
3199 @node Forks
3200 @section Debugging Forks
3201
3202 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3203 @cindex multiple processes
3204 @cindex processes, multiple
3205 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3206 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3207 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3208 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3209 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3210 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3211 will cause it to terminate.
3212
3213 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3214 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3215 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3216 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3217 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3218 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3219 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3220 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3221 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3222 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3223
3224 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3225 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3226 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3227 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3228
3229 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3230 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3231 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3232
3233 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3234 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3235
3236 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3237 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3238
3239 @table @code
3240 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3241 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3242 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3243 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3244 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3245
3246 @table @code
3247 @item parent
3248 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3249 unimpeded. This is the default.
3250
3251 @item child
3252 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3253 unimpeded.
3254
3255 @end table
3256
3257 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3258 @item show follow-fork-mode
3259 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3260 @end table
3261
3262 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3263 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3264 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3265
3266 @table @code
3267 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3268 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3269 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3270 retain debugger control over them both.
3271
3272 @table @code
3273 @item on
3274 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3275 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3276 independently. This is the default.
3277
3278 @item off
3279 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3280 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3281 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3282 is held suspended.
3283
3284 @end table
3285
3286 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3287 @item show detach-on-fork
3288 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3289 @end table
3290
3291 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3292 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3293 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3294 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3295 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3296 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3297
3298 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3299 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3300 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3301 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3302 and Programs}.
3303
3304 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3305 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3306 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3307 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3308 the child process's @code{main}.
3309
3310 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3311 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3312
3313 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3314 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3315 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3316 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3317 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3318 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3319 command.
3320
3321 @table @code
3322 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3323 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3324
3325 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3326 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3327
3328 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3329
3330 @table @code
3331 @item new
3332 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3333 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3334 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3335 original inferior.
3336
3337 For example:
3338
3339 @smallexample
3340 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3341 (gdb) info inferior
3342 Id Description Executable
3343 * 1 <null> prog1
3344 (@value{GDBP}) run
3345 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3346 Program exited normally.
3347 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3348 Id Description Executable
3349 1 <null> prog1
3350 * 2 <null> prog2
3351 @end smallexample
3352
3353 @item same
3354 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3355 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3356 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3357 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3358 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3359
3360 For example:
3361
3362 @smallexample
3363 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3364 Id Description Executable
3365 * 1 <null> prog1
3366 (@value{GDBP}) run
3367 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3368 Program exited normally.
3369 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3370 Id Description Executable
3371 * 1 <null> prog2
3372 @end smallexample
3373
3374 @end table
3375 @end table
3376
3377 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3378 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3379
3380 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3381 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3382 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3383
3384 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3385 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3386
3387 @cindex checkpoint
3388 @cindex restart
3389 @cindex bookmark
3390 @cindex snapshot of a process
3391 @cindex rewind program state
3392
3393 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3394 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3395 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3396 later.
3397
3398 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3399 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3400 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3401 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3402 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3403
3404 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3405 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3406 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3407 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3408 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3409 start again from there.
3410
3411 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3412 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3413
3414 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3415
3416 @table @code
3417 @kindex checkpoint
3418 @item checkpoint
3419 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3420 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3421 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3422
3423 @kindex info checkpoints
3424 @item info checkpoints
3425 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3426 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3427 listed:
3428
3429 @table @code
3430 @item Checkpoint ID
3431 @item Process ID
3432 @item Code Address
3433 @item Source line, or label
3434 @end table
3435
3436 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3437 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3438 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3439 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3440 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3441 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3442 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3443
3444 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3445 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3446 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3447 the debugger.
3448
3449 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3450 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3451 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3452
3453 @end table
3454
3455 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3456 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3457 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3458 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3459 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3460 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3461 previously read data can be read again.
3462
3463 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3464 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3465 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3466 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3467 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3468 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3469
3470 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3471 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3472 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3473 different execution path this time.
3474
3475 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3476 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3477 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3478 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3479 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3480 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3481 potentially pose a problem.
3482
3483 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3484
3485 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3486 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3487 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3488 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3489 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3490 next.
3491
3492 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3493 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3494 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3495 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3496 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3497
3498 @node Stopping
3499 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3500
3501 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3502 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3503 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3504
3505 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3506 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3507 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3508 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3509 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3510 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3511 explicitly request this information at any time.
3512
3513 @table @code
3514 @kindex info program
3515 @item info program
3516 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3517 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3518 @end table
3519
3520 @menu
3521 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3522 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3523 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3524 Skipping over functions and files
3525 * Signals:: Signals
3526 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3527 @end menu
3528
3529 @node Breakpoints
3530 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3531
3532 @cindex breakpoints
3533 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3534 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3535 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3536 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3537 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3538 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3539 program.
3540
3541 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3542 the executable is run.
3543
3544 @cindex watchpoints
3545 @cindex data breakpoints
3546 @cindex memory tracing
3547 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3548 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3549 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3550 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3551 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3552 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3553 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3554 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3555 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3556 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3557 same commands.
3558
3559 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3560 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3561 Automatic Display}.
3562
3563 @cindex catchpoints
3564 @cindex breakpoint on events
3565 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3566 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3567 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3568 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3569 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3570 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3571 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3572
3573 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3574 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3575 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3576 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3577 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3578 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3579 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3580 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3581 enable it again.
3582
3583 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3584 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3585 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3586 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3587 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3588 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3589 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3590
3591 @menu
3592 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3593 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3594 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3595 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3596 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3597 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3598 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3599 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3600 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3601 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3602 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3603 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3604 @end menu
3605
3606 @node Set Breaks
3607 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3608
3609 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3610 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3611 @c
3612 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3613
3614 @kindex break
3615 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3616 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3617 @cindex latest breakpoint
3618 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3619 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3620 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3621 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3622 convenience variables.
3623
3624 @table @code
3625 @item break @var{location}
3626 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3627 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3628 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3629 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3630 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3631
3632 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3633 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3634 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3635 that situation.
3636
3637 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3638 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3639 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3640
3641 @item break
3642 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3643 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3644 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3645 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3646 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3647 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3648 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3649 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3650 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3651 inside loops.
3652
3653 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3654 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3655 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3656 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3657 existed when your program stopped.
3658
3659 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3660 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3661 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3662 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3663 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3664 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3665 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3666
3667 @kindex tbreak
3668 @item tbreak @var{args}
3669 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3670 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3671 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3672 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3673
3674 @kindex hbreak
3675 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3676 @item hbreak @var{args}
3677 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3678 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3679 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3680 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3681 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3682 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3683 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3684 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3685 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3686 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3687 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3688 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3689 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3690 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3691 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3692 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3693 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3694 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3695
3696 @kindex thbreak
3697 @item thbreak @var{args}
3698 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3699 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3700 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3701 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3702 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3703 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3704 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3705 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3706
3707 @kindex rbreak
3708 @cindex regular expression
3709 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3710 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3711 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3712 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3713 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3714 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3715 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3716 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3717 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3718
3719 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3720 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3721 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3722 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3723 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3724 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3725
3726 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3727 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3728 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3729 classes.
3730
3731 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3732 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3733 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3734
3735 @smallexample
3736 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3737 @end smallexample
3738
3739 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3740 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3741 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3742 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3743 every function in a given file:
3744
3745 @smallexample
3746 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3747 @end smallexample
3748
3749 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3750 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3751
3752 @kindex info breakpoints
3753 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3754 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3755 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3756 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3757 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3758 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3759 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3760
3761 @table @emph
3762 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3763 @item Type
3764 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3765 @item Disposition
3766 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3767 @item Enabled or Disabled
3768 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3769 that are not enabled.
3770 @item Address
3771 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3772 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3773 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3774 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3775 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3776 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3777 @item What
3778 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3779 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3780 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3781 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3782 @end table
3783
3784 @noindent
3785 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3786 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3787 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3788 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3789 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3790 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3791
3792 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3793 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3794 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3795 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3796
3797 @noindent
3798 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3799 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3800 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3801 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3802 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3803
3804 @noindent
3805 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3806 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3807 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3808 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3809 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3810 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3811
3812 @noindent
3813 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3814 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3815
3816 @end table
3817
3818 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3819 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3820 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3821 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3822
3823 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3824 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3825 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3826 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3827
3828 @itemize @bullet
3829 @item
3830 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3831
3832 @item
3833 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3834 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3835
3836 @item
3837 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3838 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3839
3840 @item
3841 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3842 several places where that function is inlined.
3843 @end itemize
3844
3845 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3846 the relevant locations.
3847
3848 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3849 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3850 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3851 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3852 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3853 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3854 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3855
3856 For example:
3857
3858 @smallexample
3859 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3860 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3861 stop only if i==1
3862 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3863 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3864 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3865 @end smallexample
3866
3867 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3868 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3869 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3870 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3871 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3872 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3873 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3874 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3875 that belong to that breakpoint.
3876
3877 @cindex pending breakpoints
3878 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3879 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3880 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3881 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3882 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3883 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3884 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3885 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3886 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3887 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3888 is not yet resolved.
3889
3890 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3891 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3892 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3893 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3894 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3895 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3896
3897 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3898 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3899 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3900 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3901
3902 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3903 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3904 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3905
3906 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3907 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3908 address specification to an address:
3909
3910 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3911 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3912 @table @code
3913 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3914 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3915 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3916
3917 @item set breakpoint pending on
3918 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3919 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3920
3921 @item set breakpoint pending off
3922 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3923 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3924 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3925
3926 @item show breakpoint pending
3927 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3928 @end table
3929
3930 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3931 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3932 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3933
3934 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3935 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3936 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3937 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3938 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3939 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3940 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3941 breakpoints.
3942
3943 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3944
3945 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3946 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3947 @table @code
3948 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3949 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3950 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3951 breakpoint must be used.
3952
3953 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3954 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3955 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3956 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3957 @end table
3958
3959 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3960 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3961 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3962 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3963 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3964 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3965 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3966 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3967 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3968
3969 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3970 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3971 @table @code
3972 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3973 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3974 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3975 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3976
3977 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3978 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3979 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3980 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3981 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3982 @end table
3983
3984 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3985 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3986 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3987
3988 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3989 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3990
3991 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3992
3993 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3994 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3995 @table @code
3996 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3997 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3998 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3999 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4000 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4001
4002 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4003 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4004 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4005 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4006 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4007 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4008 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4009 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4010 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4011 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4012 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4013 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4014 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4015
4016 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4017 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4018 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4019 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4020 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4021 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4022 @end table
4023
4024
4025 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4026 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4027 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4028 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4029 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4030 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4031 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4032 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4033
4034
4035 @node Set Watchpoints
4036 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4037
4038 @cindex setting watchpoints
4039 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4040 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4041 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4042 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4043 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4044
4045 @itemize @bullet
4046 @item
4047 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4048
4049 @item
4050 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4051 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4052 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4053
4054 @item
4055 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4056 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4057 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4058 @end itemize
4059
4060 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4061 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4062 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4063 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4064 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4065 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4066 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4067 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4068 the expression changes.
4069
4070 @cindex software watchpoints
4071 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4072 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4073 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4074 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4075 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4076 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4077 culprit.)
4078
4079 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4080 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4081 slow down the running of your program.
4082
4083 @table @code
4084 @kindex watch
4085 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4086 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4087 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4088 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4089 to watch the value of a single variable:
4090
4091 @smallexample
4092 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4093 @end smallexample
4094
4095 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4096 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4097 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4098 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4099 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4100 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4101
4102 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4103 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4104 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4105 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4106 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4107 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4108 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4109 error.
4110
4111 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4112 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4113 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4114 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4115 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4116 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4117 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4118 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4119 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4120 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4121 Examples:
4122
4123 @smallexample
4124 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4125 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4126 @end smallexample
4127
4128 @kindex rwatch
4129 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4130 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4131 by the program.
4132
4133 @kindex awatch
4134 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4135 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4136 or written into by the program.
4137
4138 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4139 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4140 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4141 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4142 @end table
4143
4144 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4145 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4146 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4147 a never-changing value:
4148
4149 @smallexample
4150 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4151 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4152 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4153 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4154 @end smallexample
4155
4156 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4157 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4158 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4159 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4160 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4161 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4162
4163 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4164 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4165 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4166 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4167 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4168 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4169 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4170 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4171
4172 @table @code
4173 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4174 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4175 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4176
4177 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4178 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4179 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4180 @end table
4181
4182 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4183 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4184 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4185
4186 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4187
4188 @smallexample
4189 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4190 @end smallexample
4191
4192 @noindent
4193 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4194
4195 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4196 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4197 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4198 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4199 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4200 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4201 will print a message like this:
4202
4203 @smallexample
4204 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4205 @end smallexample
4206
4207 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4208 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4209 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4210 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4211 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4212 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4213 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4214 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4215
4216 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4217 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4218 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4219 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4220 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4221 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4222
4223 @smallexample
4224 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4225 @end smallexample
4226
4227 @noindent
4228 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4229
4230 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4231 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4232 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4233 expression with separately allocated resources.
4234
4235 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4236 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4237 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4238
4239 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4240 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4241 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4242 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4243 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4244 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4245 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4246 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4247 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4248
4249 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4250 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4251 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4252 watched expression from every thread.
4253
4254 @quotation
4255 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4256 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4257 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4258 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4259 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4260 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4261 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4262 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4263 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4264 @end quotation
4265
4266 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4267
4268 @node Set Catchpoints
4269 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4270 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4271 @cindex exception handlers
4272 @cindex event handling
4273
4274 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4275 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4276 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4277
4278 @table @code
4279 @kindex catch
4280 @item catch @var{event}
4281 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4282
4283 @table @code
4284 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4285 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4286 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4287 @kindex catch throw
4288 @kindex catch rethrow
4289 @kindex catch catch
4290 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4291 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4292
4293 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4294 regular expression will be caught.
4295
4296 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4297 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4298 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4299 exception being thrown.
4300
4301 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4302 @value{GDBN}:
4303
4304 @itemize @bullet
4305 @item
4306 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4307 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4308 supported.
4309
4310 @item
4311 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4312 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4313 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4314 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4315 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4316 built.
4317
4318 @item
4319 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4320 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4321
4322 @item
4323 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4324 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4325 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4326 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4327
4328 @item
4329 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4330 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4331 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4332 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4333 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4334 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4335 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4336 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4337 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4338
4339 @item
4340 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4341
4342 @item
4343 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4344 @end itemize
4345
4346 @item exception
4347 @kindex catch exception
4348 @cindex Ada exception catching
4349 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4350 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4351 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4352 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4353 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4354
4355 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4356 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4357 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4358 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4359 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4360 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4361 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4362 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4363
4364 @item exception unhandled
4365 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4366 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4367
4368 @item assert
4369 @kindex catch assert
4370 A failed Ada assertion.
4371
4372 @item exec
4373 @kindex catch exec
4374 @cindex break on fork/exec
4375 A call to @code{exec}.
4376
4377 @item syscall
4378 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4379 @kindex catch syscall
4380 @cindex break on a system call.
4381 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4382 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4383 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4384 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4385 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4386 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4387 will be caught.
4388
4389 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4390 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4391 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4392 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4393
4394 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4395 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4396 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4397 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4398
4399 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4400 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4401 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4402 available choices.
4403
4404 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4405 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4406 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4407 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4408 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4409 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4410 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4411 behind the OS upgrades).
4412
4413 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4414 arguments to it:
4415
4416 @smallexample
4417 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4418 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4419 (@value{GDBP}) r
4420 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4421
4422 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4423 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4424 (@value{GDBP}) c
4425 Continuing.
4426
4427 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4428 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4429 (@value{GDBP})
4430 @end smallexample
4431
4432 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4433
4434 @smallexample
4435 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4436 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4437 (@value{GDBP}) r
4438 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4439
4440 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4441 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4442 (@value{GDBP}) c
4443 Continuing.
4444
4445 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4446 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4447 (@value{GDBP})
4448 @end smallexample
4449
4450 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4451 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4452 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4453
4454 @smallexample
4455 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4456 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4457 (@value{GDBP}) r
4458 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4459
4460 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4461 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4462 (@value{GDBP}) c
4463 Continuing.
4464
4465 Program exited normally.
4466 (@value{GDBP})
4467 @end smallexample
4468
4469 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4470 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4471 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4472 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4473
4474 @smallexample
4475 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4476 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4477 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4478 (@value{GDBP})
4479 @end smallexample
4480
4481 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4482 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4483 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4484 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4485 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4486 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4487
4488 @smallexample
4489 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4490 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4491 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4492 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4493 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4494 (@value{GDBP})
4495 @end smallexample
4496
4497 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4498
4499 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4500 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4501
4502 @smallexample
4503 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4504 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4505 @end smallexample
4506
4507 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4508
4509 @item fork
4510 @kindex catch fork
4511 A call to @code{fork}.
4512
4513 @item vfork
4514 @kindex catch vfork
4515 A call to @code{vfork}.
4516
4517 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4518 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4519 @kindex catch load
4520 @kindex catch unload
4521 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4522 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4523 matches one of the affected libraries.
4524
4525 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4526 @kindex catch signal
4527 The delivery of a signal.
4528
4529 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4530 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4531 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4532
4533 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4534 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4535 signal names.
4536
4537 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4538 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4539 will be caught.
4540
4541 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4542 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4543 catchpoint.
4544
4545 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4546 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4547 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4548 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4549 commands.
4550
4551 @end table
4552
4553 @item tcatch @var{event}
4554 @kindex tcatch
4555 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4556 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4557
4558 @end table
4559
4560 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4561
4562
4563 @node Delete Breaks
4564 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4565
4566 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4567 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4568 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4569 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4570 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4571 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4572
4573 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4574 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4575 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4576 their breakpoint numbers.
4577
4578 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4579 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4580 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4581
4582 @table @code
4583 @kindex clear
4584 @item clear
4585 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4586 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4587 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4588 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4589
4590 @item clear @var{location}
4591 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4592 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4593 most useful ones are listed below:
4594
4595 @table @code
4596 @item clear @var{function}
4597 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4598 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4599
4600 @item clear @var{linenum}
4601 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4602 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4603 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4604 @end table
4605
4606 @cindex delete breakpoints
4607 @kindex delete
4608 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4609 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4610 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4611 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4612 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4613 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4614 @end table
4615
4616 @node Disabling
4617 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4618
4619 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4620 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4621 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4622 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4623 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4624
4625 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4626 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4627 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4628 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4629 do not know which numbers to use.
4630
4631 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4632 affects all of its locations.
4633
4634 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4635 different states of enablement:
4636
4637 @itemize @bullet
4638 @item
4639 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4640 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4641 @item
4642 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4643 @item
4644 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4645 disabled.
4646 @item
4647 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4648 N times, then becomes disabled.
4649 @item
4650 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4651 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4652 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4653 @end itemize
4654
4655 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4656 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4657
4658 @table @code
4659 @kindex disable
4660 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4661 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4662 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4663 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4664 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4665 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4666 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4667
4668 @kindex enable
4669 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4670 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4671 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4672
4673 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4674 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4675 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4676
4677 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4678 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4679 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4680 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4681 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4682 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4683 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4684
4685 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4686 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4687 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4688 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4689 @end table
4690
4691 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4692 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4693 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4694 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4695 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4696 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4697 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4698 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4699 Stepping}.)
4700
4701 @node Conditions
4702 @subsection Break Conditions
4703 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4704 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4705
4706 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4707 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4708 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4709 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4710 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4711 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4712 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4713 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4714
4715 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4716 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4717 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4718 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4719 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4720
4721 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4722 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4723 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4724 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4725 one.
4726
4727 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4728 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4729 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4730 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4731 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4732 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4733 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4734 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4735 conditions for the
4736 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4737 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4738
4739 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4740 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4741 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4742 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4743 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4744 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4745
4746 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4747 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4748 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4749 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4750 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4751
4752 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4753 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4754 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4755 with the @code{condition} command.
4756
4757 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4758 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4759 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4760 catchpoint.
4761
4762 @table @code
4763 @kindex condition
4764 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4765 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4766 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4767 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4768 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4769 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4770 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4771 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4772 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4773 prints an error message:
4774
4775 @smallexample
4776 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4777 @end smallexample
4778
4779 @noindent
4780 @value{GDBN} does
4781 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4782 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4783 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4784
4785 @item condition @var{bnum}
4786 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4787 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4788 @end table
4789
4790 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4791 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4792 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4793 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4794 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4795 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4796 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4797 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4798 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4799 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4800 your program reaches it.
4801
4802 @table @code
4803 @kindex ignore
4804 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4805 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4806 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4807 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4808 takes no action.
4809
4810 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4811 a count of zero.
4812
4813 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4814 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4815 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4816 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4817
4818 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4819 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4820 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4821
4822 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4823 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4824 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4825 Variables}.
4826 @end table
4827
4828 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4829
4830
4831 @node Break Commands
4832 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4833
4834 @cindex breakpoint commands
4835 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4836 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4837 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4838 enable other breakpoints.
4839
4840 @table @code
4841 @kindex commands
4842 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4843 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4844 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4845 @itemx end
4846 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4847 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4848 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4849
4850 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4851 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4852
4853 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4854 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4855 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4856 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4857 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4858 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4859 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4860 Expressions}).
4861 @end table
4862
4863 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4864 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4865
4866 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4867 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4868 that resumes execution.
4869
4870 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4871 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4872 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4873 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4874 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4875
4876 @kindex silent
4877 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4878 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4879 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4880 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4881 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4882 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4883
4884 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4885 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4886 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4887
4888 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4889 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4890
4891 @smallexample
4892 break foo if x>0
4893 commands
4894 silent
4895 printf "x is %d\n",x
4896 cont
4897 end
4898 @end smallexample
4899
4900 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4901 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4902 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4903 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4904 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4905 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4906 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4907
4908 @smallexample
4909 break 403
4910 commands
4911 silent
4912 set x = y + 4
4913 cont
4914 end
4915 @end smallexample
4916
4917 @node Dynamic Printf
4918 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4919
4920 @cindex dynamic printf
4921 @cindex dprintf
4922 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4923 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4924 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4925 having to recompile it.
4926
4927 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4928 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4929 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4930 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4931 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4932 redirects to files and so forth.
4933
4934 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4935 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4936 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4937 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4938 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4939 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4940 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4941
4942 @table @code
4943 @kindex dprintf
4944 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4945 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4946 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4947 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4948
4949 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4950 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4951 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4952 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4953 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4954 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4955
4956 @item gdb
4957 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4958 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4959
4960 @item call
4961 @kindex dprintf-style call
4962 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4963 @code{printf}).
4964
4965 @item agent
4966 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4967 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4968 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4969 support running commands on the target.
4970
4971 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4972 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4973 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4974 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4975 command.
4976
4977 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4978 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4979 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4980 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4981 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4982 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4983
4984 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4985 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4986 you could do the following:
4987
4988 @example
4989 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4990 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4991 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4992 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4993 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4994 (gdb) info break
4995 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4996 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4997 continue
4998 (gdb)
4999 @end example
5000
5001 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5002 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5003 the variable settings.
5004
5005 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5006 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5007 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5008 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5009 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5010 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5011
5012 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5013 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5014 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5015
5016 @end table
5017
5018 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5019 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5020 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5021 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5022 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5023 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5024
5025 @node Save Breakpoints
5026 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5027
5028 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5029 breakpoints}} command.
5030
5031 @table @code
5032 @kindex save breakpoints
5033 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5034 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5035 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5036 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5037 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5038 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5039 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5040 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5041 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5042 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5043 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5044 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5045 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5046 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5047 that can no longer be recreated.
5048 @end table
5049
5050 @node Static Probe Points
5051 @subsection Static Probe Points
5052
5053 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5054 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5055 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5056 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5057 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5058
5059 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5060 ELF-compatible systems:
5061
5062 @itemize @bullet
5063
5064 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5065 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5066 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5067 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5068 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5069 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5070 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5071 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5072
5073 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5074 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5075 C@t{++} languages.
5076 @end itemize
5077
5078 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5079 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5080 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5081 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5082 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5083 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5084 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5085 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5086 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5087
5088 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5089 probes}, with optional arguments:
5090
5091 @table @code
5092 @kindex info probes
5093 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5094 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5095 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5096 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5097
5098 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5099 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5100 probes from all providers are listed.
5101
5102 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5103 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5104 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5105
5106 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5107 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5108 given, all object files are considered.
5109
5110 @item info probes all
5111 List the available static probes, from all types.
5112 @end table
5113
5114 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5115 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5116 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5117 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5118 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5119
5120 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5121 commands, with optional arguments:
5122
5123 @table @code
5124 @kindex enable probes
5125 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5126 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5127 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5128 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5129
5130 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5131 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5132 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5133
5134 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5135 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5136 given, all object files are considered.
5137
5138 @kindex disable probes
5139 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5140 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5141 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5142 @end table
5143
5144 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5145 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5146 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5147 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5148 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5149 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5150 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5151 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5152 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5153 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5154 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5155 at the current probe point.
5156
5157 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5158 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5159 an error message.
5160
5161
5162 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5163 @node Error in Breakpoints
5164 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5165
5166 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5167 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5168
5169 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5170 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5171 @smallexample
5172 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5173 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5174 @end smallexample
5175
5176 @noindent
5177 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5178 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5179 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5180
5181 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5182 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5183
5184 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5185 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5186 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5187
5188 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5189 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5190 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5191 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5192
5193 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5194 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5195 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5196 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5197 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5198 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5199 first in the bundle.
5200
5201 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5202 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5203 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5204 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5205 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5206 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5207 is hit.
5208
5209 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5210 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5211
5212 @smallexample
5213 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5214 @end smallexample
5215
5216 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5217 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5218 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5219 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5220 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5221 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5222 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5223 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5224
5225 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5226 adjusted breakpoints:
5227
5228 @smallexample
5229 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5230 to 0x00010410.
5231 @end smallexample
5232
5233 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5234 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5235 frequently than expected.
5236
5237 @node Continuing and Stepping
5238 @section Continuing and Stepping
5239
5240 @cindex stepping
5241 @cindex continuing
5242 @cindex resuming execution
5243 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5244 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5245 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5246 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5247 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5248 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5249 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5250 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5251 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5252 handlers}).)
5253
5254 @table @code
5255 @kindex continue
5256 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5257 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5258 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5259 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5260 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5261 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5262 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5263 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5264 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5265 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5266
5267 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5268 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5269 @code{continue} is ignored.
5270
5271 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5272 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5273 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5274 @code{continue}.
5275 @end table
5276
5277 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5278 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5279 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5280 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5281
5282 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5283 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5284 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5285 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5286 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5287 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5288
5289 @table @code
5290 @kindex step
5291 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5292 @item step
5293 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5294 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5295 abbreviated @code{s}.
5296
5297 @quotation
5298 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5299 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5300 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5301 @c distinction here.
5302 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5303 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5304 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5305 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5306 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5307 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5308 below.
5309 @end quotation
5310
5311 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5312 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5313 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5314 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5315 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5316 called within the line.
5317
5318 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5319 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5320 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5321 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5322 was any debugging information about the routine.
5323
5324 @item step @var{count}
5325 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5326 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5327 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5328
5329 @kindex next
5330 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5331 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5332 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5333 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5334 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5335 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5336 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5337 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5338
5339 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5340
5341
5342 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5343 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5344 @c
5345 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5346 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5347 @c function are executed without stopping.
5348
5349 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5350 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5351 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5352
5353 @kindex set step-mode
5354 @item set step-mode
5355 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5356 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5357 @itemx set step-mode on
5358 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5359 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5360 information rather than stepping over it.
5361
5362 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5363 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5364 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5365
5366 @item set step-mode off
5367 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5368 debug information. This is the default.
5369
5370 @item show step-mode
5371 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5372 source line debug information.
5373
5374 @kindex finish
5375 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5376 @item finish
5377 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5378 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5379 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5380
5381 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5382 ,Returning from a Function}).
5383
5384 @kindex until
5385 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5386 @cindex run until specified location
5387 @item until
5388 @itemx u
5389 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5390 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5391 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5392 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5393 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5394 than the address of the jump.
5395
5396 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5397 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5398 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5399 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5400 through the next iteration.
5401
5402 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5403 stack frame.
5404
5405 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5406 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5407 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5408 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5409 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5410
5411 @smallexample
5412 (@value{GDBP}) f
5413 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5414 206 expand_input();
5415 (@value{GDBP}) until
5416 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5417 @end smallexample
5418
5419 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5420 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5421 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5422 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5423 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5424 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5425 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5426
5427 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5428 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5429 argument.
5430
5431 @item until @var{location}
5432 @itemx u @var{location}
5433 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5434 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5435 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5436 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5437 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5438 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5439 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5440 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5441 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5442 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5443 invocations have returned.
5444
5445 @smallexample
5446 94 int factorial (int value)
5447 95 @{
5448 96 if (value > 1) @{
5449 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5450 98 @}
5451 99 return (value);
5452 100 @}
5453 @end smallexample
5454
5455
5456 @kindex advance @var{location}
5457 @item advance @var{location}
5458 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5459 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5460 @ref{Specify Location}.
5461 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5462 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5463 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5464 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5465
5466
5467 @kindex stepi
5468 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5469 @item stepi
5470 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5471 @itemx si
5472 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5473
5474 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5475 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5476 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5477 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5478
5479 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5480
5481 @need 750
5482 @kindex nexti
5483 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5484 @item nexti
5485 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5486 @itemx ni
5487 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5488 proceed until the function returns.
5489
5490 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5491
5492 @end table
5493
5494 @anchor{range stepping}
5495 @cindex range stepping
5496 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5497 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5498 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5499 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5500 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5501 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5502 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5503 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5504 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5505 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5506 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5507 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5508 if necessary:
5509
5510 @table @code
5511 @kindex set range-stepping
5512 @kindex show range-stepping
5513 @item set range-stepping
5514 @itemx show range-stepping
5515 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5516
5517 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5518 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5519 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5520 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5521 default is @code{on}.
5522
5523 @end table
5524
5525 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5526 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5527 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5528
5529 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5530 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5531 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5532 a particular file when stepping.
5533
5534 For example, consider the following C function:
5535
5536 @smallexample
5537 101 int func()
5538 102 @{
5539 103 foo(boring());
5540 104 bar(boring());
5541 105 @}
5542 @end smallexample
5543
5544 @noindent
5545 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5546 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5547 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5548 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5549
5550 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5551 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5552 is called from many places.
5553
5554 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5555 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5556 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5557 @code{foo}.
5558
5559 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5560 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5561 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5562
5563 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5564 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5565 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5566 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5567 the underlying system.
5568 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5569 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5570
5571 @table @code
5572 @kindex skip
5573 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5574 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5575 that specify what to skip.
5576 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5577
5578 @table @code
5579 @item -file @var{file}
5580 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5581 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5582
5583 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5584 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5585 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5586 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5587 over when stepping.
5588
5589 @smallexample
5590 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5591 @end smallexample
5592
5593 @item -function @var{linespec}
5594 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5595 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5596 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5597 @xref{Specify Location}.
5598
5599 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5600 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5601 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5602 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5603
5604 This form is useful for complex function names.
5605 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5606 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5607 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5608 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5609 regular expression makes this easier.
5610
5611 @smallexample
5612 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5613 @end smallexample
5614
5615 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5616 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5617
5618 @smallexample
5619 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5620 @end smallexample
5621 @end table
5622
5623 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5624 will be skipped.
5625
5626 @kindex skip function
5627 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5628 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5629 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5630 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5631
5632 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5633 will be skipped.
5634
5635 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5636 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5637
5638 @kindex skip file
5639 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5640 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5641 will be skipped over when stepping.
5642
5643 @smallexample
5644 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5645 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5646 @end smallexample
5647
5648 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5649 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5650 @end table
5651
5652 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5653 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5654
5655 @table @code
5656 @kindex info skip
5657 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5658 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5659 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5660 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5661
5662 @table @emph
5663 @item Identifier
5664 A number identifying this skip.
5665 @item Enabled or Disabled
5666 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5667 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5668 @item Glob
5669 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5670 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5671 @item File
5672 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5673 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5674 @item RE
5675 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5676 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5677 @item Function
5678 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5679 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5680 @end table
5681
5682 @kindex skip delete
5683 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5684 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5685 skips.
5686
5687 @kindex skip enable
5688 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5689 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5690 skips.
5691
5692 @kindex skip disable
5693 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5694 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5695 skips.
5696
5697 @end table
5698
5699 @node Signals
5700 @section Signals
5701 @cindex signals
5702
5703 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5704 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5705 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5706 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5707 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5708 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5709 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5710 requested an alarm).
5711
5712 @cindex fatal signals
5713 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5714 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5715 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5716 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5717 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5718 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5719
5720 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5721 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5722 signal.
5723
5724 @cindex handling signals
5725 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5726 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5727 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5728 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5729 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5730
5731 @table @code
5732 @kindex info signals
5733 @kindex info handle
5734 @item info signals
5735 @itemx info handle
5736 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5737 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5738 the defined types of signals.
5739
5740 @item info signals @var{sig}
5741 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5742
5743 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5744
5745 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5746 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5747 for details about this command.
5748
5749 @kindex handle
5750 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5751 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5752 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5753 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5754 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5755 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5756 say what change to make.
5757 @end table
5758
5759 @c @group
5760 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5761 Their full names are:
5762
5763 @table @code
5764 @item nostop
5765 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5766 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5767
5768 @item stop
5769 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5770 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5771
5772 @item print
5773 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5774
5775 @item noprint
5776 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5777 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5778
5779 @item pass
5780 @itemx noignore
5781 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5782 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5783 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5784
5785 @item nopass
5786 @itemx ignore
5787 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5788 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5789 @end table
5790 @c @end group
5791
5792 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5793 program until you
5794 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5795 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5796 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5797 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5798 program sees that signal when you continue.
5799
5800 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5801 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5802 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5803 erroneous signals.
5804
5805 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5806 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5807 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5808 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5809 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5810 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5811 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5812 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5813 Program a Signal}.
5814
5815 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5816 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5817
5818 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5819 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5820 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5821 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5822 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5823 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5824 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5825 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5826 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5827 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5828 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5829 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5830 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5831
5832 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5833
5834 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5835 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5836 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5837 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5838
5839 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5840 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5841 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5842 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5843
5844 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5845 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5846
5847 @smallexample
5848 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5849 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5850 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5851 (@value{GDBP}) c
5852 Continuing.
5853
5854 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5855 main () sigusr1.c:28
5856 28 p = 0;
5857 (@value{GDBP}) si
5858 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5859 9 @{
5860 @end smallexample
5861
5862 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5863 program to receive the signal first:
5864
5865 @smallexample
5866 (@value{GDBP}) n
5867 28 p = 0;
5868 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5869 (@value{GDBP}) si
5870 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5871 9 @{
5872 (@value{GDBP})
5873 @end smallexample
5874
5875 @cindex extra signal information
5876 @anchor{extra signal information}
5877
5878 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5879 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5880 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5881 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5882 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5883 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5884 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5885 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5886 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5887 system header.
5888
5889 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5890 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5891
5892 @smallexample
5893 @group
5894 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5895 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5896 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5897 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5898 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5899 type = struct @{
5900 int si_signo;
5901 int si_errno;
5902 int si_code;
5903 union @{
5904 int _pad[28];
5905 struct @{...@} _kill;
5906 struct @{...@} _timer;
5907 struct @{...@} _rt;
5908 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5909 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5910 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5911 @} _sifields;
5912 @}
5913 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5914 type = struct @{
5915 void *si_addr;
5916 @}
5917 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5918 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5919 @end group
5920 @end smallexample
5921
5922 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5923
5924 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
5925 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
5926 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
5927 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
5928 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
5929 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
5930 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
5931 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
5932 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
5933 information is displayed.
5934
5935 The usual output of a segfault is:
5936 @smallexample
5937 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5938 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5939 68 value = *(p + len);
5940 @end smallexample
5941
5942 While a bound violation is presented as:
5943 @smallexample
5944 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5945 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
5946 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
5947 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5948 68 value = *(p + len);
5949 @end smallexample
5950
5951 @node Thread Stops
5952 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5953
5954 @cindex stopped threads
5955 @cindex threads, stopped
5956
5957 @cindex continuing threads
5958 @cindex threads, continuing
5959
5960 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5961 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5962 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5963 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5964 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5965 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5966 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5967 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5968 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5969
5970 @menu
5971 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5972 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5973 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5974 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5975 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5976 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5977 @end menu
5978
5979 @node All-Stop Mode
5980 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5981
5982 @cindex all-stop mode
5983
5984 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5985 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5986 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5987 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5988 underfoot.
5989
5990 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5991 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5992 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5993
5994 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5995 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5996 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5997 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5998 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5999 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6000 stops.
6001
6002 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6003 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6004 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6005 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6006
6007 @cindex automatic thread selection
6008 @cindex switching threads automatically
6009 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6010 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6011 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6012 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6013 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6014 thread.
6015
6016 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6017 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6018
6019 @table @code
6020 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6021 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6022 @cindex lock scheduler
6023 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6024 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6025 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6026 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6027 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6028 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6029 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6030 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6031 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6032 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6033 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6034 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6035 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6036 @code{on} in replay mode.
6037
6038 @item show scheduler-locking
6039 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6040 @end table
6041
6042 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6043 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6044 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6045 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6046 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6047 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6048 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6049 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6050 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6051 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6052 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6053 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6054 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6055 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6056
6057 @table @code
6058 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6059 @item set schedule-multiple
6060 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6061 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6062 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6063 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6064 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6065 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6066
6067 @item show schedule-multiple
6068 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6069 multiple processes.
6070 @end table
6071
6072 @node Non-Stop Mode
6073 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6074
6075 @cindex non-stop mode
6076
6077 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6078 @c with more details.
6079
6080 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6081 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6082 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6083 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6084 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6085 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6086
6087 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6088 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6089 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6090 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6091 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6092 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6093 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6094 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6095 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6096 independently and simultaneously.
6097
6098 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6099 or attach to your program:
6100
6101 @smallexample
6102 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6103 set pagination off
6104
6105 # Finally, turn it on!
6106 set non-stop on
6107 @end smallexample
6108
6109 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6110
6111 @table @code
6112 @kindex set non-stop
6113 @item set non-stop on
6114 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6115 @item set non-stop off
6116 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6117 @kindex show non-stop
6118 @item show non-stop
6119 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6120 @end table
6121
6122 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6123 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6124 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6125 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6126 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6127 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6128 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6129 default.
6130
6131 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6132 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6133 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6134
6135 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6136 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6137 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6138 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6139 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6140
6141 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6142 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6143 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6144 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6145 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6146
6147 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6148
6149 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6150 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6151 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6152 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6153 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6154 previously current thread.
6155
6156 @node Background Execution
6157 @subsection Background Execution
6158
6159 @cindex foreground execution
6160 @cindex background execution
6161 @cindex asynchronous execution
6162 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6163
6164 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6165 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6166 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6167 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6168 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6169 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6170
6171 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6172 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6173
6174 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6175 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6176 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6177 are:
6178
6179 @table @code
6180 @kindex run&
6181 @item run
6182 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6183
6184 @item attach
6185 @kindex attach&
6186 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6187
6188 @item step
6189 @kindex step&
6190 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6191
6192 @item stepi
6193 @kindex stepi&
6194 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6195
6196 @item next
6197 @kindex next&
6198 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6199
6200 @item nexti
6201 @kindex nexti&
6202 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6203
6204 @item continue
6205 @kindex continue&
6206 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6207
6208 @item finish
6209 @kindex finish&
6210 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6211
6212 @item until
6213 @kindex until&
6214 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6215
6216 @end table
6217
6218 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6219 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6220 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6221 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6222 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6223 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6224
6225 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6226 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6227
6228 @table @code
6229 @kindex interrupt
6230 @item interrupt
6231 @itemx interrupt -a
6232
6233 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6234 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6235 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6236 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6237 @end table
6238
6239 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6240 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6241
6242 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6243 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6244 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6245
6246 @table @code
6247 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6248 @cindex thread breakpoints
6249 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6250 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6251 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6252 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6253 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6254 specify some source line.
6255
6256 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6257 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6258 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6259 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6260 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6261
6262 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6263 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6264 program.
6265
6266 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6267 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6268 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6269
6270 @smallexample
6271 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6272 @end smallexample
6273
6274 @end table
6275
6276 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6277 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6278 thread list. For example:
6279
6280 @smallexample
6281 (@value{GDBP}) c
6282 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6283 @end smallexample
6284
6285 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6286 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6287 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6288 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6289 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6290 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6291 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6292 command.
6293
6294 @node Interrupted System Calls
6295 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6296
6297 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6298 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6299 @cindex premature return from system calls
6300 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6301 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6302 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6303 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6304 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6305 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6306 stop execution.
6307
6308 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6309 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6310 style anyways.
6311
6312 For example, do not write code like this:
6313
6314 @smallexample
6315 sleep (10);
6316 @end smallexample
6317
6318 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6319 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6320
6321 Instead, write this:
6322
6323 @smallexample
6324 int unslept = 10;
6325 while (unslept > 0)
6326 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6327 @end smallexample
6328
6329 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6330 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6331 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6332 @value{GDBN}.
6333
6334 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6335 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6336 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6337 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6338
6339 @node Observer Mode
6340 @subsection Observer Mode
6341
6342 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6343 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6344 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6345 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6346 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6347
6348 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6349 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6350 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6351 mode.
6352
6353 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6354 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6355 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6356 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6357 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6358
6359 @table @code
6360
6361 @kindex observer
6362 @item set observer on
6363 @itemx set observer off
6364 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6365 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6366 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6367 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6368
6369 @item show observer
6370 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6371
6372 @kindex may-write-registers
6373 @item set may-write-registers on
6374 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6375 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6376 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6377 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6378
6379 @item show may-write-registers
6380 Show the current permission to write registers.
6381
6382 @kindex may-write-memory
6383 @item set may-write-memory on
6384 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6385 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6386 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6387 defaults to @code{on}.
6388
6389 @item show may-write-memory
6390 Show the current permission to write memory.
6391
6392 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6393 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6394 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6395 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6396 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6397 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6398
6399 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6400 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6401
6402 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6403 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6404 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6405 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6406 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6407 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6408 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6409
6410 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6411 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6412
6413 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6414 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6415 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6416 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6417 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6418 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6419 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6420
6421 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6422 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6423
6424 @kindex may-interrupt
6425 @item set may-interrupt on
6426 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6427 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6428 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6429 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6430 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6431
6432 @item show may-interrupt
6433 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6434
6435 @end table
6436
6437 @node Reverse Execution
6438 @chapter Running programs backward
6439 @cindex reverse execution
6440 @cindex running programs backward
6441
6442 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6443 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6444 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6445 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6446
6447 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6448 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6449 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6450 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6451 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6452 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6453
6454 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6455 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6456 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6457 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6458 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6459 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6460 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6461 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6462 prior values@footnote{
6463 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6464 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6465 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6466
6467 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6468 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6469 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6470 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6471 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6472 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6473 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6474 }.
6475
6476 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6477 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6478
6479 @table @code
6480 @kindex reverse-continue
6481 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6482 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6483 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6484 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6485 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6486 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6487 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6488
6489 @kindex reverse-step
6490 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6491 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6492 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6493 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6494
6495 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6496 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6497 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6498 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6499 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6500 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6501
6502 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6503 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6504
6505 @kindex reverse-stepi
6506 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6507 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6508 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6509 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6510 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6511 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6512 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6513
6514 @kindex reverse-next
6515 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6516 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6517 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6518 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6519 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6520 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6521 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6522 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6523 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6524 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6525
6526 @kindex reverse-nexti
6527 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6528 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6529 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6530 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6531 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6532 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6533 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6534 frame) is reached.
6535
6536 @kindex reverse-finish
6537 @item reverse-finish
6538 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6539 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6540 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6541 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6542
6543 @kindex set exec-direction
6544 @item set exec-direction
6545 Set the direction of target execution.
6546 @item set exec-direction reverse
6547 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6548 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6549 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6550 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6551 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6552 @item set exec-direction forward
6553 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6554 This is the default.
6555 @end table
6556
6557
6558 @node Process Record and Replay
6559 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6560 @cindex process record and replay
6561 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6562
6563 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6564 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6565 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6566
6567 @cindex replay mode
6568 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6569 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6570 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6571 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6572 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6573 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6574 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6575 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6576 execution log.
6577
6578 @cindex record mode
6579 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6580 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6581 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6582 for future replay.
6583
6584 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6585 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6586 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6587 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6588 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6589 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6590
6591 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6592 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6593 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6594 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6595
6596 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6597 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6598
6599 @table @code
6600 @kindex target record
6601 @kindex target record-full
6602 @kindex target record-btrace
6603 @kindex record
6604 @kindex record full
6605 @kindex record btrace
6606 @kindex record btrace bts
6607 @kindex record btrace pt
6608 @kindex record bts
6609 @kindex record pt
6610 @kindex rec
6611 @kindex rec full
6612 @kindex rec btrace
6613 @kindex rec btrace bts
6614 @kindex rec btrace pt
6615 @kindex rec bts
6616 @kindex rec pt
6617 @item record @var{method}
6618 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6619 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6620 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6621 recording methods are available:
6622
6623 @table @code
6624 @item full
6625 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6626 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6627 execution.
6628
6629 @item btrace @var{format}
6630 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6631 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6632 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6633 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6634 execution.
6635
6636 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6637 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6638 formats are available:
6639
6640 @table @code
6641 @item bts
6642 @cindex branch trace store
6643 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6644 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6645 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6646
6647 @item pt
6648 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6649 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6650 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6651 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6652
6653 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6654 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6655 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6656
6657 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6658 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6659 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6660 buffer-size with care.
6661 @end table
6662
6663 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6664 @end table
6665
6666 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6667 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6668 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6669 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6670
6671 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6672 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6673 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6674 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6675 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6676
6677 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6678 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6679 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6680 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6681 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6682 does not support these two modes.
6683
6684 @kindex record stop
6685 @kindex rec s
6686 @item record stop
6687 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6688 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6689 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6690
6691 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6692 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6693 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6694 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6695 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6696
6697 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6698 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6699 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6700 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6701 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6702
6703 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6704 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6705
6706 @kindex record goto
6707 @item record goto
6708 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6709 ways to specify the location to go to:
6710
6711 @table @code
6712 @item record goto begin
6713 @itemx record goto start
6714 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6715
6716 @item record goto end
6717 Go to the end of the execution log.
6718
6719 @item record goto @var{n}
6720 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6721 @end table
6722
6723 @kindex record save
6724 @item record save @var{filename}
6725 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6726 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6727 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6728
6729 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6730
6731 @kindex record restore
6732 @item record restore @var{filename}
6733 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6734 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6735
6736 @kindex set record full
6737 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6738 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6739 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6740 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6741
6742 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6743 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6744 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6745 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6746 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6747 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6748 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6749 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6750
6751 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6752 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6753 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6754
6755 @kindex show record full
6756 @item show record full insn-number-max
6757 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6758 recording method.
6759
6760 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6761 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6762 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6763 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6764 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6765 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6766 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6767 oldest one to be deleted.
6768
6769 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6770 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6771
6772 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6773 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6774
6775 @item set record full memory-query
6776 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6777 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6778 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6779 case.
6780
6781 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6782 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6783 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6784 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6785 results.
6786
6787 @item show record full memory-query
6788 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6789
6790 @kindex set record btrace
6791 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6792 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6793 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6794 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6795 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6796 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6797 You can use the following command for that:
6798
6799 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6800 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6801 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6802 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6803 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6804 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6805 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6806 position.
6807
6808 @kindex show record btrace
6809 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6810 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6811
6812 @kindex set record btrace bts
6813 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6814 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6815 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6816 format. Default is 64KB.
6817
6818 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6819 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6820 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6821 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6822 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6823 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6824 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6825
6826 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6827 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6828
6829 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6830 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6831
6832 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6833 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6834 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6835
6836 @kindex set record btrace pt
6837 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6838 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6839 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6840 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6841
6842 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6843 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6844 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6845 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6846 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6847 actual buffer size for each thread.
6848
6849 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6850 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6851
6852 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6853 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6854
6855 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6856 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6857 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6858
6859 @kindex info record
6860 @item info record
6861 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6862 method:
6863
6864 @table @code
6865 @item full
6866 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6867 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6868
6869 @itemize @bullet
6870 @item
6871 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6872 @item
6873 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6874 @item
6875 Highest recorded instruction number.
6876 @item
6877 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6878 @item
6879 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6880 @item
6881 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6882 @end itemize
6883
6884 @item btrace
6885 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6886
6887 @itemize @bullet
6888 @item
6889 Recording format.
6890 @item
6891 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6892 @item
6893 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6894 instructions.
6895 @item
6896 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6897 @end itemize
6898
6899 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6900 @itemize @bullet
6901 @item
6902 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6903 @end itemize
6904
6905 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6906 @itemize @bullet
6907 @item
6908 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6909 @end itemize
6910 @end table
6911
6912 @kindex record delete
6913 @kindex rec del
6914 @item record delete
6915 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6916 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6917 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6918 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6919
6920 @kindex record instruction-history
6921 @kindex rec instruction-history
6922 @item record instruction-history
6923 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6924 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6925 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6926 are printed in execution order.
6927
6928 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
6929 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
6930 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
6931
6932 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
6933 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
6934 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
6935 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
6936 @code{/p} modifier.
6937
6938 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
6939 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
6940 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
6941
6942 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
6943 feature is not available for all recording formats.
6944
6945 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6946 disassemble:
6947
6948 @table @code
6949 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6950 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6951 @var{insn}.
6952
6953 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6954 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6955 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6956 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6957 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6958 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6959
6960 @item record instruction-history
6961 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6962
6963 @item record instruction-history -
6964 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6965
6966 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
6967 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6968 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6969 number @var{end} is included.
6970 @end table
6971
6972 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6973
6974 @kindex set record
6975 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6976 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6977 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6978 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6979 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6980
6981 @kindex show record
6982 @item show record instruction-history-size
6983 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6984 instruction-history} command.
6985
6986 @kindex record function-call-history
6987 @kindex rec function-call-history
6988 @item record function-call-history
6989 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6990 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6991 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6992 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6993 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6994 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6995 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6996 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6997 given together.
6998
6999 @smallexample
7000 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7001 1 void foo (void)
7002 2 @{
7003 3 @}
7004 4
7005 5 void bar (void)
7006 6 @{
7007 7 ...
7008 8 foo ();
7009 9 ...
7010 10 @}
7011 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7012 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7013 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7014 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7015 @end smallexample
7016
7017 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7018 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7019 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7020 to print:
7021
7022 @table @code
7023 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7024 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7025
7026 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7027 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7028 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7029 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7030 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7031
7032 @item record function-call-history
7033 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7034
7035 @item record function-call-history -
7036 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7037
7038 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7039 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7040 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7041 @end table
7042
7043 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7044
7045 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7046 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7047 Define how many lines to print in the
7048 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7049 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7050
7051 @item show record function-call-history-size
7052 Show how many lines to print in the
7053 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7054 @end table
7055
7056
7057 @node Stack
7058 @chapter Examining the Stack
7059
7060 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7061 stopped and how it got there.
7062
7063 @cindex call stack
7064 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7065 is generated.
7066 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7067 the arguments of the call,
7068 and the local variables of the function being called.
7069 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7070 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7071 stack}.
7072
7073 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7074 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7075
7076 @cindex selected frame
7077 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7078 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7079 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7080 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7081 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7082 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7083
7084 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7085 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7086 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7087
7088 @menu
7089 * Frames:: Stack frames
7090 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7091 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7092 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7093 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7094
7095 @end menu
7096
7097 @node Frames
7098 @section Stack Frames
7099
7100 @cindex frame, definition
7101 @cindex stack frame
7102 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7103 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7104 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7105 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7106 which the function is executing.
7107
7108 @cindex initial frame
7109 @cindex outermost frame
7110 @cindex innermost frame
7111 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7112 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7113 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7114 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7115 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7116 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7117 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7118 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7119
7120 @cindex frame pointer
7121 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7122 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7123 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7124 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7125 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7126 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7127
7128 @cindex frame number
7129 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7130 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7131 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7132 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7133 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7134
7135 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7136 @c underflow problems.
7137 @cindex frameless execution
7138 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7139 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7140 @smallexample
7141 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7142 @end smallexample
7143 generates functions without a frame.)
7144 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7145 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7146 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7147 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7148 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7149 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7150 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7151
7152 @node Backtrace
7153 @section Backtraces
7154
7155 @cindex traceback
7156 @cindex call stack traces
7157 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7158 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7159 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7160 stack.
7161
7162 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7163 @table @code
7164 @kindex backtrace
7165 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7166 @item backtrace
7167 @itemx bt
7168 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7169 frames in the stack.
7170
7171 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7172 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7173
7174 @item backtrace @var{n}
7175 @itemx bt @var{n}
7176 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7177
7178 @item backtrace -@var{n}
7179 @itemx bt -@var{n}
7180 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7181
7182 @item backtrace full
7183 @itemx bt full
7184 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7185 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7186 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7187 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7188
7189 @item backtrace no-filters
7190 @itemx bt no-filters
7191 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7192 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7193 @itemx bt no-filters full
7194 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7195 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7196 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7197 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7198 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7199 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7200 support.
7201 @end table
7202
7203 @kindex where
7204 @kindex info stack
7205 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7206 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7207
7208 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7209 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7210 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7211 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7212 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7213 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7214 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7215 multi-threaded program.
7216
7217 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7218 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7219 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7220 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7221 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7222 line number.
7223
7224 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7225 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7226
7227 @smallexample
7228 @group
7229 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7230 at builtin.c:993
7231 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7232 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7233 at macro.c:71
7234 (More stack frames follow...)
7235 @end group
7236 @end smallexample
7237
7238 @noindent
7239 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7240 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7241 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7242
7243 @noindent
7244 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7245 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7246 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7247 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7248 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7249
7250 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7251 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7252 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7253 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7254 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7255 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7256 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7257 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7258 such a backtrace might look like:
7259
7260 @smallexample
7261 @group
7262 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7263 at builtin.c:993
7264 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7265 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7266 at macro.c:71
7267 (More stack frames follow...)
7268 @end group
7269 @end smallexample
7270
7271 @noindent
7272 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7273 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7274
7275 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7276 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7277 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7278
7279 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7280 @cindex program entry point
7281 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7282 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7283 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7284 @code{main}@footnote{
7285 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7286 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7287 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7288 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7289 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7290 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7291
7292 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7293 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7294
7295 @table @code
7296 @item set backtrace past-main
7297 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7298 @kindex set backtrace
7299 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7300
7301 @item set backtrace past-main off
7302 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7303 default.
7304
7305 @item show backtrace past-main
7306 @kindex show backtrace
7307 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7308
7309 @item set backtrace past-entry
7310 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7311 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7312 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7313 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7314
7315 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7316 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7317 application. This is the default.
7318
7319 @item show backtrace past-entry
7320 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7321
7322 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7323 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7324 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7325 @cindex backtrace limit
7326 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7327 or zero means unlimited levels.
7328
7329 @item show backtrace limit
7330 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7331 @end table
7332
7333 You can control how file names are displayed.
7334
7335 @table @code
7336 @item set filename-display
7337 @itemx set filename-display relative
7338 @cindex filename-display
7339 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7340
7341 @item set filename-display basename
7342 Display only basename of a filename.
7343
7344 @item set filename-display absolute
7345 Display an absolute filename.
7346
7347 @item show filename-display
7348 Show the current way to display filenames.
7349 @end table
7350
7351 @node Selection
7352 @section Selecting a Frame
7353
7354 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7355 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7356 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7357 of the stack frame just selected.
7358
7359 @table @code
7360 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7361 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7362 @item frame @var{n}
7363 @itemx f @var{n}
7364 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7365 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7366 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7367 @code{main}.
7368
7369 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7370 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7371 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7372 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7373 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7374 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7375 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7376 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7377
7378 @kindex up
7379 @item up @var{n}
7380 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7381 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7382 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7383
7384 @kindex down
7385 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7386 @item down @var{n}
7387 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7388 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7389 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7390 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7391 @end table
7392
7393 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7394 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7395 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7396 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7397
7398 @need 1000
7399 For example:
7400
7401 @smallexample
7402 @group
7403 (@value{GDBP}) up
7404 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7405 at env.c:10
7406 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7407 @end group
7408 @end smallexample
7409
7410 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7411 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7412 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7413 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7414 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7415 for details.
7416
7417 @table @code
7418 @kindex select-frame
7419 @item select-frame
7420 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7421 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7422 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7423 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7424
7425 @kindex down-silently
7426 @kindex up-silently
7427 @item up-silently @var{n}
7428 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7429 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7430 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7431 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7432 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7433 distracting.
7434 @end table
7435
7436 @node Frame Info
7437 @section Information About a Frame
7438
7439 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7440 stack frame.
7441
7442 @table @code
7443 @item frame
7444 @itemx f
7445 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7446 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7447 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7448 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7449 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7450
7451 @kindex info frame
7452 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7453 @item info frame
7454 @itemx info f
7455 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7456 including:
7457
7458 @itemize @bullet
7459 @item
7460 the address of the frame
7461 @item
7462 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7463 @item
7464 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7465 @item
7466 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7467 @item
7468 the address of the frame's arguments
7469 @item
7470 the address of the frame's local variables
7471 @item
7472 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7473 @item
7474 which registers were saved in the frame
7475 @end itemize
7476
7477 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7478 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7479 the usual conventions.
7480
7481 @item info frame @var{addr}
7482 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7483 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7484 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7485 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7486 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7487 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7488
7489 @kindex info args
7490 @item info args
7491 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7492
7493 @item info locals
7494 @kindex info locals
7495 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7496 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7497 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7498
7499 @end table
7500
7501 @node Frame Filter Management
7502 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7503 @cindex managing frame filters
7504
7505 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7506 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7507
7508 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7509 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7510
7511 @table @code
7512 @kindex info frame-filter
7513 @item info frame-filter
7514 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7515 their name, priority and enabled status.
7516
7517 @kindex disable frame-filter
7518 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7519 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7520 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7521 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7522 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7523 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7524 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7525 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7526 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7527 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7528 may be enabled again later.
7529
7530 @kindex enable frame-filter
7531 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7532 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7533 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7534 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7535 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7536 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7537 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7538 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7539 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7540
7541 Example:
7542
7543 @smallexample
7544 (gdb) info frame-filter
7545
7546 global frame-filters:
7547 Priority Enabled Name
7548 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7549 100 Yes Reverse
7550
7551 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7552 Priority Enabled Name
7553 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7554
7555 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7556 Priority Enabled Name
7557 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7558
7559 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7560 (gdb) info frame-filter
7561
7562 global frame-filters:
7563 Priority Enabled Name
7564 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7565 100 Yes Reverse
7566
7567 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7568 Priority Enabled Name
7569 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7570
7571 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7572 Priority Enabled Name
7573 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7574
7575 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7576 (gdb) info frame-filter
7577
7578 global frame-filters:
7579 Priority Enabled Name
7580 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7581 100 Yes Reverse
7582
7583 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7584 Priority Enabled Name
7585 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7586
7587 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7588 Priority Enabled Name
7589 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7590 @end smallexample
7591
7592 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7593 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7594 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7595 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7596 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7597 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7598 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7599
7600 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7601 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7602 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7603 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7604 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7605 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7606 dictionary resides.
7607
7608 Example:
7609
7610 @smallexample
7611 (gdb) info frame-filter
7612
7613 global frame-filters:
7614 Priority Enabled Name
7615 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7616 100 Yes Reverse
7617
7618 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7619 Priority Enabled Name
7620 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7621
7622 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7623 Priority Enabled Name
7624 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7625
7626 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7627 (gdb) info frame-filter
7628
7629 global frame-filters:
7630 Priority Enabled Name
7631 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7632 50 Yes Reverse
7633
7634 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7635 Priority Enabled Name
7636 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7637
7638 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7639 Priority Enabled Name
7640 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7641 @end smallexample
7642 @end table
7643
7644 @node Source
7645 @chapter Examining Source Files
7646
7647 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7648 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7649 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7650 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7651 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7652 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7653 source files by explicit command.
7654
7655 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7656 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7657 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7658
7659 @menu
7660 * List:: Printing source lines
7661 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7662 * Edit:: Editing source files
7663 * Search:: Searching source files
7664 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7665 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7666 @end menu
7667
7668 @node List
7669 @section Printing Source Lines
7670
7671 @kindex list
7672 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7673 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7674 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7675 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7676 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7677
7678 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7679
7680 @table @code
7681 @item list @var{linenum}
7682 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7683 current source file.
7684
7685 @item list @var{function}
7686 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7687 @var{function}.
7688
7689 @item list
7690 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7691 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7692 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7693 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7694 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7695
7696 @item list -
7697 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7698 @end table
7699
7700 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7701 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7702 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7703
7704 @table @code
7705 @kindex set listsize
7706 @item set listsize @var{count}
7707 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7708 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7709 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7710 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7711
7712 @kindex show listsize
7713 @item show listsize
7714 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7715 @end table
7716
7717 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7718 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7719 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7720 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7721 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7722
7723 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7724 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7725 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7726 to specify some source line.
7727
7728 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7729
7730 @table @code
7731 @item list @var{location}
7732 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7733
7734 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7735 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7736 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7737 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7738 the same source file as the first location.
7739
7740 @item list ,@var{last}
7741 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7742
7743 @item list @var{first},
7744 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7745
7746 @item list +
7747 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7748
7749 @item list -
7750 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7751
7752 @item list
7753 As described in the preceding table.
7754 @end table
7755
7756 @node Specify Location
7757 @section Specifying a Location
7758 @cindex specifying location
7759 @cindex location
7760 @cindex source location
7761
7762 @menu
7763 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7764 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7765 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7766 @end menu
7767
7768 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7769 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7770 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7771 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7772 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7773
7774 @node Linespec Locations
7775 @subsection Linespec Locations
7776 @cindex linespec locations
7777
7778 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7779 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7780 specifying a linespec:
7781
7782 @table @code
7783 @item @var{linenum}
7784 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7785
7786 @item -@var{offset}
7787 @itemx +@var{offset}
7788 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7789 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7790 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7791 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7792 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7793 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7794 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7795 linespec.
7796
7797 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7798 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7799 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7800 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7801 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7802 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7803 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7804
7805 @item @var{function}
7806 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7807 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7808
7809 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7810 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7811
7812 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7813 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7814 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7815 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7816 functions in different source files.
7817
7818 @item @var{label}
7819 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7820 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7821 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7822 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7823
7824 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7825 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7826 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7827 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7828 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7829 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7830
7831 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7832 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7833 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7834 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7835 each one of those probes.
7836 @end table
7837
7838 @node Explicit Locations
7839 @subsection Explicit Locations
7840 @cindex explicit locations
7841
7842 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7843 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7844
7845 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7846 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7847 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7848 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7849 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7850
7851 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7852 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7853 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7854 the symbol table to know.
7855
7856 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7857 following table:
7858
7859 @table @code
7860 @item -source @var{filename}
7861 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7862 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7863 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7864 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7865 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7866
7867 @item -function @var{function}
7868 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7869 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7870 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7871 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7872
7873 @item -label @var{label}
7874 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7875 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7876 selected stack frame.
7877
7878 @item -line @var{number}
7879 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7880 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7881 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7882 relative to the current line.
7883 @end table
7884
7885 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7886 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7887
7888 @node Address Locations
7889 @subsection Address Locations
7890 @cindex address locations
7891
7892 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7893 the generalized form *@var{address}.
7894
7895 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7896 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7897 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7898 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7899 source files.
7900
7901 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7902 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7903 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7904 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7905 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
7906 of @var{address}:
7907
7908 @table @code
7909 @item @var{expression}
7910 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7911
7912 @item @var{funcaddr}
7913 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7914 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7915 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7916 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7917 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7918 (although the Pascal form also works).
7919
7920 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7921 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7922
7923 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7924 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7925 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7926 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7927 functions with identical names in different source files.
7928 @end table
7929
7930 @node Edit
7931 @section Editing Source Files
7932 @cindex editing source files
7933
7934 @kindex edit
7935 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7936 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7937 The editing program of your choice
7938 is invoked with the current line set to
7939 the active line in the program.
7940 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7941 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7942
7943 @table @code
7944 @item edit @var{location}
7945 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7946 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7947 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7948 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7949 command most commonly used:
7950
7951 @table @code
7952 @item edit @var{number}
7953 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7954
7955 @item edit @var{function}
7956 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7957 @end table
7958
7959 @end table
7960
7961 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7962 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7963 @footnote{
7964 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7965 following command-line syntax:
7966 @smallexample
7967 ex +@var{number} file
7968 @end smallexample
7969 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7970 the file where to start editing.}.
7971 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7972 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7973 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7974 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7975 @smallexample
7976 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7977 export EDITOR
7978 gdb @dots{}
7979 @end smallexample
7980 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7981 @smallexample
7982 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7983 gdb @dots{}
7984 @end smallexample
7985
7986 @node Search
7987 @section Searching Source Files
7988 @cindex searching source files
7989
7990 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7991 regular expression.
7992
7993 @table @code
7994 @kindex search
7995 @kindex forward-search
7996 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7997 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7998 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7999 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8000 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8001 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8002 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8003 @code{fo}.
8004
8005 @kindex reverse-search
8006 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8007 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8008 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8009 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8010 this command as @code{rev}.
8011 @end table
8012
8013 @node Source Path
8014 @section Specifying Source Directories
8015
8016 @cindex source path
8017 @cindex directories for source files
8018 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8019 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8020 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8021 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8022 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8023 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8024 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8025
8026 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8027 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8028 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8029 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8030 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8031 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8032 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8033 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8034 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8035 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8036 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8037
8038 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8039 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8040 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8041 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8042 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8043 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8044
8045 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8046 source files.
8047
8048 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8049 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8050 each line is in the file.
8051
8052 @kindex directory
8053 @kindex dir
8054 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8055 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8056 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8057
8058 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8059 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8060
8061 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8062 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8063 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8064 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8065 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8066 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8067 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8068 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8069 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8070 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8071 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8072 name to look up the sources.
8073
8074 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8075 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8076 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8077 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8078 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8079 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8080 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8081 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8082
8083 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8084 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8085 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8086 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8087 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8088 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8089 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8090
8091 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8092 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8093 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8094 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8095 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8096 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8097 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8098 command.
8099
8100 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8101 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8102 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8103 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8104 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8105 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8106 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8107
8108 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8109 @cindex default source path substitution
8110 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8111 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8112 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8113 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8114 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8115 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8116 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8117 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8118 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8119 together.
8120
8121 @table @code
8122 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8123 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8124 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8125 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8126 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8127 part of absolute file names) or
8128 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8129 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8130
8131 @kindex cdir
8132 @kindex cwd
8133 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8134 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8135 @cindex compilation directory
8136 @cindex current directory
8137 @cindex working directory
8138 @cindex directory, current
8139 @cindex directory, compilation
8140 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8141 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8142 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8143 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8144 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8145 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8146
8147 @item directory
8148 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8149
8150 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8151 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8152
8153 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8154 @kindex set directories
8155 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8156 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8157
8158 @item show directories
8159 @kindex show directories
8160 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8161
8162 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8163 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8164 @kindex set substitute-path
8165 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8166 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8167 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8168
8169 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8170 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8171
8172 @smallexample
8173 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8174 @end smallexample
8175
8176 @noindent
8177 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8178 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8179 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8180
8181 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8182 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8183 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8184 the substitution.
8185
8186 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8187
8188 @smallexample
8189 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8190 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8191 @end smallexample
8192
8193 @noindent
8194 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8195 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8196 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8197 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8198
8199
8200 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8201 @kindex unset substitute-path
8202 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8203 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8204 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8205
8206 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8207
8208 @item show substitute-path [path]
8209 @kindex show substitute-path
8210 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8211 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8212
8213 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8214 rules.
8215
8216 @end table
8217
8218 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8219 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8220 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8221
8222 @enumerate
8223 @item
8224 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8225
8226 @item
8227 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8228 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8229 directories in one command.
8230 @end enumerate
8231
8232 @node Machine Code
8233 @section Source and Machine Code
8234 @cindex source line and its code address
8235
8236 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8237 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8238 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8239 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8240 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8241 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8242 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8243 well as hex.
8244
8245 @table @code
8246 @kindex info line
8247 @item info line @var{location}
8248 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8249 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8250 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8251 @end table
8252
8253 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8254 the object code for the first line of function
8255 @code{m4_changequote}:
8256
8257 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8258 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8259 @smallexample
8260 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8261 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8262 @end smallexample
8263
8264 @noindent
8265 @cindex code address and its source line
8266 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8267 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8268 @smallexample
8269 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8270 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8271 @end smallexample
8272
8273 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8274 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8275 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8276 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8277 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8278 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8279 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8280 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8281 Variables}).
8282
8283 @table @code
8284 @kindex disassemble
8285 @cindex assembly instructions
8286 @cindex instructions, assembly
8287 @cindex machine instructions
8288 @cindex listing machine instructions
8289 @item disassemble
8290 @itemx disassemble /m
8291 @itemx disassemble /s
8292 @itemx disassemble /r
8293 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8294 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8295 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8296 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8297 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8298 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8299 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8300 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8301 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8302 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8303
8304 @table @code
8305 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8306 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8307 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8308 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8309 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8310 @end table
8311
8312 @noindent
8313 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8314 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8315
8316 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8317 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8318
8319 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8320 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8321 @end table
8322
8323 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8324 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8325
8326 @smallexample
8327 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8328 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8329 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8330 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8331 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8332 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8333 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8334 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8335 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8336 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8337 End of assembler dump.
8338 @end smallexample
8339
8340 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8341 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8342 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8343
8344 @smallexample
8345 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8346 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8347 5 @{
8348 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8349 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8350 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8351 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8352 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8353
8354 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8355 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8356 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8357
8358 7 return 0;
8359 8 @}
8360 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8361 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8362 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8363
8364 End of assembler dump.
8365 @end smallexample
8366
8367 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8368 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8369 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8370 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8371 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8372 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8373 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8374 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8375 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8376
8377 @file{foo.h}:
8378
8379 @smallexample
8380 int
8381 foo (int a)
8382 @{
8383 if (a < 0)
8384 return a * 2;
8385 if (a == 0)
8386 return 1;
8387 return a + 10;
8388 @}
8389 @end smallexample
8390
8391 @file{foo.c}:
8392
8393 @smallexample
8394 #include "foo.h"
8395 volatile int x, y;
8396 int
8397 main ()
8398 @{
8399 x = foo (y);
8400 return 0;
8401 @}
8402 @end smallexample
8403
8404 @smallexample
8405 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8406 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8407 5 @{
8408
8409 6 x = foo (y);
8410 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8411 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8412
8413 7 return 0;
8414 8 @}
8415 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8416 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8417 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8418 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8419
8420 End of assembler dump.
8421 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8422 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8423 foo.c:
8424 5 @{
8425 6 x = foo (y);
8426 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8427
8428 foo.h:
8429 4 if (a < 0)
8430 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8431 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8432
8433 6 if (a == 0)
8434 7 return 1;
8435 8 return a + 10;
8436 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8437 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8438 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8439 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8440
8441 foo.c:
8442 6 x = foo (y);
8443 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8444
8445 7 return 0;
8446 8 @}
8447 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8448 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8449
8450 foo.h:
8451 5 return a * 2;
8452 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8453 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8454 End of assembler dump.
8455 @end smallexample
8456
8457 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8458
8459 @smallexample
8460 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8461 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8462 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8463 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8464 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8465 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8466 End of assembler dump.
8467 @end smallexample
8468
8469 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8470 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8471 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8472 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8473
8474 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8475 mnemonics or other syntax.
8476
8477 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8478 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8479 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8480 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8481 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8482
8483 @table @code
8484 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8485 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8486 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8487 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8488 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8489 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8490
8491 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8492 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8493 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8494 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8495
8496 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8497 @item show disassembly-flavor
8498 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8499 @end table
8500
8501 @table @code
8502 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8503 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8504 @item set disassemble-next-line
8505 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8506 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8507 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8508 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8509 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8510 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8511 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8512 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8513 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8514 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8515 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8516 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8517 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8518 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8519 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8520 instruction.
8521 @end table
8522
8523
8524 @node Data
8525 @chapter Examining Data
8526
8527 @cindex printing data
8528 @cindex examining data
8529 @kindex print
8530 @kindex inspect
8531 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8532 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8533 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8534 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8535 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8536 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8537
8538 @table @code
8539 @item print @var{expr}
8540 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8541 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8542 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8543 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8544 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8545 Formats}.
8546
8547 @item print
8548 @itemx print /@var{f}
8549 @cindex reprint the last value
8550 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8551 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8552 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8553 @end table
8554
8555 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8556 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8557 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8558
8559 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8560 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8561 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8562 Table}.
8563
8564 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8565 @kindex explore
8566 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8567 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8568 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8569 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8570 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8571 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8572 embedded in the higher level data types.
8573
8574 @table @code
8575 @item explore @var{arg}
8576 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8577 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8578 @end table
8579
8580 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8581 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8582 C program as
8583
8584 @smallexample
8585 struct SimpleStruct
8586 @{
8587 int i;
8588 double d;
8589 @};
8590
8591 struct ComplexStruct
8592 @{
8593 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8594 int arr[10];
8595 @};
8596 @end smallexample
8597
8598 @noindent
8599 followed by variable declarations as
8600
8601 @smallexample
8602 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8603 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8604 @end smallexample
8605
8606 @noindent
8607 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8608 @code{explore} command as follows.
8609
8610 @smallexample
8611 (gdb) explore cs
8612 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8613 the following fields:
8614
8615 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8616 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8617
8618 Enter the field number of choice:
8619 @end smallexample
8620
8621 @noindent
8622 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8623 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8624 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8625 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8626 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8627 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8628 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8629 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8630
8631 @smallexample
8632 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8633 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8634 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8635 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8636
8637 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8638 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8639
8640 Press enter to return to parent value:
8641 @end smallexample
8642
8643 @noindent
8644 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8645 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8646 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8647 to explore.
8648
8649 @smallexample
8650 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8651 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8652
8653 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8654
8655 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8656
8657 Press enter to return to parent value:
8658 @end smallexample
8659
8660 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8661 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8662 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8663 level data structure).
8664
8665 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8666 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8667 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8668 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8669 same example as above, your can explore the type
8670 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8671 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8672
8673 @smallexample
8674 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8675 @end smallexample
8676
8677 @noindent
8678 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8679 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8680 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8681 example.
8682
8683 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8684 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8685 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8686 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8687 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8688
8689 @table @code
8690 @item explore value @var{expr}
8691 @cindex explore value
8692 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8693 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8694 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8695 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8696 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8697
8698 @item explore type @var{arg}
8699 @cindex explore type
8700 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8701 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8702 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8703 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8704 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8705 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8706 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8707 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8708 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8709 @end table
8710
8711 @menu
8712 * Expressions:: Expressions
8713 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8714 * Variables:: Program variables
8715 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8716 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8717 * Memory:: Examining memory
8718 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8719 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8720 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8721 * Value History:: Value history
8722 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8723 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8724 * Registers:: Registers
8725 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8726 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8727 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8728 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8729 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8730 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8731 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8732 character set than GDB does
8733 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8734 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8735 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8736 @end menu
8737
8738 @node Expressions
8739 @section Expressions
8740
8741 @cindex expressions
8742 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8743 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8744 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8745 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8746 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8747 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8748 @ref{Compilation}.
8749
8750 @cindex arrays in expressions
8751 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8752 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8753 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8754 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8755 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8756 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8757
8758 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8759 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8760 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8761 languages.
8762
8763 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8764 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8765
8766 @cindex casts, in expressions
8767 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8768 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8769 at that address in memory.
8770 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8771
8772 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8773 to programming languages:
8774
8775 @table @code
8776 @item @@
8777 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8778 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8779
8780 @item ::
8781 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8782 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8783
8784 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8785 @cindex type casting memory
8786 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8787 @cindex casts, to view memory
8788 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8789 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8790 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8791 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8792 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8793 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8794 @end table
8795
8796 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8797 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8798 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8799
8800 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8801 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8802 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8803 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8804 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8805 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8806 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8807
8808 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8809 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8810 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8811 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8812 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8813 as well.
8814
8815 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8816 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8817 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8818 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8819 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8820 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8821 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8822 choices.
8823
8824 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8825 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8826 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8827
8828 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8829 @smallexample
8830 @group
8831 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8832 [0] cancel
8833 [1] all
8834 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8835 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8836 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8837 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8838 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8839 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8840 > 2 4 6
8841 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8842 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8843 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8844 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8845 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8846 breakpoints.
8847 (@value{GDBP})
8848 @end group
8849 @end smallexample
8850
8851 @table @code
8852 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8853 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8854 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8855
8856 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8857 is ambiguous.
8858
8859 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8860 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8861 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8862 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8863 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8864 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8865 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8866 in the use of the menu.
8867
8868 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8869 when an ambiguity is detected.
8870
8871 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8872 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8873
8874 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8875 @item show multiple-symbols
8876 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8877 @end table
8878
8879 @node Variables
8880 @section Program Variables
8881
8882 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8883 in your program.
8884
8885 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8886 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8887
8888 @itemize @bullet
8889 @item
8890 global (or file-static)
8891 @end itemize
8892
8893 @noindent or
8894
8895 @itemize @bullet
8896 @item
8897 visible according to the scope rules of the
8898 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8899 @end itemize
8900
8901 @noindent This means that in the function
8902
8903 @smallexample
8904 foo (a)
8905 int a;
8906 @{
8907 bar (a);
8908 @{
8909 int b = test ();
8910 bar (b);
8911 @}
8912 @}
8913 @end smallexample
8914
8915 @noindent
8916 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8917 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8918 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8919 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8920
8921 @cindex variable name conflict
8922 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8923 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8924 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8925 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8926 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8927 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8928 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8929
8930 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8931 @ifnotinfo
8932 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8933 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8934 @end ifnotinfo
8935 @smallexample
8936 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8937 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8938 @end smallexample
8939
8940 @noindent
8941 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8942 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8943 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8944 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8945
8946 @smallexample
8947 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8948 @end smallexample
8949
8950 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8951 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8952 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8953 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8954 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8955
8956 @smallexample
8957 void
8958 foo (int a)
8959 @{
8960 if (a < 10)
8961 bar (a);
8962 else
8963 process (a); /* Stop here */
8964 @}
8965
8966 int
8967 bar (int a)
8968 @{
8969 foo (a + 5);
8970 @}
8971 @end smallexample
8972
8973 @noindent
8974 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8975 here is what you might see
8976 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8977
8978 @smallexample
8979 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8980 $1 = 10
8981 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8982 $2 = 5
8983 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8984 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8985 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8986 $3 = 5
8987 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8988 $4 = 0
8989 @end smallexample
8990
8991 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8992 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8993 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8994 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8995 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8996
8997 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8998 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8999 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9000 @code{some_global}.
9001
9002 @smallexample
9003 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9004 $1 = 23
9005 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9006 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9007 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9008 $2 = 27
9009 @end smallexample
9010
9011 @cindex wrong values
9012 @cindex variable values, wrong
9013 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9014 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9015 @quotation
9016 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9017 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9018 scope, and just before exit.
9019 @end quotation
9020 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9021 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9022 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9023 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9024 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9025 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9026 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9027 variable definitions may be gone.
9028
9029 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9030 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9031 when compiling.
9032
9033 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9034 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9035 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9036 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9037 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9038 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9039 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9040
9041 @smallexample
9042 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9043 @end smallexample
9044
9045 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9046 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9047 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9048 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9049 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9050
9051 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9052 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9053 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9054 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9055
9056 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9057 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9058 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9059 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9060 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9061
9062 @smallexample
9063 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9064 29 i++;
9065 (gdb) next
9066 30 e (i);
9067 (gdb) print i
9068 $1 = 31
9069 (gdb) print i@@entry
9070 $2 = 30
9071 @end smallexample
9072
9073 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9074 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9075 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9076 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9077 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9078 For program code
9079
9080 @smallexample
9081 char var0[] = "A";
9082 signed char var1[] = "A";
9083 @end smallexample
9084
9085 You get during debugging
9086 @smallexample
9087 (gdb) print var0
9088 $1 = "A"
9089 (gdb) print var1
9090 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9091 @end smallexample
9092
9093 @node Arrays
9094 @section Artificial Arrays
9095
9096 @cindex artificial array
9097 @cindex arrays
9098 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9099 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9100 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9101 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9102 program.
9103
9104 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9105 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9106 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9107 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9108 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9109 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9110 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9111 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9112 example. If a program says
9113
9114 @smallexample
9115 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9116 @end smallexample
9117
9118 @noindent
9119 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9120
9121 @smallexample
9122 p *array@@len
9123 @end smallexample
9124
9125 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9126 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9127 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9128 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9129 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9130
9131 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9132 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9133 The value need not be in memory:
9134 @smallexample
9135 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9136 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9137 @end smallexample
9138
9139 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9140 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9141 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9142 @smallexample
9143 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9144 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9145 @end smallexample
9146
9147 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9148 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9149 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9150 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9151 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9152 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9153 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9154 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9155 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9156 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9157
9158 @smallexample
9159 set $i = 0
9160 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9161 @key{RET}
9162 @key{RET}
9163 @dots{}
9164 @end smallexample
9165
9166 @node Output Formats
9167 @section Output Formats
9168
9169 @cindex formatted output
9170 @cindex output formats
9171 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9172 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9173 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9174 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9175 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9176
9177 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9178 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9179 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9180 letters supported are:
9181
9182 @table @code
9183 @item x
9184 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9185 hexadecimal.
9186
9187 @item d
9188 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9189
9190 @item u
9191 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9192
9193 @item o
9194 Print as integer in octal.
9195
9196 @item t
9197 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9198 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9199 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9200 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9201
9202 @item a
9203 @cindex unknown address, locating
9204 @cindex locate address
9205 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9206 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9207 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9208
9209 @smallexample
9210 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9211 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9212 @end smallexample
9213
9214 @noindent
9215 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9216 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9217
9218 @item c
9219 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9220 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9221 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9222 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9223
9224 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9225 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9226 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9227 data.
9228
9229 @item f
9230 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9231 using typical floating point syntax.
9232
9233 @item s
9234 @cindex printing strings
9235 @cindex printing byte arrays
9236 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9237 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9238 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9239 natural types.
9240
9241 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9242 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9243 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9244 array.
9245
9246 @item z
9247 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9248 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9249 to the size of the integer type.
9250
9251 @item r
9252 @cindex raw printing
9253 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9254 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9255 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9256 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9257 pretty-printer which might exist.
9258 @end table
9259
9260 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9261
9262 @smallexample
9263 p/x $pc
9264 @end smallexample
9265
9266 @noindent
9267 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9268 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9269
9270 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9271 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9272 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9273
9274 @node Memory
9275 @section Examining Memory
9276
9277 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9278 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9279
9280 @cindex examining memory
9281 @table @code
9282 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9283 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9284 @itemx x @var{addr}
9285 @itemx x
9286 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9287 @end table
9288
9289 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9290 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9291 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9292 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9293 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9294
9295 @table @r
9296 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9297 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9298 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
9299 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9300 @c 4.1.2.
9301
9302 @item @var{f}, the display format
9303 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9304 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9305 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9306 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9307 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9308
9309 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9310 The unit size is any of
9311
9312 @table @code
9313 @item b
9314 Bytes.
9315 @item h
9316 Halfwords (two bytes).
9317 @item w
9318 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9319 @item g
9320 Giant words (eight bytes).
9321 @end table
9322
9323 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9324 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9325 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9326 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9327 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9328 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9329 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9330 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9331 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9332 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9333 be altered.
9334
9335 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9336 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9337 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9338 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9339 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9340 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9341 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9342 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9343 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9344 a value from memory).
9345 @end table
9346
9347 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9348 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9349 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9350 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9351 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9352
9353 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9354 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9355 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9356 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9357 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9358
9359 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9360 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9361 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9362 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9363 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9364 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9365 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9366 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9367 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9368
9369 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9370 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9371 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9372 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9373 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9374 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9375 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9376
9377 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9378 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9379
9380 @smallexample
9381 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9382 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9383 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9384 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9385 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9386 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9387 @end smallexample
9388
9389 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9390 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9391 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9392 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9393 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9394 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9395 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9396 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9397 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9398
9399 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9400 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9401 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9402
9403 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9404 @cindex addressable memory unit
9405 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9406 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9407 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9408 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9409 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9410 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9411 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9412 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9413 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9414
9415 @cindex remote memory comparison
9416 @cindex target memory comparison
9417 @cindex verify remote memory image
9418 @cindex verify target memory image
9419 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9420 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9421 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9422 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9423 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9424 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9425
9426 @table @code
9427 @kindex compare-sections
9428 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9429 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9430 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9431 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9432 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9433 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9434
9435 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9436 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9437 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9438 @end table
9439
9440 @node Auto Display
9441 @section Automatic Display
9442 @cindex automatic display
9443 @cindex display of expressions
9444
9445 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9446 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9447 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9448 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9449 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9450 The automatic display looks like this:
9451
9452 @smallexample
9453 2: foo = 38
9454 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9455 @end smallexample
9456
9457 @noindent
9458 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9459 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9460 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9461 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9462 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9463 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9464
9465 @table @code
9466 @kindex display
9467 @item display @var{expr}
9468 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9469 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9470
9471 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9472
9473 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9474 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9475 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9476 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9477 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9478
9479 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9480 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9481 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9482 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9483 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9484 @end table
9485
9486 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9487 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9488 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9489
9490 @table @code
9491 @kindex delete display
9492 @kindex undisplay
9493 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9494 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9495 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9496 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9497 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9498 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9499 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9500
9501 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9502 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9503
9504 @kindex disable display
9505 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9506 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9507 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9508 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9509 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9510 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9511 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9512 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9513
9514 @kindex enable display
9515 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9516 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9517 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9518 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9519 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9520 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9521 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9522
9523 @item display
9524 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9525 done when your program stops.
9526
9527 @kindex info display
9528 @item info display
9529 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9530 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9531 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9532 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9533 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9534 @end table
9535
9536 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9537 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9538 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9539 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9540 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9541 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9542 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9543 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9544 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9545 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9546 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9547
9548 @node Print Settings
9549 @section Print Settings
9550
9551 @cindex format options
9552 @cindex print settings
9553 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9554 and symbols are printed.
9555
9556 @noindent
9557 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9558
9559 @table @code
9560 @kindex set print
9561 @item set print address
9562 @itemx set print address on
9563 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9564 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9565 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9566 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9567 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9568 @code{set print address on}:
9569
9570 @smallexample
9571 @group
9572 (@value{GDBP}) f
9573 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9574 at input.c:530
9575 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9576 @end group
9577 @end smallexample
9578
9579 @item set print address off
9580 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9581 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9582
9583 @smallexample
9584 @group
9585 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9586 (@value{GDBP}) f
9587 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9588 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9589 @end group
9590 @end smallexample
9591
9592 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9593 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9594 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9595 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9596
9597 @kindex show print
9598 @item show print address
9599 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9600 @end table
9601
9602 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9603 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9604 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9605 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9606 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9607 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9608 it prints a symbolic address:
9609
9610 @table @code
9611 @item set print symbol-filename on
9612 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9613 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9614 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9615 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9616
9617 @item set print symbol-filename off
9618 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9619 default.
9620
9621 @item show print symbol-filename
9622 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9623 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9624 @end table
9625
9626 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9627 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9628 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9629
9630 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9631 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9632
9633 @table @code
9634 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9635 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9636 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9637 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9638 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9639 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9640 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9641 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9642
9643 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9644 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9645 symbolic address.
9646 @end table
9647
9648 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9649 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9650 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9651 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9652 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9653 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9654 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9655 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9656
9657 @smallexample
9658 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9659 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9660 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9661 @end smallexample
9662
9663 @quotation
9664 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9665 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9666 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9667 @end quotation
9668
9669 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9670 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9671
9672 @table @code
9673 @item set print symbol on
9674 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9675 one exists.
9676
9677 @item set print symbol off
9678 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9679 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9680 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9681
9682 @item show print symbol
9683 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9684 address.
9685 @end table
9686
9687 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9688
9689 @table @code
9690 @item set print array
9691 @itemx set print array on
9692 @cindex pretty print arrays
9693 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9694 but uses more space. The default is off.
9695
9696 @item set print array off
9697 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9698
9699 @item show print array
9700 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9701 arrays.
9702
9703 @cindex print array indexes
9704 @item set print array-indexes
9705 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9706 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9707 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9708 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9709
9710 @item set print array-indexes off
9711 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9712
9713 @item show print array-indexes
9714 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9715 arrays.
9716
9717 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9718 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9719 @cindex number of array elements to print
9720 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9721 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9722 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9723 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9724 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9725 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9726 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9727 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9728
9729 @item show print elements
9730 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9731 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9732
9733 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9734 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9735 @cindex printing frame argument values
9736 @cindex print all frame argument values
9737 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9738 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9739 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9740 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9741 values are:
9742
9743 @table @code
9744 @item all
9745 The values of all arguments are printed.
9746
9747 @item scalars
9748 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9749 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9750 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9751 only scalar arguments are shown:
9752
9753 @smallexample
9754 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9755 at frame-args.c:23
9756 @end smallexample
9757
9758 @item none
9759 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9760 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9761
9762 @smallexample
9763 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9764 at frame-args.c:23
9765 @end smallexample
9766 @end table
9767
9768 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9769 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9770 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9771 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9772 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9773 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9774 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9775 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9776 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9777 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9778
9779 @item show print frame-arguments
9780 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9781
9782 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9783 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9784
9785 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9786 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9787 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9788 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9789 This is the default.
9790
9791 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9792 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9793
9794 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9795 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9796 @kindex set print entry-values
9797 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9798 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9799 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9800 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9801 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9802
9803 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9804 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9805 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9806 @code{no} setting.
9807
9808 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9809 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9810 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9811 this information.
9812
9813 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9814
9815 @table @code
9816 @item no
9817 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9818 point.
9819 @smallexample
9820 #0 equal (val=5)
9821 #0 different (val=6)
9822 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9823 #0 born (val=10)
9824 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9825 @end smallexample
9826
9827 @item only
9828 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9829 values are never printed.
9830 @smallexample
9831 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9832 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9833 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9834 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9835 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9836 @end smallexample
9837
9838 @item preferred
9839 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9840 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9841 value for such parameter.
9842 @smallexample
9843 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9844 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9845 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9846 #0 born (val=10)
9847 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9848 @end smallexample
9849
9850 @item if-needed
9851 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9852 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9853 parameter.
9854 @smallexample
9855 #0 equal (val=5)
9856 #0 different (val=6)
9857 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9858 #0 born (val=10)
9859 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9860 @end smallexample
9861
9862 @item both
9863 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9864 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9865 optimizations.
9866 @smallexample
9867 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9868 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9869 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9870 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9871 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9872 @end smallexample
9873
9874 @item compact
9875 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9876 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9877 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9878 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9879 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9880 @smallexample
9881 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9882 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9883 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9884 #0 born (val=10)
9885 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9886 @end smallexample
9887
9888 @item default
9889 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9890 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9891 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9892 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9893 @smallexample
9894 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9895 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9896 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9897 #0 born (val=10)
9898 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9899 @end smallexample
9900 @end table
9901
9902 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9903 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9904
9905 @item show print entry-values
9906 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9907 entry.
9908
9909 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9910 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9911 @cindex repeated array elements
9912 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9913 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9914 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9915 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9916 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9917 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9918 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9919 is 10.
9920
9921 @item show print repeats
9922 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9923 elements.
9924
9925 @item set print null-stop
9926 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9927 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9928 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9929 contain only short strings.
9930 The default is off.
9931
9932 @item show print null-stop
9933 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9934 @sc{null} character.
9935
9936 @item set print pretty on
9937 @cindex print structures in indented form
9938 @cindex indentation in structure display
9939 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9940 per line, like this:
9941
9942 @smallexample
9943 @group
9944 $1 = @{
9945 next = 0x0,
9946 flags = @{
9947 sweet = 1,
9948 sour = 1
9949 @},
9950 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9951 @}
9952 @end group
9953 @end smallexample
9954
9955 @item set print pretty off
9956 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9957
9958 @smallexample
9959 @group
9960 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9961 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9962 @end group
9963 @end smallexample
9964
9965 @noindent
9966 This is the default format.
9967
9968 @item show print pretty
9969 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9970
9971 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9972 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9973 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9974 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9975 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9976 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9977 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9978 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9979
9980 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9981 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9982 international character sets, and is the default.
9983
9984 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9985 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9986
9987 @item set print union on
9988 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9989 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9990 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9991
9992 @item set print union off
9993 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9994 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9995 instead.
9996
9997 @item show print union
9998 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9999 structures and other unions.
10000
10001 For example, given the declarations
10002
10003 @smallexample
10004 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10005 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10006 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10007 Bug_forms;
10008
10009 struct thing @{
10010 Species it;
10011 union @{
10012 Tree_forms tree;
10013 Bug_forms bug;
10014 @} form;
10015 @};
10016
10017 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10018 @end smallexample
10019
10020 @noindent
10021 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10022
10023 @smallexample
10024 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10025 @end smallexample
10026
10027 @noindent
10028 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10029
10030 @smallexample
10031 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10032 @end smallexample
10033
10034 @noindent
10035 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10036 and in Pascal.
10037 @end table
10038
10039 @need 1000
10040 @noindent
10041 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10042
10043 @table @code
10044 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10045 @item set print demangle
10046 @itemx set print demangle on
10047 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10048 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10049 linkage. The default is on.
10050
10051 @item show print demangle
10052 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10053
10054 @item set print asm-demangle
10055 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10056 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10057 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10058 The default is off.
10059
10060 @item show print asm-demangle
10061 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10062 or demangled form.
10063
10064 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10065 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10066 @kindex set demangle-style
10067 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10068 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10069 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10070
10071 @table @code
10072 @item auto
10073 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10074 This is the default.
10075
10076 @item gnu
10077 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10078
10079 @item hp
10080 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10081
10082 @item lucid
10083 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10084
10085 @item arm
10086 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10087 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10088 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10089 require further enhancement to permit that.
10090
10091 @end table
10092 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10093
10094 @item show demangle-style
10095 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10096
10097 @item set print object
10098 @itemx set print object on
10099 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10100 @cindex display derived types
10101 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10102 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10103 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10104 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10105 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10106 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10107 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10108
10109 @item set print object off
10110 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10111 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10112
10113 @item show print object
10114 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10115
10116 @item set print static-members
10117 @itemx set print static-members on
10118 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10119 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10120
10121 @item set print static-members off
10122 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10123
10124 @item show print static-members
10125 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10126
10127 @item set print pascal_static-members
10128 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10129 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10130 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10131 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10132
10133 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10134 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10135
10136 @item show print pascal_static-members
10137 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10138
10139 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10140 @item set print vtbl
10141 @itemx set print vtbl on
10142 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10143 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10144 @cindex VTBL display
10145 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10146 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10147 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10148
10149 @item set print vtbl off
10150 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10151
10152 @item show print vtbl
10153 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10154 @end table
10155
10156 @node Pretty Printing
10157 @section Pretty Printing
10158
10159 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10160 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10161 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10162
10163 @menu
10164 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10165 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10166 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10167 @end menu
10168
10169 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10170 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10171
10172 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10173 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10174 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10175
10176 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10177 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10178 pretty-printers with their names.
10179 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10180 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10181 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10182 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10183
10184 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10185 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10186 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10187 do anything special.
10188
10189 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10190
10191 @itemize @bullet
10192 @item
10193 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10194 all inferiors.
10195
10196 @item
10197 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10198 when debugging that program.
10199 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10200
10201 @item
10202 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10203 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10204 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10205 @end itemize
10206
10207 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10208 pretty-printers are selected,
10209
10210 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10211 for new types.
10212
10213 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10214 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10215
10216 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10217
10218 @smallexample
10219 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10220 $1 = @{
10221 static npos = 4294967295,
10222 _M_dataplus = @{
10223 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10224 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10225 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10226 @},
10227 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10228 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10229 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10230 @}
10231 @}
10232 @end smallexample
10233
10234 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10235
10236 @smallexample
10237 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10238 $2 = "abcd"
10239 @end smallexample
10240
10241 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10242 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10243 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10244
10245 @table @code
10246 @kindex info pretty-printer
10247 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10248 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10249 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10250
10251 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10252 whose pretty-printers to list.
10253 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10254 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10255 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10256 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10257 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10258
10259 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10260 to list.
10261
10262 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10263 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10264 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10265 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10266
10267 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10268 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10269 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10270 @end table
10271
10272 Example:
10273
10274 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10275 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10276 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10277 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10278
10279 @smallexample
10280 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10281 library1.so:
10282 foo
10283 library2.so:
10284 bar
10285 bar1
10286 bar2
10287 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10288 library2.so:
10289 bar
10290 bar1
10291 bar2
10292 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10293 1 printer disabled
10294 2 of 3 printers enabled
10295 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10296 library1.so:
10297 foo [disabled]
10298 library2.so:
10299 bar
10300 bar1
10301 bar2
10302 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10303 1 printer disabled
10304 1 of 3 printers enabled
10305 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10306 library1.so:
10307 foo [disabled]
10308 library2.so:
10309 bar
10310 bar1 [disabled]
10311 bar2
10312 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10313 1 printer disabled
10314 0 of 3 printers enabled
10315 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10316 library1.so:
10317 foo [disabled]
10318 library2.so:
10319 bar [disabled]
10320 bar1 [disabled]
10321 bar2
10322 @end smallexample
10323
10324 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10325 as can each individual subprinter.
10326
10327 @node Value History
10328 @section Value History
10329
10330 @cindex value history
10331 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10332 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10333 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10334 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10335 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10336 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10337 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10338 symbol table.
10339
10340 @cindex @code{$}
10341 @cindex @code{$$}
10342 @cindex history number
10343 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10344 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10345 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10346 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10347 history number.
10348
10349 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10350 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10351 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10352 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10353 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10354 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10355 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10356
10357 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10358 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10359
10360 @smallexample
10361 p *$
10362 @end smallexample
10363
10364 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10365 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10366
10367 @smallexample
10368 p *$.next
10369 @end smallexample
10370
10371 @noindent
10372 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10373 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10374
10375 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10376 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10377
10378 @smallexample
10379 print x
10380 set x=5
10381 @end smallexample
10382
10383 @noindent
10384 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10385 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10386
10387 @table @code
10388 @kindex show values
10389 @item show values
10390 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10391 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10392 values} does not change the history.
10393
10394 @item show values @var{n}
10395 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10396
10397 @item show values +
10398 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10399 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10400 @end table
10401
10402 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10403 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10404
10405 @node Convenience Vars
10406 @section Convenience Variables
10407
10408 @cindex convenience variables
10409 @cindex user-defined variables
10410 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10411 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10412 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10413 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10414 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10415
10416 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10417 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10418 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10419 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10420 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10421
10422 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10423 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10424 For example:
10425
10426 @smallexample
10427 set $foo = *object_ptr
10428 @end smallexample
10429
10430 @noindent
10431 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10432 @code{object_ptr}.
10433
10434 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10435 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10436 value with another assignment at any time.
10437
10438 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10439 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10440 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10441 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10442
10443 @table @code
10444 @kindex show convenience
10445 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10446 @item show convenience
10447 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10448 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10449 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10450
10451 @kindex init-if-undefined
10452 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10453 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10454 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10455 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10456 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10457 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10458 override default values used in a command script.
10459
10460 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10461 any side-effects do not occur.
10462 @end table
10463
10464 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10465 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10466 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10467
10468 @smallexample
10469 set $i = 0
10470 print bar[$i++]->contents
10471 @end smallexample
10472
10473 @noindent
10474 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10475
10476 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10477 values likely to be useful.
10478
10479 @table @code
10480 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10481 @item $_
10482 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10483 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10484 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10485 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10486 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10487 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10488 to the type of @code{$__}.
10489
10490 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10491 @item $__
10492 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10493 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10494 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10495
10496 @item $_exitcode
10497 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10498 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10499 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10500 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10501
10502 @item $_exitsignal
10503 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10504 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10505 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10506 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10507
10508 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10509 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10510 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10511 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10512 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10513
10514 @smallexample
10515 #include <signal.h>
10516
10517 int
10518 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10519 @{
10520 raise (SIGALRM);
10521 return 0;
10522 @}
10523 @end smallexample
10524
10525 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10526 or signalled would be:
10527
10528 @smallexample
10529 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10530 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10531 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10532 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10533 >echo The program has exited\n
10534 >else
10535 >echo The program has signalled\n
10536 >end
10537 >end
10538 (@value{GDBP}) run
10539 Starting program:
10540
10541 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10542 The program no longer exists.
10543 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10544 The program has signalled
10545 @end smallexample
10546
10547 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10548 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10549 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10550 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10551
10552 @smallexample
10553 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10554 The program has exited
10555 @end smallexample
10556
10557 @item $_exception
10558 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10559 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10560
10561 @item $_probe_argc
10562 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10563 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10564
10565 @item $_sdata
10566 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10567 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10568 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10569 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10570 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10571
10572 @item $_siginfo
10573 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10574 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10575 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10576 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10577 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10578
10579 @item $_tlb
10580 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10581 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10582 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10583 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10584 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10585 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10586
10587 @item $_inferior
10588 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10589 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10590
10591 @item $_thread
10592 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10593
10594 @item $_gthread
10595 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10596
10597 @end table
10598
10599 @node Convenience Funs
10600 @section Convenience Functions
10601
10602 @cindex convenience functions
10603 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10604 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10605 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10606 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10607 @value{GDBN}.
10608
10609 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10610 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10611
10612 @table @code
10613
10614 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10615 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10616 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10617 returns zero.
10618
10619 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10620 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10621 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10622 it is @code{void}:
10623
10624 @smallexample
10625 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10626 $1 = void
10627 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10628 $2 = 1
10629 (@value{GDBP}) run
10630 Starting program: ./a.out
10631 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10632 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10633 $3 = 0
10634 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10635 $4 = 0
10636 @end smallexample
10637
10638 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10639 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10640 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10641 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10642 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10643 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10644 anymore.
10645
10646 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10647 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10648
10649 @smallexample
10650 void
10651 foo (void)
10652 @{
10653 @}
10654 @end smallexample
10655
10656 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10657
10658 @smallexample
10659 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10660 $1 = void
10661 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10662 $2 = 1
10663 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10664 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10665 $3 = void
10666 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10667 $4 = 1
10668 @end smallexample
10669
10670 @end table
10671
10672 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10673 @code{Python} support.
10674
10675 @table @code
10676
10677 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10678 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10679 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10680 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10681 Otherwise it returns zero.
10682
10683 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10684 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10685 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10686 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10687 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10688 regular expression support.
10689
10690 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10691 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10692 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10693 Otherwise it returns zero.
10694
10695 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10696 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10697 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10698
10699 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10700 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10701 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10702 Otherwise it returns zero.
10703
10704 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10705 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10706 The default is 1.
10707
10708 Example:
10709
10710 @smallexample
10711 (gdb) backtrace
10712 #0 bottom_func ()
10713 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10714 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10715 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10716 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10717 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10718 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10719 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10720 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10721 $1 = 1
10722 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10723 $1 = 1
10724 @end smallexample
10725
10726 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10727 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10728 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10729 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10730
10731 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10732 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10733 The default is 1.
10734
10735 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10736 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10737 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10738 Otherwise it returns zero.
10739
10740 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10741 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10742 The default is 1.
10743
10744 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10745 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10746 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10747 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10748
10749 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10750 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10751 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10752 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10753
10754 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10755 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10756 The default is 1.
10757
10758 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10759 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10760 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10761 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10762
10763 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
10764 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10765 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10766
10767 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10768 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10769 an enumerated type:
10770
10771 @smallexample
10772 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10773 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10774 @end smallexample
10775
10776 @end table
10777
10778 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10779 convenience functions.
10780
10781 @table @code
10782 @item help function
10783 @kindex help function
10784 @cindex show all convenience functions
10785 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10786 @end table
10787
10788 @node Registers
10789 @section Registers
10790
10791 @cindex registers
10792 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10793 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10794 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10795 your machine.
10796
10797 @table @code
10798 @kindex info registers
10799 @item info registers
10800 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10801 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10802
10803 @kindex info all-registers
10804 @cindex floating point registers
10805 @item info all-registers
10806 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10807 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10808
10809 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10810 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10811 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10812 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10813 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10814 @end table
10815
10816 @anchor{standard registers}
10817 @cindex stack pointer register
10818 @cindex program counter register
10819 @cindex process status register
10820 @cindex frame pointer register
10821 @cindex standard registers
10822 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10823 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10824 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10825 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10826 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10827 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10828 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10829 you could print the program counter in hex with
10830
10831 @smallexample
10832 p/x $pc
10833 @end smallexample
10834
10835 @noindent
10836 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10837
10838 @smallexample
10839 x/i $pc
10840 @end smallexample
10841
10842 @noindent
10843 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10844 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10845 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10846 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10847 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10848 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10849 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10850
10851 @smallexample
10852 set $sp += 4
10853 @end smallexample
10854
10855 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10856 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10857 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10858 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10859 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10860 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10861 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10862
10863 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10864 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10865 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10866 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10867 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10868 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10869 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10870
10871 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10872 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10873 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10874 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10875 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10876 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10877 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10878 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10879 prints the data in both formats.
10880
10881 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10882 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10883 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10884 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10885 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10886 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10887 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10888
10889 @smallexample
10890 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10891 $1 = @{
10892 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10893 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10894 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10895 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10896 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10897 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10898 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10899 @}
10900 @end smallexample
10901
10902 @noindent
10903 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10904 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10905 value to a @code{struct} member:
10906
10907 @smallexample
10908 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10909 @end smallexample
10910
10911 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10912 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10913 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10914 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10915 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10916 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10917
10918 @cindex caller-saved registers
10919 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10920 @cindex volatile registers
10921 @cindex <not saved> values
10922 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10923 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10924 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10925 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10926 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10927 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10928 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10929 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10930 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10931 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10932 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10933 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10934 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10935 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10936 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10937 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10938 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10939 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10940 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10941 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10942 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10943 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10944 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10945
10946 @node Floating Point Hardware
10947 @section Floating Point Hardware
10948 @cindex floating point
10949
10950 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10951 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10952
10953 @table @code
10954 @kindex info float
10955 @item info float
10956 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10957 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10958 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10959 the ARM and x86 machines.
10960 @end table
10961
10962 @node Vector Unit
10963 @section Vector Unit
10964 @cindex vector unit
10965
10966 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10967 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10968
10969 @table @code
10970 @kindex info vector
10971 @item info vector
10972 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10973 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10974 @end table
10975
10976 @node OS Information
10977 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10978 @cindex OS information
10979
10980 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10981 you debug your program.
10982
10983 @cindex auxiliary vector
10984 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10985 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10986 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10987 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10988 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10989 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10990 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10991 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10992 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10993 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10994 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10995 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10996
10997 @table @code
10998 @kindex info auxv
10999 @item info auxv
11000 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11001 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11002 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11003 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11004 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11005 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11006 an unrecognized tag.
11007 @end table
11008
11009 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11010 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11011 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11012 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11013 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11014 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11015 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11016
11017 @table @code
11018 @kindex info os
11019 @item info os @var{infotype}
11020
11021 Display OS information of the requested type.
11022
11023 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11024
11025 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11026 @table @code
11027 @kindex info os cpus
11028 @item cpus
11029 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11030 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11031 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11032 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11033 kernel initialization.
11034
11035 @kindex info os files
11036 @item files
11037 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11038 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11039 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11040 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11041
11042 @kindex info os modules
11043 @item modules
11044 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11045 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11046 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11047 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11048 in memory.
11049
11050 @kindex info os msg
11051 @item msg
11052 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11053 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11054 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11055 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11056 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11057 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11058 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11059 the message queue was last changed.
11060
11061 @kindex info os processes
11062 @item processes
11063 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11064 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11065 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11066 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11067 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11068 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11069
11070 @kindex info os procgroups
11071 @item procgroups
11072 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11073 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11074 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11075 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11076 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11077 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11078 and the process group leader is listed first.
11079
11080 @kindex info os semaphores
11081 @item semaphores
11082 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11083 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11084 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11085 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11086 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11087
11088 @kindex info os shm
11089 @item shm
11090 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11091 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11092 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11093 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11094 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11095 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11096 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11097
11098 @kindex info os sockets
11099 @item sockets
11100 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11101 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11102 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11103 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11104 connection.
11105
11106 @kindex info os threads
11107 @item threads
11108 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11109 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11110 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11111 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11112 process is not listed.
11113 @end table
11114
11115 @item info os
11116 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11117 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11118 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11119 types, this command will report an error.
11120 @end table
11121
11122 @node Memory Region Attributes
11123 @section Memory Region Attributes
11124 @cindex memory region attributes
11125
11126 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11127 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11128 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11129 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11130 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11131 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11132 user can override the fetched regions.
11133
11134 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11135 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11136 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11137 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11138 all memory.
11139
11140 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11141 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11142
11143 @table @code
11144 @kindex mem
11145 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11146 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11147 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11148 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11149 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11150 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11151
11152 @item mem auto
11153 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11154 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11155
11156 @kindex delete mem
11157 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11158 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11159 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11160
11161 @kindex disable mem
11162 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11163 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11164 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11165 It may be enabled again later.
11166
11167 @kindex enable mem
11168 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11169 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11170
11171 @kindex info mem
11172 @item info mem
11173 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11174 for each region:
11175
11176 @table @emph
11177 @item Memory Region Number
11178 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11179 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11180 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11181
11182 @item Lo Address
11183 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11184
11185 @item Hi Address
11186 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11187
11188 @item Attributes
11189 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11190 @end table
11191 @end table
11192
11193
11194 @subsection Attributes
11195
11196 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11197 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11198 write accesses to a memory region.
11199
11200 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11201 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11202 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11203
11204 @table @code
11205 @item ro
11206 Memory is read only.
11207 @item wo
11208 Memory is write only.
11209 @item rw
11210 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11211 @end table
11212
11213 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11214 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11215 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11216 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11217 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11218
11219 @table @code
11220 @item 8
11221 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11222 @item 16
11223 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11224 @item 32
11225 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11226 @item 64
11227 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11228 @end table
11229
11230 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11231 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11232 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11233 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11234 @c
11235 @c @table @code
11236 @c @item hwbreak
11237 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11238 @c @item swbreak (default)
11239 @c @end table
11240
11241 @subsubsection Data Cache
11242 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11243 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11244 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11245 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11246 registers.
11247
11248 @table @code
11249 @item cache
11250 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11251 @item nocache
11252 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11253 @end table
11254
11255 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11256 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11257 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11258 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11259 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11260
11261 @table @code
11262 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11263 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11264 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11265 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11266 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11267 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11268 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11269 The default value is @code{on}.
11270 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11271 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11272 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11273 @end table
11274
11275
11276 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11277 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11278 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11279 @c
11280 @c @table @code
11281 @c @item verify
11282 @c @item noverify (default)
11283 @c @end table
11284
11285 @node Dump/Restore Files
11286 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11287 @cindex dump/restore files
11288 @cindex append data to a file
11289 @cindex dump data to a file
11290 @cindex restore data from a file
11291
11292 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11293 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11294 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11295 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11296 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11297 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11298 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11299
11300 @table @code
11301
11302 @kindex dump
11303 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11304 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11305 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11306 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11307
11308 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11309 @table @code
11310 @item binary
11311 Raw binary form.
11312 @item ihex
11313 Intel hex format.
11314 @item srec
11315 Motorola S-record format.
11316 @item tekhex
11317 Tektronix Hex format.
11318 @item verilog
11319 Verilog Hex format.
11320 @end table
11321
11322 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11323 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11324 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11325 form.
11326
11327 @kindex append
11328 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11329 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11330 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11331 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11332 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11333
11334 @kindex restore
11335 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11336 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11337 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11338 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11339 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11340
11341 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11342 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11343 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11344 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11345 from that location.
11346
11347 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11348 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11349 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11350 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11351
11352 @end table
11353
11354 @node Core File Generation
11355 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11356 @cindex dump core from inferior
11357
11358 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11359 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11360 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11361 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11362 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11363 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11364 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11365
11366 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11367 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11368 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11369
11370 @table @code
11371 @kindex gcore
11372 @kindex generate-core-file
11373 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11374 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11375 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11376 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11377 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11378 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11379
11380 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11381 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11382
11383 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11384 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11385 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11386
11387 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11388 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11389 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11390 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11391 Enable or disable the use of the file
11392 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11393 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11394 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11395 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11396
11397 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11398 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11399 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11400 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11401 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11402 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11403 about the bits that can be set in the
11404 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11405 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11406
11407 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11408 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11409 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11410 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11411 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11412 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11413 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11414 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11415 @end table
11416
11417 @node Character Sets
11418 @section Character Sets
11419 @cindex character sets
11420 @cindex charset
11421 @cindex translating between character sets
11422 @cindex host character set
11423 @cindex target character set
11424
11425 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11426 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11427 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11428 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11429 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11430 @dfn{target character set}.
11431
11432 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11433 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11434 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11435 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11436 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11437 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11438 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11439 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11440 character and string literals in expressions.
11441
11442 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11443 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11444 target-charset} command, described below.
11445
11446 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11447 support:
11448
11449 @table @code
11450 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11451 @kindex set target-charset
11452 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11453 list of supported target character sets, type
11454 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11455
11456 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11457 @kindex set host-charset
11458 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11459
11460 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11461 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11462 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11463 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11464 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11465
11466 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11467 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11468 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11469
11470 @item set charset @var{charset}
11471 @kindex set charset
11472 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11473 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11474 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11475 for both host and target.
11476
11477 @item show charset
11478 @kindex show charset
11479 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11480
11481 @item show host-charset
11482 @kindex show host-charset
11483 Show the name of the current host character set.
11484
11485 @item show target-charset
11486 @kindex show target-charset
11487 Show the name of the current target character set.
11488
11489 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11490 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11491 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11492 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11493 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11494 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11495
11496 @item show target-wide-charset
11497 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11498 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11499 @end table
11500
11501 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11502 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11503 @file{charset-test.c}:
11504
11505 @smallexample
11506 #include <stdio.h>
11507
11508 char ascii_hello[]
11509 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11510 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11511 char ibm1047_hello[]
11512 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11513 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11514
11515 main ()
11516 @{
11517 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11518 @}
11519 @end smallexample
11520
11521 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11522 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11523 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11524
11525 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11526
11527 @smallexample
11528 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11529 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11530 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11531 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11532 @dots{}
11533 (@value{GDBP})
11534 @end smallexample
11535
11536 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11537 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11538 strings:
11539
11540 @smallexample
11541 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11542 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11543 (@value{GDBP})
11544 @end smallexample
11545
11546 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11547 initial character set:
11548 @smallexample
11549 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11550 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11551 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11552 (@value{GDBP})
11553 @end smallexample
11554
11555 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11556 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11557 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11558 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11559 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11560
11561 @smallexample
11562 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11563 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11564 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11565 $2 = 72 'H'
11566 (@value{GDBP})
11567 @end smallexample
11568
11569 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11570 literals you use in expressions:
11571
11572 @smallexample
11573 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11574 $3 = 43 '+'
11575 (@value{GDBP})
11576 @end smallexample
11577
11578 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11579 character.
11580
11581 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11582 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11583 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11584
11585 @smallexample
11586 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11587 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11588 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11589 $5 = 200 '\310'
11590 (@value{GDBP})
11591 @end smallexample
11592
11593 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11594 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11595
11596 @smallexample
11597 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11598 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11599 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11600 @end smallexample
11601
11602 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11603 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11604 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11605 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11606 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11607
11608 @smallexample
11609 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11610 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11611 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11612 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11613 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11614 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11615 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11616 $7 = 72 '\110'
11617 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11618 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11619 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11620 $9 = 200 'H'
11621 (@value{GDBP})
11622 @end smallexample
11623
11624 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11625 string literals you use in expressions:
11626
11627 @smallexample
11628 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11629 $10 = 78 '+'
11630 (@value{GDBP})
11631 @end smallexample
11632
11633 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11634 character.
11635
11636 @node Caching Target Data
11637 @section Caching Data of Targets
11638 @cindex caching data of targets
11639
11640 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11641 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11642 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11643 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11644 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11645 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11646 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11647 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11648 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11649 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11650 is executing.
11651 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11652 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11653 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11654 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11655 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11656 in the code segment.
11657 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11658 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11659
11660 @table @code
11661 @kindex set remotecache
11662 @item set remotecache on
11663 @itemx set remotecache off
11664 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11665 with old scripts.
11666
11667 @kindex show remotecache
11668 @item show remotecache
11669 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11670
11671 @kindex set stack-cache
11672 @item set stack-cache on
11673 @itemx set stack-cache off
11674 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11675 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11676
11677 @kindex show stack-cache
11678 @item show stack-cache
11679 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11680
11681 @kindex set code-cache
11682 @item set code-cache on
11683 @itemx set code-cache off
11684 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11685 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11686 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11687
11688 @kindex show code-cache
11689 @item show code-cache
11690 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11691 accesses.
11692
11693 @kindex info dcache
11694 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11695 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11696 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11697 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11698 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11699 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11700
11701 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11702 printed in hex.
11703
11704 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11705 @cindex dcache size
11706 @kindex set dcache size
11707 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11708
11709 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11710 @cindex dcache line-size
11711 @kindex set dcache line-size
11712 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11713 Must be a power of 2.
11714
11715 @item show dcache size
11716 @kindex show dcache size
11717 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11718
11719 @item show dcache line-size
11720 @kindex show dcache line-size
11721 Show default size of dcache lines.
11722
11723 @end table
11724
11725 @node Searching Memory
11726 @section Search Memory
11727 @cindex searching memory
11728
11729 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11730 @code{find} command.
11731
11732 @table @code
11733 @kindex find
11734 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11735 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11736 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11737 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11738 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11739 @end table
11740
11741 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11742 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11743
11744 @table @r
11745 @item @var{s}, search query size
11746 The size of each search query value.
11747
11748 @table @code
11749 @item b
11750 bytes
11751 @item h
11752 halfwords (two bytes)
11753 @item w
11754 words (four bytes)
11755 @item g
11756 giant words (eight bytes)
11757 @end table
11758
11759 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11760 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11761 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11762
11763 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11764 value's type in the current language.
11765 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11766 pattern as a mixture of types.
11767 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11768 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11769 which is typically four bytes.
11770
11771 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11772 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11773 @end table
11774
11775 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11776 (@code{"}).
11777 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11778 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11779
11780 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11781 number of matches found.
11782
11783 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11784 @samp{$_}.
11785 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11786
11787 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11788
11789 @smallexample
11790 void
11791 hello ()
11792 @{
11793 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11794 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11795 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11796 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11797 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11798 @}
11799 @end smallexample
11800
11801 @noindent
11802 you get during debugging:
11803
11804 @smallexample
11805 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11806 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11807 1 pattern found
11808 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11809 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11810 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11811 2 patterns found
11812 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11813 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11814 1 pattern found
11815 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11816 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11817 1 pattern found
11818 (gdb) print $numfound
11819 $1 = 1
11820 (gdb) print $_
11821 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11822 @end smallexample
11823
11824 @node Value Sizes
11825 @section Value Sizes
11826
11827 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
11828 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
11829 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
11830 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
11831 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
11832
11833 @table @code
11834 @kindex set max-value-size
11835 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
11836 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
11837 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
11838 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
11839 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
11840
11841 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
11842 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
11843
11844 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
11845 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
11846 currently 16 bytes.
11847
11848 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
11849 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
11850 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
11851 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
11852 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
11853 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
11854 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
11855 size is less than @var{bytes}.
11856
11857 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
11858
11859 @kindex show max-value-size
11860 @item show max-value-size
11861 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
11862 allocate for the contents of a value.
11863 @end table
11864
11865 @node Optimized Code
11866 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11867 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11868 @cindex debugging optimized code
11869
11870 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11871 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11872 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11873 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11874 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11875 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11876 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11877
11878 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11879 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11880 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11881 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11882
11883 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11884 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11885 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11886 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11887 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11888 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11889
11890 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11891 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11892 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11893 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11894 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11895
11896 @menu
11897 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11898 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11899 @end menu
11900
11901 @node Inline Functions
11902 @section Inline Functions
11903 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11904
11905 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11906 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11907 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11908 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11909 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11910 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11911 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11912 @code{info frame} command.
11913
11914 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11915 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11916 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11917 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11918 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11919 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11920 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11921 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11922 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11923 local variables in the caller.
11924
11925 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11926 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11927 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11928 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11929 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11930 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11931 instructions are executed.
11932
11933 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11934 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11935 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11936 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11937
11938 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11939 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11940
11941 @itemize @bullet
11942 @item
11943 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11944 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11945 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11946 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11947 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11948 or inside the inlined function instead.
11949
11950 @item
11951 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11952 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11953 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11954 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11955
11956 @end itemize
11957
11958 @node Tail Call Frames
11959 @section Tail Call Frames
11960 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11961
11962 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11963 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11964 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11965 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11966 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11967
11968 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11969 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11970 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11971 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11972 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11973 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11974 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11975
11976 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11977 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11978 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11979 this information.
11980
11981 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11982 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11983
11984 @smallexample
11985 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11986 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11987 (gdb) info frame
11988 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11989 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11990 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11991 source language c++.
11992 Arglist at unknown address.
11993 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11994 @end smallexample
11995
11996 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11997 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11998 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11999 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12000 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12001 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12002
12003 @table @code
12004 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12005 @item set debug entry-values
12006 @kindex set debug entry-values
12007 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12008 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12009 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12010 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12011 result.
12012
12013 @item show debug entry-values
12014 @kindex show debug entry-values
12015 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12016 values at function entry and tail calls.
12017 @end table
12018
12019 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12020 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12021 reference by variable @code{x}):
12022
12023 @smallexample
12024 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12025 void (*x) (void) = c;
12026 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12027 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12028 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12029
12030 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
12031 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
12032 a () at t.c:3
12033 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12034 (gdb) bt
12035 #0 a () at t.c:3
12036 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12037 @end smallexample
12038
12039 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12040
12041 @smallexample
12042 int i;
12043 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12044 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12045 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12046 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12047 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12048 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12049 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12050 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12051
12052 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12053 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12054 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12055 (gdb) bt
12056 #0 f () at t.c:2
12057 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12058 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12059 @end smallexample
12060
12061 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12062 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12063
12064 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12065 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12066 @set ARROW @click{}
12067 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12068 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12069 @end ifset
12070 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12071 @set ARROW ->
12072 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12073 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12074 @end ifclear
12075
12076 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12077 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12078 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12079
12080 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12081 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12082 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12083 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12084 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12085 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12086
12087 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12088 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12089 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12090 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12091 omitted.
12092
12093 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12094 entry may fail:
12095
12096 @smallexample
12097 int v;
12098 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12099 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12100 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12101 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12102 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12103 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12104
12105 (gdb) bt
12106 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12107 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
12108 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12109 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12110 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12111 @end smallexample
12112
12113 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12114 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12115 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12116 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12117 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12118
12119 @node Macros
12120 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12121
12122 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12123 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12124 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12125 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12126 where it was defined.
12127
12128 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12129 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12130 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12131 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12132
12133 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12134 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12135 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12136 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12137 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12138 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12139 see @ref{List}.
12140
12141 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12142 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12143 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12144
12145 @table @code
12146
12147 @kindex macro expand
12148 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12149 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12150 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12151 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12152 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12153 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12154 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12155 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12156 it can be any string of tokens.
12157
12158 @kindex macro exp1
12159 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12160 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12161 @cindex expand macro once
12162 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12163 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12164 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12165 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12166 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12167 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12168 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12169 can be any string of tokens.
12170
12171 @kindex info macro
12172 @cindex macro definition, showing
12173 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12174 @cindex macros, from debug info
12175 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12176 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12177 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12178 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12179 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12180 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12181
12182 @kindex info macros
12183 @item info macros @var{location}
12184 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12185 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12186 command-line where those definitions were established.
12187
12188 @kindex macro define
12189 @cindex user-defined macros
12190 @cindex defining macros interactively
12191 @cindex macros, user-defined
12192 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12193 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12194 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12195 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12196 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12197 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12198 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12199 @var{arglist}.
12200
12201 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12202 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12203 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12204 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12205 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12206
12207 @kindex macro undef
12208 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12209 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12210 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12211 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12212 in the program being debugged.
12213
12214 @kindex macro list
12215 @item macro list
12216 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12217 @end table
12218
12219 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12220 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12221 show our source files:
12222
12223 @smallexample
12224 $ cat sample.c
12225 #include <stdio.h>
12226 #include "sample.h"
12227
12228 #define M 42
12229 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12230
12231 main ()
12232 @{
12233 #define N 28
12234 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12235 #undef N
12236 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12237 #define N 1729
12238 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12239 @}
12240 $ cat sample.h
12241 #define Q <
12242 $
12243 @end smallexample
12244
12245 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12246 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12247 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12248 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12249 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12250 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12251 information.
12252
12253 @smallexample
12254 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12255 $
12256 @end smallexample
12257
12258 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12259
12260 @smallexample
12261 $ gdb -nw sample
12262 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12263 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12264 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12265 (@value{GDBP})
12266 @end smallexample
12267
12268 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12269 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12270 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12271
12272 @smallexample
12273 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12274 3
12275 4 #define M 42
12276 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12277 6
12278 7 main ()
12279 8 @{
12280 9 #define N 28
12281 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12282 11 #undef N
12283 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12284 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12285 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12286 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12287 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12288 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12289 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12290 #define Q <
12291 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12292 expands to: (42 + 1)
12293 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12294 expands to: once (M + 1)
12295 (@value{GDBP})
12296 @end smallexample
12297
12298 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12299 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12300 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12301 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12302
12303 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12304 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12305
12306 @smallexample
12307 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12308 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12309 (@value{GDBP}) run
12310 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12311
12312 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12313 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12314 (@value{GDBP})
12315 @end smallexample
12316
12317 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12318
12319 @smallexample
12320 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12321 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12322 #define N 28
12323 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12324 expands to: 28 < 42
12325 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12326 $1 = 1
12327 (@value{GDBP})
12328 @end smallexample
12329
12330 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12331 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12332 thereof) in force at each point:
12333
12334 @smallexample
12335 (@value{GDBP}) next
12336 Hello, world!
12337 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12338 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12339 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12340 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12341 (@value{GDBP}) next
12342 We're so creative.
12343 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12344 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12345 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12346 #define N 1729
12347 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12348 expands to: 1729 < 42
12349 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12350 $2 = 0
12351 (@value{GDBP})
12352 @end smallexample
12353
12354 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12355 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12356 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12357 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12358
12359 @smallexample
12360 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12361 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12362 -D__STDC__=1
12363 (@value{GDBP})
12364 @end smallexample
12365
12366
12367 @node Tracepoints
12368 @chapter Tracepoints
12369 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12370 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12371
12372 @cindex tracepoints
12373 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12374 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12375 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12376 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12377 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12378 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12379 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12380
12381 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12382 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12383 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12384 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12385 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12386 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12387 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12388 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12389 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12390 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12391 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12392
12393 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12394 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12395 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12396 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12397 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12398 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12399 Packets}.
12400
12401 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12402 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12403 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12404
12405 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12406
12407 @menu
12408 * Set Tracepoints::
12409 * Analyze Collected Data::
12410 * Tracepoint Variables::
12411 * Trace Files::
12412 @end menu
12413
12414 @node Set Tracepoints
12415 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12416
12417 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12418 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12419 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12420 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12421 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12422 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12423 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12424
12425 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12426 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12427 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12428 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12429 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12430 tracepoint was hit.
12431
12432 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12433 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12434 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12435 either.
12436
12437 @cindex fast tracepoints
12438 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12439 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12440 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12441
12442 @cindex static tracepoints
12443 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12444 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12445 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12446 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12447 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12448 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12449 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12450 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12451 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12452 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12453 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12454 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12455 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12456 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12457 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12458 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12459 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12460 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12461 static tracepoint marker.
12462
12463 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12464 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12465
12466 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12467 conditions and actions.
12468
12469 @menu
12470 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12471 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12472 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12473 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12474 * Trace State Variables::
12475 * Tracepoint Actions::
12476 * Listing Tracepoints::
12477 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12478 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12479 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12480 @end menu
12481
12482 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12483 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12484
12485 @table @code
12486 @cindex set tracepoint
12487 @kindex trace
12488 @item trace @var{location}
12489 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12490 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12491 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12492 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12493 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12494 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12495 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12496 in tracing}).
12497 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12498 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12499 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12500 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12501 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12502 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12503 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12504 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12505 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12506 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12507 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12508 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12509
12510 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12511
12512 @smallexample
12513 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12514
12515 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12516
12517 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12518
12519 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12520
12521 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12522 @end smallexample
12523
12524 @noindent
12525 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12526
12527 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12528 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12529 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12530 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12531 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12532 information on tracepoint conditions.
12533
12534 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12535 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12536 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12537 @kindex ftrace
12538 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12539 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12540 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12541 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12542 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12543 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12544 message.
12545
12546 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12547 @code{trace}.
12548
12549 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12550 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12551 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12552 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12553 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12554 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12555 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12556 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12557
12558 @example
12559 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12560 @end example
12561
12562 @noindent
12563 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12564 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12565
12566 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12567 @cindex set static tracepoint
12568 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12569 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12570 @kindex strace
12571 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12572 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12573 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12574 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12575 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12576
12577 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12578 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12579 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12580 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12581 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12582 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12583 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12584 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12585 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12586 tracing engine:
12587
12588 @smallexample
12589 main ()
12590 @{
12591 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12592 @}
12593 @end smallexample
12594
12595 @noindent
12596 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12597 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12598
12599 @smallexample
12600 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12601 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12602 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12603 Data: "str %s"
12604 [etc...]
12605 @end smallexample
12606
12607 @noindent
12608 so you may probe the marker above with:
12609
12610 @smallexample
12611 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12612 @end smallexample
12613
12614 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12615 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12616 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12617 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12618 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12619 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12620 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12621 the @samp{Data:} field.
12622
12623 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12624 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12625 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12626
12627 @vindex $tpnum
12628 @cindex last tracepoint number
12629 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12630 @cindex tracepoint number
12631 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12632 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12633
12634 @kindex delete tracepoint
12635 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12636 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12637 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12638 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12639 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12640
12641 Examples:
12642
12643 @smallexample
12644 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12645
12646 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12647 @end smallexample
12648
12649 @noindent
12650 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12651 @end table
12652
12653 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12654 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12655
12656 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12657
12658 @table @code
12659 @kindex disable tracepoint
12660 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12661 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12662 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12663 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12664 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12665 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12666 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12667 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12668 next trace experiment.
12669
12670 @kindex enable tracepoint
12671 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12672 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12673 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12674 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12675 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12676 next time a trace experiment is run.
12677 @end table
12678
12679 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12680 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12681
12682 @table @code
12683 @kindex passcount
12684 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12685 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12686 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12687 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12688 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12689 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12690 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12691 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12692 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12693 user.
12694
12695 Examples:
12696
12697 @smallexample
12698 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12699 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12700
12701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12702 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12704 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12706 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12707 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12709 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12710 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12711 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12712 @end smallexample
12713 @end table
12714
12715 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12716 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12717 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12718 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12719
12720 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12721 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12722 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12723 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12724 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12725 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12726 is true.
12727
12728 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12729 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12730 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12731 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12732 just as with breakpoints.
12733
12734 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12735 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12736 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12737 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12738 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12739 accesses, and so forth.
12740
12741 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12742 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12743 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12744 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12745 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12746 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12747 search through.
12748
12749 @smallexample
12750 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12751 @end smallexample
12752
12753 @node Trace State Variables
12754 @subsection Trace State Variables
12755 @cindex trace state variables
12756
12757 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12758 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12759 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12760 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12761 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12762 integers.
12763
12764 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12765 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12766 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12767 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12768
12769 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12770 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12771 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12772 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12773 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12774 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12775 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12776 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12777 variable with the same name.
12778
12779 @table @code
12780
12781 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12782 @kindex tvariable
12783 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12784 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12785 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12786 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12787 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12788 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12789 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12790 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12791 value. The default initial value is 0.
12792
12793 @item info tvariables
12794 @kindex info tvariables
12795 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12796 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12797 currently running.
12798
12799 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12800 @kindex delete tvariable
12801 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12802 are specified.
12803
12804 @end table
12805
12806 @node Tracepoint Actions
12807 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12808
12809 @table @code
12810 @kindex actions
12811 @cindex tracepoint actions
12812 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12813 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12814 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12815 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12816 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12817 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12818 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12819 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12820 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12821 @code{while-stepping}.
12822
12823 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12824 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12825 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12826
12827 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12828 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12829 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12830
12831 @smallexample
12832 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12833
12834 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12835
12836 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12837 @end smallexample
12838
12839 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12840 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12841 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12842 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12843 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12844 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12845 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12846 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12847
12848 @smallexample
12849 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12850 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12851 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12852 > collect bar,baz
12853 > collect $regs
12854 > while-stepping 12
12855 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12856 > end
12857 end
12858 @end smallexample
12859
12860 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12861 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12862 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12863 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12864 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12865 special arguments are supported:
12866
12867 @table @code
12868 @item $regs
12869 Collect all registers.
12870
12871 @item $args
12872 Collect all function arguments.
12873
12874 @item $locals
12875 Collect all local variables.
12876
12877 @item $_ret
12878 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12879 of a backtrace.
12880
12881 @item $_probe_argc
12882 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12883 tracepoint is located.
12884 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12885
12886 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12887 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12888 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12889 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12890
12891 @item $_sdata
12892 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12893 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12894 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12895 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12896 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12897 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12898 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12899 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12900 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12901
12902 @smallexample
12903 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12904 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12905 @end smallexample
12906
12907 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12908 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12909 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12910 @value{GDBN}.
12911 @end table
12912
12913 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12914 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12915 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12916
12917 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12918 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12919 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12920 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12921 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12922 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12923 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12924 @samp{mystr}.
12925
12926 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12927 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12928
12929 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12930 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12931 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12932 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12933 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12934 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12935 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12936 action were used.
12937
12938 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12939 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12940 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12941 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12942 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12943 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12944
12945 @smallexample
12946 > while-stepping 12
12947 > collect $regs, myglobal
12948 > end
12949 >
12950 @end smallexample
12951
12952 @noindent
12953 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12954 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12955 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12956 @code{stepping}.
12957
12958 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12959 @kindex set default-collect
12960 @cindex default collection action
12961 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12962 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12963 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12964 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12965 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12966 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12967
12968 @item show default-collect
12969 @kindex show default-collect
12970 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12971 tracepoint hit.
12972
12973 @end table
12974
12975 @node Listing Tracepoints
12976 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12977
12978 @table @code
12979 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12980 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12981 @cindex information about tracepoints
12982 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12983 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12984 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12985 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12986 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12987 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12988
12989 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12990 tracing:
12991
12992 @itemize @bullet
12993 @item
12994 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12995
12996 @item
12997 the state about installed on target of each location
12998 @end itemize
12999
13000 @smallexample
13001 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13002 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13003 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13004 while-stepping 20
13005 collect globfoo, $regs
13006 end
13007 collect globfoo2
13008 end
13009 pass count 1200
13010 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13011 collect $eip
13012 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13013 installed on target
13014 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13015 installed on target
13016 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13017 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13018 not installed on target
13019 (@value{GDBP})
13020 @end smallexample
13021
13022 @noindent
13023 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13024 @end table
13025
13026 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13027 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13028
13029 @table @code
13030 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13031 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13032 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13033 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13034 program.
13035
13036 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13037
13038 @table @emph
13039 @item Count
13040 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13041 stable identifier.
13042 @item ID
13043 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13044 @item Enabled or Disabled
13045 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13046 that are not enabled.
13047 @item Address
13048 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13049 @item What
13050 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13051 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13052 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13053 will be left blank.
13054 @end table
13055
13056 @noindent
13057 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13058
13059 @table @emph
13060 @item Data
13061 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13062 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13063 marker call.
13064 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13065 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13066 @end table
13067
13068 @smallexample
13069 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13070 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13071 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13072 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13073 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13074 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13075 Data: str %s
13076 (@value{GDBP})
13077 @end smallexample
13078 @end table
13079
13080 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13081 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13082
13083 @table @code
13084 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13085 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13086 @cindex collected data discarded
13087 @item tstart
13088 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13089 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13090 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13091 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13092 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13093 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13094 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13095 information, and so forth.
13096
13097 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13098 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13099 @item tstop
13100 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13101 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13102 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13103 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13104 needs to be stopped quickly.
13105
13106 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13107 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13108 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13109
13110 @kindex tstatus
13111 @cindex status of trace data collection
13112 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13113 @item tstatus
13114 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13115 collection.
13116 @end table
13117
13118 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13119
13120 @smallexample
13121 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13122 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13123 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13124 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13125 > while-stepping 11
13126 > collect $regs
13127 > end
13128 > end
13129 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13130 [time passes @dots{}]
13131 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13132 @end smallexample
13133
13134 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13135 @cindex disconnected tracing
13136 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13137 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13138 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13139 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13140 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13141 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13142 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13143 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13144
13145 @table @code
13146 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13147 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13148 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13149 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13150 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13151 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13152 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13153 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13154
13155 @item show disconnected-tracing
13156 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13157 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13158
13159 @end table
13160
13161 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13162 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13163 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13164 it will continue after reconnection.
13165
13166 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13167 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13168 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13169 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13170 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13171 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13172 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13173 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13174 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13175 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13176
13177 @cindex circular trace buffer
13178 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13179 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13180 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13181 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13182 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13183 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13184 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13185 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13186 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13187 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13188 the next run.
13189
13190 @table @code
13191 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13192 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13193 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13194 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13195 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13196 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13197 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13198
13199 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13200 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13201 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13202 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13203 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13204 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13205
13206 @end table
13207
13208 @table @code
13209 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13210 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13211 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13212 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13213 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13214 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13215 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13216 likes. This is also the default.
13217
13218 @item show trace-buffer-size
13219 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13220 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13221 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13222 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13223 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13224 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13225 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13226 @end table
13227
13228 @table @code
13229 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13230 @kindex set trace-user
13231
13232 @item show trace-user
13233 @kindex show trace-user
13234
13235 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13236 @kindex set trace-notes
13237 Set the trace run's notes.
13238
13239 @item show trace-notes
13240 @kindex show trace-notes
13241 Show the trace run's notes.
13242
13243 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13244 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13245 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13246 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13247 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13248
13249 @item show trace-stop-notes
13250 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13251 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13252
13253 @end table
13254
13255 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13256 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13257
13258 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13259 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13260 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13261 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13262 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13263 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13264 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13265 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13266 mentioned here.
13267
13268 @itemize @bullet
13269
13270 @item
13271 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13272 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13273 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13274 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13275 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13276 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13277 cannot be collected either.
13278
13279 @item
13280 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13281 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13282 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13283 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13284 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13285 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13286 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13287 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13288 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13289 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13290
13291 @item
13292 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13293 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13294 in a misleading way.
13295
13296 @item
13297 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13298 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13299 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13300 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13301 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13302 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13303 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13304 by @code{ptr}.
13305
13306 @item
13307 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13308 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13309 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13310 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13311 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13312 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13313 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13314 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13315 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13316 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13317 invalid address.
13318
13319 @item
13320 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13321 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13322 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13323 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13324 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13325 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13326 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13327 it to zero.
13328
13329 @end itemize
13330
13331 @node Analyze Collected Data
13332 @section Using the Collected Data
13333
13334 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13335 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13336 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13337 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13338 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13339 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13340 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13341 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13342 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13343 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13344 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13345 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13346 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13347 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13348 the buffer will fail.
13349
13350 @menu
13351 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13352 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13353 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13354 @end menu
13355
13356 @node tfind
13357 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13358
13359 @kindex tfind
13360 @cindex select trace snapshot
13361 @cindex find trace snapshot
13362 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13363 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13364 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13365 snapshot is selected.
13366
13367 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13368
13369 @table @code
13370 @item tfind start
13371 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13372 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13373
13374 @item tfind none
13375 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13376
13377 @item tfind end
13378 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13379
13380 @item tfind
13381 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
13382
13383 @item tfind -
13384 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13385 retracing earlier steps.
13386
13387 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13388 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13389 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13390 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13391 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13392
13393 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13394 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13395 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13396 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13397 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13398
13399 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13400 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13401 addresses (exclusive).
13402
13403 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13404 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13405 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13406
13407 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13408 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13409 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13410 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13411 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13412 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13413 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13414 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13415 @end table
13416
13417 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13418 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13419 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13420 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13421 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13422 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13423 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13424 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13425 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13426 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13427 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13428 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13429 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13430 tracepoint as the current one.
13431
13432 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13433 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13434 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13435 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13436 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13437
13438 @smallexample
13439 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13440 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13441 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13442 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13443 > tfind
13444 > end
13445
13446 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13447 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13448 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13449 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13450 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13451 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13452 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13453 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13454 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13455 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13456 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13457 @end smallexample
13458
13459 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13460 the buffer:
13461
13462 @smallexample
13463 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13464 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13465 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13466 > tfind line
13467 > end
13468
13469 Frame 0, X = 1
13470 Frame 7, X = 2
13471 Frame 13, X = 255
13472 @end smallexample
13473
13474 @node tdump
13475 @subsection @code{tdump}
13476 @kindex tdump
13477 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13478 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13479
13480 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13481 the current trace snapshot.
13482
13483 @smallexample
13484 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13485 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13486 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13487 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13488 > end
13489
13490 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13491
13492 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13493 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13494 at gdb_test.c:444
13495 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13496
13497 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13498 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13499 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13500 d1 0x18 24
13501 d2 0x80 128
13502 d3 0x33 51
13503 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13504 d5 0x22 34
13505 d6 0xe0 224
13506 d7 0x380035 3670069
13507 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13508 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13509 a2 0x100 256
13510 a3 0x322000 3284992
13511 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13512 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13513 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13514 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13515 ps 0x0 0
13516 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13517 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13518 fpstatus 0x0 0
13519 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13520 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13521 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13522 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13523 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13524 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13525 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13526 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13527 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13528
13529 (@value{GDBP})
13530 @end smallexample
13531
13532 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13533 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13534 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13535 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13536
13537 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13538 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13539 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13540 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13541 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13542 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13543 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13544 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13545 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13546 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13547
13548 @node save tracepoints
13549 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13550 @kindex save tracepoints
13551 @kindex save-tracepoints
13552 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13553
13554 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13555 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13556 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13557 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13558 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13559 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13560
13561 @node Tracepoint Variables
13562 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13563 @cindex tracepoint variables
13564 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13565
13566 @table @code
13567 @vindex $trace_frame
13568 @item (int) $trace_frame
13569 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13570 snapshot is selected.
13571
13572 @vindex $tracepoint
13573 @item (int) $tracepoint
13574 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13575
13576 @vindex $trace_line
13577 @item (int) $trace_line
13578 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13579
13580 @vindex $trace_file
13581 @item (char []) $trace_file
13582 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13583
13584 @vindex $trace_func
13585 @item (char []) $trace_func
13586 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13587 @end table
13588
13589 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13590 use @code{output} instead.
13591
13592 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13593 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13594 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13595 which are managed by the target.
13596
13597 @smallexample
13598 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13599
13600 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13601 > output $trace_file
13602 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13603 > tfind
13604 > end
13605 @end smallexample
13606
13607 @node Trace Files
13608 @section Using Trace Files
13609 @cindex trace files
13610
13611 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13612 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13613 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13614 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13615 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13616
13617 @table @code
13618
13619 @kindex tsave
13620 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13621 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13622 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13623 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13624 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13625 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13626 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13627 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13628 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13629 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13630 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13631 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
13632 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13633 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13634 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13635
13636 @kindex target tfile
13637 @kindex tfile
13638 @kindex target ctf
13639 @kindex ctf
13640 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13641 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13642 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13643 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13644 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13645 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13646 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13647 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13648 the host.
13649
13650 @smallexample
13651 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13652 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13653 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13654 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13655 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13656 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13657 i = 0
13658 a = 0
13659 b = 1 '\001'
13660 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13661 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13662 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13663 $1 = 1
13664 @end smallexample
13665
13666 @end table
13667
13668 @node Overlays
13669 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13670 @cindex overlays
13671
13672 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13673 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13674 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13675 use overlays.
13676
13677 @menu
13678 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13679 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13680 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13681 mapped by asking the inferior.
13682 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13683 @end menu
13684
13685 @node How Overlays Work
13686 @section How Overlays Work
13687 @cindex mapped overlays
13688 @cindex unmapped overlays
13689 @cindex load address, overlay's
13690 @cindex mapped address
13691 @cindex overlay area
13692
13693 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13694 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13695 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13696 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13697 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13698
13699 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13700 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13701 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13702 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13703 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13704 largest overlay as well.
13705
13706 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13707 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13708 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13709 there.
13710
13711 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13712 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13713 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13714
13715 @smallexample
13716 @group
13717 Data Instruction Larger
13718 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13719 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13720 | | | | | |
13721 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13722 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13723 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13724 | and heap | | | | | |
13725 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13726 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13727 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13728 | | | | | |
13729 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13730 address | | | | | |
13731 | overlay | <-' | | |
13732 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13733 | | <---. | | load address
13734 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13735 | | | |
13736 +-----------+ | |
13737 +-----------+
13738 | |
13739 +-----------+
13740
13741 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13742 @end group
13743 @end smallexample
13744
13745 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13746 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13747 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13748 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13749 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13750 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13751 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13752 program and the overlay area.
13753
13754 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13755 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13756 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13757 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13758 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13759 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13760 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13761
13762 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13763 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13764 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13765
13766 @itemize @bullet
13767
13768 @item
13769 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13770 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13771 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13772 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13773
13774 @item
13775 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13776 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13777 your program's performance.
13778
13779 @item
13780 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13781 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13782 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13783 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13784 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13785 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13786 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13787
13788 @item
13789 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13790 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13791 instruction and data spaces.
13792
13793 @end itemize
13794
13795 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13796 improved in many ways:
13797
13798 @itemize @bullet
13799
13800 @item
13801 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13802 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13803 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13804 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13805 area in the usual way.
13806
13807 @item
13808 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13809 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13810
13811 @item
13812 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13813 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13814 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13815 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13816 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13817 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13818 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13819
13820 @end itemize
13821
13822
13823 @node Overlay Commands
13824 @section Overlay Commands
13825
13826 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13827 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13828 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13829 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13830 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13831 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13832
13833 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13834 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13835
13836 @table @code
13837 @item overlay off
13838 @kindex overlay
13839 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13840 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13841 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13842 overlay support is disabled.
13843
13844 @item overlay manual
13845 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13846 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13847 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13848 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13849 commands described below.
13850
13851 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13852 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13853 @cindex map an overlay
13854 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13855 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13856 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13857 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13858 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13859 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13860
13861 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13862 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13863 @cindex unmap an overlay
13864 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13865 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13866 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13867 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13868
13869 @item overlay auto
13870 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13871 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13872 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13873 Overlay Debugging}.
13874
13875 @item overlay load-target
13876 @itemx overlay load
13877 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13878 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13879 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13880 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13881 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13882 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13883
13884 @item overlay list-overlays
13885 @itemx overlay list
13886 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13887 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13888 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13889
13890 @end table
13891
13892 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13893 of the function the address falls in:
13894
13895 @smallexample
13896 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13897 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13898 @end smallexample
13899 @noindent
13900 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13901 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13902 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13903 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13904
13905 @smallexample
13906 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13907 No sections are mapped.
13908 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13909 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13910 @end smallexample
13911 @noindent
13912 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13913 name normally:
13914
13915 @smallexample
13916 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13917 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13918 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13919 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13920 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13921 @end smallexample
13922
13923 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13924 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13925 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13926 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13927 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13928
13929 @itemize @bullet
13930 @item
13931 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13932 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13933 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13934 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13935 @item
13936 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13937 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13938 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13939 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13940 breakpoints properly.
13941 @end itemize
13942
13943
13944 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13945 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13946 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13947
13948 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13949 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13950 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13951 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13952 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13953 current state of the overlays.
13954
13955 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13956 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13957
13958 @table @asis
13959
13960 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13961 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13962
13963 @smallexample
13964 struct
13965 @{
13966 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13967 unsigned long vma;
13968
13969 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13970 unsigned long size;
13971
13972 /* The overlay's load address. */
13973 unsigned long lma;
13974
13975 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13976 zero otherwise. */
13977 unsigned long mapped;
13978 @}
13979 @end smallexample
13980
13981 @item @code{_novlys}:
13982 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13983 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13984
13985 @end table
13986
13987 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13988 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13989 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13990 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13991 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13992 currently mapped.
13993
13994 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13995 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13996 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13997 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13998 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13999 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14000 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14001 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14002 are not being executed.
14003
14004 @node Overlay Sample Program
14005 @section Overlay Sample Program
14006 @cindex overlay example program
14007
14008 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14009 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14010 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14011 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14012 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14013 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14014 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14015
14016 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14017 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14018 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14019 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14020
14021 @table @file
14022 @item overlays.c
14023 The main program file.
14024 @item ovlymgr.c
14025 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14026 @item foo.c
14027 @itemx bar.c
14028 @itemx baz.c
14029 @itemx grbx.c
14030 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14031 @item d10v.ld
14032 @itemx m32r.ld
14033 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14034 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14035 @end table
14036
14037 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14038 cross-compiler like this:
14039
14040 @smallexample
14041 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14042 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14043 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14044 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14045 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14046 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14047 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14048 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14049 @end smallexample
14050
14051 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14052 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14053 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14054
14055
14056 @node Languages
14057 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14058 @cindex languages
14059
14060 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14061 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14062 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14063 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14064 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14065 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14066
14067 @cindex working language
14068 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14069 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14070 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14071 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14072 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14073 language}.
14074
14075 @menu
14076 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14077 * Show:: Displaying the language
14078 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14079 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14080 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14081 @end menu
14082
14083 @node Setting
14084 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14085
14086 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14087 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14088 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14089 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14090 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14091 are printed, etc.
14092
14093 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14094 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14095 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14096 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14097 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14098 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14099 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14100 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14101 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14102 Displaying the Language}.
14103
14104 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14105 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14106 another language. In that case, make the
14107 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14108 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14109 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14110
14111 @menu
14112 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14113 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14114 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14115 @end menu
14116
14117 @node Filenames
14118 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14119
14120 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14121 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14122
14123 @table @file
14124 @item .ada
14125 @itemx .ads
14126 @itemx .adb
14127 @itemx .a
14128 Ada source file.
14129
14130 @item .c
14131 C source file
14132
14133 @item .C
14134 @itemx .cc
14135 @itemx .cp
14136 @itemx .cpp
14137 @itemx .cxx
14138 @itemx .c++
14139 C@t{++} source file
14140
14141 @item .d
14142 D source file
14143
14144 @item .m
14145 Objective-C source file
14146
14147 @item .f
14148 @itemx .F
14149 Fortran source file
14150
14151 @item .mod
14152 Modula-2 source file
14153
14154 @item .s
14155 @itemx .S
14156 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14157 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14158 @end table
14159
14160 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14161 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14162
14163 @node Manually
14164 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14165
14166 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14167 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14168 your program.
14169
14170 @kindex set language
14171 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14172 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14173 a language, such as
14174 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14175 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14176
14177 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14178 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14179 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14180 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14181 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14182 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14183 command such as:
14184
14185 @smallexample
14186 print a = b + c
14187 @end smallexample
14188
14189 @noindent
14190 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14191 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14192 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14193 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14194
14195 @node Automatically
14196 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14197
14198 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14199 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14200 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14201 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14202 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14203 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14204 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14205 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14206 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14207
14208 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14209 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14210 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14211 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14212 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14213
14214 @node Show
14215 @section Displaying the Language
14216
14217 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14218 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14219
14220 @table @code
14221 @item show language
14222 @anchor{show language}
14223 @kindex show language
14224 Display the current working language. This is the
14225 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14226 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14227
14228 @item info frame
14229 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14230 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14231 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14232 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14233 information listed here.
14234
14235 @item info source
14236 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14237 Display the source language of this source file.
14238 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14239 information listed here.
14240 @end table
14241
14242 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14243 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14244 with a language explicitly:
14245
14246 @table @code
14247 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14248 @kindex set extension-language
14249 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14250 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14251
14252 @item info extensions
14253 @kindex info extensions
14254 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14255 @end table
14256
14257 @node Checks
14258 @section Type and Range Checking
14259
14260 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14261 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14262 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14263 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14264 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14265 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14266 errors when your program is running.
14267
14268 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14269 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14270 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14271 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14272
14273 @menu
14274 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14275 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14276 @end menu
14277
14278 @cindex type checking
14279 @cindex checks, type
14280 @node Type Checking
14281 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14282
14283 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14284 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14285 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14286 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14287
14288 @smallexample
14289 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14290
14291 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14292 $1 = 2
14293 @exdent but
14294 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14295 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14296 @end smallexample
14297
14298 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14299 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14300
14301 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14302 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14303 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14304 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14305 expressions like the second example above.
14306
14307 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14308 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14309 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14310 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14311 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14312 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14313
14314 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14315
14316 @kindex set check type
14317 @kindex show check type
14318 @table @code
14319 @item set check type on
14320 @itemx set check type off
14321 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14322 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14323 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14324
14325 @item show check type
14326 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14327 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14328 @end table
14329
14330 @cindex range checking
14331 @cindex checks, range
14332 @node Range Checking
14333 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14334
14335 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14336 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14337 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14338 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14339 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14340
14341 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14342 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14343 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14344 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14345
14346 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14347 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14348 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14349 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14350 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14351 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14352
14353 @smallexample
14354 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14355 @end smallexample
14356
14357 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14358 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14359 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14360
14361 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14362
14363 @kindex set check range
14364 @kindex show check range
14365 @table @code
14366 @item set check range auto
14367 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14368 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14369 each language.
14370
14371 @item set check range on
14372 @itemx set check range off
14373 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14374 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14375 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14376 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14377
14378 @item set check range warn
14379 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14380 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14381 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14382 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14383 systems).
14384
14385 @item show range
14386 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14387 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14388 @end table
14389
14390 @node Supported Languages
14391 @section Supported Languages
14392
14393 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
14394 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14395 @c This is false ...
14396 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14397 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14398 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14399 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14400 language.
14401
14402 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14403 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14404 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14405 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14406 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14407 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14408 language reference or tutorial.
14409
14410 @menu
14411 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14412 * D:: D
14413 * Go:: Go
14414 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14415 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14416 * Fortran:: Fortran
14417 * Pascal:: Pascal
14418 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14419 * Ada:: Ada
14420 @end menu
14421
14422 @node C
14423 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14424
14425 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14426 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14427
14428 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14429 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14430 together.
14431
14432 @cindex C@t{++}
14433 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14434 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14435 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14436 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14437 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14438 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14439 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14440
14441 @menu
14442 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14443 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14444 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14445 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14446 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14447 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14448 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14449 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14450 @end menu
14451
14452 @node C Operators
14453 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14454
14455 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14456
14457 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14458 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14459 often defined on groups of types.
14460
14461 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14462
14463 @itemize @bullet
14464
14465 @item
14466 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14467 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14468
14469 @item
14470 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14471 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14472
14473 @item
14474 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14475
14476 @item
14477 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14478
14479 @end itemize
14480
14481 @noindent
14482 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14483 in order of increasing precedence:
14484
14485 @table @code
14486 @item ,
14487 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14488 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14489 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14490
14491 @item =
14492 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14493 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14494
14495 @item @var{op}=
14496 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14497 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14498 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14499 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14500 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14501
14502 @item ?:
14503 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14504 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14505 should be of an integral type.
14506
14507 @item ||
14508 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14509
14510 @item &&
14511 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14512
14513 @item |
14514 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14515
14516 @item ^
14517 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14518
14519 @item &
14520 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14521
14522 @item ==@r{, }!=
14523 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14524 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14525
14526 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14527 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14528 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14529 and non-zero for true.
14530
14531 @item <<@r{, }>>
14532 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14533
14534 @item @@
14535 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14536
14537 @item +@r{, }-
14538 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14539 pointer types.
14540
14541 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14542 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14543 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14544 integral types.
14545
14546 @item ++@r{, }--
14547 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14548 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14549 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14550 operation takes place.
14551
14552 @item *
14553 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14554 @code{++}.
14555
14556 @item &
14557 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14558
14559 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14560 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14561 to examine the address
14562 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14563 stored.
14564
14565 @item -
14566 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14567 precedence as @code{++}.
14568
14569 @item !
14570 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14571 @code{++}.
14572
14573 @item ~
14574 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14575 @code{++}.
14576
14577
14578 @item .@r{, }->
14579 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14580 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14581 pointer based on the stored type information.
14582 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14583
14584 @item .*@r{, }->*
14585 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14586
14587 @item []
14588 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14589 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14590
14591 @item ()
14592 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14593
14594 @item ::
14595 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14596 and @code{class} types.
14597
14598 @item ::
14599 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14600 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14601 above.
14602 @end table
14603
14604 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14605 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14606 predefined meaning.
14607
14608 @node C Constants
14609 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14610
14611 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14612
14613 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14614 following ways:
14615
14616 @itemize @bullet
14617 @item
14618 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14619 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14620 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14621 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14622 @code{long} value.
14623
14624 @item
14625 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14626 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14627 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14628 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14629 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14630 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14631 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14632 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14633 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14634 constant.
14635
14636 @item
14637 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14638 integral equivalents.
14639
14640 @item
14641 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14642 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14643 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14644 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14645 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14646 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14647 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14648 @samp{\n} for newline.
14649
14650 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14651 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14652 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14653 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14654
14655 @item
14656 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14657 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14658 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14659 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14660 characters.
14661
14662 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14663 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14664 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14665
14666 @item
14667 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14668 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14669
14670 @item
14671 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14672 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14673 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14674 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14675 @end itemize
14676
14677 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14678 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14679
14680 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14681 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14682
14683 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14684 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14685 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14686 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14687 @quotation
14688 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14689 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14690 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14691 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14692 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14693 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14694 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14695 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14696 @end quotation
14697
14698 @enumerate
14699
14700 @cindex member functions
14701 @item
14702 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14703
14704 @smallexample
14705 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14706 @end smallexample
14707
14708 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14709 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14710 @item
14711 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14712 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14713 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14714 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14715 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14716
14717 @cindex call overloaded functions
14718 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14719 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14720 @item
14721 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14722 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14723 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14724 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14725 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14726 default arguments.
14727
14728 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14729 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14730 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14731 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14732 number of function arguments.
14733
14734 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14735 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14736 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14737
14738 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14739 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14740 @smallexample
14741 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14742 @end smallexample
14743
14744 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14745 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14746
14747 @cindex reference declarations
14748 @item
14749 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14750 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14751 dereferenced.
14752
14753 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14754 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14755 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14756 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14757 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14758
14759 @item
14760 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14761 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14762 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14763 necessary, for example in an expression like
14764 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14765 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14766 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14767
14768 @item
14769 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14770 specification.
14771 @end enumerate
14772
14773 @node C Defaults
14774 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14775
14776 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14777
14778 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14779 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14780 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14781 selects the working language.
14782
14783 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14784 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14785 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14786 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14787 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14788 for further details.
14789
14790 @node C Checks
14791 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14792
14793 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14794
14795 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14796 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14797 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14798 constants to pointers.
14799
14800 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14801 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14802 that is not itself an array.
14803
14804 @node Debugging C
14805 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14806
14807 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14808 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14809 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14810 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14811
14812 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14813 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14814 ,Expressions}.
14815
14816 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14817 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14818
14819 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14820
14821 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14822 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14823
14824 @table @code
14825 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14826 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14827 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14828 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14829 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14830 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14831
14832 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14833 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14834 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14835 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14836 classes.
14837 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14838
14839 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14840 @item catch throw
14841 @itemx catch rethrow
14842 @itemx catch catch
14843 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14844 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14845
14846 @cindex inheritance
14847 @item ptype @var{typename}
14848 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14849 @var{typename}.
14850 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14851
14852 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14853 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14854 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14855 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14856 multiple inheritance is in use.
14857
14858 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14859 @item demangle @var{name}
14860 Demangle @var{name}.
14861 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14862
14863 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14864 @item set print demangle
14865 @itemx show print demangle
14866 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14867 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14868 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14869 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14870 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14871
14872 @item set print object
14873 @itemx show print object
14874 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14875 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14876
14877 @item set print vtbl
14878 @itemx show print vtbl
14879 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14880 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14881 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14882 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14883
14884 @kindex set overload-resolution
14885 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14886 @item set overload-resolution on
14887 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14888 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14889 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14890 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14891 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14892 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14893
14894 @item set overload-resolution off
14895 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14896 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14897 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14898 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14899 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14900 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14901 argument types.
14902
14903 @kindex show overload-resolution
14904 @item show overload-resolution
14905 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14906
14907 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14908 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14909 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14910 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14911 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14912 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14913 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14914 @end table
14915
14916 @node Decimal Floating Point
14917 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14918 @cindex decimal floating point format
14919
14920 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14921 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14922 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14923 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14924
14925 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14926 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14927 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14928 configured target.
14929
14930 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14931 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14932 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14933
14934 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14935 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14936 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14937
14938 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14939 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14940 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14941
14942 @node D
14943 @subsection D
14944
14945 @cindex D
14946 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14947 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14948 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14949
14950 @node Go
14951 @subsection Go
14952
14953 @cindex Go (programming language)
14954 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14955 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14956
14957 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14958
14959 @table @code
14960 @cindex current Go package
14961 @item The current Go package
14962 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14963 specifying global variables and functions.
14964
14965 For example, given the program:
14966
14967 @example
14968 package main
14969 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14970 func main () @{
14971 // ...
14972 @}
14973 @end example
14974
14975 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14976
14977 @example
14978 (gdb) p myglob
14979 (gdb) p main.myglob
14980 @end example
14981
14982 @cindex builtin Go types
14983 @item Builtin Go types
14984 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14985 as a string.
14986
14987 @cindex builtin Go functions
14988 @item Builtin Go functions
14989 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14990 function and handles it internally.
14991
14992 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14993 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14994 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14995 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14996 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14997 @end table
14998
14999 @node Objective-C
15000 @subsection Objective-C
15001
15002 @cindex Objective-C
15003 This section provides information about some commands and command
15004 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15005 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15006 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15007
15008 @menu
15009 * Method Names in Commands::
15010 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15011 @end menu
15012
15013 @node Method Names in Commands
15014 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15015
15016 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15017 names as line specifications:
15018
15019 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15020 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15021 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15022 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15023 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15024 @itemize
15025 @item @code{clear}
15026 @item @code{break}
15027 @item @code{info line}
15028 @item @code{jump}
15029 @item @code{list}
15030 @end itemize
15031
15032 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15033
15034 @smallexample
15035 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15036 @end smallexample
15037
15038 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15039 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15040 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15041 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15042 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15043 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15044 debugged, enter:
15045
15046 @smallexample
15047 break -[Fruit create]
15048 @end smallexample
15049
15050 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15051 enter:
15052
15053 @smallexample
15054 list +[NSText initialize]
15055 @end smallexample
15056
15057 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15058 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15059 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15060 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15061
15062 @smallexample
15063 break create
15064 @end smallexample
15065
15066 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15067 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15068 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15069 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15070 none apply.
15071
15072 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15073 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15074
15075 @smallexample
15076 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15077 @end smallexample
15078
15079 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15080 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15081 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15082 @kindex print-object
15083 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15084
15085 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15086
15087 @smallexample
15088 print -[@var{object} hash]
15089 @end smallexample
15090
15091 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15092 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15093 @noindent
15094 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15095 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15096 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15097 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15098 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15099 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15100
15101 @node OpenCL C
15102 @subsection OpenCL C
15103
15104 @cindex OpenCL C
15105 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15106
15107 @menu
15108 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15109 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15110 * OpenCL C Operators::
15111 @end menu
15112
15113 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15114 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15115
15116 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15117 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15118 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15119 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15120 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15121
15122 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15123 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15124
15125 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15126 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15127 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15128 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15129
15130 @node OpenCL C Operators
15131 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15132
15133 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15134 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15135 vector data types.
15136
15137 @node Fortran
15138 @subsection Fortran
15139 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15140
15141 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15142 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15143
15144 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15145 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15146 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15147 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15148 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15149 underscore.
15150
15151 @menu
15152 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15153 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15154 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15155 @end menu
15156
15157 @node Fortran Operators
15158 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15159
15160 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15161
15162 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15163 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15164 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15165
15166 @table @code
15167 @item **
15168 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15169 of the second one.
15170
15171 @item :
15172 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15173 represent a section of array.
15174
15175 @item %
15176 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15177 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15178 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15179 union type.
15180 @end table
15181
15182 @node Fortran Defaults
15183 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15184
15185 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15186
15187 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15188 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15189 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15190 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15191
15192 @node Special Fortran Commands
15193 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15194
15195 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15196
15197 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15198 such as displaying common blocks.
15199
15200 @table @code
15201 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15202 @kindex info common
15203 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15204 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15205 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15206 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15207 printed.
15208 @end table
15209
15210 @node Pascal
15211 @subsection Pascal
15212
15213 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15214 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15215 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15216 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15217 syntax.
15218
15219 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15220 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15221 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15222
15223 @node Modula-2
15224 @subsection Modula-2
15225
15226 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15227
15228 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15229 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15230 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15231 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15232 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15233 table.
15234
15235 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15236 @menu
15237 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15238 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15239 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15240 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15241 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15242 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15243 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15244 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15245 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15246 @end menu
15247
15248 @node M2 Operators
15249 @subsubsection Operators
15250 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15251
15252 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15253 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15254 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15255 following definitions hold:
15256
15257 @itemize @bullet
15258
15259 @item
15260 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15261 their subranges.
15262
15263 @item
15264 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15265
15266 @item
15267 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15268
15269 @item
15270 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15271 @var{type}}.
15272
15273 @item
15274 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15275
15276 @item
15277 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15278
15279 @item
15280 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15281 @end itemize
15282
15283 @noindent
15284 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15285 increasing precedence:
15286
15287 @table @code
15288 @item ,
15289 Function argument or array index separator.
15290
15291 @item :=
15292 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15293 @var{value}.
15294
15295 @item <@r{, }>
15296 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15297 types.
15298
15299 @item <=@r{, }>=
15300 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15301 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15302 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15303
15304 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15305 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15306 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15307 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15308 comment character.
15309
15310 @item IN
15311 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15312 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15313
15314 @item OR
15315 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15316
15317 @item AND@r{, }&
15318 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15319
15320 @item @@
15321 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15322
15323 @item +@r{, }-
15324 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15325 and difference on set types.
15326
15327 @item *
15328 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15329 on set types.
15330
15331 @item /
15332 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15333 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15334
15335 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15336 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15337 precedence as @code{*}.
15338
15339 @item -
15340 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15341
15342 @item ^
15343 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15344
15345 @item NOT
15346 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15347 @code{^}.
15348
15349 @item .
15350 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15351 precedence as @code{^}.
15352
15353 @item []
15354 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15355
15356 @item ()
15357 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15358 as @code{^}.
15359
15360 @item ::@r{, }.
15361 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15362 @end table
15363
15364 @quotation
15365 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15366 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15367 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15368 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15369 @end quotation
15370
15371
15372 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15373 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15374 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15375
15376 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15377 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15378
15379 @table @var
15380
15381 @item a
15382 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15383
15384 @item c
15385 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15386
15387 @item i
15388 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15389
15390 @item m
15391 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15392 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15393 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15394
15395 @item n
15396 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15397
15398 @item r
15399 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15400
15401 @item t
15402 represents a type.
15403
15404 @item v
15405 represents a variable.
15406
15407 @item x
15408 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15409 explanation of the function for details.
15410 @end table
15411
15412 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15413
15414 @table @code
15415 @item ABS(@var{n})
15416 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15417
15418 @item CAP(@var{c})
15419 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15420 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15421
15422 @item CHR(@var{i})
15423 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15424
15425 @item DEC(@var{v})
15426 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15427
15428 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15429 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15430 new value.
15431
15432 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15433 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15434 set.
15435
15436 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15437 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15438
15439 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15440 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15441
15442 @item INC(@var{v})
15443 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15444
15445 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15446 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15447 new value.
15448
15449 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15450 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15451 there. Returns the new set.
15452
15453 @item MAX(@var{t})
15454 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15455
15456 @item MIN(@var{t})
15457 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15458
15459 @item ODD(@var{i})
15460 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15461
15462 @item ORD(@var{x})
15463 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15464 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15465 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15466 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15467
15468 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15469 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15470 variable or a type.
15471
15472 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15473 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15474
15475 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15476 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15477 variable or a type.
15478
15479 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15480 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15481 @end table
15482
15483 @quotation
15484 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15485 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15486 an error.
15487 @end quotation
15488
15489 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15490 @node M2 Constants
15491 @subsubsection Constants
15492
15493 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15494 ways:
15495
15496 @itemize @bullet
15497
15498 @item
15499 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15500 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15501 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15502 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15503
15504 @item
15505 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15506 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15507 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15508 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15509 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15510 digits.
15511
15512 @item
15513 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15514 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15515 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15516 followed by a @samp{C}.
15517
15518 @item
15519 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15520 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15521 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15522 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15523 sequences.
15524
15525 @item
15526 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15527
15528 @item
15529 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15530 @code{FALSE}.
15531
15532 @item
15533 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15534
15535 @item
15536 Set constants are not yet supported.
15537 @end itemize
15538
15539 @node M2 Types
15540 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15541 @cindex Modula-2 types
15542
15543 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15544 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15545 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15546 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15547 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15548 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15549
15550 The first example contains the following section of code:
15551
15552 @smallexample
15553 VAR
15554 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15555 r: [20..40] ;
15556 @end smallexample
15557
15558 @noindent
15559 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15560 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15561
15562 @smallexample
15563 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15564 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15565 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15566 SET OF CHAR
15567 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15568 21
15569 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15570 [20..40]
15571 @end smallexample
15572
15573 @noindent
15574 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15575
15576 @smallexample
15577 VAR
15578 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15579 @end smallexample
15580
15581 @noindent
15582 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15583
15584 @smallexample
15585 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15586 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15587 @end smallexample
15588
15589 @noindent
15590 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15591 expressions using the debugger.
15592
15593 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15594 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15595
15596 @smallexample
15597 VAR
15598 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15599 @end smallexample
15600
15601 @smallexample
15602 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15603 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15604 @end smallexample
15605
15606 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15607 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15608 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15609 above.
15610
15611 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15612
15613 @smallexample
15614 TYPE
15615 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15616 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15617 VAR
15618 s: t ;
15619 BEGIN
15620 s := blue ;
15621 @end smallexample
15622
15623 @noindent
15624 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15625 and value of a variable.
15626
15627 @smallexample
15628 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15629 $1 = blue
15630 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15631 type = [blue..yellow]
15632 @end smallexample
15633
15634 @noindent
15635 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15636 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15637 their @code{C} counterparts.
15638
15639 @smallexample
15640 VAR
15641 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15642 BEGIN
15643 s[1] := 1 ;
15644 @end smallexample
15645
15646 @smallexample
15647 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15648 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15649 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15650 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15651 @end smallexample
15652
15653 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15654 pointer types as shown in this example:
15655
15656 @smallexample
15657 VAR
15658 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15659 BEGIN
15660 NEW(s) ;
15661 s^[1] := 1 ;
15662 @end smallexample
15663
15664 @noindent
15665 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15666
15667 @smallexample
15668 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15669 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15670 @end smallexample
15671
15672 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15673 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15674 types:
15675
15676 @smallexample
15677 TYPE
15678 foo = RECORD
15679 f1: CARDINAL ;
15680 f2: CHAR ;
15681 f3: myarray ;
15682 END ;
15683
15684 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15685 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15686 VAR
15687 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15688 @end smallexample
15689
15690 @noindent
15691 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15692 below.
15693
15694 @smallexample
15695 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15696 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15697 f1 : CARDINAL;
15698 f2 : CHAR;
15699 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15700 END
15701 @end smallexample
15702
15703 @node M2 Defaults
15704 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15705 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15706
15707 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15708 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15709 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15710 selected the working language.
15711
15712 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15713 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15714 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15715 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15716
15717 @node Deviations
15718 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15719 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15720
15721 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15722 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15723
15724 @itemize @bullet
15725 @item
15726 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15727 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15728 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15729 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15730 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15731 returned a pointer.)
15732
15733 @item
15734 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15735 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15736 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15737 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15738
15739 @item
15740 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15741 argument.
15742
15743 @item
15744 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15745 @end itemize
15746
15747 @node M2 Checks
15748 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15749 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15750
15751 @quotation
15752 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15753 range checking.
15754 @end quotation
15755 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15756
15757 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15758
15759 @itemize @bullet
15760 @item
15761 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15762 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15763
15764 @item
15765 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15766 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15767 @end itemize
15768
15769 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15770 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15771
15772 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15773 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15774
15775 @node M2 Scope
15776 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15777 @cindex scope
15778 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15779 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15780 @ifinfo
15781 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15782 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15783 @end ifinfo
15784 @ifnotinfo
15785 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15786 @end ifnotinfo
15787
15788 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15789 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15790 similar syntax:
15791
15792 @smallexample
15793
15794 @var{module} . @var{id}
15795 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15796 @end smallexample
15797
15798 @noindent
15799 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15800 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15801 identifier within your program, except another module.
15802
15803 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15804 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15805 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15806 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15807
15808 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15809 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15810 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15811 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15812 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15813 @var{module}.
15814
15815 @node GDB/M2
15816 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15817
15818 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15819 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15820 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15821 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15822 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15823 analogue in Modula-2.
15824
15825 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15826 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15827 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15828 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15829 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15830 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15831
15832 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15833 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15834 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15835
15836 @node Ada
15837 @subsection Ada
15838 @cindex Ada
15839
15840 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15841 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15842 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15843 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15844 to be difficult.
15845
15846
15847 @cindex expressions in Ada
15848 @menu
15849 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15850 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15851 in @value{GDBN}.
15852 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15853 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15854 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
15855 subprograms.
15856 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15857 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15858 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15859 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15860 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15861 Profile
15862 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15863 @end menu
15864
15865 @node Ada Mode Intro
15866 @subsubsection Introduction
15867 @cindex Ada mode, general
15868
15869 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15870 syntax, with some extensions.
15871 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15872
15873 @itemize @bullet
15874 @item
15875 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15876 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15877 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15878 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15879
15880 @item
15881 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15882 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15883
15884 @item
15885 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15886 @end itemize
15887
15888 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15889 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15890 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15891 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15892 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15893
15894 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15895 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15896 was translated from an Ada source file.
15897
15898 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15899 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15900 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15901 middle (to allow based literals).
15902
15903 @node Omissions from Ada
15904 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15905 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15906
15907 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15908
15909 @itemize @bullet
15910 @item
15911 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15912
15913 @itemize @minus
15914 @item
15915 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15916 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15917
15918 @item
15919 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15920
15921 @item
15922 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15923
15924 @item
15925 @t{'Tag}.
15926
15927 @item
15928 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15929 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15930
15931 @item
15932 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15933 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15934
15935 @item
15936 @t{'Address}.
15937 @end itemize
15938
15939 @item
15940 The names in
15941 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15942 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15943 not currently available.
15944
15945 @item
15946 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15947 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15948 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15949 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15950 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15951 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15952 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15953 indeterminate values.
15954
15955 @item
15956 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15957 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15958 are not implemented.
15959
15960 @item
15961 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15962 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15963 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15964 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15965 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15966
15967 @smallexample
15968 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15969 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15970 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15971 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15972 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15973 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15974 @end smallexample
15975
15976 Changing a
15977 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15978 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15979 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15980 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15981 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15982 declared to have a type such as:
15983
15984 @smallexample
15985 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15986 Id : Integer;
15987 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15988 end record;
15989 @end smallexample
15990
15991 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15992 assignments:
15993
15994 @smallexample
15995 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15996 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15997 @end smallexample
15998
15999 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16000 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16001 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16002 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16003 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16004 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16005 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16006 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16007
16008 @item
16009 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16010
16011 @item
16012 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16013 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16014 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16015 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16016 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16017 the proper resolution.
16018
16019 @item
16020 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16021
16022 @item
16023 Entry calls are not implemented.
16024
16025 @item
16026 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16027 formats are not supported.
16028
16029 @item
16030 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16031
16032 @item
16033 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16034 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16035 context.
16036 Should your program
16037 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16038 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16039 @end itemize
16040
16041 @node Additions to Ada
16042 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16043 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16044
16045 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16046 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16047
16048 @itemize @bullet
16049 @item
16050 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16051 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16052 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16053 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16054 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16055 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16056 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16057 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16058
16059 @item
16060 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16061 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16062 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16063
16064 @item
16065 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16066 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16067
16068 @item
16069 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16070 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16071 @end itemize
16072
16073 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16074 additions specific to Ada:
16075
16076 @itemize @bullet
16077 @item
16078 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16079 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16080
16081 @smallexample
16082 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16083 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16084 @end smallexample
16085
16086 @item
16087 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16088 the value of its right-hand operand.
16089 This allows, for example,
16090 complex conditional breaks:
16091
16092 @smallexample
16093 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16094 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16095 @end smallexample
16096
16097 @item
16098 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16099 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16100 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16101 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16102 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16103 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16104 in strings. For example,
16105 @smallexample
16106 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16107 @end smallexample
16108 @noindent
16109 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16110 after each period.
16111
16112 @item
16113 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16114 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16115 to write
16116
16117 @smallexample
16118 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16119 @end smallexample
16120
16121 @item
16122 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16123 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16124 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16125 of 3 might print as
16126
16127 @smallexample
16128 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16129 @end smallexample
16130
16131 @noindent
16132 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16133 clause.
16134
16135 @item
16136 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16137 multi-character subsequence of
16138 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16139 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16140 in place of @t{a'length}.
16141
16142 @item
16143 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16144 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16145 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16146 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16147 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16148 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16149 For example,
16150 @smallexample
16151 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16152 @end smallexample
16153
16154 @item
16155 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16156 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16157 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16158 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16159 object.
16160
16161 @end itemize
16162
16163 @node Overloading support for Ada
16164 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16165 @cindex overloading, Ada
16166
16167 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16168 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16169 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16170 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16171 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16172 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16173
16174 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16175 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16176 use, for instance:
16177
16178 @smallexample
16179 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16180 Multiple matches for f
16181 [0] cancel
16182 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16183 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16184 >
16185 @end smallexample
16186
16187 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16188 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16189 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16190
16191 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16192 case:
16193
16194 @table @code
16195
16196 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16197 @item set ada print-signatures
16198 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16199 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16200 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16201
16202 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16203 @item show ada print-signatures
16204 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16205 overloads selection menu.
16206 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16207
16208 @end table
16209
16210 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16211 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16212
16213 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16214 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16215 before reaching the main procedure.
16216 As defined in the Ada Reference
16217 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16218 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16219 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16220 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16221
16222 @node Ada Exceptions
16223 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16224
16225 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16226
16227 @table @code
16228 @kindex info exceptions
16229 @item info exceptions
16230 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16231 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16232 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16233 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16234 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16235 @end table
16236
16237 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16238 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16239 argument.
16240
16241 @smallexample
16242 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16243 All defined Ada exceptions:
16244 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16245 program_error: 0x613d20
16246 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16247 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16248 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16249 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16250 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16251 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16252 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16253 @end smallexample
16254
16255 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16256 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16257
16258 @node Ada Tasks
16259 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16260 @cindex Ada, tasking
16261
16262 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16263 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16264
16265 @table @code
16266 @kindex info tasks
16267 @item info tasks
16268 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16269
16270
16271 @smallexample
16272 @iftex
16273 @leftskip=0.5cm
16274 @end iftex
16275 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16276 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16277 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16278 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16279 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16280 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16281
16282 @end smallexample
16283
16284 @noindent
16285 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16286 task currently being inspected.
16287
16288 @table @asis
16289 @item ID
16290 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16291
16292 @item TID
16293 The Ada task ID.
16294
16295 @item P-ID
16296 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16297
16298 @item Pri
16299 The base priority of the task.
16300
16301 @item State
16302 Current state of the task.
16303
16304 @table @code
16305 @item Unactivated
16306 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16307 executing.
16308
16309 @item Runnable
16310 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16311 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16312
16313 @item Terminated
16314 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16315 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16316 terminated themselves.
16317
16318 @item Child Activation Wait
16319 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16320
16321 @item Accept Statement
16322 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16323
16324 @item Waiting on entry call
16325 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16326
16327 @item Async Select Wait
16328 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16329 select statement.
16330
16331 @item Delay Sleep
16332 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16333 alternative open.
16334
16335 @item Child Termination Wait
16336 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16337 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16338 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16339
16340 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16341 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16342 finish terminating.
16343
16344 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16345 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16346 @end table
16347
16348 @item Name
16349 Name of the task in the program.
16350
16351 @end table
16352
16353 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16354 @item info task @var{taskno}
16355 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16356 the following example:
16357 @smallexample
16358 @iftex
16359 @leftskip=0.5cm
16360 @end iftex
16361 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16362 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16363 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16364 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16365 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16366 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16367 Name: task_1
16368 Thread: 0x807f378
16369 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16370 Base Priority: 15
16371 State: Runnable
16372 @end smallexample
16373
16374 @item task
16375 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16376 @cindex current Ada task ID
16377 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16378
16379 @smallexample
16380 @iftex
16381 @leftskip=0.5cm
16382 @end iftex
16383 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16384 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16385 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16386 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16387 (@value{GDBP}) task
16388 [Current task is 2]
16389 @end smallexample
16390
16391 @item task @var{taskno}
16392 @cindex Ada task switching
16393 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16394 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16395 from the current task to the given task.
16396
16397 @smallexample
16398 @iftex
16399 @leftskip=0.5cm
16400 @end iftex
16401 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16402 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16403 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16404 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16405 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16406 [Switching to task 1]
16407 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16408 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16409 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16410 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16411 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16412 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16413 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16414 @end smallexample
16415
16416 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16417 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16418 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16419 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16420 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16421 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16422 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16423 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16424 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16425
16426 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16427 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16428 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16429 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16430 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16431
16432 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16433 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16434 program.
16435
16436 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16437 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16438 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16439
16440 For example,
16441
16442 @smallexample
16443 @iftex
16444 @leftskip=0.5cm
16445 @end iftex
16446 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16447 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16448 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16449 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16450 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16451 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16452 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16453 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16454 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16455 Continuing.
16456 task # 1 running
16457 task # 2 running
16458
16459 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16460 15 flush;
16461 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16462 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16463 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16464 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16465 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16466 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16467 @end smallexample
16468 @end table
16469
16470 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16471 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16472 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16473
16474 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16475 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16476 the platform being used.
16477 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16478 switching is not supported.
16479
16480 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16481 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16482 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16483 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16484 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16485 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16486
16487 @node Ravenscar Profile
16488 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16489 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16490
16491 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16492 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16493 requirements.
16494
16495 @table @code
16496 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16497 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16498 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16499 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16500 Profile. This is the default.
16501
16502 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16503 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16504 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16505 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16506 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16507 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16508 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16509
16510 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16511 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16512 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16513 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16514
16515 @end table
16516
16517 @node Ada Glitches
16518 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16519 @cindex Ada, problems
16520
16521 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16522 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16523 @value{GDBN},
16524 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16525 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16526
16527 @itemize @bullet
16528 @item
16529 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16530 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16531
16532 @item
16533 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16534 argument lists are treated as positional).
16535
16536 @item
16537 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16538
16539 @item
16540 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16541 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16542 the host machine.
16543
16544 @item
16545 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16546 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16547 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16548 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16549 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16550 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16551 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16552 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16553 you can usually resolve the confusion
16554 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16555 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16556 @end itemize
16557
16558 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16559 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16560 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16561 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16562 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16563 enabled.
16564
16565 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16566 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16567 @table @code
16568
16569 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16570 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16571 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16572 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16573 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16574 This is the default.
16575
16576 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16577 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16578 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16579 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16580 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16581 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16582 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16583
16584 @end table
16585
16586 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16587 @cindex GNAT encoding
16588 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16589 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16590 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16591 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16592 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16593 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16594
16595 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16596 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16597 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16598 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16599 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16600 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16601 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16602 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16603
16604 @table @code
16605
16606 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16607 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16608 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16609 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16610
16611 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16612 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16613 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16614
16615 @end table
16616
16617 @node Unsupported Languages
16618 @section Unsupported Languages
16619
16620 @cindex unsupported languages
16621 @cindex minimal language
16622 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16623 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16624 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16625 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16626 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16627 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16628
16629 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16630 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16631 language.
16632
16633 @node Symbols
16634 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16635
16636 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16637 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16638 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16639 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16640 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16641 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16642 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16643
16644 @cindex symbol names
16645 @cindex names of symbols
16646 @cindex quoting names
16647 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16648 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16649 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16650 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16651 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16652 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16653 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16654 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16655
16656 @smallexample
16657 p 'foo.c'::x
16658 @end smallexample
16659
16660 @noindent
16661 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16662
16663 @table @code
16664 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16665 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16666 @kindex set case-sensitive
16667 @item set case-sensitive on
16668 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16669 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16670 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16671 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16672 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16673 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16674 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16675 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16676 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16677 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16678 case-insensitive matches.
16679
16680 @kindex show case-sensitive
16681 @item show case-sensitive
16682 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16683 lookups.
16684
16685 @kindex set print type methods
16686 @item set print type methods
16687 @itemx set print type methods on
16688 @itemx set print type methods off
16689 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16690 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16691 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16692 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16693 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16694 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16695
16696 @kindex show print type methods
16697 @item show print type methods
16698 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16699 classes.
16700
16701 @kindex set print type typedefs
16702 @item set print type typedefs
16703 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16704 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16705
16706 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16707 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16708 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16709 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16710 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16711 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16712 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16713 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16714 types.
16715
16716 @kindex show print type typedefs
16717 @item show print type typedefs
16718 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16719 printing classes.
16720
16721 @kindex info address
16722 @cindex address of a symbol
16723 @item info address @var{symbol}
16724 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16725 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16726 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16727 is always stored.
16728
16729 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16730 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16731 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16732
16733 @kindex info symbol
16734 @cindex symbol from address
16735 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16736 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16737 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16738 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16739 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16740
16741 @smallexample
16742 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16743 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16744 @end smallexample
16745
16746 @noindent
16747 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16748 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16749
16750 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16751 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16752
16753 @smallexample
16754 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16755 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16756 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16757 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16758 @end smallexample
16759
16760 @kindex demangle
16761 @cindex demangle
16762 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16763 Demangle @var{name}.
16764 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16765 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16766
16767 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16768 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16769
16770 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16771 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16772
16773 @kindex whatis
16774 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16775 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16776 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16777 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16778
16779 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16780 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16781 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16782
16783 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16784 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16785 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16786 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16787 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16788 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16789 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16790 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16791 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16792
16793 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16794 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16795 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16796 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16797 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16798 unroll it.
16799
16800 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16801 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16802 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16803
16804 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16805 Available flags are:
16806
16807 @table @code
16808 @item r
16809 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16810 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16811 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16812
16813 @item m
16814 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16815
16816 @item M
16817 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16818 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16819
16820 @item t
16821 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16822 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16823 names are substituted when printing other types.
16824
16825 @item T
16826 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16827 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16828 @end table
16829
16830 @kindex ptype
16831 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16832 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16833 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16834 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16835
16836 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16837 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16838 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16839 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16840 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16841 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16842 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16843 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16844
16845 For example, for this variable declaration:
16846
16847 @smallexample
16848 typedef double real_t;
16849 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16850 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16851 complex_t var;
16852 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16853 @end smallexample
16854
16855 @noindent
16856 the two commands give this output:
16857
16858 @smallexample
16859 @group
16860 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16861 type = complex_t
16862 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16863 type = struct complex @{
16864 real_t real;
16865 double imag;
16866 @}
16867 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16868 type = struct complex
16869 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16870 type = struct complex
16871 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16872 type = struct complex @{
16873 real_t real;
16874 double imag;
16875 @}
16876 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16877 type = real_t *
16878 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16879 type = double *
16880 @end group
16881 @end smallexample
16882
16883 @noindent
16884 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16885 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16886
16887 @cindex incomplete type
16888 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16889 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16890 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16891 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16892 given these declarations:
16893
16894 @smallexample
16895 struct foo;
16896 struct foo *fooptr;
16897 @end smallexample
16898
16899 @noindent
16900 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16901
16902 @smallexample
16903 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16904 $1 = <incomplete type>
16905 @end smallexample
16906
16907 @noindent
16908 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16909 completely specified.
16910
16911 @kindex info types
16912 @item info types @var{regexp}
16913 @itemx info types
16914 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16915 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16916 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16917 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16918 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16919 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16920 name is @code{value}.
16921
16922 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16923 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16924 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16925
16926 @kindex info type-printers
16927 @item info type-printers
16928 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16929 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16930 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16931 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16932 type printers.
16933
16934 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16935
16936 @kindex enable type-printer
16937 @kindex disable type-printer
16938 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16939 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16940 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16941
16942 @kindex info scope
16943 @cindex local variables
16944 @item info scope @var{location}
16945 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16946 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16947 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16948 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16949 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16950
16951 @smallexample
16952 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16953 Scope for command_line_handler:
16954 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16955 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16956 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16957 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16958 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16959 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16960 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16961 @end smallexample
16962
16963 @noindent
16964 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16965 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16966 collect}.
16967
16968 @kindex info source
16969 @item info source
16970 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16971 the function containing the current point of execution:
16972 @itemize @bullet
16973 @item
16974 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16975 @item
16976 the directory it was compiled in,
16977 @item
16978 its length, in lines,
16979 @item
16980 which programming language it is written in,
16981 @item
16982 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
16983 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
16984 @item
16985 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16986 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16987 @item
16988 whether the debugging information includes information about
16989 preprocessor macros.
16990 @end itemize
16991
16992
16993 @kindex info sources
16994 @item info sources
16995 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16996 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16997 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16998
16999 @kindex info functions
17000 @item info functions
17001 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17002
17003 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17004 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17005 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17006 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17007 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17008 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
17009 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17010 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17011
17012 @kindex info variables
17013 @item info variables
17014 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17015 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17016
17017 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17018 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17019 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17020 @var{regexp}.
17021
17022 @kindex info classes
17023 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17024 @item info classes
17025 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17026 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17027 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17028 expression.
17029
17030 @kindex info selectors
17031 @item info selectors
17032 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17033 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17034 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17035 expression.
17036
17037 @ignore
17038 This was never implemented.
17039 @kindex info methods
17040 @item info methods
17041 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17042 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17043 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17044 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17045 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17046 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17047 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17048 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17049 @end ignore
17050
17051 @cindex opaque data types
17052 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17053 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17054 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17055 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17056 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17057 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17058 another source file. The default is on.
17059
17060 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17061 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17062
17063 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17064 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17065 is printed as follows:
17066 @smallexample
17067 @{<no data fields>@}
17068 @end smallexample
17069
17070 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17071 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17072 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17073
17074 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17075 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17076 @item set print symbol-loading
17077 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17078 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17079 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17080 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17081 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17082 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17083 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17084 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17085 can be annoying.
17086 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17087 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17088 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17089 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17090
17091 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17092 @item show print symbol-loading
17093 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17094 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17095
17096 @kindex maint print symbols
17097 @cindex symbol dump
17098 @kindex maint print psymbols
17099 @cindex partial symbol dump
17100 @kindex maint print msymbols
17101 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17102 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
17103 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
17104 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
17105 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
17106 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
17107 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
17108 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
17109 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
17110 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
17111 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
17112 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
17113 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
17114 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
17115 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
17116 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
17117 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17118 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17119
17120 @kindex maint info symtabs
17121 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17122 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17123 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17124 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17125 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17126 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17127 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17128
17129 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17130 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17131 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17132 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17133 structure in more detail. For example:
17134
17135 @smallexample
17136 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17137 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17138 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17139 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17140 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17141 readin no
17142 fullname (null)
17143 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17144 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17145 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17146 dependencies (none)
17147 @}
17148 @}
17149 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17150 (@value{GDBP})
17151 @end smallexample
17152 @noindent
17153 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17154 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17155 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17156 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17157 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17158
17159 @smallexample
17160 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17161 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17162 line 1574.
17163 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17164 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17165 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17166 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17167 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17168 dirname (null)
17169 fullname (null)
17170 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17171 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17172 debugformat DWARF 2
17173 @}
17174 @}
17175 (@value{GDBP})
17176 @end smallexample
17177
17178 @kindex maint info line-table
17179 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17180 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17181 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17182
17183 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17184 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17185 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17186
17187 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17188 @cindex symbol cache size
17189 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17190 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17191 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17192 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17193 with different sizes.
17194
17195 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17196 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17197 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17198
17199 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17200 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17201 @item maint print symbol-cache
17202 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17203 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17204
17205 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17206 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17207 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17208 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17209 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17210
17211 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17212 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17213 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17214 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17215 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17216 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17217
17218 @end table
17219
17220 @node Altering
17221 @chapter Altering Execution
17222
17223 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17224 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17225 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17226 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17227 program.
17228
17229 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17230 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17231 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17232
17233 @menu
17234 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17235 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17236 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17237 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17238 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17239 * Patching:: Patching your program
17240 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17241 @end menu
17242
17243 @node Assignment
17244 @section Assignment to Variables
17245
17246 @cindex assignment
17247 @cindex setting variables
17248 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17249 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17250
17251 @smallexample
17252 print x=4
17253 @end smallexample
17254
17255 @noindent
17256 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17257 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17258 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17259 information on operators in supported languages.
17260
17261 @kindex set variable
17262 @cindex variables, setting
17263 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17264 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17265 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17266 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17267 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17268
17269 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17270 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17271 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17272 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17273 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17274 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17275 command @code{set width}:
17276
17277 @smallexample
17278 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17279 type = double
17280 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17281 $4 = 13
17282 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17283 Invalid syntax in expression.
17284 @end smallexample
17285
17286 @noindent
17287 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17288 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17289
17290 @smallexample
17291 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17292 @end smallexample
17293
17294 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17295 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17296 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17297 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17298 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17299 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17300
17301 @smallexample
17302 @group
17303 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17304 type = double
17305 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17306 $1 = 1
17307 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17308 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17309 $2 = 1
17310 (@value{GDBP}) r
17311 The program being debugged has been started already.
17312 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17313 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17314 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17315 Invalid bfd target.
17316 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17317 The current BFD target is "=4".
17318 @end group
17319 @end smallexample
17320
17321 @noindent
17322 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17323 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17324 @code{g}, use
17325
17326 @smallexample
17327 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17328 @end smallexample
17329
17330 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17331 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17332 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17333 same length or shorter.
17334 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17335 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17336
17337 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17338 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17339 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17340 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17341 and representation in memory), and
17342
17343 @smallexample
17344 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17345 @end smallexample
17346
17347 @noindent
17348 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17349
17350 @node Jumping
17351 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17352
17353 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17354 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17355 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17356
17357 @table @code
17358 @kindex jump
17359 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17360 @item jump @var{location}
17361 @itemx j @var{location}
17362 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17363 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17364 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17365 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17366 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17367
17368 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17369 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17370 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17371 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17372 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17373 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17374 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17375 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17376 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17377 @end table
17378
17379 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17380 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17381 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17382 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17383 example,
17384
17385 @smallexample
17386 set $pc = 0x485
17387 @end smallexample
17388
17389 @noindent
17390 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17391 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17392 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17393
17394 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17395 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17396 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17397 detail.
17398
17399 @c @group
17400 @node Signaling
17401 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17402 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17403
17404 @table @code
17405 @kindex signal
17406 @item signal @var{signal}
17407 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17408 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17409 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17410 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17411
17412 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17413 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17414 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17415 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17416 signal.
17417
17418 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17419 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17420 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17421 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17422 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17423 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17424 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17425 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17426
17427 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17428 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17429 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17430 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17431 passes the signal directly to your program.
17432
17433 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17434 after executing the command.
17435
17436 @kindex queue-signal
17437 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17438 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17439 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17440 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17441 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17442 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17443 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17444 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17445 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17446
17447 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17448 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17449 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17450 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17451 @code{continue} command.
17452
17453 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17454 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17455 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17456 (@pxref{Signals}).
17457 @end table
17458 @c @end group
17459
17460 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17461 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17462
17463 @node Returning
17464 @section Returning from a Function
17465
17466 @table @code
17467 @cindex returning from a function
17468 @kindex return
17469 @item return
17470 @itemx return @var{expression}
17471 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17472 command. If you give an
17473 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17474 value.
17475 @end table
17476
17477 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17478 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17479 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17480 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17481
17482 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17483 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17484 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17485 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17486 of functions.
17487
17488 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17489 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17490 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17491 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17492 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17493
17494 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17495 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17496 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17497 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17498 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17499 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17500 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17501 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17502 assignment into the right register(s).
17503
17504 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17505 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17506 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17507 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17508 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17509 into a @code{long long int}:
17510
17511 @smallexample
17512 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17513 29 return 31;
17514 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17515 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17516 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17517 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17518 (@value{GDBP})
17519 @end smallexample
17520
17521 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17522 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17523 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17524 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17525 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17526 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17527 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17528 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17529
17530 @smallexample
17531 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17532 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17533 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17534 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17535 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17536 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17537 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17538 (@value{GDBP})
17539 @end smallexample
17540
17541 @node Calling
17542 @section Calling Program Functions
17543
17544 @table @code
17545 @cindex calling functions
17546 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17547 @item print @var{expr}
17548 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17549 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17550 debugged.
17551
17552 @kindex call
17553 @item call @var{expr}
17554 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17555 returned values.
17556
17557 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17558 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17559 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17560 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17561 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17562 value history.
17563 @end table
17564
17565 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17566 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17567 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17568 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17569
17570 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17571 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17572 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17573 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17574 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17575 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17576 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17577 in that case is controlled by the
17578 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17579
17580 @table @code
17581 @item set unwindonsignal
17582 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17583 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17584 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17585 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17586 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17587 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17588 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17589 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17590 received.
17591
17592 @item show unwindonsignal
17593 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17594 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17595 @value{GDBN}.
17596
17597 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17598 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17599 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17600 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17601 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17602 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17603 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17604 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17605 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17606 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17607
17608 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17609 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17610 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17611 @value{GDBN}.
17612
17613 @end table
17614
17615 @cindex weak alias functions
17616 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17617 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17618 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17619 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17620 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17621 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17622 function instead.
17623
17624 @node Patching
17625 @section Patching Programs
17626
17627 @cindex patching binaries
17628 @cindex writing into executables
17629 @cindex writing into corefiles
17630
17631 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17632 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17633 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17634 patching your program's binary.
17635
17636 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17637 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17638 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17639 repairs.
17640
17641 @table @code
17642 @kindex set write
17643 @item set write on
17644 @itemx set write off
17645 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17646 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17647 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17648
17649 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17650 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17651 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17652
17653 @item show write
17654 @kindex show write
17655 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17656 as well as reading.
17657 @end table
17658
17659 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17660 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17661 @cindex injecting code
17662 @cindex writing into executables
17663 @cindex compiling code
17664
17665 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17666 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17667 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17668 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17669
17670 @table @code
17671 @kindex compile code
17672 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17673 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17674 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17675 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17676 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17677 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17678 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17679 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17680 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17681 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17682 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17683 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17684
17685 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17686 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17687 E.g.:
17688
17689 @smallexample
17690 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17691 @end smallexample
17692
17693 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17694 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17695 from actual source code. E.g.:
17696
17697 @smallexample
17698 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17699 @end smallexample
17700
17701 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17702 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17703 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17704 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17705 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17706 editor.
17707
17708 @smallexample
17709 compile code
17710 >printf ("hello\n");
17711 >printf ("world\n");
17712 >end
17713 @end smallexample
17714
17715 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17716 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17717 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17718 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17719 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17720 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17721 inferior symbols otherwise.
17722
17723 @kindex compile file
17724 @item compile file @var{filename}
17725 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17726 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17727
17728 @smallexample
17729 compile file /home/user/example.c
17730 @end smallexample
17731 @end table
17732
17733 @table @code
17734 @item compile print @var{expr}
17735 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17736 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17737 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
17738 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17739 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17740 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17741 Formats}.
17742
17743 @item compile print
17744 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
17745 @cindex reprint the last value
17746 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17747 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17748 command without any text following the command. This will start the
17749 multiple-line editor.
17750 @end table
17751
17752 @noindent
17753 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17754
17755 @table @code
17756 @anchor{set debug compile}
17757 @item set debug compile
17758 @cindex compile command debugging info
17759 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17760 injecting the code. The default is off.
17761
17762 @item show debug compile
17763 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17764 compiling and injecting the code.
17765 @end table
17766
17767 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17768
17769 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17770 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17771 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17772 injecting process.
17773
17774 @noindent
17775 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17776
17777 @table @asis
17778 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17779 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17780 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17781 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17782
17783 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17784 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17785 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17786 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17787 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17788 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17789 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17790 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17791
17792 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17793 @end table
17794
17795 @noindent
17796 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17797
17798 @table @code
17799 @item set compile-args
17800 @cindex compile command options override
17801 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17802 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17803 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17804 compilation.
17805
17806 @item show compile-args
17807 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17808 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17809 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17810 @end table
17811
17812 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17813
17814 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17815 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17816 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17817
17818 @table @asis
17819 @item C code examples and caveats
17820 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17821 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17822 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17823 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17824 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17825
17826 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17827 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17828 much like any other normal debugging session.
17829
17830 @smallexample
17831 void function1 (void)
17832 @{
17833 int i = 42;
17834 printf ("function 1\n");
17835 @}
17836
17837 void function2 (void)
17838 @{
17839 int j = 12;
17840 function1 ();
17841 @}
17842
17843 int main(void)
17844 @{
17845 int k = 6;
17846 int *p;
17847 function2 ();
17848 return 0;
17849 @}
17850 @end smallexample
17851
17852 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17853 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17854 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17855
17856 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
17857 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
17858 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
17859 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
17860 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
17861
17862 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
17863 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
17864 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
17865 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
17866 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
17867 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
17868 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
17869 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
17870 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
17871 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
17872
17873 @smallexample
17874 compile code k = 3;
17875 @end smallexample
17876
17877 @noindent
17878 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
17879 something else in the example program changes it, or another
17880 @code{compile} command changes it.
17881
17882 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
17883 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
17884 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
17885 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
17886 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
17887
17888 @smallexample
17889 compile code j = 3;
17890 @end smallexample
17891
17892 @noindent
17893 will result in a compilation error message.
17894
17895 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
17896 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
17897 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
17898
17899 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
17900 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
17901 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
17902 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
17903
17904 @smallexample
17905 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
17906 @end smallexample
17907
17908 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
17909 command has completed:
17910
17911 @smallexample
17912 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
17913 @end smallexample
17914
17915 @noindent
17916 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
17917 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
17918 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
17919 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
17920 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
17921
17922 @smallexample
17923 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
17924 @end smallexample
17925
17926 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
17927 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
17928 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
17929 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
17930 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
17931 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
17932 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
17933 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
17934
17935 @smallexample
17936 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
17937 @end smallexample
17938
17939 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
17940 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
17941 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
17942 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
17943 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
17944 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
17945 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
17946
17947 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
17948 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
17949 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
17950 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
17951 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
17952 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
17953
17954 @smallexample
17955 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
17956 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17957 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
17958 Compilation failed.
17959 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17960 42
17961 @end smallexample
17962
17963 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
17964 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
17965 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
17966 will print to the console.
17967 @end table
17968
17969 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
17970
17971 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
17972 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
17973 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
17974 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
17975 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
17976 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
17977 target architecture and operating system.
17978
17979 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
17980 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
17981 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
17982 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
17983 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
17984 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
17985 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
17986
17987 @node GDB Files
17988 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
17989
17990 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
17991 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
17992 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
17993 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
17994
17995 @menu
17996 * Files:: Commands to specify files
17997 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
17998 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
17999 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18000 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18001 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18002 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18003 @end menu
18004
18005 @node Files
18006 @section Commands to Specify Files
18007
18008 @cindex symbol table
18009 @cindex core dump file
18010
18011 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18012 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18013 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18014 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18015
18016 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18017 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18018 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18019 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18020 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18021 new files are useful.
18022
18023 @table @code
18024 @cindex executable file
18025 @kindex file
18026 @item file @var{filename}
18027 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18028 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18029 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18030 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18031 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18032 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18033 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18034 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18035
18036 @cindex unlinked object files
18037 @cindex patching object files
18038 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18039 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18040 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18041 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18042 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18043 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18044 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18045 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18046
18047 @item file
18048 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18049 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18050
18051 @kindex exec-file
18052 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18053 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18054 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18055 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18056 discard information on the executable file.
18057
18058 @kindex symbol-file
18059 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18060 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18061 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18062 table and program to run from the same file.
18063
18064 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18065 program's symbol table.
18066
18067 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18068 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18069 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18070 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18071 @value{GDBN}.
18072
18073 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18074 executing it once.
18075
18076 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18077 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18078 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18079 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18080 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18081 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18082 optimized code.
18083
18084 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18085 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18086 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18087 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18088 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18089
18090 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18091 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18092 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18093 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18094 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18095 Warnings and Messages}.)
18096
18097 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18098 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18099 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18100 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18101 in stabs format.
18102
18103 @kindex readnow
18104 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18105 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18106 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18107 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18108 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18109 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18110 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18111 entire symbol table available.
18112
18113 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18114 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18115 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18116 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18117 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18118 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18119 @c files.
18120
18121 @kindex core-file
18122 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18123 @itemx core
18124 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18125 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18126 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18127 executable file itself for other parts.
18128
18129 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18130 to be used.
18131
18132 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18133 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18134 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18135 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18136 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18137
18138 @kindex add-symbol-file
18139 @cindex dynamic linking
18140 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18141 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18142 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18143 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18144 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18145 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18146 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18147 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18148 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18149 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18150 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18151 @var{address} as an expression.
18152
18153 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18154 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18155 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18156 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18157
18158 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18159
18160 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18161 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18162 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18163 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18164 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18165 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18166 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18167 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18168 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18169
18170 @itemize @bullet
18171 @item
18172 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18173 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18174 @item
18175 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18176 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18177 @item
18178 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18179 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18180 @end itemize
18181
18182 @noindent
18183 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18184 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18185 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18186 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18187 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18188 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18189 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18190 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18191 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18192 way.
18193
18194 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18195
18196 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18197 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18198 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18199 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18200 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18201 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18202
18203 @smallexample
18204 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18205 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18206 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18207 (y or n) y
18208 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18209 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18210 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18211 (gdb)
18212 @end smallexample
18213
18214
18215 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18216
18217 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18218 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18219 @cindex load symbols from memory
18220 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18221 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18222 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18223 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18224 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18225 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18226 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18227 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18228 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18229
18230 @kindex section
18231 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18232 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18233 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18234 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18235 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18236 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18237 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18238 their addresses.
18239
18240 @kindex info files
18241 @kindex info target
18242 @item info files
18243 @itemx info target
18244 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18245 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18246 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18247 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18248 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18249 current ones.
18250
18251 @kindex maint info sections
18252 @item maint info sections
18253 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18254 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18255 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18256 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18257 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18258 may be arbitrarily combined):
18259
18260 @table @code
18261 @item ALLOBJ
18262 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18263 @item @var{sections}
18264 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18265 @item @var{section-flags}
18266 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18267 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18268 @table @code
18269 @item ALLOC
18270 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18271 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18272 @item LOAD
18273 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18274 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18275 @item RELOC
18276 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18277 @item READONLY
18278 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18279 @item CODE
18280 Section contains executable code only.
18281 @item DATA
18282 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18283 @item ROM
18284 Section will reside in ROM.
18285 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18286 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18287 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18288 Section is not empty.
18289 @item NEVER_LOAD
18290 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18291 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18292 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18293 COFF shared library information.
18294 @item IS_COMMON
18295 Section contains common symbols.
18296 @end table
18297 @end table
18298 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18299 @cindex read-only sections
18300 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18301 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18302 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18303 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18304 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18305 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18306 enhancement to debugging performance.
18307
18308 The default is off.
18309
18310 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18311 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18312 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18313 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18314
18315 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18316 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18317 @end table
18318
18319 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18320 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18321 name and remembers it that way.
18322
18323 @cindex shared libraries
18324 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18325 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18326 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18327 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18328
18329 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18330 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18331
18332 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18333 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18334 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18335 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18336 debugging a core file).
18337
18338 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18339 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18340 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18341
18342 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18343 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18344 particularly large or there are many of them.
18345
18346 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18347 commands:
18348
18349 @table @code
18350 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18351 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18352 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18353 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18354 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18355 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18356 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18357 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18358
18359 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18360 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18361 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18362 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18363 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18364 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18365 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18366 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18367 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18368
18369 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18370 @item show auto-solib-add
18371 Display the current autoloading mode.
18372 @end table
18373
18374 @cindex load shared library
18375 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18376 command:
18377
18378 @table @code
18379 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18380 @kindex info share
18381 @item info share @var{regex}
18382 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18383 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18384 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18385 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18386
18387 @kindex info dll
18388 @item info dll @var{regex}
18389 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18390
18391 @kindex sharedlibrary
18392 @kindex share
18393 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18394 @itemx share @var{regex}
18395 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18396 Unix regular expression.
18397 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18398 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18399 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18400 loaded.
18401
18402 @item nosharedlibrary
18403 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18404 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18405 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18406 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18407 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18408 discarded.
18409 @end table
18410
18411 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18412 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18413 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18414 Catchpoints}).
18415
18416 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18417 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18418 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18419 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18420
18421 @table @code
18422 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18423 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18424 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18425 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18426 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18427 shared library.
18428
18429 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18430 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18431 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18432 library events happen.
18433 @end table
18434
18435 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18436 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18437 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18438 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18439 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18440 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18441 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18442 not.
18443
18444 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18445 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18446 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18447 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18448 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18449
18450 @table @code
18451 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18452 @cindex system root, alternate
18453 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18454 @kindex set sysroot
18455 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18456 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18457 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18458 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18459 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18460 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18461 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18462 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18463 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18464 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18465 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18466 @var{path}.
18467
18468 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18469 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18470 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18471 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18472 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18473 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18474 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18475 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18476 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18477 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18478 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18479 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18480 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18481 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18482
18483 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18484 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18485 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18486 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18487 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18488
18489 @smallexample
18490 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18491 @end smallexample
18492
18493 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18494 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18495 system:
18496
18497 @smallexample
18498 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18499 @end smallexample
18500
18501 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18502 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18503 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18504 colons:
18505
18506 @smallexample
18507 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18508 @end smallexample
18509
18510 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18511 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18512 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18513 @samp{z}):
18514
18515 @smallexample
18516 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18517 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18518 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18519 @end smallexample
18520
18521 @noindent
18522 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18523 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18524 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18525
18526 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18527 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18528
18529 @smallexample
18530 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18531 @end smallexample
18532
18533 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18534 if you don't want or need to.
18535
18536 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18537 sysroot}.
18538
18539 @cindex default system root
18540 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18541 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18542 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18543 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18544 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18545 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18546 location.
18547
18548 @kindex show sysroot
18549 @item show sysroot
18550 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18551
18552 @kindex set solib-search-path
18553 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18554 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18555 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18556 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18557 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18558 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18559 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18560 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18561 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18562 of shared library symbols.
18563
18564 @kindex show solib-search-path
18565 @item show solib-search-path
18566 Display the current shared library search path.
18567
18568 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18569 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18570 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18571 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18572 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18573
18574 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18575 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18576 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18577 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18578 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18579 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18580 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18581 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18582 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18583 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18584 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18585 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18586 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18587 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18588 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18589 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18590 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18591 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18592 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18593 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18594 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18595 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18596
18597 @table @code
18598 @item unix
18599 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18600 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18601 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18602 the forward slash.
18603
18604 @item dos-based
18605 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18606 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18607 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18608 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18609 considered directory separators.
18610
18611 @item auto
18612 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18613 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18614 This is the default.
18615 @end table
18616 @end table
18617
18618 @cindex file name canonicalization
18619 @cindex base name differences
18620 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18621 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18622 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18623 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18624 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18625 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18626 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18627 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18628 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18629 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18630 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18631 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18632 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18633 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18634 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18635
18636 @table @code
18637 @item set basenames-may-differ
18638 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18639 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18640
18641 @item show basenames-may-differ
18642 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18643 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18644 @end table
18645
18646 @node File Caching
18647 @section File Caching
18648 @cindex caching of opened files
18649 @cindex caching of bfd objects
18650
18651 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18652 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
18653 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
18654 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18655
18656 @table @code
18657 @kindex maint info bfds
18658 @item maint info bfds
18659 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18660 @value{GDBN}.
18661
18662 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18663 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18664 @kindex bfd caching
18665 @item maint set bfd-sharing
18666 @item maint show bfd-sharing
18667 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
18668 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18669 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
18670 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18671 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
18672 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18673 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18674
18675 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18676 @kindex bfd caching
18677 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18678 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
18679
18680 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
18681 @kindex bfd caching
18682 @item show debug bfd-cache
18683 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
18684 @end table
18685
18686 @node Separate Debug Files
18687 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18688 @cindex separate debugging information files
18689 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18690 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18691 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18692 @cindex global debugging information directories
18693 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18694 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18695
18696 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18697 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18698 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18699 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18700 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18701 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18702 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18703
18704 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18705 file:
18706
18707 @itemize @bullet
18708 @item
18709 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18710 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18711 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18712 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18713 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18714 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18715 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18716 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18717
18718 @item
18719 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18720 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18721 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18722 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18723 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18724 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18725 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18726 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18727 below.
18728 @end itemize
18729
18730 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18731 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18732
18733 @itemize @bullet
18734 @item
18735 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18736 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18737 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18738 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18739 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18740
18741 @item
18742 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18743 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18744 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18745 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18746 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18747 hex characters, not 10.)
18748 @end itemize
18749
18750 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18751 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18752 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18753 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18754 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18755 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18756
18757 @itemize @minus
18758 @item
18759 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18760 @item
18761 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18762 @item
18763 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18764 @item
18765 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18766 @end itemize
18767
18768 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18769 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18770 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18771 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18772 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18773
18774 @table @code
18775
18776 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18777 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18778 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18779 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18780 concatenating them by a path separator.
18781
18782 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18783 @item show debug-file-directory
18784 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18785 information files.
18786
18787 @end table
18788
18789 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18790 @cindex debug link sections
18791 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18792 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18793
18794 @itemize
18795 @item
18796 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18797 a zero byte,
18798 @item
18799 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18800 boundary within the section, and
18801 @item
18802 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18803 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18804 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18805 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18806 @end itemize
18807
18808 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18809 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18810 described above.
18811
18812 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18813 @cindex build ID sections
18814 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18815 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18816 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18817 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18818 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18819 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18820 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18821 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18822 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18823
18824 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18825 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18826 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18827 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18828 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18829 in an ordinary executable.
18830
18831 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18832 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18833 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18834 following commands:
18835
18836 @smallexample
18837 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18838 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18839 @end smallexample
18840
18841 @noindent
18842 These commands remove the debugging
18843 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18844 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18845 two files:
18846
18847 @itemize @bullet
18848 @item
18849 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18850 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18851
18852 @smallexample
18853 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18854 @end smallexample
18855
18856 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
18857 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
18858 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
18859 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
18860
18861 @item
18862 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
18863 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
18864 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
18865 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
18866 @end itemize
18867
18868 @noindent
18869
18870 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
18871 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
18872 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
18873
18874 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
18875 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
18876 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
18877 @c different ways!
18878 @ifhtml
18879 @display
18880 @html
18881 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
18882 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
18883 @end html
18884 @end display
18885 @end ifhtml
18886 @ifnothtml
18887 @display
18888 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
18889 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
18890 @end display
18891 @end ifnothtml
18892
18893 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
18894 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
18895 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
18896 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
18897 CRC.
18898
18899 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
18900 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
18901 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
18902 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
18903 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
18904
18905 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
18906 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
18907 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
18908 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
18909 @code{0xffffffff}.
18910
18911 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
18912 @smallexample
18913 unsigned long
18914 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
18915 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
18916 @{
18917 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
18918 @{
18919 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
18920 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
18921 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
18922 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
18923 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
18924 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
18925 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
18926 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
18927 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
18928 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
18929 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
18930 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
18931 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
18932 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
18933 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
18934 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
18935 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
18936 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
18937 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
18938 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
18939 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
18940 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
18941 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
18942 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
18943 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
18944 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
18945 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
18946 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
18947 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
18948 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
18949 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
18950 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
18951 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
18952 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
18953 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
18954 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
18955 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
18956 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
18957 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
18958 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
18959 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
18960 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
18961 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
18962 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
18963 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
18964 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
18965 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
18966 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
18967 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
18968 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
18969 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
18970 0x2d02ef8d
18971 @};
18972 unsigned char *end;
18973
18974 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18975 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
18976 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
18977 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18978 @}
18979 @end smallexample
18980
18981 @noindent
18982 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
18983
18984 @node MiniDebugInfo
18985 @section Debugging information in a special section
18986 @cindex separate debug sections
18987 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
18988
18989 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
18990 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
18991 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
18992 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
18993
18994 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
18995 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
18996 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
18997 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
18998 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
18999 debugging information might be included in the section.
19000
19001 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19002 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19003 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19004
19005 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19006 standard utilities:
19007
19008 @smallexample
19009 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19010 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19011 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19012 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19013
19014 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19015 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19016 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19017 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19018 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19019 | sort > funcsyms
19020
19021 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19022 # table.
19023 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19024
19025 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19026 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19027
19028 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19029 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19030 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19031 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19032
19033 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19034 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19035
19036 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19037 # original binary.
19038 xz mini_debuginfo
19039 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19040 @end smallexample
19041
19042 @node Index Files
19043 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19044 @cindex index files
19045 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19046
19047 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19048 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19049 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19050 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19051 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19052 startup.
19053
19054 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19055 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19056 using @command{objcopy}.
19057
19058 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19059
19060 @table @code
19061 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19062 @kindex save gdb-index
19063 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19064 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19065 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19066 @var{directory}.
19067 @end table
19068
19069 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19070 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19071
19072 @smallexample
19073 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19074 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19075 @end smallexample
19076
19077 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19078 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19079 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19080 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19081 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19082 The default is @code{off}.
19083 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19084 @xref{Index Section Format}.
19085
19086 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19087 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19088
19089 @smallexample
19090 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19091 @end smallexample
19092
19093 Instead you must do, for example,
19094
19095 @smallexample
19096 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19097 @end smallexample
19098
19099 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19100 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19101 currently work for programs using Ada.
19102
19103 @node Symbol Errors
19104 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19105
19106 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19107 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19108 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19109 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19110 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19111 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19112 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19113 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19114 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19115 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19116 Messages}).
19117
19118 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19119
19120 @table @code
19121 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19122
19123 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19124 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19125 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19126 in its outer scope blocks.
19127
19128 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19129 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19130 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19131 function.
19132
19133 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19134
19135 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19136 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19137 do so.
19138
19139 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19140 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19141 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19142 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19143 Messages}.)
19144
19145 @item bad block start address patched
19146
19147 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19148 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19149 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19150
19151 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19152 starting on the previous source line.
19153
19154 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19155
19156 @cindex foo
19157 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19158 larger than the size of the string table.
19159
19160 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19161 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19162 with this name.
19163
19164 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19165
19166 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19167 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19168 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19169
19170 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19171 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19172 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19173 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19174 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19175 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19176
19177 @item stub type has NULL name
19178
19179 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19180
19181 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19182 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19183 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19184 it.
19185
19186 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19187
19188 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19189
19190 @end table
19191
19192 @node Data Files
19193 @section GDB Data Files
19194
19195 @cindex prefix for data files
19196 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19197 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19198
19199 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19200 is currently using.
19201
19202 @table @code
19203 @kindex set data-directory
19204 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19205 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19206 to @var{directory}.
19207
19208 @kindex show data-directory
19209 @item show data-directory
19210 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19211 @end table
19212
19213 @cindex default data directory
19214 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19215 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19216 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19217 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19218 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19219 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19220 location.
19221
19222 The data directory may also be specified with the
19223 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19224 @xref{Mode Options}.
19225
19226 @node Targets
19227 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19228
19229 @cindex debugging target
19230 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19231
19232 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19233 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19234 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19235 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19236 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19237 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19238 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19239 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19240
19241 @cindex target architecture
19242 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19243 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19244 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19245 command.
19246
19247 @table @code
19248 @kindex set architecture
19249 @kindex show architecture
19250 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19251 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19252 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19253 supported architectures.
19254
19255 @item show architecture
19256 Show the current target architecture.
19257
19258 @item set processor
19259 @itemx processor
19260 @kindex set processor
19261 @kindex show processor
19262 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19263 and @code{show architecture}.
19264 @end table
19265
19266 @menu
19267 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19268 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19269 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19270 @end menu
19271
19272 @node Active Targets
19273 @section Active Targets
19274
19275 @cindex stacking targets
19276 @cindex active targets
19277 @cindex multiple targets
19278
19279 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19280 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19281 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19282 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19283 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19284 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19285 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19286 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19287 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19288
19289 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19290 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19291 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19292 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19293
19294 @node Target Commands
19295 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19296
19297 @table @code
19298 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19299 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19300 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19301 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19302 protocol of the target machine.
19303
19304 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19305 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19306 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19307
19308 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19309 after executing the command.
19310
19311 @kindex help target
19312 @item help target
19313 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19314 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19315 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19316
19317 @item help target @var{name}
19318 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19319 select it.
19320
19321 @kindex set gnutarget
19322 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19323 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19324 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19325 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19326 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19327 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19328
19329 @quotation
19330 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19331 you must know the actual BFD name.
19332 @end quotation
19333
19334 @noindent
19335 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19336
19337 @kindex show gnutarget
19338 @item show gnutarget
19339 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19340 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19341 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19342 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19343 @end table
19344
19345 @cindex common targets
19346 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19347 configuration):
19348
19349 @table @code
19350 @kindex target
19351 @item target exec @var{program}
19352 @cindex executable file target
19353 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19354 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19355
19356 @item target core @var{filename}
19357 @cindex core dump file target
19358 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19359 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19360
19361 @item target remote @var{medium}
19362 @cindex remote target
19363 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19364 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19365 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19366
19367 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19368 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19369
19370 @smallexample
19371 target remote /dev/ttya
19372 @end smallexample
19373
19374 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19375 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19376 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19377 clobbered by the download.
19378
19379 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19380 @cindex built-in simulator target
19381 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19382 In general,
19383 @smallexample
19384 target sim
19385 load
19386 run
19387 @end smallexample
19388 @noindent
19389 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19390 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19391 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19392 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19393 Processors}.
19394
19395 @item target native
19396 @cindex native target
19397 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19398 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19399 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19400 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19401
19402 @end table
19403
19404 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19405 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19406
19407 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19408 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19409 various aspects of this process.
19410
19411 @table @code
19412
19413 @item set hash
19414 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19415 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19416 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19417 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19418 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19419 monitor.
19420
19421 @item show hash
19422 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19423 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19424
19425 @item set debug monitor
19426 @kindex set debug monitor
19427 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19428 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19429 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19430
19431 @item show debug monitor
19432 @kindex show debug monitor
19433 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19434 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19435 @end table
19436
19437 @table @code
19438
19439 @kindex load @var{filename}
19440 @item load @var{filename}
19441 @anchor{load}
19442 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19443 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19444 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19445 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19446 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19447 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19448
19449 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19450 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19451 target is @dots{}}''
19452
19453 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19454 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19455 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19456 specifies a fixed address.
19457 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19458
19459 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19460 load programs into flash memory.
19461
19462 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19463 @end table
19464
19465 @node Byte Order
19466 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19467
19468 @cindex choosing target byte order
19469 @cindex target byte order
19470
19471 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19472 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19473 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19474 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19475 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19476 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19477
19478 @table @code
19479 @kindex set endian
19480 @item set endian big
19481 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19482
19483 @item set endian little
19484 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19485
19486 @item set endian auto
19487 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19488 executable.
19489
19490 @item show endian
19491 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19492
19493 @end table
19494
19495 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19496 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19497 target system.
19498
19499
19500 @node Remote Debugging
19501 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19502 @cindex remote debugging
19503
19504 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19505 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19506 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19507 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19508 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19509
19510 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19511 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19512 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19513 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19514 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19515 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19516
19517 Other remote targets may be available in your
19518 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19519
19520 @menu
19521 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19522 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19523 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19524 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19525 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19526 @end menu
19527
19528 @node Connecting
19529 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19530 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
19531 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19532 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19533 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19534 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19535 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19536
19537 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19538 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19539 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19540 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19541
19542 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
19543
19544 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19545 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19546 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19547 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19548
19549 @table @asis
19550
19551 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19552 @item Result of detach or program exit
19553 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19554 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19555 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19556
19557 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19558 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19559 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19560 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19561
19562 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19563 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
19564 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19565 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19566
19567 @item Specifying the program to debug
19568 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19569 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19570 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19571 target.
19572
19573 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19574 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19575 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19576
19577 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19578 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19579 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19580 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19581
19582 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19583 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19584 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19585 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19586 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19587 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
19588 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19589 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
19590 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19591
19592 @item The @code{run} command
19593 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19594 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19595 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
19596 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19597 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19598
19599 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19600 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19601 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19602 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
19603 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19604
19605 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19606 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19607 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19608 @code{target remote} mode.
19609
19610 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19611 @item Attaching
19612 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19613 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19614 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19615
19616 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19617 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19618 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19619 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19620 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19621
19622 @end table
19623
19624 @anchor{Host and target files}
19625 @subsection Host and Target Files
19626 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19627 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
19628
19629 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
19630 information for your program running on the target. This requires
19631 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
19632 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
19633 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
19634
19635 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
19636 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
19637 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
19638 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
19639 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
19640
19641 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
19642 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19643 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19644 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
19645 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
19646 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
19647 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
19648 target libraries.
19649
19650 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19651 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19652 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19653 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19654 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19655 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19656 programs.
19657
19658 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
19659 @cindex remote connection commands
19660 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19661 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19662 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19663 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
19664 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
19665 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
19666 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
19667
19668 @table @code
19669
19670 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
19671 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
19672 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19673 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
19674 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19675
19676 @smallexample
19677 target remote /dev/ttyb
19678 @end smallexample
19679
19680 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19681 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19682 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19683 @code{target} command.
19684
19685 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19686 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19687 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19688 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19689 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19690 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19691 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19692 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
19693 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19694 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19695 target.
19696
19697 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19698 @code{manyfarms}:
19699
19700 @smallexample
19701 target remote manyfarms:2828
19702 @end smallexample
19703
19704 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19705 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19706 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19707 port 1234 on your local machine:
19708
19709 @smallexample
19710 target remote :1234
19711 @end smallexample
19712 @noindent
19713
19714 Note that the colon is still required here.
19715
19716 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19717 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19718 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19719 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19720 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19721
19722 @smallexample
19723 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19724 @end smallexample
19725
19726 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19727 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19728 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19729 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19730
19731 @item target remote | @var{command}
19732 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
19733 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19734 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19735 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19736 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19737 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19738 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19739 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19740 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19741
19742 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19743 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19744 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19745
19746 @end table
19747
19748 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19749 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19750 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19751 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19752 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19753 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19754 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19755
19756 @smallexample
19757 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19758 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19759 @end smallexample
19760
19761 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
19762 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
19763 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
19764 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
19765
19766 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
19767 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
19768
19769 @table @code
19770 @kindex detach (remote)
19771 @item detach
19772 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19773 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19774 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19775 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19776 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
19777 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
19778 still connected to the target.
19779
19780 @kindex disconnect
19781 @item disconnect
19782 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
19783 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19784 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19785 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19786 another target.
19787
19788 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19789 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19790 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19791 @kindex monitor
19792 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19793 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19794 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19795 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19796 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19797 and implement.
19798 @end table
19799
19800 @node File Transfer
19801 @section Sending files to a remote system
19802 @cindex remote target, file transfer
19803 @cindex file transfer
19804 @cindex sending files to remote systems
19805
19806 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19807 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
19808 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19809 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
19810 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19811 the only way to upload or download files.
19812
19813 Not all remote targets support these commands.
19814
19815 @table @code
19816 @kindex remote put
19817 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19818 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19819 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19820
19821 @kindex remote get
19822 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
19823 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
19824 on the host system.
19825
19826 @kindex remote delete
19827 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
19828 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
19829
19830 @end table
19831
19832 @node Server
19833 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
19834
19835 @kindex gdbserver
19836 @cindex remote connection without stubs
19837 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
19838 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
19839 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
19840 linking in the usual debugging stub.
19841
19842 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
19843 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
19844 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
19845 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
19846 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
19847 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
19848 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
19849 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
19850 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
19851 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
19852 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
19853 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
19854 choice for debugging.
19855
19856 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
19857 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
19858 protocol.
19859
19860 @quotation
19861 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
19862 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
19863 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
19864 target system with the same privileges as the user running
19865 @code{gdbserver}.
19866 @end quotation
19867
19868 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
19869 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
19870 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
19871 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
19872
19873 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
19874 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
19875 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
19876 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
19877 system does all the symbol handling.
19878
19879 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
19880 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
19881 syntax is:
19882
19883 @smallexample
19884 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
19885 @end smallexample
19886
19887 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
19888 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
19889 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
19890 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
19891 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
19892 @file{/dev/com1}:
19893
19894 @smallexample
19895 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
19896 @end smallexample
19897
19898 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
19899 with it.
19900
19901 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
19902
19903 @smallexample
19904 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
19905 @end smallexample
19906
19907 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
19908 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
19909 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
19910 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
19911 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
19912 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
19913 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
19914 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
19915 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
19916 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
19917 @code{target remote} command.
19918
19919 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
19920 with ssh:
19921
19922 @smallexample
19923 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
19924 @end smallexample
19925
19926 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
19927 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
19928 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
19929 You could elide it if you want to.
19930
19931 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
19932 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
19933 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
19934 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
19935
19936 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
19937 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
19938 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
19939 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
19940
19941 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
19942 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
19943
19944 @smallexample
19945 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
19946 @end smallexample
19947
19948 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
19949 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
19950
19951 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
19952 @value{GDBN} attach command
19953 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
19954
19955 @pindex pidof
19956 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
19957 @code{pidof} utility:
19958
19959 @smallexample
19960 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
19961 @end smallexample
19962
19963 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
19964 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
19965 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
19966
19967 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
19968
19969 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
19970 port.
19971
19972 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
19973 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
19974 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
19975 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
19976 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
19977 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
19978 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
19979 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
19980
19981 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
19982 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
19983 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
19984
19985 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
19986 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
19987 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
19988 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
19989 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
19990 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
19991 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
19992 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
19993 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
19994 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
19995 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
19996 instance closes its port after the first connection.
19997
19998 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
19999 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20000
20001 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20002 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20003 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20004 program. For more information,
20005 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20006
20007 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20008 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20009 status information about the debugging process.
20010 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20011 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20012 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20013 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20014
20015 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20016 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20017 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20018 Possible options are:
20019
20020 @table @code
20021 @item none
20022 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20023 @item all
20024 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20025 @item timestamps
20026 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20027 @end table
20028
20029 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20030 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20031
20032 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20033 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20034 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20035 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20036 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20037
20038 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20039 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20040 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20041 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20042
20043 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20044 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20045 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20046 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20047
20048 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20049 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20050 environment:
20051
20052 @smallexample
20053 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20054 @end smallexample
20055
20056 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20057
20058 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20059 @itemize
20060
20061 @item
20062 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20063
20064 @item
20065 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20066 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
20067 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20068 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20069 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20070 @code{--with-sysroot}).
20071
20072 @item
20073 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20074 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20075 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20076 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20077 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20078 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20079 program is already on the target.
20080
20081 @end itemize
20082
20083 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20084 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20085 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20086
20087 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20088 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20089 Here are the available commands.
20090
20091 @table @code
20092 @item monitor help
20093 List the available monitor commands.
20094
20095 @item monitor set debug 0
20096 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20097 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20098
20099 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20100 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20101 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20102 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20103
20104 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20105 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20106 Possible options are:
20107
20108 @table @code
20109 @item none
20110 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20111 @item all
20112 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20113 @item timestamps
20114 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20115 @end table
20116
20117 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20118 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20119
20120 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20121 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20122 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20123 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20124 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20125 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20126
20127 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20128 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20129
20130 @item monitor exit
20131 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20132 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20133 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20134 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20135 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20136
20137 @end table
20138
20139 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20140 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20141
20142 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20143 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20144
20145 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20146 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20147 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20148 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20149 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20150 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20151 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20152 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20153 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20154 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20155 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20156 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20157
20158 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20159
20160 @table @code
20161 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20162
20163 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20164 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20165 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20166
20167 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20168
20169 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20170 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20171 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20172 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20173 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20174 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20175
20176 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20177
20178 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20179 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20180 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20181 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20182 command for that. For example:
20183
20184 @smallexample
20185 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20186 @end smallexample
20187
20188 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20189 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20190 @end table
20191
20192 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20193 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20194 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20195 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20196 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20197 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20198 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20199 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20200 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20201 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20202
20203 @smallexample
20204 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20205 @end smallexample
20206
20207 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20208
20209 @smallexample
20210 $ gdb myprogram
20211 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20212 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20213 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20214 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20215 @end smallexample
20216
20217 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20218 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20219 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20220 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20221 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20222 tracing.
20223
20224 @node Remote Configuration
20225 @section Remote Configuration
20226
20227 @kindex set remote
20228 @kindex show remote
20229 This section documents the configuration options available when
20230 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20231 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20232 system-call-allowed}.
20233
20234 @table @code
20235 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20236 @cindex address size for remote targets
20237 @cindex bits in remote address
20238 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20239 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20240 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20241 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20242
20243 @item show remoteaddresssize
20244 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20245
20246 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20247 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20248 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20249 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20250 remote targets.
20251
20252 @item show serial baud
20253 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20254
20255 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20256 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20257 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20258
20259 @item show serial parity
20260 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20261
20262 @item set remotebreak
20263 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20264 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20265 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20266 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20267 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20268 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20269 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20270 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20271
20272 @item show remotebreak
20273 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20274 interrupt the remote program.
20275
20276 @item set remoteflow on
20277 @itemx set remoteflow off
20278 @kindex set remoteflow
20279 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20280 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20281
20282 @item show remoteflow
20283 @kindex show remoteflow
20284 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20285
20286 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20287 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20288 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20289 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20290 @code{ascii}.
20291
20292 @item show remotelogbase
20293 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20294 protocol.
20295
20296 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20297 @cindex record serial communications on file
20298 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20299 default is not to record at all.
20300
20301 @item show remotelogfile.
20302 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20303 serial communications.
20304
20305 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20306 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20307 @cindex remote timeout
20308 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20309 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20310
20311 @item show remotetimeout
20312 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20313 responses.
20314
20315 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20316 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20317 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20318 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20319 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20320 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20321 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20322 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20323
20324 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20325 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20326 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20327 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20328 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20329 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20330 as unlimited.
20331
20332 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20333 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20334 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20335
20336 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20337 @itemx show remote exec-file
20338 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20339 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20340 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20341 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20342 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20343 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20344
20345 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20346 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20347 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20348 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20349 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20350 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20351 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20352 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20353 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20354 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20355
20356 @item show interrupt-sequence
20357 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20358 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20359 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20360 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20361
20362 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20363 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20364 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20365 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20366 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20367 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20368
20369 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20370 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20371 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20372
20373 @kindex set tcp
20374 @kindex show tcp
20375 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20376 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20377 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20378 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20379 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20380 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20381 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20382 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20383 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20384
20385 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20386 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20387
20388 @item show tcp auto-retry
20389 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20390
20391 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20392 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20393 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20394 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20395 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20396 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20397 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20398 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20399 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20400 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20401 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20402
20403 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20404 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20405 @end table
20406
20407 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20408 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20409 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20410 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20411 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20412 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20413 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20414 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20415 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20416
20417 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20418 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20419 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20420 @value{GDBN} developers.
20421
20422 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20423 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20424 are:
20425
20426 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20427 @item Command Name
20428 @tab Remote Packet
20429 @tab Related Features
20430
20431 @item @code{fetch-register}
20432 @tab @code{p}
20433 @tab @code{info registers}
20434
20435 @item @code{set-register}
20436 @tab @code{P}
20437 @tab @code{set}
20438
20439 @item @code{binary-download}
20440 @tab @code{X}
20441 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20442
20443 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20444 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20445 @tab @code{info auxv}
20446
20447 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20448 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20449 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20450
20451 @item @code{attach}
20452 @tab @code{vAttach}
20453 @tab @code{attach}
20454
20455 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20456 @tab @code{vCont}
20457 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20458
20459 @item @code{run}
20460 @tab @code{vRun}
20461 @tab @code{run}
20462
20463 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20464 @tab @code{Z0}
20465 @tab @code{break}
20466
20467 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20468 @tab @code{Z1}
20469 @tab @code{hbreak}
20470
20471 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20472 @tab @code{Z2}
20473 @tab @code{watch}
20474
20475 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20476 @tab @code{Z3}
20477 @tab @code{rwatch}
20478
20479 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20480 @tab @code{Z4}
20481 @tab @code{awatch}
20482
20483 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20484 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20485 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20486
20487 @item @code{target-features}
20488 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20489 @tab @code{set architecture}
20490
20491 @item @code{library-info}
20492 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20493 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20494
20495 @item @code{memory-map}
20496 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20497 @tab @code{info mem}
20498
20499 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20500 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20501 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20502
20503 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20504 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20505 @tab @code{info spu}
20506
20507 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20508 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20509 @tab @code{info spu}
20510
20511 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20512 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20513 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20514
20515 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20516 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20517 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20518
20519 @item @code{threads}
20520 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20521 @tab @code{info threads}
20522
20523 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20524 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20525 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20526
20527 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20528 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20529 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20530
20531 @item @code{search-memory}
20532 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20533 @tab @code{find}
20534
20535 @item @code{supported-packets}
20536 @tab @code{qSupported}
20537 @tab Remote communications parameters
20538
20539 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
20540 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20541 @tab @code{catch syscall}
20542
20543 @item @code{pass-signals}
20544 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20545 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20546
20547 @item @code{program-signals}
20548 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20549 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20550
20551 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20552 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20553 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20554
20555 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20556 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20557 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20558
20559 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20560 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20561 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20562
20563 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20564 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20565 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20566
20567 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20568 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20569 @tab @code{remote delete}
20570
20571 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20572 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20573 @tab Host I/O
20574
20575 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20576 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20577 @tab Host I/O
20578
20579 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20580 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20581 @tab Host I/O
20582
20583 @item @code{noack-packet}
20584 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20585 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20586
20587 @item @code{osdata}
20588 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20589 @tab @code{info os}
20590
20591 @item @code{query-attached}
20592 @tab @code{qAttached}
20593 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20594
20595 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20596 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20597 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20598
20599 @item @code{trace-status}
20600 @tab @code{qTStatus}
20601 @tab @code{tstatus}
20602
20603 @item @code{traceframe-info}
20604 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20605 @tab Traceframe info
20606
20607 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20608 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20609 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20610
20611 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20612 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20613 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20614
20615 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20616 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20617 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20618
20619 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
20620 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
20621 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
20622
20623 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
20624 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20625 @tab @code{break}
20626
20627 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20628 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20629 @tab @code{hbreak}
20630
20631 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
20632 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
20633 @tab @code{fork}
20634
20635 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20636 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20637 @tab @code{vfork}
20638
20639 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
20640 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
20641 @tab @code{exec}
20642
20643 @item @code{thread-events}
20644 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
20645 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20646
20647 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
20648 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
20649 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20650
20651 @end multitable
20652
20653 @node Remote Stub
20654 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
20655
20656 @cindex debugging stub, example
20657 @cindex remote stub, example
20658 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
20659 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
20660 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
20661 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
20662 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
20663 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20664 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20665 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20666
20667 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20668 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20669 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20670 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
20671 program, you need:
20672
20673 @enumerate
20674 @item
20675 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20676 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
20677 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20678
20679 @item
20680 A C subroutine library to support your program's
20681 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20682
20683 @item
20684 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20685 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
20686 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20687 documentation.
20688 @end enumerate
20689
20690 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20691 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20692 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20693
20694 @table @emph
20695 @item On the host,
20696 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20697 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20698 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20699
20700 @item On the target,
20701 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20702 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
20703 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20704
20705 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20706 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20707 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20708 @end table
20709
20710 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20711 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20712 @sc{sparc} boards.
20713
20714 @cindex remote serial stub list
20715 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20716
20717 @table @code
20718
20719 @item i386-stub.c
20720 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20721 @cindex Intel
20722 @cindex i386
20723 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20724
20725 @item m68k-stub.c
20726 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20727 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20728 @cindex m680x0
20729 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20730
20731 @item sh-stub.c
20732 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20733 @cindex Renesas
20734 @cindex SH
20735 For Renesas SH architectures.
20736
20737 @item sparc-stub.c
20738 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20739 @cindex Sparc
20740 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20741
20742 @item sparcl-stub.c
20743 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20744 @cindex Fujitsu
20745 @cindex SparcLite
20746 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20747
20748 @end table
20749
20750 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20751 recently added stubs.
20752
20753 @menu
20754 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20755 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20756 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20757 @end menu
20758
20759 @node Stub Contents
20760 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20761
20762 @cindex remote serial stub
20763 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20764 subroutines:
20765
20766 @table @code
20767 @item set_debug_traps
20768 @findex set_debug_traps
20769 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20770 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20771 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20772 program's startup code.
20773
20774 @item handle_exception
20775 @findex handle_exception
20776 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20777 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20778 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20779 run when a trap is triggered.
20780
20781 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20782 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20783 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20784 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20785 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20786 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20787 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20788 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20789 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20790 machine.
20791
20792 @item breakpoint
20793 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20794 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20795 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20796 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20797 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20798 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20799 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20800 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20801 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20802 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20803 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
20804
20805 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20806 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20807 start of your debugging session.
20808 @end table
20809
20810 @node Bootstrapping
20811 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20812
20813 @cindex remote stub, support routines
20814 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20815 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20816 debugging target machine.
20817
20818 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20819 serial port.
20820
20821 @table @code
20822 @item int getDebugChar()
20823 @findex getDebugChar
20824 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
20825 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
20826 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20827
20828 @item void putDebugChar(int)
20829 @findex putDebugChar
20830 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
20831 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
20832 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20833 @end table
20834
20835 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
20836 @cindex interrupting remote targets
20837 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
20838 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
20839 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
20840 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
20841 remote system to stop.
20842
20843 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
20844 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
20845 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
20846 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
20847
20848 Other routines you need to supply are:
20849
20850 @table @code
20851 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
20852 @findex exceptionHandler
20853 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
20854 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
20855 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
20856 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
20857 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
20858 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
20859 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
20860 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
20861 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
20862 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
20863 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
20864 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
20865 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
20866
20867 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
20868 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
20869 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
20870 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
20871 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
20872
20873 @item void flush_i_cache()
20874 @findex flush_i_cache
20875 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
20876 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
20877 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
20878
20879 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
20880 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
20881 @end table
20882
20883 @noindent
20884 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
20885
20886 @table @code
20887 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
20888 @findex memset
20889 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
20890 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
20891 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
20892 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
20893 @end table
20894
20895 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
20896 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
20897 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
20898 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
20899
20900
20901 @node Debug Session
20902 @subsection Putting it All Together
20903
20904 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
20905 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
20906 steps.
20907
20908 @enumerate
20909 @item
20910 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
20911 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
20912 @display
20913 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
20914 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
20915 @end display
20916
20917 @item
20918 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
20919 procedure is called:
20920
20921 @smallexample
20922 set_debug_traps();
20923 breakpoint();
20924 @end smallexample
20925
20926 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
20927 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
20928 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
20929 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
20930 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
20931 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
20932 progress.
20933
20934 @item
20935 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
20936 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
20937
20938 @smallexample
20939 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
20940 @end smallexample
20941
20942 @noindent
20943 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
20944 function in your program, that function is called when
20945 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
20946 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
20947 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
20948
20949 @item
20950 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
20951 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
20952
20953 @item
20954 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
20955 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
20956
20957 @item
20958 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
20959 @c document that. FIXME.
20960 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
20961 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
20962
20963 @item
20964 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
20965 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20966
20967 @end enumerate
20968
20969 @node Configurations
20970 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
20971
20972 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
20973 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
20974 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
20975
20976 There are three major categories of configurations: native
20977 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
20978 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
20979 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
20980 are quite different from each other.
20981
20982 @menu
20983 * Native::
20984 * Embedded OS::
20985 * Embedded Processors::
20986 * Architectures::
20987 @end menu
20988
20989 @node Native
20990 @section Native
20991
20992 This section describes details specific to particular native
20993 configurations.
20994
20995 @menu
20996 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
20997 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
20998 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
20999 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21000 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21001 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21002 @end menu
21003
21004 @node BSD libkvm Interface
21005 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21006
21007 @cindex libkvm
21008 @cindex kernel memory image
21009 @cindex kernel crash dump
21010
21011 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21012 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21013 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21014 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21015 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21016 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21017 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21018 @code{kvm} target:
21019
21020 @smallexample
21021 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21022 @end smallexample
21023
21024 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21025 argument:
21026
21027 @smallexample
21028 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21029 @end smallexample
21030
21031 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21032 available:
21033
21034 @table @code
21035 @kindex kvm
21036 @item kvm pcb
21037 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21038
21039 @item kvm proc
21040 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21041 modern FreeBSD systems.
21042 @end table
21043
21044 @node SVR4 Process Information
21045 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
21046 @cindex /proc
21047 @cindex examine process image
21048 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21049
21050 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21051 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21052 process using file-system subroutines.
21053
21054 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21055 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21056 information about the process running your program, or about any
21057 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
21058 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21059
21060 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21061 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21062
21063 @table @code
21064 @kindex info proc
21065 @cindex process ID
21066 @item info proc
21067 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21068 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21069 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21070 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21071 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21072 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21073 executable file's absolute file name.
21074
21075 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21076 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21077 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21078 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21079 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21080 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21081
21082 @item info proc cmdline
21083 @cindex info proc cmdline
21084 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21085 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21086
21087 @item info proc cwd
21088 @cindex info proc cwd
21089 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21090 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21091
21092 @item info proc exe
21093 @cindex info proc exe
21094 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
21095 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21096
21097 @item info proc mappings
21098 @cindex memory address space mappings
21099 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21100 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21101 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21102 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21103 memory access rights to that range.
21104
21105 @item info proc stat
21106 @itemx info proc status
21107 @cindex process detailed status information
21108 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
21109 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21110 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21111 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21112 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21113 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21114 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21115
21116 @item info proc all
21117 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21118 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21119
21120 @ignore
21121 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21122 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21123 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21124 @kindex info proc times
21125 @item info proc times
21126 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21127 its children.
21128
21129 @kindex info proc id
21130 @item info proc id
21131 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21132 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21133 @end ignore
21134
21135 @item set procfs-trace
21136 @kindex set procfs-trace
21137 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21138 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21139
21140 @item show procfs-trace
21141 @kindex show procfs-trace
21142 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21143
21144 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
21145 @kindex set procfs-file
21146 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21147 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21148 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21149 standard output.
21150
21151 @item show procfs-file
21152 @kindex show procfs-file
21153 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21154
21155 @item proc-trace-entry
21156 @itemx proc-trace-exit
21157 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
21158 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
21159 @kindex proc-trace-entry
21160 @kindex proc-trace-exit
21161 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
21162 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
21163 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21164 from the @code{syscall} interface.
21165
21166 @item info pidlist
21167 @kindex info pidlist
21168 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21169 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21170 processes and all the threads within each process.
21171
21172 @item info meminfo
21173 @kindex info meminfo
21174 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21175 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21176 @end table
21177
21178 @node DJGPP Native
21179 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21180 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21181 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21182 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21183
21184 @cindex DPMI
21185 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21186 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21187 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21188 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21189
21190 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21191 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21192 subsection describes those commands.
21193
21194 @table @code
21195 @kindex info dos
21196 @item info dos
21197 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21198 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21199
21200 @kindex sysinfo
21201 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21202 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21203 @item info dos sysinfo
21204 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21205 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21206 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21207
21208 @cindex GDT
21209 @cindex LDT
21210 @cindex IDT
21211 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21212 @cindex descriptor tables display
21213 @item info dos gdt
21214 @itemx info dos ldt
21215 @itemx info dos idt
21216 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21217 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21218 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21219 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21220 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21221 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21222 rights.
21223
21224 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21225 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21226 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21227 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21228 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21229
21230 @cindex garbled pointers
21231 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21232 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21233 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21234 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21235 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21236 debugged program's data segment:
21237
21238 @smallexample
21239 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21240 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21241 @end smallexample
21242
21243 @noindent
21244 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21245 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21246
21247 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21248 @item info dos pde
21249 @itemx info dos pte
21250 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21251 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21252 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21253 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21254 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21255 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21256 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21257 that is currently in use.
21258
21259 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21260 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21261 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21262 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21263 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21264 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21265 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21266
21267 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21268 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21269 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21270 controller.
21271
21272 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21273
21274 @cindex physical address from linear address
21275 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21276 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21277 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21278 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21279 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21280 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21281 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21282
21283 @smallexample
21284 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21285 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21286 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21287 @end smallexample
21288
21289 @noindent
21290 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21291 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21292 attributes of that page.
21293
21294 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21295 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21296 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21297 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21298 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21299 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21300
21301 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21302 transfer buffer:
21303
21304 @smallexample
21305 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21306 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21307 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21308 @end smallexample
21309
21310 @noindent
21311 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21312 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21313 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21314 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21315 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21316
21317 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21318 @end table
21319
21320 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21321 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21322 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21323 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21324
21325 @table @code
21326 @kindex set com1base
21327 @kindex set com1irq
21328 @kindex set com2base
21329 @kindex set com2irq
21330 @kindex set com3base
21331 @kindex set com3irq
21332 @kindex set com4base
21333 @kindex set com4irq
21334 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21335 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21336 port.
21337
21338 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21339 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21340 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21341
21342 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21343 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21344 other 3 COM ports.
21345
21346 @kindex show com1base
21347 @kindex show com1irq
21348 @kindex show com2base
21349 @kindex show com2irq
21350 @kindex show com3base
21351 @kindex show com3irq
21352 @kindex show com4base
21353 @kindex show com4irq
21354 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21355 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21356 lines used by the COM ports.
21357
21358 @item info serial
21359 @kindex info serial
21360 @cindex DOS serial port status
21361 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21362 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21363 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21364 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21365 @end table
21366
21367
21368 @node Cygwin Native
21369 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21370 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21371 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21372 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21373
21374 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21375 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21376
21377 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21378 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21379 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21380 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21381 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21382 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21383 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21384 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21385
21386 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21387 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21388 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21389
21390 @table @code
21391 @kindex info w32
21392 @item info w32
21393 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21394 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21395
21396 @item info w32 selector
21397 This command displays information returned by
21398 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21399 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21400 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21401 Without argument, this command displays information
21402 about the six segment registers.
21403
21404 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21405 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21406 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21407 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21408
21409 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21410 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21411 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21412 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21413 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21414 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21415 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21416 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21417 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21418 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21419 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21420
21421 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21422 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21423 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21424 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21425
21426 @kindex set new-console
21427 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21428 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21429 be started in a new console on next start.
21430 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21431 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21432
21433 @kindex show new-console
21434 @item show new-console
21435 Displays whether a new console is used
21436 when the debuggee is started.
21437
21438 @kindex set new-group
21439 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21440 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21441 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21442 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21443 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21444
21445 @kindex show new-group
21446 @item show new-group
21447 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21448
21449 @kindex set debugevents
21450 @item set debugevents
21451 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21452 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21453 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21454 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21455 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21456
21457 @kindex set debugexec
21458 @item set debugexec
21459 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21460 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21461
21462 @kindex set debugexceptions
21463 @item set debugexceptions
21464 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21465 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21466
21467 @kindex set debugmemory
21468 @item set debugmemory
21469 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21470 and writes by the debugger.
21471
21472 @kindex set shell
21473 @item set shell
21474 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21475 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21476
21477 @kindex show shell
21478 @item show shell
21479 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21480
21481 @end table
21482
21483 @menu
21484 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21485 @end menu
21486
21487 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21488 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21489 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21490 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21491
21492 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21493 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21494 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21495 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21496 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21497 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21498 ``minimal symbols''.
21499
21500 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21501 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21502 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21503 program run once to completion.
21504
21505 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21506
21507 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21508 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21509 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21510 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21511 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21512 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21513 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21514 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21515 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21516
21517 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21518 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21519 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21520 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21521 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21522 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21523
21524 @smallexample
21525 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21526 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21527
21528 Non-debugging symbols:
21529 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21530 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21531 @end smallexample
21532
21533 @smallexample
21534 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21535 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21536
21537 Non-debugging symbols:
21538 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21539 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21540 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21541 [etc...]
21542 @end smallexample
21543
21544 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21545
21546 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21547 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21548 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21549 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21550 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21551 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21552 a function within a DLL without a running program.
21553
21554 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21555 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21556 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21557 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21558 problem:
21559
21560 @smallexample
21561 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21562 $1 = 268572168
21563 @end smallexample
21564
21565 @smallexample
21566 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21567 0x10021610: "\230y\""
21568 @end smallexample
21569
21570 And two possible solutions:
21571
21572 @smallexample
21573 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21574 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21575 @end smallexample
21576
21577 @smallexample
21578 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
21579 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
21580 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
21581 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
21582 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
21583 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21584 @end smallexample
21585
21586 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21587 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21588 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21589 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21590 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21591
21592 @smallexample
21593 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21594 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21595 @end smallexample
21596
21597 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21598 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21599 safe.
21600
21601 @node Hurd Native
21602 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21603 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21604
21605 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21606 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21607
21608 @table @code
21609 @item set signals
21610 @itemx set sigs
21611 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21612 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21613 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21614 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21615 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21616 @code{signals}.
21617
21618 @item show signals
21619 @itemx show sigs
21620 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
21621 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21622 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
21623
21624 @item set signal-thread
21625 @itemx set sigthread
21626 @kindex set signal-thread
21627 @kindex set sigthread
21628 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
21629 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
21630 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
21631 signal-thread}.
21632
21633 @item show signal-thread
21634 @itemx show sigthread
21635 @kindex show signal-thread
21636 @kindex show sigthread
21637 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
21638 delivered a signal.
21639
21640 @item set stopped
21641 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21642 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
21643 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
21644 continued by delivering a signal to it.
21645
21646 @item show stopped
21647 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21648 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
21649 stopped.
21650
21651 @item set exceptions
21652 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21653 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
21654 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21655 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
21656 trapping on.
21657
21658 @item show exceptions
21659 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21660 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21661
21662 @item set task pause
21663 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21664 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21665 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21666 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21667 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21668 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
21669 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
21670 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21671 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21672
21673 @item show task pause
21674 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21675 Show the current state of task suspension.
21676
21677 @item set task detach-suspend-count
21678 @cindex task suspend count
21679 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21680 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21681 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21682
21683 @item show task detach-suspend-count
21684 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21685
21686 @item set task exception-port
21687 @itemx set task excp
21688 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21689 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21690 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21691 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21692
21693 @item set noninvasive
21694 @cindex noninvasive task options
21695 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21696 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
21697 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21698 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21699
21700 @item info send-rights
21701 @itemx info receive-rights
21702 @itemx info port-rights
21703 @itemx info port-sets
21704 @itemx info dead-names
21705 @itemx info ports
21706 @itemx info psets
21707 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21708 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21709 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21710 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21711 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21712 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21713 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21714 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21715 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21716
21717 @item set thread pause
21718 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21719 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21720 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21721 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21722 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21723 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21724 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21725 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21726 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21727 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21728 only the current thread.
21729
21730 @item show thread pause
21731 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21732 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21733
21734 @item set thread run
21735 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21736
21737 @item show thread run
21738 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21739
21740 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21741 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21742 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21743 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21744 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21745 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21746 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21747
21748 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21749 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21750 detaching.
21751
21752 @item set thread exception-port
21753 @itemx set thread excp
21754 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21755 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21756 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21757
21758 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21759 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21760 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21761 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21762
21763 @item set thread default
21764 @itemx show thread default
21765 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21766 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21767 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21768 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21769 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21770 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21771 the non-default commands.
21772 @end table
21773
21774 @node Darwin
21775 @subsection Darwin
21776 @cindex Darwin
21777
21778 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21779
21780 @table @code
21781 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
21782 @kindex set debug darwin
21783 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21784 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
21785
21786 @item show debug darwin
21787 @kindex show debug darwin
21788 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21789
21790 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21791 @kindex set debug mach-o
21792 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
21793 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
21794 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
21795 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
21796 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
21797 usage.
21798
21799 @item show debug mach-o
21800 @kindex show debug mach-o
21801 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
21802
21803 @item set mach-exceptions on
21804 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
21805 @kindex set mach-exceptions
21806 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
21807 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
21808 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
21809 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
21810
21811 @item show mach-exceptions
21812 @kindex show mach-exceptions
21813 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21814 @end table
21815
21816
21817 @node Embedded OS
21818 @section Embedded Operating Systems
21819
21820 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
21821 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
21822 architectures.
21823
21824 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
21825 various real-time operating systems.
21826
21827 @node Embedded Processors
21828 @section Embedded Processors
21829
21830 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
21831 configurations.
21832
21833 @cindex send command to simulator
21834 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
21835 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
21836
21837 @table @code
21838 @item sim @var{command}
21839 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
21840 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
21841 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
21842 acceptable commands.
21843 @end table
21844
21845
21846 @menu
21847 * ARM:: ARM
21848 * M32R/SDI:: Renesas M32R/SDI
21849 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
21850 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
21851 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
21852 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
21853 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
21854 * CRIS:: CRIS
21855 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
21856 @end menu
21857
21858 @node ARM
21859 @subsection ARM
21860
21861 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
21862
21863 @table @code
21864 @item set arm disassembler
21865 @kindex set arm
21866 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
21867 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
21868
21869 @item show arm disassembler
21870 @kindex show arm
21871 Show the current disassembly style.
21872
21873 @item set arm apcs32
21874 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
21875 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
21876
21877 @item show arm apcs32
21878 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
21879
21880 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
21881 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
21882 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
21883
21884 @table @code
21885 @item auto
21886 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
21887 @item softfpa
21888 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
21889 processors.
21890 @item fpa
21891 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
21892 @item softvfp
21893 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
21894 @item vfp
21895 VFP co-processor.
21896 @end table
21897
21898 @item show arm fpu
21899 Show the current type of the FPU.
21900
21901 @item set arm abi
21902 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
21903
21904 @item show arm abi
21905 Show the currently used ABI.
21906
21907 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21908 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
21909 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
21910 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
21911 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
21912 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
21913 register).
21914
21915 @item show arm fallback-mode
21916 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
21917
21918 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21919 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
21920 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
21921 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
21922 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
21923
21924 @item show arm force-mode
21925 Show the current forced instruction mode.
21926
21927 @item set debug arm
21928 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
21929 target support subsystem.
21930
21931 @item show debug arm
21932 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
21933 @end table
21934
21935 @table @code
21936 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21937 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
21938
21939 @table @code
21940 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
21941 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
21942 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
21943 The default value is @code{all}.
21944
21945 @table @code
21946 @item none
21947 @item demon
21948 @item angel
21949 @item redboot
21950 @item all
21951 @end table
21952 @end table
21953 @end table
21954
21955 @node M32R/SDI
21956 @subsection Renesas M32R/SDI
21957
21958 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
21959
21960 @table @code
21961 @item sdireset
21962 @kindex sdireset
21963 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
21964 This command resets the SDI connection.
21965
21966 @item sdistatus
21967 @kindex sdistatus
21968 This command shows the SDI connection status.
21969
21970 @item debug_chaos
21971 @kindex debug_chaos
21972 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
21973 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
21974
21975 @item use_debug_dma
21976 @kindex use_debug_dma
21977 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
21978
21979 @item use_mon_code
21980 @kindex use_mon_code
21981 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
21982
21983 @item use_ib_break
21984 @kindex use_ib_break
21985 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
21986
21987 @item use_dbt_break
21988 @kindex use_dbt_break
21989 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
21990 @end table
21991
21992 @node M68K
21993 @subsection M68k
21994
21995 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
21996
21997 @node MicroBlaze
21998 @subsection MicroBlaze
21999 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22000 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22001
22002 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22003 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
22004 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22005 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22006 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22007 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22008 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22009 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
22010 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
22011 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22012 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22013
22014 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22015
22016 @table @code
22017 @item target remote :1234
22018 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22019 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22020
22021 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22022 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22023 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22024
22025 @item load
22026 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22027
22028 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22029 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22030
22031 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22032 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22033 @end table
22034
22035 @node MIPS Embedded
22036 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22037
22038 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
22039 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
22040 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
22041 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
22042
22043 @need 1000
22044 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
22045
22046 @table @code
22047 @item target mips @var{port}
22048 @kindex target mips @var{port}
22049 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
22050 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
22051 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
22052 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
22053 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
22054 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
22055
22056 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
22057 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
22058 debugger:
22059
22060 @smallexample
22061 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
22062 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
22063 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
22064 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
22065 (@value{GDBP}) run
22066 @end smallexample
22067
22068 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
22069 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
22070 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
22071 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
22072 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
22073
22074 @item target pmon @var{port}
22075 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
22076 PMON ROM monitor.
22077
22078 @item target ddb @var{port}
22079 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
22080 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
22081
22082 @item target lsi @var{port}
22083 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
22084 LSI variant of PMON.
22085
22086 @end table
22087
22088
22089 @noindent
22090 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22091
22092 @table @code
22093 @item set mipsfpu double
22094 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22095 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22096 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22097 @itemx show mipsfpu
22098 @kindex set mipsfpu
22099 @kindex show mipsfpu
22100 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22101 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22102 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22103 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22104 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22105 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22106 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22107 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22108 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22109 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22110 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22111 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22112 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22113
22114 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22115 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22116 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22117
22118 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22119 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22120
22121 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
22122 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
22123 @itemx show timeout
22124 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
22125 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
22126 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
22127 @kindex set timeout
22128 @kindex show timeout
22129 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
22130 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
22131 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
22132 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
22133 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
22134 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
22135 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
22136 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
22137 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
22138 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
22139
22140 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
22141 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
22142 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
22143 to run before stopping.
22144
22145 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
22146 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
22147 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
22148 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
22149 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
22150 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
22151
22152 @item show syn-garbage-limit
22153 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
22154 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
22155 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
22156
22157 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
22158 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
22159 @cindex remote monitor prompt
22160 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
22161 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
22162 @table @asis
22163 @item pmon target
22164 @samp{PMON}
22165 @item ddb target
22166 @samp{NEC010}
22167 @item lsi target
22168 @samp{PMON>}
22169 @end table
22170
22171 @item show monitor-prompt
22172 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
22173 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
22174 remote monitor.
22175
22176 @item set monitor-warnings
22177 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
22178 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
22179 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
22180 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
22181 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
22182
22183 @item show monitor-warnings
22184 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
22185 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
22186
22187 @item pmon @var{command}
22188 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
22189 @cindex send PMON command
22190 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
22191 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
22192 @end table
22193
22194 @node PowerPC Embedded
22195 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22196
22197 @cindex DVC register
22198 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22199 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22200
22201 @smallexample
22202 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22203 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22204 @end smallexample
22205
22206 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22207 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22208 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22209 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22210 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22211 or newer.
22212
22213 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22214 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22215 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22216 watching variables of scalar types.
22217
22218 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22219 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22220
22221 @smallexample
22222 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22223 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22224 @end smallexample
22225
22226 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22227 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22228
22229 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22230 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22231 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22232 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22233 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22234 use the @code{break-range} command.
22235
22236 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22237
22238 @table @code
22239 @kindex break-range
22240 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22241 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22242 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22243 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22244 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22245 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22246 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22247 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22248 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22249
22250 @kindex set powerpc
22251 @item set powerpc soft-float
22252 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22253 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22254 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22255 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22256
22257 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22258 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22259 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22260 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22261 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22262 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22263 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22264 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22265
22266 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22267 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22268 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22269 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22270 address of its first byte.
22271
22272 @end table
22273
22274 @node AVR
22275 @subsection Atmel AVR
22276 @cindex AVR
22277
22278 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22279 following AVR-specific commands:
22280
22281 @table @code
22282 @item info io_registers
22283 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22284 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22285 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22286 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22287 @end table
22288
22289 @node CRIS
22290 @subsection CRIS
22291 @cindex CRIS
22292
22293 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22294 following CRIS-specific commands:
22295
22296 @table @code
22297 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22298 @cindex CRIS version
22299 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22300 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22301 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22302
22303 @item show cris-version
22304 Show the current CRIS version.
22305
22306 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22307 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22308 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22309 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22310 @code{R59}.
22311
22312 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22313 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22314
22315 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22316 @cindex CRIS mode
22317 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22318 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22319 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22320
22321 @item show cris-mode
22322 Show the current CRIS mode.
22323 @end table
22324
22325 @node Super-H
22326 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22327 @cindex Super-H
22328
22329 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22330 commands:
22331
22332 @table @code
22333 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22334 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22335 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22336 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22337 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22338 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22339 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22340 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22341 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22342 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22343 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22344 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22345
22346 @item show sh calling-convention
22347 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22348 Show the current calling convention setting.
22349
22350 @end table
22351
22352
22353 @node Architectures
22354 @section Architectures
22355
22356 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22357 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22358
22359 @menu
22360 * AArch64::
22361 * i386::
22362 * Alpha::
22363 * MIPS::
22364 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22365 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22366 * PowerPC::
22367 * Nios II::
22368 @end menu
22369
22370 @node AArch64
22371 @subsection AArch64
22372 @cindex AArch64 support
22373
22374 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22375 following special commands:
22376
22377 @table @code
22378 @item set debug aarch64
22379 @kindex set debug aarch64
22380 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22381 messages are to be displayed.
22382
22383 @item show debug aarch64
22384 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22385
22386 @end table
22387
22388 @node i386
22389 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22390
22391 @table @code
22392 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22393 @kindex set struct-convention
22394 @cindex struct return convention
22395 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22396 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22397 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22398 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22399 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22400 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22401 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22402 be returned in a register.
22403
22404 @item show struct-convention
22405 @kindex show struct-convention
22406 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22407 from functions.
22408 @end table
22409
22410
22411 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22412 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22413
22414 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22415 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22416 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22417 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22418 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22419 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22420 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22421
22422 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22423 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22424 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22425 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22426 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22427 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22428
22429 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22430 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22431 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22432
22433 @smallexample
22434 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22435 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22436 @end smallexample
22437
22438 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22439 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22440 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22441 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22442 the pointer.
22443
22444 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22445 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22446 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22447 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22448 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22449
22450 @table @code
22451 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22452 @kindex show mpx bound
22453 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22454
22455 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22456 @kindex set mpx bound
22457 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22458 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22459 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22460 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22461 @end table
22462
22463 @node Alpha
22464 @subsection Alpha
22465
22466 See the following section.
22467
22468 @node MIPS
22469 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22470
22471 @cindex stack on Alpha
22472 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22473 @cindex Alpha stack
22474 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22475 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22476 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22477 find the beginning of a function.
22478
22479 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22480 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22481 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22482 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22483 commands:
22484
22485 @table @code
22486 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22487 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22488 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22489 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22490 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22491 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22492 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22493 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22494
22495 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22496 Display the current limit.
22497 @end table
22498
22499 @noindent
22500 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22501 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22502
22503 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22504 programs:
22505
22506 @table @code
22507 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22508 @kindex set mips abi
22509 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22510 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22511 values of @var{arg} are:
22512
22513 @table @samp
22514 @item auto
22515 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22516 default).
22517 @item o32
22518 @item o64
22519 @item n32
22520 @item n64
22521 @item eabi32
22522 @item eabi64
22523 @end table
22524
22525 @item show mips abi
22526 @kindex show mips abi
22527 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22528
22529 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22530 @kindex set mips compression
22531 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22532 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22533 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22534 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22535 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22536 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22537 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22538 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22539 provided by the executable.
22540
22541 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22542 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22543 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22544 identified as such.
22545
22546 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22547 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22548 implicitly from an executable.
22549
22550 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22551 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22552 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22553 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22554 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22555
22556 @item show mips compression
22557 @kindex show mips compression
22558 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22559 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22560
22561 @item set mipsfpu
22562 @itemx show mipsfpu
22563 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22564
22565 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22566 @kindex set mips mask-address
22567 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22568 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22569 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22570 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22571 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22572
22573 @item show mips mask-address
22574 @kindex show mips mask-address
22575 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22576 not.
22577
22578 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22579 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22580 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22581 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22582 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22583 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22584
22585 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22586 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22587 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22588
22589 @item set debug mips
22590 @kindex set debug mips
22591 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22592 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22593
22594 @item show debug mips
22595 @kindex show debug mips
22596 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22597 @end table
22598
22599
22600 @node HPPA
22601 @subsection HPPA
22602 @cindex HPPA support
22603
22604 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22605 following special commands:
22606
22607 @table @code
22608 @item set debug hppa
22609 @kindex set debug hppa
22610 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22611 messages are to be displayed.
22612
22613 @item show debug hppa
22614 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22615
22616 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22617 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22618 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22619 given @var{address}.
22620
22621 @end table
22622
22623
22624 @node SPU
22625 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22626 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22627 @cindex SPU
22628
22629 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22630 it provides the following special commands:
22631
22632 @table @code
22633 @item info spu event
22634 @kindex info spu
22635 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22636 and pending event status.
22637
22638 @item info spu signal
22639 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22640 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22641 notification channels.
22642
22643 @item info spu mailbox
22644 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22645 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22646 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22647
22648 @item info spu dma
22649 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22650 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22651 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22652
22653 @item info spu proxydma
22654 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22655 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22656 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22657
22658 @end table
22659
22660 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22661 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22662 special commands:
22663
22664 @table @code
22665 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22666 @kindex set spu
22667 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22668 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22669 function. The default is @code{off}.
22670
22671 @item show spu stop-on-load
22672 @kindex show spu
22673 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22674
22675 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22676 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22677 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22678 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22679 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22680 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22681
22682 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22683 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22684
22685 @end table
22686
22687 @node PowerPC
22688 @subsection PowerPC
22689 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22690
22691 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22692 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22693 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22694 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22695 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22696
22697 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22698 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22699 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22700
22701 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22702 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22703
22704 @node Nios II
22705 @subsection Nios II
22706 @cindex Nios II architecture
22707
22708 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22709 it provides the following special commands:
22710
22711 @table @code
22712
22713 @item set debug nios2
22714 @kindex set debug nios2
22715 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22716 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22717
22718 @item show debug nios2
22719 @kindex show debug nios2
22720 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22721 @end table
22722
22723 @node Controlling GDB
22724 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22725
22726 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22727 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22728 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22729 described here.
22730
22731 @menu
22732 * Prompt:: Prompt
22733 * Editing:: Command editing
22734 * Command History:: Command history
22735 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22736 * Numbers:: Numbers
22737 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22738 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22739 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22740 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22741 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22742 @end menu
22743
22744 @node Prompt
22745 @section Prompt
22746
22747 @cindex prompt
22748
22749 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22750 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22751 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22752 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22753 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22754 which one you are talking to.
22755
22756 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22757 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22758 or a prompt that does not.
22759
22760 @table @code
22761 @kindex set prompt
22762 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22763 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22764
22765 @kindex show prompt
22766 @item show prompt
22767 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22768 @end table
22769
22770 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22771 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22772 are:
22773
22774 @table @code
22775 @kindex set extended-prompt
22776 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22777 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22778 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22779 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22780 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22781 is displayed.
22782
22783 For example:
22784
22785 @smallexample
22786 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22787 @end smallexample
22788
22789 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22790 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22791
22792 @kindex show extended-prompt
22793 @item show extended-prompt
22794 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22795 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22796 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22797 @end table
22798
22799 @node Editing
22800 @section Command Editing
22801 @cindex readline
22802 @cindex command line editing
22803
22804 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22805 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22806 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22807 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22808 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22809 debugging sessions.
22810
22811 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22812 command @code{set}.
22813
22814 @table @code
22815 @kindex set editing
22816 @cindex editing
22817 @item set editing
22818 @itemx set editing on
22819 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22820
22821 @item set editing off
22822 Disable command line editing.
22823
22824 @kindex show editing
22825 @item show editing
22826 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22827 @end table
22828
22829 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22830 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22831 @end ifset
22832 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22833 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22834 @end ifclear
22835 for more details about the Readline
22836 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22837 encouraged to read that chapter.
22838
22839 @node Command History
22840 @section Command History
22841 @cindex command history
22842
22843 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22844 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22845 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22846 history facility.
22847
22848 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22849 package, to provide the history facility.
22850 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22851 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22852 @end ifset
22853 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22854 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22855 @end ifclear
22856 for the detailed description of the History library.
22857
22858 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22859 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22860 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22861 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22862 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22863 pressed on a line by itself.
22864
22865 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22866 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22867 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22868 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22869
22870 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22871 history.
22872
22873 @table @code
22874 @cindex history substitution
22875 @cindex history file
22876 @kindex set history filename
22877 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22878 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22879 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22880 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22881 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22882 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22883 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22884 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22885 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22886 is not set.
22887
22888 @cindex save command history
22889 @kindex set history save
22890 @item set history save
22891 @itemx set history save on
22892 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22893 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22894
22895 @item set history save off
22896 Stop recording command history in a file.
22897
22898 @cindex history size
22899 @kindex set history size
22900 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
22901 @item set history size @var{size}
22902 @itemx set history size unlimited
22903 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22904 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
22905 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
22906 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
22907 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
22908 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
22909
22910 @cindex remove duplicate history
22911 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
22912 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
22913 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
22914 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
22915 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
22916 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
22917 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
22918 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
22919 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
22920
22921 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
22922 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
22923
22924 @end table
22925
22926 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22927 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22928 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22929 @end ifset
22930 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22931 @xref{Event Designators},
22932 @end ifclear
22933 for more details.
22934
22935 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22936 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22937 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22938 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22939 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22940 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22941 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22942 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22943
22944 The commands to control history expansion are:
22945
22946 @table @code
22947 @item set history expansion on
22948 @itemx set history expansion
22949 @kindex set history expansion
22950 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22951
22952 @item set history expansion off
22953 Disable history expansion.
22954
22955 @c @group
22956 @kindex show history
22957 @item show history
22958 @itemx show history filename
22959 @itemx show history save
22960 @itemx show history size
22961 @itemx show history expansion
22962 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22963 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22964 @c @end group
22965 @end table
22966
22967 @table @code
22968 @kindex show commands
22969 @cindex show last commands
22970 @cindex display command history
22971 @item show commands
22972 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22973
22974 @item show commands @var{n}
22975 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22976
22977 @item show commands +
22978 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22979 @end table
22980
22981 @node Screen Size
22982 @section Screen Size
22983 @cindex size of screen
22984 @cindex screen size
22985 @cindex pagination
22986 @cindex page size
22987 @cindex pauses in output
22988
22989 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22990 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22991 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22992 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22993 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22994 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22995 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22996 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22997
22998 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22999 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23000 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23001 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
23002 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23003 width} commands:
23004
23005 @table @code
23006 @kindex set height
23007 @kindex set width
23008 @kindex show width
23009 @kindex show height
23010 @item set height @var{lpp}
23011 @itemx set height unlimited
23012 @itemx show height
23013 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
23014 @itemx set width unlimited
23015 @itemx show width
23016 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23017 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
23018 commands display the current settings.
23019
23020 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23021 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23022 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23023 buffer.
23024
23025 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23026 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23027
23028 @item set pagination on
23029 @itemx set pagination off
23030 @kindex set pagination
23031 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
23032 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
23033 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23034 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23035
23036 @item show pagination
23037 @kindex show pagination
23038 Show the current pagination mode.
23039 @end table
23040
23041 @node Numbers
23042 @section Numbers
23043 @cindex number representation
23044 @cindex entering numbers
23045
23046 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23047 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23048 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23049 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23050 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
23051 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23052 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23053 both input and output with the commands described below.
23054
23055 @table @code
23056 @kindex set input-radix
23057 @item set input-radix @var{base}
23058 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23059 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23060 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23061 example, any of
23062
23063 @smallexample
23064 set input-radix 012
23065 set input-radix 10.
23066 set input-radix 0xa
23067 @end smallexample
23068
23069 @noindent
23070 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23071 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23072 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23073 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23074 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23075 change the radix.
23076
23077 @kindex set output-radix
23078 @item set output-radix @var{base}
23079 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23080 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23081 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23082
23083 @kindex show input-radix
23084 @item show input-radix
23085 Display the current default base for numeric input.
23086
23087 @kindex show output-radix
23088 @item show output-radix
23089 Display the current default base for numeric display.
23090
23091 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23092 @itemx show radix
23093 @kindex set radix
23094 @kindex show radix
23095 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23096 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23097 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23098 default value of 10.
23099
23100 @end table
23101
23102 @node ABI
23103 @section Configuring the Current ABI
23104
23105 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23106 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23107 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23108 current ABI.
23109
23110 @cindex OS ABI
23111 @kindex set osabi
23112 @kindex show osabi
23113 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23114
23115 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23116 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23117 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23118 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23119 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23120 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23121 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23122 platform provides.
23123
23124 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23125 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23126 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23127 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23128
23129 @table @code
23130 @item show osabi
23131 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23132
23133 @item set osabi
23134 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23135
23136 @item set osabi @var{abi}
23137 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23138 @end table
23139
23140 @cindex float promotion
23141
23142 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23143 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23144 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23145 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23146 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23147 @code{double} and then passed.
23148
23149 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23150 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23151 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23152
23153 @table @code
23154 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23155 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23156 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23157 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23158 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23159
23160 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23161 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23162 functions.
23163
23164 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23165 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23166 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23167 @end table
23168
23169 @kindex set cp-abi
23170 @kindex show cp-abi
23171 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23172 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23173 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23174 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23175 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23176 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23177 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23178 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23179 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23180 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23181 ``auto''.
23182
23183 @table @code
23184 @item show cp-abi
23185 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23186
23187 @item set cp-abi
23188 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23189
23190 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23191 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23192 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23193 @end table
23194
23195 @node Auto-loading
23196 @section Automatically loading associated files
23197 @cindex auto-loading
23198
23199 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23200 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23201 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23202 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23203 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23204 sources).
23205
23206 @menu
23207 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23208 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23209
23210 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23211 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23212 @end menu
23213
23214 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23215 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23216 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23217
23218 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23219 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23220 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23221
23222 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23223 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23224
23225 @table @code
23226 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23227 @kindex set auto-load off
23228 @item set auto-load off
23229 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23230 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23231 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23232 @smallexample
23233 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23234 @end smallexample
23235
23236 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23237 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23238 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23239 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23240 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23241 @code{set auto-load no}.
23242
23243 @anchor{show auto-load}
23244 @kindex show auto-load
23245 @item show auto-load
23246 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23247 or disabled.
23248
23249 @smallexample
23250 (gdb) show auto-load
23251 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23252 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23253 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23254 is on.
23255 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23256 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23257 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23258 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23259 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23260 @end smallexample
23261
23262 @anchor{info auto-load}
23263 @kindex info auto-load
23264 @item info auto-load
23265 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23266 not.
23267
23268 @smallexample
23269 (gdb) info auto-load
23270 gdb-scripts:
23271 Loaded Script
23272 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23273 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23274 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23275 loaded.
23276 python-scripts:
23277 Loaded Script
23278 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23279 @end smallexample
23280 @end table
23281
23282 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23283
23284 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23285 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23286 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23287 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23288 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23289 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23290 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23291 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23292 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23293 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23294 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23295 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23296 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23297 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23298 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23299 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23300 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23301 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23302 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23303 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23304 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23305 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23306 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23307 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23308 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23309 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23310 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23311 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23312 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23313 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23314 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23315 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23316 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23317 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23318 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23319 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23320 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23321 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23322 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23323 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23324 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23325 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23326 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23327 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23328 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23329 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23330 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23331 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23332 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23333 @end multitable
23334
23335 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23336 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23337 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23338
23339 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23340 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23341 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23342
23343 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23344 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23345
23346 @table @code
23347 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23348 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23349 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23350 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23351 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23352
23353 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23354 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23355 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23356 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23357 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23358
23359 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23360 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23361 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23362 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23363 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23364 @end table
23365
23366 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23367 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23368 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23369
23370 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23371
23372 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23373 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23374
23375 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23376 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23377 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23378 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23379 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23380 library.
23381
23382 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23383 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23384
23385 @table @code
23386 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23387 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23388 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23389 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23390
23391 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23392 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23393 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23394 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23395 enabled or disabled.
23396
23397 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23398 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23399 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23400 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23401 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23402 @end table
23403
23404 @node Auto-loading safe path
23405 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23406 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23407
23408 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23409 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23410 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23411 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23412 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23413
23414 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23415 get loaded:
23416
23417 @smallexample
23418 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23419 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23420 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23421 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23422 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23423 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23424 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23425 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23426 @end smallexample
23427
23428 @noindent
23429 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23430 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23431
23432 @smallexample
23433 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23434 @end smallexample
23435
23436 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23437
23438 @table @code
23439 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23440 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23441 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23442 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23443 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23444 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23445 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23446 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23447 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23448 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23449
23450 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23451 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23452 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23453
23454 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23455 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23456 @item show auto-load safe-path
23457 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23458 scripts.
23459
23460 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23461 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23462 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23463 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23464 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23465 by the host platform path separator in use.
23466 @end table
23467
23468 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23469 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23470 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23471 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23472 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23473
23474 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23475 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23476 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23477 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23478 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23479 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23480 init file in the current directory
23481 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23482
23483 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23484 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23485
23486 @table @asis
23487 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23488 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23489 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23490 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23491
23492 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23493 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23494 @value{GDBN} session.
23495
23496 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23497 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23498 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23499 from trusted sources.
23500
23501 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23502 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23503 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23504 trusted sources.
23505 @end table
23506
23507 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23508 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23509
23510 @table @asis
23511 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23512 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23513
23514 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23515 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23516 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23517 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23518 @end table
23519
23520 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23521 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23522 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23523 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23524 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23525 recommended to be entered.
23526
23527 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23528 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23529 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23530
23531 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23532 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23533 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23534 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23535 be printed.
23536
23537 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23538 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23539 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23540
23541 @smallexample
23542 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23543 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23544 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23545 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23546 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23547 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23548 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23549 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23550 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23551 @end smallexample
23552
23553 @table @code
23554 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23555 @kindex set debug auto-load
23556 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23557 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23558
23559 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23560 @kindex show debug auto-load
23561 @item show debug auto-load
23562 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23563 on or off.
23564 @end table
23565
23566 @node Messages/Warnings
23567 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23568
23569 @cindex verbose operation
23570 @cindex optional warnings
23571 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23572 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23573 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23574 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23575
23576 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23577 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23578 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23579
23580 @table @code
23581 @kindex set verbose
23582 @item set verbose on
23583 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23584
23585 @item set verbose off
23586 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23587
23588 @kindex show verbose
23589 @item show verbose
23590 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23591 @end table
23592
23593 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23594 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23595 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23596 Symbol Files}).
23597
23598 @table @code
23599
23600 @kindex set complaints
23601 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23602 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23603 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23604 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23605 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23606
23607 @kindex show complaints
23608 @item show complaints
23609 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23610
23611 @end table
23612
23613 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23614 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23615 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23616 you try to run a program which is already running:
23617
23618 @smallexample
23619 (@value{GDBP}) run
23620 The program being debugged has been started already.
23621 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23622 @end smallexample
23623
23624 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23625 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23626
23627 @table @code
23628
23629 @kindex set confirm
23630 @cindex flinching
23631 @cindex confirmation
23632 @cindex stupid questions
23633 @item set confirm off
23634 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23635 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23636 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23637
23638 @item set confirm on
23639 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23640
23641 @kindex show confirm
23642 @item show confirm
23643 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23644
23645 @end table
23646
23647 @cindex command tracing
23648 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23649 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23650 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23651 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23652
23653 @table @code
23654 @kindex set trace-commands
23655 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23656 @item set trace-commands on
23657 Enable command tracing.
23658 @item set trace-commands off
23659 Disable command tracing.
23660 @item show trace-commands
23661 Display the current state of command tracing.
23662 @end table
23663
23664 @node Debugging Output
23665 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23666 @cindex optional debugging messages
23667
23668 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23669 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23670 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23671 section documents those commands.
23672
23673 @table @code
23674 @kindex set exec-done-display
23675 @item set exec-done-display
23676 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23677 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23678 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23679 @kindex show exec-done-display
23680 @item show exec-done-display
23681 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23682 notification.
23683 @kindex set debug
23684 @cindex ARM AArch64
23685 @item set debug aarch64
23686 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23687 The default is off.
23688 @kindex show debug
23689 @item show debug aarch64
23690 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23691 ARM AArch64.
23692 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23693 @cindex architecture debugging info
23694 @item set debug arch
23695 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23696 @item show debug arch
23697 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23698 @item set debug aix-solib
23699 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23700 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23701 support module. The default is off.
23702 @item show debug aix-thread
23703 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23704 @item set debug aix-thread
23705 @cindex AIX threads
23706 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23707 module.
23708 @item show debug aix-thread
23709 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23710 @item set debug check-physname
23711 @cindex physname
23712 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23713 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23714 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23715 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23716 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23717 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23718 @item show debug check-physname
23719 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23720 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23721 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23722 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23723 exported symbols. The default is off.
23724 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23725 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23726 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23727 @item set debug dwarf-die
23728 @cindex DWARF DIEs
23729 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23730 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23731 A value of zero turns off the display.
23732 @item show debug dwarf-die
23733 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23734 @item set debug dwarf-line
23735 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
23736 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23737 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
23738 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23739 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23740 @item show debug dwarf-line
23741 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23742 @item set debug dwarf-read
23743 @cindex DWARF Reading
23744 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23745 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23746 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23747 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23748 @item show debug dwarf-read
23749 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23750 @item set debug displaced
23751 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23752 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23753 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23754 @item show debug displaced
23755 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23756 related to displaced stepping.
23757 @item set debug event
23758 @cindex event debugging info
23759 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23760 default is off.
23761 @item show debug event
23762 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23763 info.
23764 @item set debug expression
23765 @cindex expression debugging info
23766 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23767 expression parsing. The default is off.
23768 @item show debug expression
23769 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23770 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23771 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
23772 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
23773 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
23774 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
23775 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
23776 @item set debug frame
23777 @cindex frame debugging info
23778 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23779 default is off.
23780 @item show debug frame
23781 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23782 info.
23783 @item set debug gnu-nat
23784 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23785 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23786 @item show debug gnu-nat
23787 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23788 @item set debug infrun
23789 @cindex inferior debugging info
23790 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23791 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23792 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23793 @item show debug infrun
23794 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23795 @item set debug jit
23796 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23797 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23798 @item show debug jit
23799 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23800 @item set debug lin-lwp
23801 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23802 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23803 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23804 @item show debug lin-lwp
23805 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23806 @item set debug linux-namespaces
23807 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
23808 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
23809 @item show debug linux-namespaces
23810 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
23811 @item set debug mach-o
23812 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23813 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23814 processing. The default is off.
23815 @item show debug mach-o
23816 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23817 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23818 @item set debug notification
23819 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23820 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23821 The default is off.
23822 @item show debug notification
23823 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23824 @item set debug observer
23825 @cindex observer debugging info
23826 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23827 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23828 @item show debug observer
23829 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23830 @item set debug overload
23831 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23832 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23833 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23834 is off.
23835 @item show debug overload
23836 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23837 debugging info.
23838 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23839 @cindex debug expression parser
23840 @item set debug parser
23841 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23842 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23843 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23844 details. The default is off.
23845 @item show debug parser
23846 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23847 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23848 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23849 @cindex debug remote protocol
23850 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23851 @cindex display remote packets
23852 @item set debug remote
23853 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23854 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23855 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23856 @item show debug remote
23857 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23858 @item set debug serial
23859 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23860 default is off.
23861 @item show debug serial
23862 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23863 info.
23864 @item set debug solib-frv
23865 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23866 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23867 @item show debug solib-frv
23868 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23869 messages.
23870 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23871 @cindex symbol lookup
23872 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23873 The default is 0 (off).
23874 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23875 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23876 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23877 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23878 @item set debug symfile
23879 @cindex symbol file functions
23880 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23881 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23882 @item show debug symfile
23883 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23884 @item set debug symtab-create
23885 @cindex symbol table creation
23886 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23887 The default is 0 (off).
23888 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23889 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23890 @item show debug symtab-create
23891 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23892 @item set debug target
23893 @cindex target debugging info
23894 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23895 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23896 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23897 value of large memory transfers.
23898 @item show debug target
23899 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23900 info.
23901 @item set debug timestamp
23902 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23903 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23904 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23905 message.
23906 @item show debug timestamp
23907 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23908 debugging info.
23909 @item set debug varobj
23910 @cindex variable object debugging info
23911 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23912 info. The default is off.
23913 @item show debug varobj
23914 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23915 debugging info.
23916 @item set debug xml
23917 @cindex XML parser debugging
23918 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23919 @item show debug xml
23920 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23921 @end table
23922
23923 @node Other Misc Settings
23924 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23925 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23926
23927 @table @code
23928 @kindex set interactive-mode
23929 @item set interactive-mode
23930 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23931 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23932 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23933 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23934 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23935 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23936 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23937 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23938
23939 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23940 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23941 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23942 inside a cygwin window.
23943
23944 @kindex show interactive-mode
23945 @item show interactive-mode
23946 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23947 @end table
23948
23949 @node Extending GDB
23950 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23951 @cindex extending GDB
23952
23953 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23954 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23955 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23956 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23957 being debugged.
23958
23959 @menu
23960 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23961 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23962 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23963 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23964 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23965 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23966 @end menu
23967
23968 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23969 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23970 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23971 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23972 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23973 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23974
23975 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23976 setting:
23977
23978 @table @code
23979 @kindex set script-extension
23980 @kindex show script-extension
23981 @item set script-extension off
23982 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23983
23984 @item set script-extension soft
23985 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23986 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23987 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23988 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23989
23990 @item set script-extension strict
23991 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23992 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23993 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23994
23995 @item show script-extension
23996 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23997
23998 @end table
23999
24000 @node Sequences
24001 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
24002
24003 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24004 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24005 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24006 files.
24007
24008 @menu
24009 * Define:: How to define your own commands
24010 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
24011 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24012 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
24013 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
24014 @end menu
24015
24016 @node Define
24017 @subsection User-defined Commands
24018
24019 @cindex user-defined command
24020 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24021 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24022 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
24023 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
24024 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
24025 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
24026
24027 @smallexample
24028 define adder
24029 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24030 end
24031 @end smallexample
24032
24033 @noindent
24034 To execute the command use:
24035
24036 @smallexample
24037 adder 1 2 3
24038 @end smallexample
24039
24040 @noindent
24041 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24042 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24043 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24044 functions calls.
24045
24046 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24047 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24048 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24049 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
24050
24051 @smallexample
24052 define adder
24053 if $argc == 2
24054 print $arg0 + $arg1
24055 end
24056 if $argc == 3
24057 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24058 end
24059 end
24060 @end smallexample
24061
24062 @table @code
24063
24064 @kindex define
24065 @item define @var{commandname}
24066 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24067 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24068 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24069 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24070 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24071 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24072
24073 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24074 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
24075 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24076
24077 @kindex document
24078 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24079 @item document @var{commandname}
24080 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24081 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
24082 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24083 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24084 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24085 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24086
24087 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24088 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
24089 does not change the documentation.
24090
24091 @kindex dont-repeat
24092 @cindex don't repeat command
24093 @item dont-repeat
24094 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24095 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24096 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24097
24098 @kindex help user-defined
24099 @item help user-defined
24100 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24101 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24102 included (if any).
24103
24104 @kindex show user
24105 @item show user
24106 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
24107 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24108 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24109 definitions for all user-defined commands.
24110 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24111
24112 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24113 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
24114 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
24115 @item show max-user-call-depth
24116 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
24117 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24118 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24119 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24120 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24121 @end table
24122
24123 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24124 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24125
24126 When user-defined commands are executed, the
24127 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24128 stops execution of the user-defined command.
24129
24130 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24131 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24132 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24133 messages when used in a user-defined command.
24134
24135 @node Hooks
24136 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24137 @cindex command hooks
24138 @cindex hooks, for commands
24139 @cindex hooks, pre-command
24140
24141 @kindex hook
24142 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24143 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24144 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24145 before that command.
24146
24147 @cindex hooks, post-command
24148 @kindex hookpost
24149 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24150 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24151 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24152 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24153 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24154
24155 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24156 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24157
24158 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24159 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24160
24161 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24162 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24163 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24164 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24165 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24166
24167 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24168 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24169 you could define:
24170
24171 @smallexample
24172 define hook-stop
24173 handle SIGALRM nopass
24174 end
24175
24176 define hook-run
24177 handle SIGALRM pass
24178 end
24179
24180 define hook-continue
24181 handle SIGALRM pass
24182 end
24183 @end smallexample
24184
24185 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24186 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24187 you could define:
24188
24189 @smallexample
24190 define hook-echo
24191 echo <<<---
24192 end
24193
24194 define hookpost-echo
24195 echo --->>>\n
24196 end
24197
24198 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24199 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24200 (@value{GDBP})
24201
24202 @end smallexample
24203
24204 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24205 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24206 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24207 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24208 @c or not?
24209 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24210 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24211 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24212
24213 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24214 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24215 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24216
24217 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24218 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24219
24220 @node Command Files
24221 @subsection Command Files
24222
24223 @cindex command files
24224 @cindex scripting commands
24225 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24226 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24227 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24228 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24229 terminal.
24230
24231 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24232 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24233 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24234 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24235 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24236
24237 @table @code
24238 @kindex source
24239 @cindex execute commands from a file
24240 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24241 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24242 @end table
24243
24244 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24245 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24246 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24247 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24248 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24249
24250 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24251 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24252 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24253 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24254 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24255 is not relevant to scripts.
24256
24257 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24258 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24259 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24260 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24261 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24262 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24263 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24264 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24265 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24266 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24267 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24268 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24269 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24270 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24271
24272 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24273 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24274 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24275
24276 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24277 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24278 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24279 when called from command files.
24280
24281 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24282 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24283 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24284 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24285 the next command.
24286
24287 @smallexample
24288 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24289 @end smallexample
24290
24291 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24292 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24293 would be directed to @file{log}.
24294
24295 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24296 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24297 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24298 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24299 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24300 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24301 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24302 conditionally, etc.
24303
24304 @table @code
24305 @kindex if
24306 @kindex else
24307 @item if
24308 @itemx else
24309 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24310 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24311 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24312 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24313 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24314 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24315 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24316
24317 @kindex while
24318 @item while
24319 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24320 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24321 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24322 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24323 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24324 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24325
24326 @kindex loop_break
24327 @item loop_break
24328 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24329 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24330 line.
24331
24332 @kindex loop_continue
24333 @item loop_continue
24334 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24335 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24336 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24337 the controlling expression.
24338
24339 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24340 @item end
24341 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24342 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24343 @end table
24344
24345
24346 @node Output
24347 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24348
24349 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24350 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24351 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24352 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24353 want.
24354
24355 @table @code
24356 @kindex echo
24357 @item echo @var{text}
24358 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24359 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24360 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24361 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24362 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24363 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24364 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24365 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24366 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24367 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24368 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24369
24370 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24371 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24372
24373 @smallexample
24374 echo This is some text\n\
24375 which is continued\n\
24376 onto several lines.\n
24377 @end smallexample
24378
24379 produces the same output as
24380
24381 @smallexample
24382 echo This is some text\n
24383 echo which is continued\n
24384 echo onto several lines.\n
24385 @end smallexample
24386
24387 @kindex output
24388 @item output @var{expression}
24389 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24390 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24391 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24392 on expressions.
24393
24394 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24395 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24396 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24397 Formats}, for more information.
24398
24399 @kindex printf
24400 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24401 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24402 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24403 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24404 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24405 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24406 executing the code below:
24407
24408 @smallexample
24409 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24410 @end smallexample
24411
24412 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24413 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24414 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24415 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24416 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24417 printed.
24418
24419 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24420
24421 @smallexample
24422 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24423 @end smallexample
24424
24425 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24426 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24427 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24428
24429 @itemize @bullet
24430 @item
24431 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24432
24433 @item
24434 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24435 width.
24436
24437 @item
24438 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24439 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24440
24441 @item
24442 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24443 supported.
24444
24445 @item
24446 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24447
24448 @item
24449 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24450 @end itemize
24451
24452 @noindent
24453 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24454 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24455 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24456 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24457
24458 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24459 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24460 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24461 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24462 supported.
24463
24464 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24465 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24466 together with a floating point specifier.
24467 letters:
24468
24469 @itemize @bullet
24470 @item
24471 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24472
24473 @item
24474 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24475
24476 @item
24477 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24478 @end itemize
24479
24480 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24481 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24482 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24483
24484 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24485 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24486
24487 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24488 @smallexample
24489 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24490 @end smallexample
24491
24492 @kindex eval
24493 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24494 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24495 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24496
24497 @end table
24498
24499 @node Auto-loading sequences
24500 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24501 @cindex native script auto-loading
24502
24503 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24504 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24505 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24506 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24507
24508 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24509 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24510
24511 @table @code
24512 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24513 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24514 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24515 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24516
24517 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24518 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24519 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24520 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24521 disabled.
24522
24523 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24524 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24525 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24526 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24527 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24528 auto-loaded.
24529 @end table
24530
24531 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24532 matching names are printed.
24533
24534 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24535 @include python.texi
24536
24537 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24538 @include guile.texi
24539
24540 @node Auto-loading extensions
24541 @section Auto-loading extensions
24542 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24543
24544 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24545 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24546 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24547 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24548 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24549
24550 @menu
24551 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24552 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24553 * Which flavor to choose?::
24554 @end menu
24555
24556 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24557 debugging commands and features.
24558
24559 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24560 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24561 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24562 for more information.
24563 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24564 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24565
24566 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24567 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24568
24569 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24570 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24571 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24572 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24573 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24574
24575 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24576 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24577 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24578 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24579
24580 @table @code
24581 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24582 GDB's own command language
24583 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24584 Python
24585 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24586 Guile
24587 @end table
24588
24589 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24590 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24591 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24592 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24593 script in the specified extension language.
24594
24595 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24596 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24597
24598 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24599 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24600
24601 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24602 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24603 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24604 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24605 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24606 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24607
24608 @table @code
24609 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24610 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24611 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24612 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24613 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24614 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24615
24616 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24617 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24618
24619 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24620 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24621 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24622 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24623
24624 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24625 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24626 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24627 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24628 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24629 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24630 platform.
24631
24632 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24633 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24634 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24635
24636 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24637 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24638 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24639 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24640
24641 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24642 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24643 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24644 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24645 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24646 @end table
24647
24648 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24649 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24650 @var{objfile} is opened.
24651 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24652 is evaluated more than once.
24653
24654 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24655 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24656 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24657
24658 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24659 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24660 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24661 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24662 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24663 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24664 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24665
24666 The following entries are supported:
24667
24668 @table @code
24669 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24670 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24671 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24672 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24673 @end table
24674
24675 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24676
24677 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24678 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24679 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24680 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24681 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24682
24683 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24684 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24685
24686 @example
24687 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24688 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24689 asm("\
24690 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24691 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24692 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24693 .popsection \n\
24694 ");
24695 @end example
24696
24697 @noindent
24698 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24699 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24700
24701 @example
24702 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24703 @end example
24704
24705 The script name may include directories if desired.
24706
24707 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24708 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24709
24710 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24711 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24712 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24713 will remove duplicates.
24714
24715 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24716
24717 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24718 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24719 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24720 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24721 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24722 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24723 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24724 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24725 on its name.
24726
24727 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24728 testsuite.
24729
24730 @example
24731 #include "symcat.h"
24732 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24733 asm(
24734 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24735 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24736 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24737 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24738 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24739 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24740 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24741 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24742 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24743 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24744 ".byte 0\n"
24745 ".popsection\n"
24746 );
24747 @end example
24748
24749 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24750 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24751 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24752 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24753
24754 @node Which flavor to choose?
24755 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24756
24757 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24758 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24759
24760 @noindent
24761 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24762
24763 @itemize @bullet
24764 @item
24765 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24766
24767 @item
24768 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24769
24770 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24771 in the source search path.
24772 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24773 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24774
24775 @item
24776 Doesn't require source code additions.
24777 @end itemize
24778
24779 @noindent
24780 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24781
24782 @itemize @bullet
24783 @item
24784 Works with static linking.
24785
24786 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24787 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24788 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24789 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24790 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24791
24792 @item
24793 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24794
24795 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24796 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24797
24798 @item
24799 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24800
24801 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24802 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24803 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24804 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24805 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24806 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24807 @end itemize
24808
24809 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24810 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24811
24812 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24813 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24814 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24815
24816 @subsection Python comes first
24817
24818 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24819 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24820 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24821 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24822 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24823 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24824 pretty-printed form of a value).
24825 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24826 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24827 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24828
24829 @node Aliases
24830 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24831 @cindex aliases for commands
24832
24833 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24834 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24835 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24836 that involves less typing.
24837
24838 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24839 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24840 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24841
24842 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24843 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24844 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24845
24846 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24847
24848 @table @code
24849
24850 @kindex alias
24851 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24852
24853 @end table
24854
24855 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24856 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24857 underscores.
24858
24859 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24860 that is being aliased.
24861
24862 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24863 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24864 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24865
24866 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24867 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24868
24869 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24870 of a command so that there is less to type.
24871 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24872 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24873 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24874 The following will accomplish this.
24875
24876 @smallexample
24877 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24878 @end smallexample
24879
24880 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24881 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24882 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24883 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24884
24885 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24886 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24887 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24888 of a command.
24889
24890 @smallexample
24891 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24892 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24893 (gdb) set p elms 20
24894 (gdb) show p elms
24895 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24896 @end smallexample
24897
24898 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24899 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24900 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24901
24902 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24903 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24904
24905 @smallexample
24906 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24907 @end smallexample
24908
24909 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24910 alias for a more complex command.
24911 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24912
24913 @smallexample
24914 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24915 (gdb) spe 20
24916 @end smallexample
24917
24918 @node Interpreters
24919 @chapter Command Interpreters
24920 @cindex command interpreters
24921
24922 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24923 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24924 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24925
24926 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24927 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24928 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24929 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24930
24931 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24932 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24933 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24934 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24935
24936 @table @code
24937 @item console
24938 @cindex console interpreter
24939 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24940 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24941 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24942
24943 @item mi
24944 @cindex mi interpreter
24945 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24946 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24947 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24948 Interface}.
24949
24950 @item mi2
24951 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24952 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24953
24954 @item mi1
24955 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24956 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24957
24958 @end table
24959
24960 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24961 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24962 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24963 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24964 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24965 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24966 the IDE inoperable!
24967
24968 @kindex interpreter-exec
24969 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24970 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24971 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24972 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24973
24974 @smallexample
24975 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24976 @end smallexample
24977
24978 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24979 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24980
24981 @node TUI
24982 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24983 @cindex TUI
24984 @cindex Text User Interface
24985
24986 @menu
24987 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24988 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24989 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24990 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24991 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24992 @end menu
24993
24994 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24995 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24996 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24997 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24998 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24999 is available.
25000
25001 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25002 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25003 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25004 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25005 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25006 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25007
25008 @node TUI Overview
25009 @section TUI Overview
25010
25011 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25012
25013 @table @emph
25014 @item command
25015 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25016 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
25017 managed using readline.
25018
25019 @item source
25020 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
25021 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25022
25023 @item assembly
25024 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25025
25026 @item register
25027 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
25028 when their values change.
25029 @end table
25030
25031 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25032 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25033 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
25034 indicates the breakpoint type:
25035
25036 @table @code
25037 @item B
25038 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25039
25040 @item b
25041 Breakpoint which was never hit.
25042
25043 @item H
25044 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25045
25046 @item h
25047 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25048 @end table
25049
25050 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25051
25052 @table @code
25053 @item +
25054 Breakpoint is enabled.
25055
25056 @item -
25057 Breakpoint is disabled.
25058 @end table
25059
25060 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25061 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25062 changes.
25063
25064 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
25065 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
25066 layouts:
25067
25068 @itemize @bullet
25069 @item
25070 source only,
25071
25072 @item
25073 assembly only,
25074
25075 @item
25076 source and assembly,
25077
25078 @item
25079 source and registers, or
25080
25081 @item
25082 assembly and registers.
25083 @end itemize
25084
25085 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25086
25087 @table @emph
25088 @item target
25089 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25090 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25091
25092 @item process
25093 Gives the current process or thread number.
25094 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25095
25096 @item function
25097 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25098 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25099 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25100 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25101
25102 @item line
25103 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25104 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25105
25106 @item pc
25107 Indicates the current program counter address.
25108 @end table
25109
25110 @node TUI Keys
25111 @section TUI Key Bindings
25112 @cindex TUI key bindings
25113
25114 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25115 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25116 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25117 @end ifset
25118 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25119 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25120 @end ifclear
25121 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25122 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25123
25124 @table @kbd
25125 @kindex C-x C-a
25126 @item C-x C-a
25127 @kindex C-x a
25128 @itemx C-x a
25129 @kindex C-x A
25130 @itemx C-x A
25131 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25132 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25133 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25134 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25135 The screen is then refreshed.
25136
25137 @kindex C-x 1
25138 @item C-x 1
25139 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25140 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25141 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25142
25143 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25144
25145 @kindex C-x 2
25146 @item C-x 2
25147 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25148 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25149 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25150 previous layout and the new one.
25151
25152 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25153
25154 @kindex C-x o
25155 @item C-x o
25156 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25157 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25158 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25159
25160 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25161
25162 @kindex C-x s
25163 @item C-x s
25164 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25165 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25166 @end table
25167
25168 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25169
25170 @table @asis
25171 @kindex PgUp
25172 @item @key{PgUp}
25173 Scroll the active window one page up.
25174
25175 @kindex PgDn
25176 @item @key{PgDn}
25177 Scroll the active window one page down.
25178
25179 @kindex Up
25180 @item @key{Up}
25181 Scroll the active window one line up.
25182
25183 @kindex Down
25184 @item @key{Down}
25185 Scroll the active window one line down.
25186
25187 @kindex Left
25188 @item @key{Left}
25189 Scroll the active window one column left.
25190
25191 @kindex Right
25192 @item @key{Right}
25193 Scroll the active window one column right.
25194
25195 @kindex C-L
25196 @item @kbd{C-L}
25197 Refresh the screen.
25198 @end table
25199
25200 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25201 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25202 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25203 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25204 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25205
25206 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25207 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25208 @cindex TUI single key mode
25209
25210 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25211 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25212 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25213
25214 @table @kbd
25215 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25216 @item c
25217 continue
25218
25219 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25220 @item d
25221 down
25222
25223 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25224 @item f
25225 finish
25226
25227 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25228 @item n
25229 next
25230
25231 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25232 @item q
25233 exit the SingleKey mode.
25234
25235 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25236 @item r
25237 run
25238
25239 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25240 @item s
25241 step
25242
25243 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25244 @item u
25245 up
25246
25247 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25248 @item v
25249 info locals
25250
25251 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25252 @item w
25253 where
25254 @end table
25255
25256 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25257 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25258 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25259 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25260 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25261 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25262
25263
25264 @node TUI Commands
25265 @section TUI-specific Commands
25266 @cindex TUI commands
25267
25268 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25269 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25270 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25271 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25272
25273 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25274 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25275 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25276 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25277 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25278
25279 @table @code
25280 @item tui enable
25281 @kindex tui enable
25282 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25283 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25284 otherwise a default layout is used.
25285
25286 @item tui disable
25287 @kindex tui disable
25288 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25289
25290 @item info win
25291 @kindex info win
25292 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25293
25294 @item layout @var{name}
25295 @kindex layout
25296 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25297 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25298 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25299
25300 @table @code
25301 @item next
25302 Display the next layout.
25303
25304 @item prev
25305 Display the previous layout.
25306
25307 @item src
25308 Display the source and command windows.
25309
25310 @item asm
25311 Display the assembly and command windows.
25312
25313 @item split
25314 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25315
25316 @item regs
25317 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25318 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25319 register, assembler, and command windows.
25320 @end table
25321
25322 @item focus @var{name}
25323 @kindex focus
25324 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25325 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25326
25327 @table @code
25328 @item next
25329 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25330
25331 @item prev
25332 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25333
25334 @item src
25335 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25336
25337 @item asm
25338 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25339
25340 @item regs
25341 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25342
25343 @item cmd
25344 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25345 @end table
25346
25347 @item refresh
25348 @kindex refresh
25349 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25350
25351 @item tui reg @var{group}
25352 @kindex tui reg
25353 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25354 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25355 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25356 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25357 following groups are available on most targets:
25358 @table @code
25359 @item next
25360 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25361 through all of the available register groups.
25362
25363 @item prev
25364 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25365 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25366 @var{next}.
25367
25368 @item general
25369 Display the general registers.
25370 @item float
25371 Display the floating point registers.
25372 @item system
25373 Display the system registers.
25374 @item vector
25375 Display the vector registers.
25376 @item all
25377 Display all registers.
25378 @end table
25379
25380 @item update
25381 @kindex update
25382 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25383
25384 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25385 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25386 @kindex winheight
25387 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25388 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25389 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25390 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25391 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25392
25393 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25394 @kindex tabset
25395 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25396 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25397 assembly windows.
25398 @end table
25399
25400 @node TUI Configuration
25401 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25402 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25403
25404 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25405
25406 @table @code
25407 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25408 @kindex set tui border-kind
25409 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25410 The possible values are the following:
25411 @table @code
25412 @item space
25413 Use a space character to draw the border.
25414
25415 @item ascii
25416 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25417
25418 @item acs
25419 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25420 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25421 @end table
25422
25423 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25424 @kindex set tui border-mode
25425 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25426 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25427 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25428 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25429 @table @code
25430 @item normal
25431 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25432
25433 @item standout
25434 Use standout mode.
25435
25436 @item reverse
25437 Use reverse video mode.
25438
25439 @item half
25440 Use half bright mode.
25441
25442 @item half-standout
25443 Use half bright and standout mode.
25444
25445 @item bold
25446 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25447
25448 @item bold-standout
25449 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25450 @end table
25451 @end table
25452
25453 @node Emacs
25454 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25455
25456 @cindex Emacs
25457 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25458 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25459 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25460 @value{GDBN}.
25461
25462 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25463 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25464 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25465 created Emacs buffer.
25466 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25467
25468 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25469 things:
25470
25471 @itemize @bullet
25472 @item
25473 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25474 the GUD buffer.
25475
25476 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25477 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25478
25479 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25480 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25481 in this way.
25482
25483 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25484 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25485 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25486 stop.
25487
25488 @item
25489 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25490
25491 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25492 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25493 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25494 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25495 and the source.
25496
25497 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25498 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25499 @end itemize
25500
25501 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25502 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25503 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25504 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25505
25506 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25507 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25508 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25509 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25510 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25511 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25512 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25513 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25514 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25515
25516 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25517 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25518 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25519 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25520
25521 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25522 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25523 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25524 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25525 one you want.
25526
25527 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25528 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25529
25530 @table @kbd
25531 @item C-h m
25532 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25533
25534 @item C-c C-s
25535 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25536 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25537
25538 @item C-c C-n
25539 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25540 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25541 to show the current file and location.
25542
25543 @item C-c C-i
25544 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25545 display window accordingly.
25546
25547 @item C-c C-f
25548 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25549 @code{finish} command.
25550
25551 @item C-c C-r
25552 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25553 command.
25554
25555 @item C-c <
25556 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25557 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25558 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25559
25560 @item C-c >
25561 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25562 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25563 @end table
25564
25565 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25566 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25567
25568 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25569 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25570 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25571 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25572 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25573 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25574 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25575
25576 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25577 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25578 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25579 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25580 frame.
25581
25582 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25583 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25584 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25585 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25586 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25587 to correspond properly with the code.
25588
25589 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25590 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25591 Emacs Manual}).
25592
25593 @node GDB/MI
25594 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25595
25596 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25597
25598 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25599 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25600 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25601 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25602 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25603 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25604
25605 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25606 in the form of a reference manual.
25607
25608 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25609 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25610 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25611
25612 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25613
25614 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25615 This chapter uses the following notation:
25616
25617 @itemize @bullet
25618 @item
25619 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25620
25621 @item
25622 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25623 it may or may not be given.
25624
25625 @item
25626 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25627 may repeat zero or more times.
25628
25629 @item
25630 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25631 may repeat one or more times.
25632
25633 @item
25634 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25635 @end itemize
25636
25637 @ignore
25638 @heading Dependencies
25639 @end ignore
25640
25641 @menu
25642 * GDB/MI General Design::
25643 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25644 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25645 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25646 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25647 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25648 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25649 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25650 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25651 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25652 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25653 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25654 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25655 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25656 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25657 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25658 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25659 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25660 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25661 @ignore
25662 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25663 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25664 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25665 @end ignore
25666 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25667 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25668 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25669 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25670 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25671 @end menu
25672
25673 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25674 @node GDB/MI General Design
25675 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25676 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25677
25678 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25679 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25680 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25681 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25682 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25683 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25684 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25685 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25686 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25687 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25688
25689 The important examples of notifications are:
25690 @itemize @bullet
25691
25692 @item
25693 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25694 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25695 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25696 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25697 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25698 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25699 command itself was successfully executed.
25700
25701 @item
25702 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25703 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25704 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25705 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25706 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25707 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25708
25709 @item
25710 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25711 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25712 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25713 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25714 orthogonal frontend design.
25715
25716 @end itemize
25717
25718 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25719 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25720 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25721 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25722 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25723 the user interface.
25724
25725
25726 @menu
25727 * Context management::
25728 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25729 * Thread groups::
25730 @end menu
25731
25732 @node Context management
25733 @subsection Context management
25734
25735 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25736
25737 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25738 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25739 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25740 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25741 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25742 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25743 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25744 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25745 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25746
25747 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25748 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25749 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25750 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25751 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25752 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25753 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25754 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25755 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25756 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
25757 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
25758
25759 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25760 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25761 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25762 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25763 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25764 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25765 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25766 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25767 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25768 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25769
25770 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25771 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25772 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25773 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25774 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25775 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25776 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25777 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25778 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25779 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25780 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25781 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25782 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25783 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25784 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25785 @samp{--frame} options.
25786
25787 @subsubsection Language
25788
25789 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25790 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25791 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25792 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25793 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25794 For instance:
25795
25796 @smallexample
25797 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25798 ^done,value="4"
25799 (gdb)
25800 @end smallexample
25801
25802 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25803 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25804 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25805
25806 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25807 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25808
25809 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25810 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25811 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25812 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25813 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25814 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25815 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25816 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25817 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25818
25819 @table @code
25820 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25821 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25822 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25823
25824 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25825 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25826 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25827
25828 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25829 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25830 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25831 MI commands even while the target is running.
25832
25833 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25834 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25835 @end table
25836
25837 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25838 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25839 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25840 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25841 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25842 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25843
25844 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25845 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25846 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25847 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25848 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25849 are running.
25850
25851 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25852 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25853 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25854 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25855 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25856 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25857 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25858 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25859 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25860 @samp{--thread} option).
25861
25862 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25863 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25864 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25865 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25866
25867 @node Thread groups
25868 @subsection Thread groups
25869 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25870 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25871 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25872 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25873 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25874
25875 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25876 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25877 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25878 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25879 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25880 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25881 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25882 into processes.
25883
25884 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25885 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25886 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25887 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25888 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25889 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25890 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25891 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25892 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25893 the members of specific thread group.
25894
25895 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25896 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25897 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25898 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25899 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25900 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25901 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25902 after attaching to that thread group.
25903
25904 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25905 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25906 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25907 such thread groups.
25908
25909 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25910 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25911 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25912
25913 @menu
25914 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25915 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25916 @end menu
25917
25918 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25919 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25920
25921 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25922 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25923 @table @code
25924 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25925 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25926
25927 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25928 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25929 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25930
25931 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25932 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25933 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25934
25935 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25936 "any sequence of digits"
25937
25938 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25939 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25940
25941 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25942 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25943
25944 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25945 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25946
25947 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25948 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25949 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25950
25951 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25952 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25953
25954 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25955 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25956 @end table
25957
25958 @noindent
25959 Notes:
25960
25961 @itemize @bullet
25962 @item
25963 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25964 output is described below.
25965
25966 @item
25967 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25968 finishes.
25969
25970 @item
25971 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25972 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25973 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25974 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25975 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25976 @end itemize
25977
25978 Pragmatics:
25979
25980 @itemize @bullet
25981 @item
25982 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25983
25984 @item
25985 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25986 @end itemize
25987
25988 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25989 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25990
25991 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25992 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25993 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25994 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25995 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25996 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25997
25998 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25999 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26000 @var{token}.
26001
26002 @table @code
26003 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
26004 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26005
26006 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26007 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26008
26009 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26010 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26011
26012 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26013 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26014
26015 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26016 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26017
26018 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26019 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26020
26021 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26022 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26023
26024 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26025 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26026
26027 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26028 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
26029
26030 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
26031 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
26032 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
26033
26034 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
26035 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
26036
26037 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
26038 @code{ @var{string} }
26039
26040 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
26041 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26042
26043 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
26044 @code{@var{c-string}}
26045
26046 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26047 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26048
26049 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
26050 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26051 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26052
26053 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26054 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26055
26056 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26057 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26058
26059 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26060 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26061
26062 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26063 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26064
26065 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26066 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26067
26068 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26069 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
26070 @end table
26071
26072 @noindent
26073 Notes:
26074
26075 @itemize @bullet
26076 @item
26077 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26078
26079 @item
26080 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
26081 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26082 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26083 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
26084 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26085 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26086 prior command.
26087
26088 @item
26089 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26090 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26091 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26092 prefixed by @samp{+}.
26093
26094 @item
26095 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26096 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26097 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26098 @samp{*}.
26099
26100 @item
26101 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26102 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26103 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26104 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26105
26106 @item
26107 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26108 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26109 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26110 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26111
26112 @item
26113 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26114 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26115 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26116
26117 @item
26118 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26119 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26120 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26121 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26122
26123 @item
26124 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26125 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26126 @var{values}.
26127
26128
26129 @end itemize
26130
26131 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26132 details about the various output records.
26133
26134 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26135 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26136 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26137
26138 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26139 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26140
26141 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26142 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26143 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26144 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26145 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26146 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26147
26148 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26149 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26150 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26151
26152 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26153 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26154 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26155 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26156
26157 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26158 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26159
26160 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26161 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26162 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26163 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26164 might change.
26165
26166 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26167 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26168 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26169 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26170
26171 @itemize @bullet
26172 @item
26173 New MI commands may be added.
26174
26175 @item
26176 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26177
26178 @item
26179 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26180 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26181
26182 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26183 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26184
26185 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26186 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26187 @end itemize
26188
26189 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26190 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26191 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26192 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26193 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26194
26195 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26196 @c version?
26197
26198 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26199 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26200 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26201 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26202 @cindex mailing lists
26203
26204 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26205 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26206 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26207
26208 @menu
26209 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26210 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26211 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26212 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26213 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26214 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26215 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26216 @end menu
26217
26218 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26219 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26220
26221 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26222 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26223 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26224 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26225
26226 @table @code
26227 @findex ^done
26228 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26229 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26230 values.
26231
26232 @item "^running"
26233 @findex ^running
26234 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26235 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26236 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26237 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26238 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26239 which threads are resumed.
26240
26241 @item "^connected"
26242 @findex ^connected
26243 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26244
26245 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26246 @findex ^error
26247 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26248 the corresponding error message.
26249
26250 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26251 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26252 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26253
26254 @table @samp
26255 @item "undefined-command"
26256 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26257 @end table
26258
26259 @item "^exit"
26260 @findex ^exit
26261 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26262
26263 @end table
26264
26265 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26266 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26267
26268 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26269 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26270 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26271 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26272 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26273
26274 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26275 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26276 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26277 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26278 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26279
26280 @table @code
26281 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26282 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26283 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26284
26285 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26286 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26287 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26288 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26289
26290 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26291 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26292 internals.
26293 @end table
26294
26295 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26296 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26297
26298 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26299 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26300 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26301 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26302 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26303 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26304
26305 The following is the list of possible async records:
26306
26307 @table @code
26308
26309 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26310 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26311 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26312 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26313 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26314 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26315 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26316 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26317 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26318 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26319 it run freely.
26320
26321 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26322 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26323 following values:
26324
26325 @table @code
26326 @item breakpoint-hit
26327 A breakpoint was reached.
26328 @item watchpoint-trigger
26329 A watchpoint was triggered.
26330 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26331 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26332 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26333 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26334 @item function-finished
26335 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26336 @item location-reached
26337 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26338 @item watchpoint-scope
26339 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26340 @item end-stepping-range
26341 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26342 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26343 @item exited-signalled
26344 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26345 @item exited
26346 The inferior exited.
26347 @item exited-normally
26348 The inferior exited normally.
26349 @item signal-received
26350 A signal was received by the inferior.
26351 @item solib-event
26352 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26353 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26354 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26355 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26356 @item fork
26357 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26358 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26359 @item vfork
26360 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26361 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26362 @item syscall-entry
26363 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26364 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26365 @item syscall-return
26366 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26367 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26368 @item exec
26369 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26370 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26371 @end table
26372
26373 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26374 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26375 Depending on whether all-stop
26376 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26377 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26378 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26379 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26380 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26381 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26382 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26383 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26384 if such information is not available.
26385
26386 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26387 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26388 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26389 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26390 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26391 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26392 cannot be used in any way.
26393
26394 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26395 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26396 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26397 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26398 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26399 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26400
26401 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26402 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26403 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26404 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26405 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26406 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26407
26408 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26409 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26410 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26411 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26412 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26413
26414 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
26415 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
26416 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
26417 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
26418 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
26419 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
26420 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
26421
26422 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26423 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26424 that thread.
26425
26426 @item =library-loaded,...
26427 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26428 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26429 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26430 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26431 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26432 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26433 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26434 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26435 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26436 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26437 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26438 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26439 thread groups.
26440
26441 @item =library-unloaded,...
26442 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26443 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26444 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26445 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26446 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26447 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26448 thread groups.
26449
26450 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26451 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26452 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26453 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26454 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26455
26456 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26457 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26458 initial value @var{initial}.
26459
26460 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26461 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26462 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26463 trace state variables are deleted.
26464
26465 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26466 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26467 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26468 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26469 value of trace state variable is known.
26470
26471 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26472 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26473 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26474 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26475 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26476 user.
26477
26478 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26479 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26480 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26481
26482 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26483 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26484
26485 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
26486 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26487 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26488 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26489 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26490
26491 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26492 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26493 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26494 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26495 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26496 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26497
26498 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26499 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26500 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26501 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26502 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26503 executable code.
26504 @end table
26505
26506 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26507 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26508
26509 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26510 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26511 following fields:
26512
26513 @table @code
26514 @item number
26515 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26516 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26517 @samp{1.2}.
26518
26519 @item type
26520 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26521 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26522
26523 @item catch-type
26524 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26525 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26526
26527 @item disp
26528 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26529 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26530 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26531
26532 @item enabled
26533 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26534 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26535 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26536
26537 @item addr
26538 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26539 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26540 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26541 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26542 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26543
26544 @item func
26545 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26546 If not known, this field is not present.
26547
26548 @item filename
26549 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26550 If not known, this field is not present.
26551
26552 @item fullname
26553 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26554 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26555
26556 @item line
26557 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26558 If not known, this field is not present.
26559
26560 @item at
26561 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26562 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26563 by a symbol name.
26564
26565 @item pending
26566 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26567 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26568
26569 @item evaluated-by
26570 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26571 @samp{target}.
26572
26573 @item thread
26574 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26575 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26576
26577 @item task
26578 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26579 field will hold the task identifier.
26580
26581 @item cond
26582 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26583
26584 @item ignore
26585 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26586
26587 @item enable
26588 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26589
26590 @item traceframe-usage
26591 FIXME.
26592
26593 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26594 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26595
26596 @item mask
26597 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26598
26599 @item pass
26600 A tracepoint's pass count.
26601
26602 @item original-location
26603 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26604 This field is optional.
26605
26606 @item times
26607 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26608
26609 @item installed
26610 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26611 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26612 is not.
26613
26614 @item what
26615 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26616
26617 @end table
26618
26619 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26620 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26621
26622 @smallexample
26623 -> -break-insert main
26624 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26625 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26626 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26627 times="0"@}
26628 <- (gdb)
26629 @end smallexample
26630
26631 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26632 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26633
26634 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26635 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26636 fields:
26637
26638 @table @code
26639 @item level
26640 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26641 zero. This field is always present.
26642
26643 @item func
26644 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26645 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26646
26647 @item addr
26648 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26649
26650 @item file
26651 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26652 address. This field may be absent.
26653
26654 @item line
26655 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26656 may be absent.
26657
26658 @item from
26659 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26660 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26661
26662 @end table
26663
26664 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26665 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26666
26667 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26668 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26669
26670 @table @code
26671 @item id
26672 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26673 always present.
26674
26675 @item target-id
26676 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26677
26678 @item details
26679 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26680 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26681 frontend. This field is optional.
26682
26683 @item state
26684 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26685 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26686
26687 @item core
26688 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26689 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26690 @end table
26691
26692 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26693 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26694
26695 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26696 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26697 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26698 the @code{exception-name} field.
26699
26700 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26701 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26702 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26703 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26704
26705 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26706 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26707 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26708 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26709
26710 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26711 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26712
26713 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26714
26715 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26716 information of the breakpoint.
26717
26718 @smallexample
26719 -> -break-insert main
26720 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26721 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26722 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26723 times="0"@}
26724 <- (gdb)
26725 @end smallexample
26726
26727 @subheading Program Execution
26728
26729 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26730 reason that execution stopped.
26731
26732 @smallexample
26733 -> -exec-run
26734 <- ^running
26735 <- (gdb)
26736 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26737 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26738 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26739 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26740 <- (gdb)
26741 -> -exec-continue
26742 <- ^running
26743 <- (gdb)
26744 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26745 <- (gdb)
26746 @end smallexample
26747
26748 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26749
26750 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26751
26752 @smallexample
26753 -> (gdb)
26754 <- -gdb-exit
26755 <- ^exit
26756 @end smallexample
26757
26758 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26759 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26760 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26761 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26762 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26763 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26764
26765 @subheading A Bad Command
26766
26767 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26768
26769 @smallexample
26770 -> -rubbish
26771 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26772 <- (gdb)
26773 @end smallexample
26774
26775
26776 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26777 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26778 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26779
26780 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26781 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26782
26783 @subheading Motivation
26784
26785 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26786
26787 @subheading Introduction
26788
26789 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26790
26791 @subheading Commands
26792
26793 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26794
26795 @subsubheading Synopsis
26796
26797 @smallexample
26798 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26799 @end smallexample
26800
26801 @subsubheading Result
26802
26803 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26804
26805 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26806
26807 @subsubheading Example
26808
26809 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26810 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26811
26812
26813 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26814 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26815 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26816
26817 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26818 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26819 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26820 breakpoints.
26821
26822 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26823 @findex -break-after
26824
26825 @subsubheading Synopsis
26826
26827 @smallexample
26828 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26829 @end smallexample
26830
26831 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26832 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26833 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26834 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26835
26836 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26837
26838 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26839
26840 @subsubheading Example
26841
26842 @smallexample
26843 (gdb)
26844 -break-insert main
26845 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26846 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26847 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26848 times="0"@}
26849 (gdb)
26850 -break-after 1 3
26851 ~
26852 ^done
26853 (gdb)
26854 -break-list
26855 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26856 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26857 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26858 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26859 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26860 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26861 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26862 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26863 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26864 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26865 (gdb)
26866 @end smallexample
26867
26868 @ignore
26869 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26870 @findex -break-catch
26871 @end ignore
26872
26873 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26874 @findex -break-commands
26875
26876 @subsubheading Synopsis
26877
26878 @smallexample
26879 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26880 @end smallexample
26881
26882 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26883 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26884 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26885 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26886 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26887 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26888
26889 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26890
26891 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26892
26893 @subsubheading Example
26894
26895 @smallexample
26896 (gdb)
26897 -break-insert main
26898 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26899 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26900 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26901 times="0"@}
26902 (gdb)
26903 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26904 ^done
26905 (gdb)
26906 @end smallexample
26907
26908 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26909 @findex -break-condition
26910
26911 @subsubheading Synopsis
26912
26913 @smallexample
26914 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26915 @end smallexample
26916
26917 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26918 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26919 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26920 command below).
26921
26922 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26923
26924 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26925
26926 @subsubheading Example
26927
26928 @smallexample
26929 (gdb)
26930 -break-condition 1 1
26931 ^done
26932 (gdb)
26933 -break-list
26934 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26935 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26936 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26937 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26938 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26939 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26940 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26941 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26942 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26943 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26944 (gdb)
26945 @end smallexample
26946
26947 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26948 @findex -break-delete
26949
26950 @subsubheading Synopsis
26951
26952 @smallexample
26953 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26954 @end smallexample
26955
26956 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26957 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26958
26959 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26960
26961 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26962
26963 @subsubheading Example
26964
26965 @smallexample
26966 (gdb)
26967 -break-delete 1
26968 ^done
26969 (gdb)
26970 -break-list
26971 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26972 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26973 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26974 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26975 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26976 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26977 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26978 body=[]@}
26979 (gdb)
26980 @end smallexample
26981
26982 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26983 @findex -break-disable
26984
26985 @subsubheading Synopsis
26986
26987 @smallexample
26988 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26989 @end smallexample
26990
26991 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26992 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26993
26994 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26995
26996 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26997
26998 @subsubheading Example
26999
27000 @smallexample
27001 (gdb)
27002 -break-disable 2
27003 ^done
27004 (gdb)
27005 -break-list
27006 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27007 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27008 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27009 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27010 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27011 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27012 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27013 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27014 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27015 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27016 (gdb)
27017 @end smallexample
27018
27019 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
27020 @findex -break-enable
27021
27022 @subsubheading Synopsis
27023
27024 @smallexample
27025 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27026 @end smallexample
27027
27028 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
27029
27030 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27031
27032 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
27033
27034 @subsubheading Example
27035
27036 @smallexample
27037 (gdb)
27038 -break-enable 2
27039 ^done
27040 (gdb)
27041 -break-list
27042 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27043 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27044 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27045 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27046 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27047 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27048 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27049 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27050 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27051 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27052 (gdb)
27053 @end smallexample
27054
27055 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27056 @findex -break-info
27057
27058 @subsubheading Synopsis
27059
27060 @smallexample
27061 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27062 @end smallexample
27063
27064 @c REDUNDANT???
27065 Get information about a single breakpoint.
27066
27067 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27068 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27069 table.
27070
27071 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27072
27073 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27074
27075 @subsubheading Example
27076 N.A.
27077
27078 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27079 @findex -break-insert
27080 @anchor{-break-insert}
27081
27082 @subsubheading Synopsis
27083
27084 @smallexample
27085 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27086 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27087 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27088 @end smallexample
27089
27090 @noindent
27091 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27092
27093 @table @var
27094 @item linespec location
27095 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27096
27097 @item explicit location
27098 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27099 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27100 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27101
27102 @table @samp
27103 @item --source @var{filename}
27104 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27105 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27106
27107 @item --function @var{function}
27108 The name of a function or method.
27109
27110 @item --label @var{label}
27111 The name of a label.
27112
27113 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
27114 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27115 @end table
27116
27117 @item address location
27118 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27119 @end table
27120
27121 @noindent
27122 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27123
27124 @table @samp
27125 @item -t
27126 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27127 @item -h
27128 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27129 @item -f
27130 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27131 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27132 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27133 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27134 cannot be parsed.
27135 @item -d
27136 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27137 @item -a
27138 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
27139 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27140 @item -c @var{condition}
27141 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27142 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27143 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27144 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27145 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27146 @var{thread-id}.
27147 @end table
27148
27149 @subsubheading Result
27150
27151 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27152 resulting breakpoint.
27153
27154 Note: this format is open to change.
27155 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27156
27157 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27158
27159 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27160 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27161
27162 @subsubheading Example
27163
27164 @smallexample
27165 (gdb)
27166 -break-insert main
27167 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27168 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27169 times="0"@}
27170 (gdb)
27171 -break-insert -t foo
27172 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27173 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27174 times="0"@}
27175 (gdb)
27176 -break-list
27177 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27178 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27179 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27180 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27181 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27182 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27183 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27184 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27185 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27186 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27187 times="0"@},
27188 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27189 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27190 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27191 times="0"@}]@}
27192 (gdb)
27193 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27194 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27195 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27196 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27197 @c times="0"@}
27198 @c (gdb)
27199 @end smallexample
27200
27201 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27202 @findex -dprintf-insert
27203
27204 @subsubheading Synopsis
27205
27206 @smallexample
27207 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27208 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27209 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27210 [ @var{argument} ]
27211 @end smallexample
27212
27213 @noindent
27214 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27215 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27216
27217 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27218
27219 @table @samp
27220 @item -t
27221 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27222 @item -f
27223 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27224 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27225 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27226 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27227 cannot be parsed.
27228 @item -d
27229 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27230 @item -c @var{condition}
27231 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27232 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27233 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27234 to @var{ignore-count}.
27235 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27236 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27237 @var{thread-id}.
27238 @end table
27239
27240 @subsubheading Result
27241
27242 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27243 resulting breakpoint.
27244
27245 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27246
27247 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27248
27249 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27250
27251 @subsubheading Example
27252
27253 @smallexample
27254 (gdb)
27255 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27256 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27257 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27258 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27259 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27260 original-location="foo"@}
27261 (gdb)
27262 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27263 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27264 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27265 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27266 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27267 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27268 (gdb)
27269 @end smallexample
27270
27271 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27272 @findex -break-list
27273
27274 @subsubheading Synopsis
27275
27276 @smallexample
27277 -break-list
27278 @end smallexample
27279
27280 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27281
27282 @table @samp
27283 @item Number
27284 number of the breakpoint
27285 @item Type
27286 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27287 @item Disposition
27288 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27289 or @samp{nokeep}
27290 @item Enabled
27291 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27292 @item Address
27293 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27294 @item What
27295 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27296 name, line number
27297 @item Thread-groups
27298 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27299 @item Times
27300 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27301 @end table
27302
27303 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27304 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27305
27306 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27307
27308 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27309
27310 @subsubheading Example
27311
27312 @smallexample
27313 (gdb)
27314 -break-list
27315 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27316 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27317 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27318 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27319 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27320 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27321 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27322 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27323 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27324 times="0"@},
27325 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27326 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27327 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27328 (gdb)
27329 @end smallexample
27330
27331 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27332
27333 @smallexample
27334 (gdb)
27335 -break-list
27336 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27337 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27338 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27339 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27340 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27341 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27342 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27343 body=[]@}
27344 (gdb)
27345 @end smallexample
27346
27347 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27348 @findex -break-passcount
27349
27350 @subsubheading Synopsis
27351
27352 @smallexample
27353 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27354 @end smallexample
27355
27356 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27357 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27358 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27359 command @samp{passcount}.
27360
27361 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27362 @findex -break-watch
27363
27364 @subsubheading Synopsis
27365
27366 @smallexample
27367 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27368 @end smallexample
27369
27370 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27371 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27372 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27373 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27374 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27375 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27376 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27377 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27378
27379 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27380 breakpoints inserted.
27381
27382 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27383
27384 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27385 @samp{rwatch}.
27386
27387 @subsubheading Example
27388
27389 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27390
27391 @smallexample
27392 (gdb)
27393 -break-watch x
27394 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27395 (gdb)
27396 -exec-continue
27397 ^running
27398 (gdb)
27399 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27400 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27401 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27402 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27403 (gdb)
27404 @end smallexample
27405
27406 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27407 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27408 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27409
27410 @smallexample
27411 (gdb)
27412 -break-watch C
27413 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27414 (gdb)
27415 -exec-continue
27416 ^running
27417 (gdb)
27418 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27419 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27420 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27421 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27422 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27423 (gdb)
27424 -exec-continue
27425 ^running
27426 (gdb)
27427 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27428 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27429 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27430 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27431 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27432 (gdb)
27433 @end smallexample
27434
27435 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27436 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27437 deleted.
27438
27439 @smallexample
27440 (gdb)
27441 -break-watch C
27442 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27443 (gdb)
27444 -break-list
27445 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27446 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27447 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27448 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27449 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27450 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27451 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27452 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27453 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27454 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27455 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27456 times="1"@},
27457 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27458 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27459 (gdb)
27460 -exec-continue
27461 ^running
27462 (gdb)
27463 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27464 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27465 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27466 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27467 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27468 (gdb)
27469 -break-list
27470 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27471 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27472 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27473 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27474 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27475 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27476 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27477 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27478 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27479 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27480 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27481 times="1"@},
27482 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27483 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27484 (gdb)
27485 -exec-continue
27486 ^running
27487 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27488 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27489 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27490 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27491 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27492 (gdb)
27493 -break-list
27494 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27495 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27496 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27497 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27498 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27499 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27500 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27501 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27502 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27503 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27504 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27505 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27506 (gdb)
27507 @end smallexample
27508
27509
27510 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27511 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27512 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27513
27514 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27515 catchpoints.
27516
27517 @menu
27518 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27519 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27520 @end menu
27521
27522 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27523 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27524
27525 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27526 @findex -catch-load
27527
27528 @subsubheading Synopsis
27529
27530 @smallexample
27531 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27532 @end smallexample
27533
27534 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27535 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27536 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27537 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27538 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27539
27540
27541 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27542
27543 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27544
27545 @subsubheading Example
27546
27547 @smallexample
27548 -catch-load -t foo.so
27549 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27550 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27551 (gdb)
27552 @end smallexample
27553
27554
27555 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27556 @findex -catch-unload
27557
27558 @subsubheading Synopsis
27559
27560 @smallexample
27561 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27562 @end smallexample
27563
27564 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27565 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27566 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27567 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27568 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27569
27570 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27571
27572 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27573
27574 @subsubheading Example
27575
27576 @smallexample
27577 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27578 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27579 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27580 (gdb)
27581 @end smallexample
27582
27583 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27584 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27585
27586 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27587 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27588
27589 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27590 @findex -catch-assert
27591
27592 @subsubheading Synopsis
27593
27594 @smallexample
27595 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27596 @end smallexample
27597
27598 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27599
27600 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27601
27602 @table @samp
27603 @item -c @var{condition}
27604 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27605 @item -d
27606 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27607 @item -t
27608 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27609 @end table
27610
27611 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27612
27613 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27614
27615 @subsubheading Example
27616
27617 @smallexample
27618 -catch-assert
27619 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27620 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27621 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27622 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27623 (gdb)
27624 @end smallexample
27625
27626 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27627 @findex -catch-exception
27628
27629 @subsubheading Synopsis
27630
27631 @smallexample
27632 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27633 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27634 @end smallexample
27635
27636 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27637 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27638 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27639 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27640 catchpoints.
27641
27642 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27643
27644 @table @samp
27645 @item -c @var{condition}
27646 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27647 @item -d
27648 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27649 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27650 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27651 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27652 @item -t
27653 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27654 @item -u
27655 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27656 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27657 @end table
27658
27659 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27660
27661 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27662 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27663
27664 @subsubheading Example
27665
27666 @smallexample
27667 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27668 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27669 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27670 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27671 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27672 (gdb)
27673 @end smallexample
27674
27675 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27676 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27677 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27678
27679 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27680 @findex -exec-arguments
27681
27682
27683 @subsubheading Synopsis
27684
27685 @smallexample
27686 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27687 @end smallexample
27688
27689 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27690 @samp{-exec-run}.
27691
27692 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27693
27694 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27695
27696 @subsubheading Example
27697
27698 @smallexample
27699 (gdb)
27700 -exec-arguments -v word
27701 ^done
27702 (gdb)
27703 @end smallexample
27704
27705
27706 @ignore
27707 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27708 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27709
27710 @subsubheading Synopsis
27711
27712 @smallexample
27713 -exec-show-arguments
27714 @end smallexample
27715
27716 Print the arguments of the program.
27717
27718 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27719
27720 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27721
27722 @subsubheading Example
27723 N.A.
27724 @end ignore
27725
27726
27727 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27728 @findex -environment-cd
27729
27730 @subsubheading Synopsis
27731
27732 @smallexample
27733 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27734 @end smallexample
27735
27736 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27737
27738 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27739
27740 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27741
27742 @subsubheading Example
27743
27744 @smallexample
27745 (gdb)
27746 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27747 ^done
27748 (gdb)
27749 @end smallexample
27750
27751
27752 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27753 @findex -environment-directory
27754
27755 @subsubheading Synopsis
27756
27757 @smallexample
27758 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27759 @end smallexample
27760
27761 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27762 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27763 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27764 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27765 occurs as normal.
27766 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27767 multiple directories in a single command
27768 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27769 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27770 If blanks are needed as
27771 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27772 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27773 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27774 character must not be used
27775 in any directory name.
27776 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27777
27778 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27779
27780 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27781
27782 @subsubheading Example
27783
27784 @smallexample
27785 (gdb)
27786 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27787 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27788 (gdb)
27789 -environment-directory ""
27790 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27791 (gdb)
27792 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27793 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27794 (gdb)
27795 -environment-directory -r
27796 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27797 (gdb)
27798 @end smallexample
27799
27800
27801 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27802 @findex -environment-path
27803
27804 @subsubheading Synopsis
27805
27806 @smallexample
27807 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27808 @end smallexample
27809
27810 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27811 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27812 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27813 supplied in addition to the
27814 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27815 occurs as normal.
27816 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27817 multiple directories in a single command
27818 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27819 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27820 If blanks are needed as
27821 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27822 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27823 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27824 character must not be used
27825 in any directory name.
27826 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27827
27828
27829 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27830
27831 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27832
27833 @subsubheading Example
27834
27835 @smallexample
27836 (gdb)
27837 -environment-path
27838 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27839 (gdb)
27840 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27841 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27842 (gdb)
27843 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27844 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27845 (gdb)
27846 @end smallexample
27847
27848
27849 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27850 @findex -environment-pwd
27851
27852 @subsubheading Synopsis
27853
27854 @smallexample
27855 -environment-pwd
27856 @end smallexample
27857
27858 Show the current working directory.
27859
27860 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27861
27862 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27863
27864 @subsubheading Example
27865
27866 @smallexample
27867 (gdb)
27868 -environment-pwd
27869 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27870 (gdb)
27871 @end smallexample
27872
27873 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27874 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27875 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27876
27877
27878 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27879 @findex -thread-info
27880
27881 @subsubheading Synopsis
27882
27883 @smallexample
27884 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27885 @end smallexample
27886
27887 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
27888 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
27889 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
27890 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
27891 current thread.
27892
27893 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27894
27895 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27896 about all threads.
27897
27898 @subsubheading Result
27899
27900 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27901 defined for a given thread:
27902
27903 @table @samp
27904 @item current
27905 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27906
27907 @item id
27908 The global identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27909
27910 @item target-id
27911 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27912
27913 @item details
27914 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27915 field is optional.
27916
27917 @item name
27918 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27919 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27920 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27921 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27922 field is omitted.
27923
27924 @item frame
27925 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27926
27927 @item state
27928 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27929 values:
27930
27931 @table @code
27932 @item stopped
27933 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27934 threads.
27935
27936 @item running
27937 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27938 threads.
27939
27940 @end table
27941
27942 @item core
27943 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27944 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27945
27946 @end table
27947
27948 @subsubheading Example
27949
27950 @smallexample
27951 -thread-info
27952 ^done,threads=[
27953 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27954 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27955 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27956 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27957 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27958 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27959 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27960 state="running"@}],
27961 current-thread-id="1"
27962 (gdb)
27963 @end smallexample
27964
27965 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27966 @findex -thread-list-ids
27967
27968 @subsubheading Synopsis
27969
27970 @smallexample
27971 -thread-list-ids
27972 @end smallexample
27973
27974 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
27975 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
27976 threads.
27977
27978 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27979 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27980
27981 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27982
27983 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27984
27985 @subsubheading Example
27986
27987 @smallexample
27988 (gdb)
27989 -thread-list-ids
27990 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27991 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27992 (gdb)
27993 @end smallexample
27994
27995
27996 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27997 @findex -thread-select
27998
27999 @subsubheading Synopsis
28000
28001 @smallexample
28002 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
28003 @end smallexample
28004
28005 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
28006 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
28007 topmost frame for that thread.
28008
28009 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28010 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
28011
28012 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28013
28014 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28015
28016 @subsubheading Example
28017
28018 @smallexample
28019 (gdb)
28020 -exec-next
28021 ^running
28022 (gdb)
28023 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28024 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28025 (gdb)
28026 -thread-list-ids
28027 ^done,
28028 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28029 number-of-threads="3"
28030 (gdb)
28031 -thread-select 3
28032 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
28033 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28034 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28035 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28036 (gdb)
28037 @end smallexample
28038
28039 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28040 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28041 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28042
28043 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28044 @findex -ada-task-info
28045
28046 @subsubheading Synopsis
28047
28048 @smallexample
28049 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28050 @end smallexample
28051
28052 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28053 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28054
28055 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28056
28057 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28058 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28059
28060 @subsubheading Result
28061
28062 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28063 defined for each Ada task:
28064
28065 @table @samp
28066 @item current
28067 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28068
28069 @item id
28070 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28071
28072 @item task-id
28073 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28074
28075 @item thread-id
28076 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28077 task.
28078
28079 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28080 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28081 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28082
28083 @item parent-id
28084 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28085 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28086
28087 @item priority
28088 The base priority of the task.
28089
28090 @item state
28091 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28092 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28093
28094 @item name
28095 The name of the task.
28096
28097 @end table
28098
28099 @subsubheading Example
28100
28101 @smallexample
28102 -ada-task-info
28103 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28104 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28105 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28106 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28107 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28108 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28109 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28110 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28111 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28112 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28113 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28114 (gdb)
28115 @end smallexample
28116
28117 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28118 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
28119 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28120
28121 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28122 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28123 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28124 other cases.
28125
28126 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28127 @findex -exec-continue
28128
28129 @subsubheading Synopsis
28130
28131 @smallexample
28132 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28133 @end smallexample
28134
28135 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28136 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
28137 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28138 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
28139 @itemize @bullet
28140 @item
28141 breakpoints or watchpoints
28142 @item
28143 signals or exceptions
28144 @item
28145 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28146 @item
28147 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28148 @end itemize
28149 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28150 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28151 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
28152 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28153 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28154 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28155
28156 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28157
28158 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28159
28160 @subsubheading Example
28161
28162 @smallexample
28163 -exec-continue
28164 ^running
28165 (gdb)
28166 @@Hello world
28167 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28168 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28169 line="13"@}
28170 (gdb)
28171 @end smallexample
28172
28173
28174 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28175 @findex -exec-finish
28176
28177 @subsubheading Synopsis
28178
28179 @smallexample
28180 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28181 @end smallexample
28182
28183 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28184 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28185 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28186 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28187 function was called.
28188
28189 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28190
28191 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28192
28193 @subsubheading Example
28194
28195 Function returning @code{void}.
28196
28197 @smallexample
28198 -exec-finish
28199 ^running
28200 (gdb)
28201 @@hello from foo
28202 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28203 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28204 (gdb)
28205 @end smallexample
28206
28207 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28208 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28209 value itself.
28210
28211 @smallexample
28212 -exec-finish
28213 ^running
28214 (gdb)
28215 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28216 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28217 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28218 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28219 (gdb)
28220 @end smallexample
28221
28222
28223 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28224 @findex -exec-interrupt
28225
28226 @subsubheading Synopsis
28227
28228 @smallexample
28229 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28230 @end smallexample
28231
28232 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28233 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28234 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28235 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28236 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28237
28238 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28239 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28240 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28241 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28242
28243 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28244 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28245 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28246 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28247
28248 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28249
28250 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28251
28252 @subsubheading Example
28253
28254 @smallexample
28255 (gdb)
28256 111-exec-continue
28257 111^running
28258
28259 (gdb)
28260 222-exec-interrupt
28261 222^done
28262 (gdb)
28263 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28264 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28265 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28266 (gdb)
28267
28268 (gdb)
28269 -exec-interrupt
28270 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28271 (gdb)
28272 @end smallexample
28273
28274 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28275 @findex -exec-jump
28276
28277 @subsubheading Synopsis
28278
28279 @smallexample
28280 -exec-jump @var{location}
28281 @end smallexample
28282
28283 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28284 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28285 different forms of @var{location}.
28286
28287 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28288
28289 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28290
28291 @subsubheading Example
28292
28293 @smallexample
28294 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28295 *running,thread-id="all"
28296 ^running
28297 @end smallexample
28298
28299
28300 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28301 @findex -exec-next
28302
28303 @subsubheading Synopsis
28304
28305 @smallexample
28306 -exec-next [--reverse]
28307 @end smallexample
28308
28309 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28310 of the next source line is reached.
28311
28312 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28313 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28314 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28315 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28316 source line where the function was called.
28317
28318
28319 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28320
28321 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28322
28323 @subsubheading Example
28324
28325 @smallexample
28326 -exec-next
28327 ^running
28328 (gdb)
28329 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28330 (gdb)
28331 @end smallexample
28332
28333
28334 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28335 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28336
28337 @subsubheading Synopsis
28338
28339 @smallexample
28340 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28341 @end smallexample
28342
28343 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28344 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28345 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28346 printed as well.
28347
28348 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28349 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28350 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28351 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28352 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28353
28354 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28355
28356 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28357
28358 @subsubheading Example
28359
28360 @smallexample
28361 (gdb)
28362 -exec-next-instruction
28363 ^running
28364
28365 (gdb)
28366 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28367 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28368 (gdb)
28369 @end smallexample
28370
28371
28372 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28373 @findex -exec-return
28374
28375 @subsubheading Synopsis
28376
28377 @smallexample
28378 -exec-return
28379 @end smallexample
28380
28381 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28382 Displays the new current frame.
28383
28384 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28385
28386 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28387
28388 @subsubheading Example
28389
28390 @smallexample
28391 (gdb)
28392 200-break-insert callee4
28393 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28394 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28395 (gdb)
28396 000-exec-run
28397 000^running
28398 (gdb)
28399 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28400 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28401 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28402 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28403 (gdb)
28404 205-break-delete
28405 205^done
28406 (gdb)
28407 111-exec-return
28408 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28409 args=[@{name="strarg",
28410 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28411 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28412 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28413 (gdb)
28414 @end smallexample
28415
28416
28417 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28418 @findex -exec-run
28419
28420 @subsubheading Synopsis
28421
28422 @smallexample
28423 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28424 @end smallexample
28425
28426 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28427 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28428 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28429 the program has exited exceptionally.
28430
28431 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28432 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28433 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28434 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28435 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28436
28437 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28438 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28439 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28440 (@pxref{Starting}).
28441
28442 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28443
28444 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28445
28446 @subsubheading Examples
28447
28448 @smallexample
28449 (gdb)
28450 -break-insert main
28451 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28452 (gdb)
28453 -exec-run
28454 ^running
28455 (gdb)
28456 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28457 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28458 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28459 (gdb)
28460 @end smallexample
28461
28462 @noindent
28463 Program exited normally:
28464
28465 @smallexample
28466 (gdb)
28467 -exec-run
28468 ^running
28469 (gdb)
28470 x = 55
28471 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28472 (gdb)
28473 @end smallexample
28474
28475 @noindent
28476 Program exited exceptionally:
28477
28478 @smallexample
28479 (gdb)
28480 -exec-run
28481 ^running
28482 (gdb)
28483 x = 55
28484 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28485 (gdb)
28486 @end smallexample
28487
28488 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28489 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28490
28491 @smallexample
28492 (gdb)
28493 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28494 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28495 @end smallexample
28496
28497
28498 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28499
28500
28501 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28502 @findex -exec-step
28503
28504 @subsubheading Synopsis
28505
28506 @smallexample
28507 -exec-step [--reverse]
28508 @end smallexample
28509
28510 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28511 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28512 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28513 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28514 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28515 previously executed source line.
28516
28517 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28518
28519 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28520
28521 @subsubheading Example
28522
28523 Stepping into a function:
28524
28525 @smallexample
28526 -exec-step
28527 ^running
28528 (gdb)
28529 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28530 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28531 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28532 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28533 (gdb)
28534 @end smallexample
28535
28536 Regular stepping:
28537
28538 @smallexample
28539 -exec-step
28540 ^running
28541 (gdb)
28542 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28543 (gdb)
28544 @end smallexample
28545
28546
28547 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28548 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28549
28550 @subsubheading Synopsis
28551
28552 @smallexample
28553 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28554 @end smallexample
28555
28556 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28557 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28558 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28559 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28560 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28561 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28562 as well.
28563
28564 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28565
28566 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28567
28568 @subsubheading Example
28569
28570 @smallexample
28571 (gdb)
28572 -exec-step-instruction
28573 ^running
28574
28575 (gdb)
28576 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28577 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28578 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28579 (gdb)
28580 -exec-step-instruction
28581 ^running
28582
28583 (gdb)
28584 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28585 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28586 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28587 (gdb)
28588 @end smallexample
28589
28590
28591 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28592 @findex -exec-until
28593
28594 @subsubheading Synopsis
28595
28596 @smallexample
28597 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28598 @end smallexample
28599
28600 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28601 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28602 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28603 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28604
28605 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28606
28607 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28608
28609 @subsubheading Example
28610
28611 @smallexample
28612 (gdb)
28613 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28614 ^running
28615 (gdb)
28616 x = 55
28617 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28618 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28619 (gdb)
28620 @end smallexample
28621
28622 @ignore
28623 @subheading -file-clear
28624 Is this going away????
28625 @end ignore
28626
28627 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28628 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28629 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28630
28631 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28632 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28633
28634 @smallexample
28635 -enable-frame-filters
28636 @end smallexample
28637
28638 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28639 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28640 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28641 request that this functionality be enabled.
28642
28643 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28644
28645 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28646 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28647
28648 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28649 @findex -stack-info-frame
28650
28651 @subsubheading Synopsis
28652
28653 @smallexample
28654 -stack-info-frame
28655 @end smallexample
28656
28657 Get info on the selected frame.
28658
28659 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28660
28661 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28662 (without arguments).
28663
28664 @subsubheading Example
28665
28666 @smallexample
28667 (gdb)
28668 -stack-info-frame
28669 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28670 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28671 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28672 (gdb)
28673 @end smallexample
28674
28675 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28676 @findex -stack-info-depth
28677
28678 @subsubheading Synopsis
28679
28680 @smallexample
28681 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28682 @end smallexample
28683
28684 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28685 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28686
28687 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28688
28689 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28690
28691 @subsubheading Example
28692
28693 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28694
28695 @smallexample
28696 (gdb)
28697 -stack-info-depth
28698 ^done,depth="12"
28699 (gdb)
28700 -stack-info-depth 4
28701 ^done,depth="4"
28702 (gdb)
28703 -stack-info-depth 12
28704 ^done,depth="12"
28705 (gdb)
28706 -stack-info-depth 11
28707 ^done,depth="11"
28708 (gdb)
28709 -stack-info-depth 13
28710 ^done,depth="12"
28711 (gdb)
28712 @end smallexample
28713
28714 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28715 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28716 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28717
28718 @subsubheading Synopsis
28719
28720 @smallexample
28721 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28722 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28723 @end smallexample
28724
28725 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28726 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28727 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28728 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28729 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28730 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28731 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28732 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28733
28734 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28735 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28736 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28737 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28738 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28739 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28740
28741 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28742 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28743 are still displayed, however.
28744
28745 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28746 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28747
28748 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28749
28750 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28751 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28752 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28753
28754 @subsubheading Example
28755
28756 @smallexample
28757 (gdb)
28758 -stack-list-frames
28759 ^done,
28760 stack=[
28761 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28762 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28763 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28764 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28765 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28766 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28767 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28768 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28769 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28770 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28771 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28772 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28773 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28774 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28775 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28776 (gdb)
28777 -stack-list-arguments 0
28778 ^done,
28779 stack-args=[
28780 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28781 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28782 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28783 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28784 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28785 (gdb)
28786 -stack-list-arguments 1
28787 ^done,
28788 stack-args=[
28789 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28790 frame=@{level="1",
28791 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28792 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28793 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28794 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28795 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28796 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28797 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28798 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28799 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28800 (gdb)
28801 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28802 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28803 (gdb)
28804 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28805 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28806 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28807 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28808 (gdb)
28809 @end smallexample
28810
28811 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28812
28813
28814 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28815 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28816 @findex -stack-list-frames
28817
28818 @subsubheading Synopsis
28819
28820 @smallexample
28821 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28822 @end smallexample
28823
28824 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28825 following info:
28826
28827 @table @samp
28828 @item @var{level}
28829 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28830 @item @var{addr}
28831 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28832 @item @var{func}
28833 Function name.
28834 @item @var{file}
28835 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28836 @item @var{fullname}
28837 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28838 @item @var{line}
28839 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28840 @item @var{from}
28841 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28842 if the frame's function is not known.
28843 @end table
28844
28845 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28846 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28847 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28848 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28849 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28850 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28851 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28852 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28853 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28854
28855 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28856
28857 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28858
28859 @subsubheading Example
28860
28861 Full stack backtrace:
28862
28863 @smallexample
28864 (gdb)
28865 -stack-list-frames
28866 ^done,stack=
28867 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28868 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28869 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28870 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28871 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28872 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28873 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28874 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28875 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28876 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28877 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28878 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28879 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28880 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28881 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28882 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28883 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28884 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28885 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28886 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28887 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28888 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28889 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28890 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28891 (gdb)
28892 @end smallexample
28893
28894 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28895
28896 @smallexample
28897 (gdb)
28898 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28899 ^done,stack=
28900 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28901 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28902 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28903 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28904 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28905 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28906 (gdb)
28907 @end smallexample
28908
28909 Show a single frame:
28910
28911 @smallexample
28912 (gdb)
28913 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28914 ^done,stack=
28915 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28916 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28917 (gdb)
28918 @end smallexample
28919
28920
28921 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28922 @findex -stack-list-locals
28923 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
28924
28925 @subsubheading Synopsis
28926
28927 @smallexample
28928 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28929 @end smallexample
28930
28931 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28932 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28933 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28934 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28935 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28936 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28937 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28938 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28939 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28940 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28941
28942 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28943 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
28944 variables are still displayed, however.
28945
28946 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28947 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28948
28949 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28950
28951 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
28952
28953 @subsubheading Example
28954
28955 @smallexample
28956 (gdb)
28957 -stack-list-locals 0
28958 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28959 (gdb)
28960 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28961 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28962 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28963 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28964 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28965 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28966 (gdb)
28967 @end smallexample
28968
28969 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
28970 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28971 @findex -stack-list-variables
28972
28973 @subsubheading Synopsis
28974
28975 @smallexample
28976 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28977 @end smallexample
28978
28979 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28980 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28981 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28982 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28983 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28984 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28985 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28986
28987 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28988 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
28989 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
28990
28991 @subsubheading Example
28992
28993 @smallexample
28994 (gdb)
28995 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28996 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28997 (gdb)
28998 @end smallexample
28999
29000
29001 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29002 @findex -stack-select-frame
29003
29004 @subsubheading Synopsis
29005
29006 @smallexample
29007 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29008 @end smallexample
29009
29010 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29011 the stack.
29012
29013 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29014 option to every command.
29015
29016 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29017
29018 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29019 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29020
29021 @subsubheading Example
29022
29023 @smallexample
29024 (gdb)
29025 -stack-select-frame 2
29026 ^done
29027 (gdb)
29028 @end smallexample
29029
29030 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29031 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29032 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29033
29034 @ignore
29035
29036 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29037
29038 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29039 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29040 used by @code{Insight}.
29041
29042 The two main reasons for that are:
29043
29044 @enumerate 1
29045 @item
29046 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29047
29048 @item
29049 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29050 now).
29051 @end enumerate
29052
29053 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29054 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29055 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29056 hints about their use.
29057
29058 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29059 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29060 least, the following operations:
29061
29062 @itemize @bullet
29063 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29064 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29065 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29066 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29067 @end itemize
29068
29069 @end ignore
29070
29071 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29072
29073 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29074
29075 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29076 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29077 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29078 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29079 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29080 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29081 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29082 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29083 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29084 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29085 object, or to change display format.
29086
29087 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29088 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29089 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29090 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29091 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29092 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29093 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29094 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29095 child will be created.
29096
29097 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29098 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29099 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29100 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29101 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29102
29103 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29104 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29105 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29106 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29107 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29108 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29109 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29110 variables that frontend has created.
29111
29112 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29113 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29114 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29115 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29116 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29117 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29118 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29119 implicitly updated.
29120
29121 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29122 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29123 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29124 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29125 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29126 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29127 frame. Consider this example:
29128
29129 @smallexample
29130 void do_work(...)
29131 @{
29132 struct work_state state;
29133
29134 if (...)
29135 do_work(...);
29136 @}
29137 @end smallexample
29138
29139 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29140 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29141 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29142 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29143 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29144
29145 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29146 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29147 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29148 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29149 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29150 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29151
29152 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29153 access this functionality:
29154
29155 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29156 @item @strong{Operation}
29157 @tab @strong{Description}
29158
29159 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29160 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29161 @item @code{-var-create}
29162 @tab create a variable object
29163 @item @code{-var-delete}
29164 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29165 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29166 @tab set the display format of this variable
29167 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29168 @tab show the display format of this variable
29169 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29170 @tab tells how many children this object has
29171 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29172 @tab return a list of the object's children
29173 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29174 @tab show the type of this variable object
29175 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
29176 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29177 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29178 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29179 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29180 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29181 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29182 @tab get the value of this variable
29183 @item @code{-var-assign}
29184 @tab set the value of this variable
29185 @item @code{-var-update}
29186 @tab update the variable and its children
29187 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29188 @tab set frozeness attribute
29189 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29190 @tab set range of children to display on update
29191 @end multitable
29192
29193 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29194 how it can be used.
29195
29196 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29197
29198 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29199 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29200
29201 @smallexample
29202 -enable-pretty-printing
29203 @end smallexample
29204
29205 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29206 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29207 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29208 request that this functionality be enabled.
29209
29210 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29211
29212 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29213 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29214
29215 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29216 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29217
29218 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29219 @findex -var-create
29220
29221 @subsubheading Synopsis
29222
29223 @smallexample
29224 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29225 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29226 @end smallexample
29227
29228 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29229 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29230 register.
29231
29232 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29233 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29234 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29235 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29236 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29237
29238 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29239 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29240 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29241 object must be created.
29242
29243 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29244 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29245
29246 @itemize @bullet
29247 @item
29248 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29249
29250 @item
29251 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29252
29253 @item
29254 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29255 @end itemize
29256
29257 @cindex dynamic varobj
29258 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29259 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29260 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29261 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29262 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29263 compatibility for existing clients.
29264
29265 @subsubheading Result
29266
29267 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29268 are:
29269
29270 @table @samp
29271 @item name
29272 The name of the varobj.
29273
29274 @item numchild
29275 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29276 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29277 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29278
29279 @item value
29280 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29281 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29282 will not be interesting.
29283
29284 @item type
29285 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29286 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29287 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29288 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29289 @emph{declared} one.
29290
29291 @item thread-id
29292 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29293 thread's global identifier.
29294
29295 @item has_more
29296 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29297 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29298
29299 @item dynamic
29300 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29301 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29302 then this attribute will not be present.
29303
29304 @item displayhint
29305 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29306 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29307 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29308 @end table
29309
29310 Typical output will look like this:
29311
29312 @smallexample
29313 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29314 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29315 @end smallexample
29316
29317
29318 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29319 @findex -var-delete
29320
29321 @subsubheading Synopsis
29322
29323 @smallexample
29324 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29325 @end smallexample
29326
29327 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29328 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29329
29330 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29331
29332
29333 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29334 @findex -var-set-format
29335
29336 @subsubheading Synopsis
29337
29338 @smallexample
29339 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29340 @end smallexample
29341
29342 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29343 @var{format-spec}.
29344
29345 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29346 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29347
29348 @smallexample
29349 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29350 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29351 @end smallexample
29352
29353 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29354 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29355 for pointers, etc.).
29356
29357 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29358 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29359 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29360 zero-hexadecimal format.
29361
29362 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29363 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29364
29365 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29366 @findex -var-show-format
29367
29368 @subsubheading Synopsis
29369
29370 @smallexample
29371 -var-show-format @var{name}
29372 @end smallexample
29373
29374 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29375
29376 @smallexample
29377 @var{format} @expansion{}
29378 @var{format-spec}
29379 @end smallexample
29380
29381
29382 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29383 @findex -var-info-num-children
29384
29385 @subsubheading Synopsis
29386
29387 @smallexample
29388 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29389 @end smallexample
29390
29391 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29392
29393 @smallexample
29394 numchild=@var{n}
29395 @end smallexample
29396
29397 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29398 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29399 be available.
29400
29401
29402 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29403 @findex -var-list-children
29404
29405 @subsubheading Synopsis
29406
29407 @smallexample
29408 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29409 @end smallexample
29410 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29411
29412 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29413 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29414 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29415 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29416 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29417 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29418 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29419 and unions.
29420
29421 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29422 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29423 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29424 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29425 reported.
29426
29427 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29428 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29429 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29430 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29431 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29432 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29433 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29434 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29435 the visible items.
29436
29437 For each child the following results are returned:
29438
29439 @table @var
29440
29441 @item name
29442 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29443
29444 @item exp
29445 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29446 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29447
29448 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29449 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29450
29451 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29452 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29453 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29454 type and value are not present.
29455
29456 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29457 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29458 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29459
29460 @item numchild
29461 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29462 0.
29463
29464 @item type
29465 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29466 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29467 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29468 @emph{declared} one.
29469
29470 @item value
29471 If values were requested, this is the value.
29472
29473 @item thread-id
29474 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29475 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
29476
29477 @item frozen
29478 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29479
29480 @item displayhint
29481 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29482 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29483 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29484
29485 @item dynamic
29486 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29487 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29488 then this attribute will not be present.
29489
29490 @end table
29491
29492 The result may have its own attributes:
29493
29494 @table @samp
29495 @item displayhint
29496 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29497 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29498 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29499
29500 @item has_more
29501 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29502 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29503 @end table
29504
29505 @subsubheading Example
29506
29507 @smallexample
29508 (gdb)
29509 -var-list-children n
29510 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29511 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29512 (gdb)
29513 -var-list-children --all-values n
29514 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29515 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29516 @end smallexample
29517
29518
29519 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29520 @findex -var-info-type
29521
29522 @subsubheading Synopsis
29523
29524 @smallexample
29525 -var-info-type @var{name}
29526 @end smallexample
29527
29528 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29529 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29530 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29531
29532 @smallexample
29533 type=@var{typename}
29534 @end smallexample
29535
29536
29537 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29538 @findex -var-info-expression
29539
29540 @subsubheading Synopsis
29541
29542 @smallexample
29543 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29544 @end smallexample
29545
29546 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29547 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29548 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29549
29550 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29551 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29552
29553 @smallexample
29554 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29555 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29556 @end smallexample
29557
29558 @noindent
29559 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29560 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29561
29562 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29563 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29564 is of limited use.
29565
29566 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29567 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29568
29569 @subsubheading Synopsis
29570
29571 @smallexample
29572 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29573 @end smallexample
29574
29575 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29576 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29577 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29578 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29579 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29580 watchpoint from a variable object.
29581
29582 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29583 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29584
29585 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29586 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29587 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29588 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29589 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29590 @smallexample
29591 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29592 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29593 @end smallexample
29594
29595 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29596 @findex -var-show-attributes
29597
29598 @subsubheading Synopsis
29599
29600 @smallexample
29601 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29602 @end smallexample
29603
29604 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29605
29606 @smallexample
29607 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29608 @end smallexample
29609
29610 @noindent
29611 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29612
29613 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29614 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29615
29616 @subsubheading Synopsis
29617
29618 @smallexample
29619 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29620 @end smallexample
29621
29622 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29623 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29624 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29625 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29626 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29627 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29628 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29629
29630 @smallexample
29631 value=@var{value}
29632 @end smallexample
29633
29634 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29635 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29636
29637 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29638 @findex -var-assign
29639
29640 @subsubheading Synopsis
29641
29642 @smallexample
29643 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29644 @end smallexample
29645
29646 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29647 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29648 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29649 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29650
29651 @subsubheading Example
29652
29653 @smallexample
29654 (gdb)
29655 -var-assign var1 3
29656 ^done,value="3"
29657 (gdb)
29658 -var-update *
29659 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29660 (gdb)
29661 @end smallexample
29662
29663 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29664 @findex -var-update
29665
29666 @subsubheading Synopsis
29667
29668 @smallexample
29669 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29670 @end smallexample
29671
29672 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29673 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29674 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29675 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29676 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29677 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29678 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29679 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29680 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29681 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29682 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29683 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29684 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29685
29686 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29687 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29688 diagnostic.
29689
29690 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29691 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29692
29693 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29694 @samp{changelist}.
29695
29696 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29697
29698 @table @samp
29699 @item name
29700 The name of the varobj.
29701
29702 @item value
29703 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29704 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29705
29706 @item in_scope
29707 @anchor{-var-update}
29708 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29709
29710 @table @code
29711 @item "true"
29712 The variable object's current value is valid.
29713
29714 @item "false"
29715 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29716 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29717 scope.
29718
29719 @item "invalid"
29720 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29721 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29722 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29723 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29724 objects.
29725 @end table
29726
29727 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29728 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29729
29730 @item type_changed
29731 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29732 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29733 be @samp{false}.
29734
29735 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29736 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29737 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29738 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29739 unset.
29740
29741 @item new_type
29742 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29743 hold the new type.
29744
29745 @item new_num_children
29746 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29747 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29748
29749 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29750 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29751 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29752 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29753 children which may be available.
29754
29755 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29756 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29757 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29758 only happen at the end of the update range).
29759
29760 @item displayhint
29761 The display hint, if any.
29762
29763 @item has_more
29764 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29765 available outside the varobj's update range.
29766
29767 @item dynamic
29768 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29769 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29770 then this attribute will not be present.
29771
29772 @item new_children
29773 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29774 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29775 be listed in this attribute.
29776 @end table
29777
29778 @subsubheading Example
29779
29780 @smallexample
29781 (gdb)
29782 -var-assign var1 3
29783 ^done,value="3"
29784 (gdb)
29785 -var-update --all-values var1
29786 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29787 type_changed="false"@}]
29788 (gdb)
29789 @end smallexample
29790
29791 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29792 @findex -var-set-frozen
29793 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29794
29795 @subsubheading Synopsis
29796
29797 @smallexample
29798 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29799 @end smallexample
29800
29801 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29802 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29803 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29804 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29805 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29806 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29807 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29808 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29809 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29810 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29811 @code{-var-update} does.
29812
29813 @subsubheading Example
29814
29815 @smallexample
29816 (gdb)
29817 -var-set-frozen V 1
29818 ^done
29819 (gdb)
29820 @end smallexample
29821
29822 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29823 @findex -var-set-update-range
29824 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29825
29826 @subsubheading Synopsis
29827
29828 @smallexample
29829 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29830 @end smallexample
29831
29832 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29833 @code{-var-update}.
29834
29835 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29836 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29837 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29838 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29839
29840 @subsubheading Example
29841
29842 @smallexample
29843 (gdb)
29844 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29845 ^done
29846 @end smallexample
29847
29848 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29849 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29850 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29851
29852 @subsubheading Synopsis
29853
29854 @smallexample
29855 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29856 @end smallexample
29857
29858 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29859
29860 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29861 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29862
29863 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29864 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29865 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29866 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29867 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29868 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29869 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29870
29871 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29872 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29873 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29874 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29875
29876 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29877 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29878 can be used to check this.
29879
29880 @subsubheading Example
29881
29882 Resetting the visualizer:
29883
29884 @smallexample
29885 (gdb)
29886 -var-set-visualizer V None
29887 ^done
29888 @end smallexample
29889
29890 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29891
29892 @smallexample
29893 (gdb)
29894 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29895 ^done
29896 @end smallexample
29897
29898 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29899 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29900
29901 @smallexample
29902 (gdb)
29903 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29904 ^done
29905 @end smallexample
29906
29907 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29908 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29909 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29910
29911 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29912 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29913 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29914 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29915
29916 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
29917 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
29918
29919 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29920 @c @subheading -data-assign
29921 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29922 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29923 @c set variable
29924 @c @subsubheading Example
29925 @c N.A.
29926
29927 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29928 @findex -data-disassemble
29929
29930 @subsubheading Synopsis
29931
29932 @smallexample
29933 -data-disassemble
29934 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29935 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29936 -- @var{mode}
29937 @end smallexample
29938
29939 @noindent
29940 Where:
29941
29942 @table @samp
29943 @item @var{start-addr}
29944 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29945 @item @var{end-addr}
29946 is the end address
29947 @item @var{filename}
29948 is the name of the file to disassemble
29949 @item @var{linenum}
29950 is the line number to disassemble around
29951 @item @var{lines}
29952 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
29953 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
29954 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
29955 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
29956 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
29957 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
29958 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
29959 are displayed.
29960 @item @var{mode}
29961 is one of:
29962 @itemize @bullet
29963 @item 0 disassembly only
29964 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
29965 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
29966 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
29967 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
29968 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
29969 @end itemize
29970
29971 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
29972 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
29973 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
29974 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
29975 @end table
29976
29977 @subsubheading Result
29978
29979 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
29980 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
29981 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
29982
29983 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
29984 following fields:
29985
29986 @table @code
29987 @item address
29988 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
29989
29990 @item func-name
29991 The name of the function this instruction is within.
29992
29993 @item offset
29994 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
29995
29996 @item inst
29997 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
29998
29999 @item opcodes
30000 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
30001 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30002
30003 @end table
30004
30005 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30006 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30007
30008 @table @code
30009 @item line
30010 The line number within @samp{file}.
30011
30012 @item file
30013 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
30014 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30015 used.
30016
30017 @item fullname
30018 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
30019 using the source file search path
30020 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
30021 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
30022
30023 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
30024 present in the debug information.
30025
30026 @item line_asm_insn
30027 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30028 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30029 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30030 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30031 @samp{opcodes}.
30032
30033 @end table
30034
30035 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30036 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30037 adjust its format.
30038
30039 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30040
30041 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30042
30043 @subsubheading Example
30044
30045 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30046
30047 @smallexample
30048 (gdb)
30049 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30050 ^done,
30051 asm_insns=[
30052 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30053 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30054 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30055 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30056 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30057 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30058 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30059 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30060 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30061 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30062 (gdb)
30063 @end smallexample
30064
30065 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30066 @code{main}.
30067
30068 @smallexample
30069 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30070 ^done,asm_insns=[
30071 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30072 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30073 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30074 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30075 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30076 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30077 [@dots{}]
30078 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30079 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30080 (gdb)
30081 @end smallexample
30082
30083 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30084
30085 @smallexample
30086 (gdb)
30087 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30088 ^done,asm_insns=[
30089 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30090 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30091 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30092 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30093 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30094 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30095 (gdb)
30096 @end smallexample
30097
30098 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30099
30100 @smallexample
30101 (gdb)
30102 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30103 ^done,asm_insns=[
30104 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30105 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30106 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30107 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30108 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30109 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30110 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30111 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30112 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30113 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30114 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30115 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30116 (gdb)
30117 @end smallexample
30118
30119
30120 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30121 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
30122
30123 @subsubheading Synopsis
30124
30125 @smallexample
30126 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30127 @end smallexample
30128
30129 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30130 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30131 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30132
30133 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30134
30135 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30136 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30137 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
30138
30139 @subsubheading Example
30140
30141 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30142 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30143 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30144 output.
30145
30146 @smallexample
30147 211-data-evaluate-expression A
30148 211^done,value="1"
30149 (gdb)
30150 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30151 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30152 (gdb)
30153 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30154 411^done,value="4"
30155 (gdb)
30156 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30157 511^done,value="4"
30158 (gdb)
30159 @end smallexample
30160
30161
30162 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30163 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30164
30165 @subsubheading Synopsis
30166
30167 @smallexample
30168 -data-list-changed-registers
30169 @end smallexample
30170
30171 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30172
30173 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30174
30175 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30176 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30177
30178 @subsubheading Example
30179
30180 On a PPC MBX board:
30181
30182 @smallexample
30183 (gdb)
30184 -exec-continue
30185 ^running
30186
30187 (gdb)
30188 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30189 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30190 line="5"@}
30191 (gdb)
30192 -data-list-changed-registers
30193 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30194 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30195 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30196 (gdb)
30197 @end smallexample
30198
30199
30200 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30201 @findex -data-list-register-names
30202
30203 @subsubheading Synopsis
30204
30205 @smallexample
30206 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30207 @end smallexample
30208
30209 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30210 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30211 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30212 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30213 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30214 include empty register names.
30215
30216 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30217
30218 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30219 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30220 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30221
30222 @subsubheading Example
30223
30224 For the PPC MBX board:
30225 @smallexample
30226 (gdb)
30227 -data-list-register-names
30228 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30229 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30230 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30231 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30232 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30233 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30234 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30235 (gdb)
30236 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30237 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30238 (gdb)
30239 @end smallexample
30240
30241 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30242 @findex -data-list-register-values
30243
30244 @subsubheading Synopsis
30245
30246 @smallexample
30247 -data-list-register-values
30248 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30249 @end smallexample
30250
30251 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30252 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30253 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30254 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30255 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30256 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30257
30258 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30259
30260 @table @code
30261 @item x
30262 Hexadecimal
30263 @item o
30264 Octal
30265 @item t
30266 Binary
30267 @item d
30268 Decimal
30269 @item r
30270 Raw
30271 @item N
30272 Natural
30273 @end table
30274
30275 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30276
30277 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30278 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30279
30280 @subsubheading Example
30281
30282 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30283 don't appear in the actual output):
30284
30285 @smallexample
30286 (gdb)
30287 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30288 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30289 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30290 (gdb)
30291 -data-list-register-values x
30292 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30293 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30294 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30295 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30296 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30297 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30298 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30299 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30300 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30301 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30302 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30303 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30304 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30305 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30306 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30307 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30308 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30309 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30310 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30311 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30312 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30313 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30314 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30315 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30316 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30317 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30318 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30319 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30320 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30321 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30322 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30323 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30324 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30325 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30326 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30327 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30328 (gdb)
30329 @end smallexample
30330
30331
30332 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30333 @findex -data-read-memory
30334
30335 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30336
30337 @subsubheading Synopsis
30338
30339 @smallexample
30340 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30341 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30342 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30343 @end smallexample
30344
30345 @noindent
30346 where:
30347
30348 @table @samp
30349 @item @var{address}
30350 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30351 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30352 quoted using the C convention.
30353
30354 @item @var{word-format}
30355 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30356 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30357 ,Output Formats}).
30358
30359 @item @var{word-size}
30360 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30361
30362 @item @var{nr-rows}
30363 The number of rows in the output table.
30364
30365 @item @var{nr-cols}
30366 The number of columns in the output table.
30367
30368 @item @var{aschar}
30369 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30370 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30371 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30372 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30373
30374 @item @var{byte-offset}
30375 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30376 @end table
30377
30378 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30379 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30380 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30381 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30382 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30383 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30384 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30385 @samp{addr}.
30386
30387 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30388 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30389 @samp{prev-page}.
30390
30391 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30392
30393 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30394 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30395
30396 @subsubheading Example
30397
30398 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30399 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30400 word. Display each word in hex.
30401
30402 @smallexample
30403 (gdb)
30404 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30405 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30406 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30407 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30408 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30409 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30410 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30411 (gdb)
30412 @end smallexample
30413
30414 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30415 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30416
30417 @smallexample
30418 (gdb)
30419 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30420 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30421 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30422 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30423 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30424 (gdb)
30425 @end smallexample
30426
30427 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30428 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30429 used as the non-printable character.
30430
30431 @smallexample
30432 (gdb)
30433 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30434 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30435 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30436 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30437 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30438 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30439 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30440 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30441 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30442 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30443 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30444 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30445 (gdb)
30446 @end smallexample
30447
30448 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30449 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30450
30451 @subsubheading Synopsis
30452
30453 @smallexample
30454 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30455 @var{address} @var{count}
30456 @end smallexample
30457
30458 @noindent
30459 where:
30460
30461 @table @samp
30462 @item @var{address}
30463 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30464 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30465 quoted using the C convention.
30466
30467 @item @var{count}
30468 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30469 literal.
30470
30471 @item @var{offset}
30472 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30473 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30474 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30475 arithmetics itself.
30476
30477 @end table
30478
30479 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30480 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30481 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30482 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30483 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30484 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30485
30486 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30487 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30488 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30489 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30490 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30491 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30492 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30493 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30494
30495 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30496 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30497 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30498 and has the following fields:
30499
30500 @table @code
30501 @item begin
30502 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30503
30504 @item end
30505 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30506
30507 @item offset
30508 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30509 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30510
30511 @item contents
30512 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30513
30514 @end table
30515
30516
30517
30518 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30519
30520 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30521
30522 @subsubheading Example
30523
30524 @smallexample
30525 (gdb)
30526 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30527 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30528 end="0xbffff15e",
30529 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30530 (gdb)
30531 @end smallexample
30532
30533
30534 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30535 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30536
30537 @subsubheading Synopsis
30538
30539 @smallexample
30540 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30541 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30542 @end smallexample
30543
30544 @noindent
30545 where:
30546
30547 @table @samp
30548 @item @var{address}
30549 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30550 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30551 be quoted using the C convention.
30552
30553 @item @var{contents}
30554 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30555 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30556
30557 @item @var{count}
30558 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30559 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30560 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30561 @var{count} memory units.
30562
30563 @end table
30564
30565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30566
30567 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30568
30569 @subsubheading Example
30570
30571 @smallexample
30572 (gdb)
30573 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30574 ^done
30575 (gdb)
30576 @end smallexample
30577
30578 @smallexample
30579 (gdb)
30580 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30581 ^done
30582 (gdb)
30583 @end smallexample
30584
30585 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30586 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30587 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30588
30589 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30590 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30591
30592 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30593 @findex -trace-find
30594
30595 @subsubheading Synopsis
30596
30597 @smallexample
30598 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30599 @end smallexample
30600
30601 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30602 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30603 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30604
30605 @table @samp
30606
30607 @item none
30608 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30609
30610 @item frame-number
30611 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30612 that index.
30613
30614 @item tracepoint-number
30615 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30616 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30617
30618 @item pc
30619 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30620 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30621 address.
30622
30623 @item pc-inside-range
30624 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30625 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30626 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30627
30628 @item pc-outside-range
30629 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30630 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30631 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30632
30633 @item line
30634 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30635 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30636 the specified location.
30637
30638 @end table
30639
30640 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30641 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30642
30643 @table @samp
30644 @item found
30645 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30646 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30647
30648 @item traceframe
30649 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30650 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30651
30652 @item tracepoint
30653 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30654 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30655
30656 @item frame
30657 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30658 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30659 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30660
30661 @end table
30662
30663 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30664
30665 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30666
30667 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30668 @findex -trace-define-variable
30669
30670 @subsubheading Synopsis
30671
30672 @smallexample
30673 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30674 @end smallexample
30675
30676 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30677 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30678 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30679 with the @samp{$} character.
30680
30681 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30682
30683 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30684
30685 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30686 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30687
30688 @subsubheading Synopsis
30689
30690 @smallexample
30691 -trace-frame-collected
30692 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30693 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30694 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30695 [--memory-contents]
30696 @end smallexample
30697
30698 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30699 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30700 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30701 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30702 See the output description table below for more details.
30703
30704 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30705 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30706 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30707 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30708 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30709
30710 For instance, if the actions were
30711 @smallexample
30712 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30713 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30714 @end smallexample
30715
30716 @noindent
30717 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30718 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30719 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30720 objects would be computed expressions.
30721
30722 An example output would be:
30723
30724 @smallexample
30725 (gdb)
30726 -trace-frame-collected
30727 ^done,
30728 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30729 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30730 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30731 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30732 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30733 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30734 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30735 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30736 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30737 ...
30738 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30739 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30740 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30741 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30742 (gdb)
30743 @end smallexample
30744
30745 Where:
30746
30747 @table @code
30748 @item explicit-variables
30749 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30750 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30751 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30752 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30753 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30754 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30755 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30756 arrays, structures and unions.
30757
30758 @item computed-expressions
30759 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30760 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30761 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30762 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30763
30764 @item registers
30765 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30766 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30767 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30768 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30769 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30770
30771 @item tvars
30772 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30773 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30774 current value are returned.
30775
30776 @item memory
30777 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30778 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30779 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30780
30781 @table @code
30782 @item address
30783 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30784
30785 @item length
30786 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30787
30788 @item contents
30789 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30790 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30791
30792 @end table
30793
30794 @end table
30795
30796 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30797
30798 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30799
30800 @subsubheading Example
30801
30802 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30803 @findex -trace-list-variables
30804
30805 @subsubheading Synopsis
30806
30807 @smallexample
30808 -trace-list-variables
30809 @end smallexample
30810
30811 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30812 table has the following fields:
30813
30814 @table @samp
30815 @item name
30816 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30817
30818 @item initial
30819 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30820 field is always present.
30821
30822 @item current
30823 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30824 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30825 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30826 presently running.
30827
30828 @end table
30829
30830 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30831
30832 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30833
30834 @subsubheading Example
30835
30836 @smallexample
30837 (gdb)
30838 -trace-list-variables
30839 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30840 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30841 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30842 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30843 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30844 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30845 (gdb)
30846 @end smallexample
30847
30848 @subheading -trace-save
30849 @findex -trace-save
30850
30851 @subsubheading Synopsis
30852
30853 @smallexample
30854 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
30855 @end smallexample
30856
30857 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30858 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30859 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30860 to perform the save.
30861
30862 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30863
30864 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30865
30866
30867 @subheading -trace-start
30868 @findex -trace-start
30869
30870 @subsubheading Synopsis
30871
30872 @smallexample
30873 -trace-start
30874 @end smallexample
30875
30876 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
30877 have any fields.
30878
30879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30880
30881 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30882
30883 @subheading -trace-status
30884 @findex -trace-status
30885
30886 @subsubheading Synopsis
30887
30888 @smallexample
30889 -trace-status
30890 @end smallexample
30891
30892 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30893 the following fields:
30894
30895 @table @samp
30896
30897 @item supported
30898 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30899 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30900 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30901 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30902 started. This field is always present.
30903
30904 @item running
30905 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30906 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30907 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30908
30909 @item stop-reason
30910 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30911 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30912 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30913 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
30914 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30915 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30916 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30917 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30918 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30919
30920 @item stopping-tracepoint
30921 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
30922 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30923 @samp{passcount}.
30924
30925 @item frames
30926 @itemx frames-created
30927 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30928 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30929 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30930 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
30931
30932 @item buffer-size
30933 @itemx buffer-free
30934 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30935 remaining space. These fields are optional.
30936
30937 @item circular
30938 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
30939 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30940 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30941 and may fill up.
30942
30943 @item disconnected
30944 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
30945 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
30946 that the trace run will stop.
30947
30948 @item trace-file
30949 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
30950 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
30951
30952 @end table
30953
30954 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30955
30956 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
30957
30958 @subheading -trace-stop
30959 @findex -trace-stop
30960
30961 @subsubheading Synopsis
30962
30963 @smallexample
30964 -trace-stop
30965 @end smallexample
30966
30967 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
30968 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
30969 @samp{running} fields are not output.
30970
30971 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30972
30973 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
30974
30975
30976 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30977 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
30978 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
30979
30980
30981 @ignore
30982 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
30983 @findex -symbol-info-address
30984
30985 @subsubheading Synopsis
30986
30987 @smallexample
30988 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
30989 @end smallexample
30990
30991 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
30992
30993 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30994
30995 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
30996
30997 @subsubheading Example
30998 N.A.
30999
31000
31001 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31002 @findex -symbol-info-file
31003
31004 @subsubheading Synopsis
31005
31006 @smallexample
31007 -symbol-info-file
31008 @end smallexample
31009
31010 Show the file for the symbol.
31011
31012 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31013
31014 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
31015 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
31016
31017 @subsubheading Example
31018 N.A.
31019
31020
31021 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31022 @findex -symbol-info-function
31023
31024 @subsubheading Synopsis
31025
31026 @smallexample
31027 -symbol-info-function
31028 @end smallexample
31029
31030 Show which function the symbol lives in.
31031
31032 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31033
31034 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31035
31036 @subsubheading Example
31037 N.A.
31038
31039
31040 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31041 @findex -symbol-info-line
31042
31043 @subsubheading Synopsis
31044
31045 @smallexample
31046 -symbol-info-line
31047 @end smallexample
31048
31049 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31050
31051 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31052
31053 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31054 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31055
31056 @subsubheading Example
31057 N.A.
31058
31059
31060 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31061 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
31062
31063 @subsubheading Synopsis
31064
31065 @smallexample
31066 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31067 @end smallexample
31068
31069 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31070
31071 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31072
31073 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31074
31075 @subsubheading Example
31076 N.A.
31077
31078
31079 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31080 @findex -symbol-list-functions
31081
31082 @subsubheading Synopsis
31083
31084 @smallexample
31085 -symbol-list-functions
31086 @end smallexample
31087
31088 List the functions in the executable.
31089
31090 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31091
31092 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31093 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31094
31095 @subsubheading Example
31096 N.A.
31097 @end ignore
31098
31099
31100 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31101 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31102
31103 @subsubheading Synopsis
31104
31105 @smallexample
31106 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31107 @end smallexample
31108
31109 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31110 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31111 ascending PC order.
31112
31113 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31114
31115 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31116
31117 @subsubheading Example
31118 @smallexample
31119 (gdb)
31120 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
31121 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31122 (gdb)
31123 @end smallexample
31124
31125
31126 @ignore
31127 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31128 @findex -symbol-list-types
31129
31130 @subsubheading Synopsis
31131
31132 @smallexample
31133 -symbol-list-types
31134 @end smallexample
31135
31136 List all the type names.
31137
31138 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31139
31140 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31141 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31142
31143 @subsubheading Example
31144 N.A.
31145
31146
31147 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31148 @findex -symbol-list-variables
31149
31150 @subsubheading Synopsis
31151
31152 @smallexample
31153 -symbol-list-variables
31154 @end smallexample
31155
31156 List all the global and static variable names.
31157
31158 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31159
31160 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31161
31162 @subsubheading Example
31163 N.A.
31164
31165
31166 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31167 @findex -symbol-locate
31168
31169 @subsubheading Synopsis
31170
31171 @smallexample
31172 -symbol-locate
31173 @end smallexample
31174
31175 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31176
31177 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31178
31179 @subsubheading Example
31180 N.A.
31181
31182
31183 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31184 @findex -symbol-type
31185
31186 @subsubheading Synopsis
31187
31188 @smallexample
31189 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31190 @end smallexample
31191
31192 Show type of @var{variable}.
31193
31194 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31195
31196 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31197 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31198
31199 @subsubheading Example
31200 N.A.
31201 @end ignore
31202
31203
31204 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31205 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31206 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31207
31208 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31209 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31210
31211 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31212 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31213
31214 @subsubheading Synopsis
31215
31216 @smallexample
31217 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31218 @end smallexample
31219
31220 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31221 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31222 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31223 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31224 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31225 notification.
31226
31227 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31228
31229 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31230
31231 @subsubheading Example
31232
31233 @smallexample
31234 (gdb)
31235 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31236 ^done
31237 (gdb)
31238 @end smallexample
31239
31240
31241 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31242 @findex -file-exec-file
31243
31244 @subsubheading Synopsis
31245
31246 @smallexample
31247 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31248 @end smallexample
31249
31250 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31251 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31252 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31253 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31254 notification.
31255
31256 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31257
31258 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31259
31260 @subsubheading Example
31261
31262 @smallexample
31263 (gdb)
31264 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31265 ^done
31266 (gdb)
31267 @end smallexample
31268
31269
31270 @ignore
31271 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31272 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31273
31274 @subsubheading Synopsis
31275
31276 @smallexample
31277 -file-list-exec-sections
31278 @end smallexample
31279
31280 List the sections of the current executable file.
31281
31282 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31283
31284 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31285 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31286 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31287
31288 @subsubheading Example
31289 N.A.
31290 @end ignore
31291
31292
31293 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31294 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31295
31296 @subsubheading Synopsis
31297
31298 @smallexample
31299 -file-list-exec-source-file
31300 @end smallexample
31301
31302 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31303 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31304 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31305 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31306
31307 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31308
31309 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31310
31311 @subsubheading Example
31312
31313 @smallexample
31314 (gdb)
31315 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31316 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31317 (gdb)
31318 @end smallexample
31319
31320
31321 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31322 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31323
31324 @subsubheading Synopsis
31325
31326 @smallexample
31327 -file-list-exec-source-files
31328 @end smallexample
31329
31330 List the source files for the current executable.
31331
31332 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31333 name) of a source file.
31334
31335 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31336
31337 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31338 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31339
31340 @subsubheading Example
31341 @smallexample
31342 (gdb)
31343 -file-list-exec-source-files
31344 ^done,files=[
31345 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31346 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31347 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31348 (gdb)
31349 @end smallexample
31350
31351 @ignore
31352 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31353 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31354
31355 @subsubheading Synopsis
31356
31357 @smallexample
31358 -file-list-shared-libraries
31359 @end smallexample
31360
31361 List the shared libraries in the program.
31362
31363 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31364
31365 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
31366
31367 @subsubheading Example
31368 N.A.
31369
31370
31371 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31372 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31373
31374 @subsubheading Synopsis
31375
31376 @smallexample
31377 -file-list-symbol-files
31378 @end smallexample
31379
31380 List symbol files.
31381
31382 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31383
31384 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31385
31386 @subsubheading Example
31387 N.A.
31388 @end ignore
31389
31390
31391 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31392 @findex -file-symbol-file
31393
31394 @subsubheading Synopsis
31395
31396 @smallexample
31397 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31398 @end smallexample
31399
31400 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31401 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31402 produced, except for a completion notification.
31403
31404 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31405
31406 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31407
31408 @subsubheading Example
31409
31410 @smallexample
31411 (gdb)
31412 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31413 ^done
31414 (gdb)
31415 @end smallexample
31416
31417 @ignore
31418 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31419 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31420 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31421
31422 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31423
31424 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31425
31426 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31427
31428 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31429
31430 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31431
31432 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31433
31434 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31435
31436 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31437
31438 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31439 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31440 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31441
31442 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31443
31444 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31445
31446 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31447
31448 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31449 @end ignore
31450
31451
31452 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31453 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31454 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31455
31456
31457 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31458 @findex -target-attach
31459
31460 @subsubheading Synopsis
31461
31462 @smallexample
31463 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31464 @end smallexample
31465
31466 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31467 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31468 group, the id previously returned by
31469 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31470
31471 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31472
31473 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31474
31475 @subsubheading Example
31476 @smallexample
31477 (gdb)
31478 -target-attach 34
31479 =thread-created,id="1"
31480 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31481 ^done
31482 (gdb)
31483 @end smallexample
31484
31485 @ignore
31486 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31487 @findex -target-compare-sections
31488
31489 @subsubheading Synopsis
31490
31491 @smallexample
31492 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31493 @end smallexample
31494
31495 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31496 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31497
31498 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31499
31500 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31501
31502 @subsubheading Example
31503 N.A.
31504 @end ignore
31505
31506
31507 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31508 @findex -target-detach
31509
31510 @subsubheading Synopsis
31511
31512 @smallexample
31513 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31514 @end smallexample
31515
31516 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31517 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31518 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31519
31520 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31521
31522 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31523
31524 @subsubheading Example
31525
31526 @smallexample
31527 (gdb)
31528 -target-detach
31529 ^done
31530 (gdb)
31531 @end smallexample
31532
31533
31534 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31535 @findex -target-disconnect
31536
31537 @subsubheading Synopsis
31538
31539 @smallexample
31540 -target-disconnect
31541 @end smallexample
31542
31543 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31544 generally not resumed.
31545
31546 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31547
31548 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31549
31550 @subsubheading Example
31551
31552 @smallexample
31553 (gdb)
31554 -target-disconnect
31555 ^done
31556 (gdb)
31557 @end smallexample
31558
31559
31560 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31561 @findex -target-download
31562
31563 @subsubheading Synopsis
31564
31565 @smallexample
31566 -target-download
31567 @end smallexample
31568
31569 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31570 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31571
31572 @table @samp
31573 @item section
31574 The name of the section.
31575 @item section-sent
31576 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31577 @item section-size
31578 The size of the section.
31579 @item total-sent
31580 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31581 @item total-size
31582 The size of the overall executable to download.
31583 @end table
31584
31585 @noindent
31586 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31587 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31588
31589 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31590 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31591
31592 @table @samp
31593 @item section
31594 The name of the section.
31595 @item section-size
31596 The size of the section.
31597 @item total-size
31598 The size of the overall executable to download.
31599 @end table
31600
31601 @noindent
31602 At the end, a summary is printed.
31603
31604 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31605
31606 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31607
31608 @subsubheading Example
31609
31610 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31611 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31612
31613 @smallexample
31614 (gdb)
31615 -target-download
31616 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31617 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31618 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31619 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31620 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31621 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31622 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31623 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31624 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31625 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31626 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31627 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31628 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31629 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31630 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31631 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31632 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31633 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31634 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31635 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31636 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31637 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31638 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31639 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31640 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31641 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31642 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31643 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31644 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31645 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31646 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31647 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31648 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31649 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31650 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31651 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31652 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31653 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31654 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31655 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31656 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31657 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31658 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31659 write-rate="429"
31660 (gdb)
31661 @end smallexample
31662
31663
31664 @ignore
31665 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31666 @findex -target-exec-status
31667
31668 @subsubheading Synopsis
31669
31670 @smallexample
31671 -target-exec-status
31672 @end smallexample
31673
31674 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31675 not, for instance).
31676
31677 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31678
31679 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31680
31681 @subsubheading Example
31682 N.A.
31683
31684
31685 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31686 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31687
31688 @subsubheading Synopsis
31689
31690 @smallexample
31691 -target-list-available-targets
31692 @end smallexample
31693
31694 List the possible targets to connect to.
31695
31696 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31697
31698 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31699
31700 @subsubheading Example
31701 N.A.
31702
31703
31704 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31705 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31706
31707 @subsubheading Synopsis
31708
31709 @smallexample
31710 -target-list-current-targets
31711 @end smallexample
31712
31713 Describe the current target.
31714
31715 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31716
31717 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31718 other things).
31719
31720 @subsubheading Example
31721 N.A.
31722
31723
31724 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31725 @findex -target-list-parameters
31726
31727 @subsubheading Synopsis
31728
31729 @smallexample
31730 -target-list-parameters
31731 @end smallexample
31732
31733 @c ????
31734 @end ignore
31735
31736 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31737
31738 No equivalent.
31739
31740 @subsubheading Example
31741 N.A.
31742
31743
31744 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31745 @findex -target-select
31746
31747 @subsubheading Synopsis
31748
31749 @smallexample
31750 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31751 @end smallexample
31752
31753 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31754
31755 @table @samp
31756 @item @var{type}
31757 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31758 @item @var{parameters}
31759 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31760 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31761 @end table
31762
31763 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31764 which the target program is, in the following form:
31765
31766 @smallexample
31767 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31768 args=[@var{arg list}]
31769 @end smallexample
31770
31771 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31772
31773 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31774
31775 @subsubheading Example
31776
31777 @smallexample
31778 (gdb)
31779 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31780 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31781 (gdb)
31782 @end smallexample
31783
31784 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31785 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31786 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31787
31788
31789 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31790 @findex -target-file-put
31791
31792 @subsubheading Synopsis
31793
31794 @smallexample
31795 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31796 @end smallexample
31797
31798 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31799 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31800
31801 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31802
31803 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31804
31805 @subsubheading Example
31806
31807 @smallexample
31808 (gdb)
31809 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31810 ^done
31811 (gdb)
31812 @end smallexample
31813
31814
31815 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31816 @findex -target-file-get
31817
31818 @subsubheading Synopsis
31819
31820 @smallexample
31821 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31822 @end smallexample
31823
31824 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31825 on the host system.
31826
31827 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31828
31829 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31830
31831 @subsubheading Example
31832
31833 @smallexample
31834 (gdb)
31835 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31836 ^done
31837 (gdb)
31838 @end smallexample
31839
31840
31841 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31842 @findex -target-file-delete
31843
31844 @subsubheading Synopsis
31845
31846 @smallexample
31847 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31848 @end smallexample
31849
31850 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31851
31852 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31853
31854 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31855
31856 @subsubheading Example
31857
31858 @smallexample
31859 (gdb)
31860 -target-file-delete remotefile
31861 ^done
31862 (gdb)
31863 @end smallexample
31864
31865
31866 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31867 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31868 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31869
31870 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31871 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31872
31873 @subsubheading Synopsis
31874
31875 @smallexample
31876 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31877 @end smallexample
31878
31879 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31880 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31881 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31882
31883 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31884
31885 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31886
31887 @subsubheading Result
31888
31889 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
31890 defined for each exception:
31891
31892 @table @samp
31893 @item name
31894 The name of the exception.
31895
31896 @item address
31897 The address of the exception.
31898
31899 @end table
31900
31901 @subsubheading Example
31902
31903 @smallexample
31904 -info-ada-exceptions aint
31905 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31906 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31907 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31908 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31909 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31910 @end smallexample
31911
31912 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
31913
31914 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
31915 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
31916 Catchpoint Commands}.
31917
31918
31919 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31920 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
31921 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
31922
31923 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
31924 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
31925 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
31926 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
31927
31928 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
31929 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
31930 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
31931
31932 @subsubheading Synopsis
31933
31934 @smallexample
31935 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
31936 @end smallexample
31937
31938 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
31939
31940 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
31941 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
31942 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
31943 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
31944 dash.
31945
31946 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31947
31948 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31949
31950 @subsubheading Result
31951
31952 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
31953
31954 @table @samp
31955 @item exists
31956 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
31957 @code{"false"} otherwise.
31958
31959 @end table
31960
31961 @subsubheading Example
31962
31963 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
31964
31965 @smallexample
31966 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
31967 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
31968 @end smallexample
31969
31970 @noindent
31971 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
31972 to the debugger:
31973
31974 @smallexample
31975 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
31976 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
31977 @end smallexample
31978
31979 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31980 @findex -list-features
31981 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
31982
31983 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31984 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31985 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31986 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31987 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31988 startup.
31989
31990 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31991 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31992 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31993 is given below.
31994
31995 Example output:
31996
31997 @smallexample
31998 (gdb) -list-features
31999 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32000 @end smallexample
32001
32002 The current list of features is:
32003
32004 @ftable @samp
32005 @item frozen-varobjs
32006 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32007 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32008 of @code{-varobj-create}.
32009 @item pending-breakpoints
32010 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32011 command.
32012 @item python
32013 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32014 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32015 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32016 @item thread-info
32017 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32018 @item data-read-memory-bytes
32019 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32020 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32021 @item breakpoint-notifications
32022 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32023 CLI will be announced via async records.
32024 @item ada-task-info
32025 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32026 @item language-option
32027 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
32028 option (@pxref{Context management}).
32029 @item info-gdb-mi-command
32030 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
32031 @item undefined-command-error-code
32032 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
32033 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
32034 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
32035 @item exec-run-start-option
32036 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
32037 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
32038 @end ftable
32039
32040 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32041 @findex -list-target-features
32042
32043 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32044 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32045 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32046 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
32047 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32048 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32049 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32050 Example output:
32051
32052 @smallexample
32053 (gdb) -list-target-features
32054 ^done,result=["async"]
32055 @end smallexample
32056
32057 The current list of features is:
32058
32059 @table @samp
32060 @item async
32061 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32062 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32063 while the target is running.
32064
32065 @item reverse
32066 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32067 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32068
32069 @end table
32070
32071 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32072 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32073 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32074
32075 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
32076
32077 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32078 @findex -gdb-exit
32079
32080 @subsubheading Synopsis
32081
32082 @smallexample
32083 -gdb-exit
32084 @end smallexample
32085
32086 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32087
32088 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32089
32090 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32091
32092 @subsubheading Example
32093
32094 @smallexample
32095 (gdb)
32096 -gdb-exit
32097 ^exit
32098 @end smallexample
32099
32100
32101 @ignore
32102 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32103 @findex -exec-abort
32104
32105 @subsubheading Synopsis
32106
32107 @smallexample
32108 -exec-abort
32109 @end smallexample
32110
32111 Kill the inferior running program.
32112
32113 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32114
32115 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32116
32117 @subsubheading Example
32118 N.A.
32119 @end ignore
32120
32121
32122 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32123 @findex -gdb-set
32124
32125 @subsubheading Synopsis
32126
32127 @smallexample
32128 -gdb-set
32129 @end smallexample
32130
32131 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32132 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32133
32134 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32135
32136 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32137
32138 @subsubheading Example
32139
32140 @smallexample
32141 (gdb)
32142 -gdb-set $foo=3
32143 ^done
32144 (gdb)
32145 @end smallexample
32146
32147
32148 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32149 @findex -gdb-show
32150
32151 @subsubheading Synopsis
32152
32153 @smallexample
32154 -gdb-show
32155 @end smallexample
32156
32157 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32158
32159 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32160
32161 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32162
32163 @subsubheading Example
32164
32165 @smallexample
32166 (gdb)
32167 -gdb-show annotate
32168 ^done,value="0"
32169 (gdb)
32170 @end smallexample
32171
32172 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32173
32174
32175 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32176 @findex -gdb-version
32177
32178 @subsubheading Synopsis
32179
32180 @smallexample
32181 -gdb-version
32182 @end smallexample
32183
32184 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32185
32186 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32187
32188 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32189 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32190
32191 @subsubheading Example
32192
32193 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32194 @c box in TeX.
32195 @smallexample
32196 (gdb)
32197 -gdb-version
32198 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32199 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32200 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32201 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32202 ~ certain conditions.
32203 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32204 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32205 ~ details.
32206 ~This GDB was configured as
32207 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32208 ^done
32209 (gdb)
32210 @end smallexample
32211
32212 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32213 @findex -list-thread-groups
32214
32215 @subheading Synopsis
32216
32217 @smallexample
32218 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32219 @end smallexample
32220
32221 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32222 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32223 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32224 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32225 top-level thread groups.
32226
32227 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32228 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32229 available on the target.
32230
32231 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32232 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32233 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32234 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32235 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32236 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32237 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32238 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32239
32240 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32241 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32242 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32243 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32244 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32245 @samp{threads} field.
32246
32247 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32248 the following caveats:
32249
32250 @itemize @bullet
32251 @item
32252 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32253 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32254 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32255
32256 @item
32257 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32258 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32259 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32260 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32261 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32262 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32263
32264 @end itemize
32265
32266 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32267 have the following fields:
32268
32269 @table @code
32270 @item id
32271 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32272 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32273 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32274
32275 @item type
32276 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32277 valid type.
32278
32279 @item pid
32280 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32281 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32282
32283 @item exit-code
32284 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32285 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32286 only if the process is not running.
32287
32288 @item num_children
32289 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32290 absent for an available thread group.
32291
32292 @item threads
32293 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32294 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32295 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32296
32297 @item cores
32298 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32299 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32300 such information is not available.
32301
32302 @item executable
32303 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32304 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32305 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32306
32307 @end table
32308
32309 @subheading Example
32310
32311 @smallexample
32312 @value{GDBP}
32313 -list-thread-groups
32314 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32315 -list-thread-groups 17
32316 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32317 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32318 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32319 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32320 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32321 -list-thread-groups --available
32322 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32323 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32324 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32325 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32326 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32327 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32328 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32329 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32330 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32331 @end smallexample
32332
32333 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32334 @findex -info-os
32335
32336 @subsubheading Synopsis
32337
32338 @smallexample
32339 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32340 @end smallexample
32341
32342 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32343 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32344 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32345 of data of that type.
32346
32347 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32348 system.
32349
32350 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32351
32352 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32353
32354 @subsubheading Example
32355
32356 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32357 like this:
32358
32359 @smallexample
32360 @value{GDBP}
32361 -info-os
32362 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32363 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32364 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32365 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32366 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32367 col2="CPUs"@},
32368 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32369 col2="File descriptors"@},
32370 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32371 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32372 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32373 col2="Message queues"@},
32374 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32375 col2="Processes"@},
32376 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32377 col2="Process groups"@},
32378 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32379 col2="Semaphores"@},
32380 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32381 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32382 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32383 col2="Sockets"@},
32384 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32385 col2="Threads"@}]
32386 @value{GDBP}
32387 -info-os processes
32388 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32389 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32390 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32391 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32392 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32393 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32394 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32395 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32396 ...
32397 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32398 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32399 (gdb)
32400 @end smallexample
32401
32402 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32403 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32404 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32405 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32406 @code{info os} omits it.)
32407
32408 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32409 @findex -add-inferior
32410
32411 @subheading Synopsis
32412
32413 @smallexample
32414 -add-inferior
32415 @end smallexample
32416
32417 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32418 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32419 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32420 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32421 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32422 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32423
32424 @subheading Example
32425
32426 @smallexample
32427 @value{GDBP}
32428 -add-inferior
32429 ^done,inferior="i3"
32430 @end smallexample
32431
32432 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32433 @findex -interpreter-exec
32434
32435 @subheading Synopsis
32436
32437 @smallexample
32438 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32439 @end smallexample
32440 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32441
32442 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32443
32444 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32445
32446 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32447
32448 @subheading Example
32449
32450 @smallexample
32451 (gdb)
32452 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32453 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32454 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32455 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32456 ^done
32457 (gdb)
32458 @end smallexample
32459
32460 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32461 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32462
32463 @subheading Synopsis
32464
32465 @smallexample
32466 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32467 @end smallexample
32468
32469 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32470
32471 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32472
32473 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32474
32475 @subheading Example
32476
32477 @smallexample
32478 (gdb)
32479 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32480 ^done
32481 (gdb)
32482 @end smallexample
32483
32484 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32485 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32486
32487 @subheading Synopsis
32488
32489 @smallexample
32490 -inferior-tty-show
32491 @end smallexample
32492
32493 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32494
32495 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32496
32497 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32498
32499 @subheading Example
32500
32501 @smallexample
32502 (gdb)
32503 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32504 ^done
32505 (gdb)
32506 -inferior-tty-show
32507 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32508 (gdb)
32509 @end smallexample
32510
32511 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32512 @findex -enable-timings
32513
32514 @subheading Synopsis
32515
32516 @smallexample
32517 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32518 @end smallexample
32519
32520 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32521 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32522 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32523 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32524
32525 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32526
32527 No equivalent.
32528
32529 @subheading Example
32530
32531 @smallexample
32532 (gdb)
32533 -enable-timings
32534 ^done
32535 (gdb)
32536 -break-insert main
32537 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32538 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32539 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32540 times="0"@},
32541 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32542 (gdb)
32543 -enable-timings no
32544 ^done
32545 (gdb)
32546 -exec-run
32547 ^running
32548 (gdb)
32549 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32550 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32551 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32552 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32553 (gdb)
32554 @end smallexample
32555
32556 @node Annotations
32557 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32558
32559 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32560 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32561 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32562 relatively high level.
32563
32564 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32565 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32566
32567 @ignore
32568 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32569 @end ignore
32570
32571 @menu
32572 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32573 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32574 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32575 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32576 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32577 * Annotations for Running::
32578 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32579 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32580 @end menu
32581
32582 @node Annotations Overview
32583 @section What is an Annotation?
32584 @cindex annotations
32585
32586 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32587 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32588 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32589 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32590 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32591 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32592 cannot contain newline characters.
32593
32594 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32595 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32596 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32597 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32598 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32599 means those three characters as output.
32600
32601 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32602 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32603 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32604 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32605 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32606 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32607 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32608 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32609 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32610
32611 @table @code
32612 @kindex set annotate
32613 @item set annotate @var{level}
32614 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32615 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32616
32617 @item show annotate
32618 @kindex show annotate
32619 Show the current annotation level.
32620 @end table
32621
32622 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32623
32624 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32625
32626 @smallexample
32627 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32628 GNU gdb 6.0
32629 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32630 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32631 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32632 under certain conditions.
32633 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32634 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32635 for details.
32636 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32637
32638 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32639 (@value{GDBP})
32640 ^Z^Zprompt
32641 @kbd{quit}
32642
32643 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32644 $
32645 @end smallexample
32646
32647 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32648 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32649 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32650 output from @value{GDBN}.
32651
32652 @node Server Prefix
32653 @section The Server Prefix
32654 @cindex server prefix
32655
32656 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32657 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32658 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32659 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32660 a transparent manner.
32661
32662 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32663 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32664 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32665 @code{print} command.
32666
32667 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32668 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32669
32670 @node Prompting
32671 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32672
32673 @cindex annotations for prompts
32674 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32675 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32676 over, etc.
32677
32678 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32679 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32680 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32681 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32682 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32683 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32684 features the following annotations:
32685
32686 @smallexample
32687 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32688 ^Z^Zprompt
32689 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32690 @end smallexample
32691
32692 The input types are
32693
32694 @table @code
32695 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32696 @findex prompt annotation
32697 @findex post-prompt annotation
32698 @item prompt
32699 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32700
32701 @findex pre-commands annotation
32702 @findex commands annotation
32703 @findex post-commands annotation
32704 @item commands
32705 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32706 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32707
32708 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32709 @findex overload-choice annotation
32710 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32711 @item overload-choice
32712 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32713
32714 @findex pre-query annotation
32715 @findex query annotation
32716 @findex post-query annotation
32717 @item query
32718 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32719
32720 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32721 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32722 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32723 @item prompt-for-continue
32724 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32725 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32726 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32727 presence of annotations.
32728 @end table
32729
32730 @node Errors
32731 @section Errors
32732 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32733
32734 @findex quit annotation
32735 @smallexample
32736 ^Z^Zquit
32737 @end smallexample
32738
32739 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32740
32741 @findex error annotation
32742 @smallexample
32743 ^Z^Zerror
32744 @end smallexample
32745
32746 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32747
32748 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32749 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32750 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32751 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32752 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32753 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32754 to the top level.
32755
32756 @findex error-begin annotation
32757 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32758
32759 @smallexample
32760 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32761 @end smallexample
32762
32763 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32764 message.
32765
32766 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32767 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32768 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32769
32770 @node Invalidation
32771 @section Invalidation Notices
32772
32773 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32774 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32775 changed.
32776
32777 @table @code
32778 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32779 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32780
32781 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32782 have changed.
32783
32784 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32785 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32786
32787 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32788 deleted a breakpoint.
32789 @end table
32790
32791 @node Annotations for Running
32792 @section Running the Program
32793 @cindex annotations for running programs
32794
32795 @findex starting annotation
32796 @findex stopping annotation
32797 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32798 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32799
32800 @smallexample
32801 ^Z^Zstarting
32802 @end smallexample
32803
32804 is output. When the program stops,
32805
32806 @smallexample
32807 ^Z^Zstopped
32808 @end smallexample
32809
32810 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32811 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32812
32813 @table @code
32814 @findex exited annotation
32815 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32816 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32817 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32818
32819 @findex signalled annotation
32820 @findex signal-name annotation
32821 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32822 @findex signal-string annotation
32823 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32824 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32825 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32826 annotation continues:
32827
32828 @smallexample
32829 @var{intro-text}
32830 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32831 @var{name}
32832 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32833 @var{middle-text}
32834 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32835 @var{string}
32836 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32837 @var{end-text}
32838 @end smallexample
32839
32840 @noindent
32841 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32842 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32843 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32844 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32845 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32846
32847 @findex signal annotation
32848 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32849 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32850 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32851 terminated with it.
32852
32853 @findex breakpoint annotation
32854 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32855 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32856
32857 @findex watchpoint annotation
32858 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32859 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32860 @end table
32861
32862 @node Source Annotations
32863 @section Displaying Source
32864 @cindex annotations for source display
32865
32866 @findex source annotation
32867 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32868
32869 @smallexample
32870 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32871 @end smallexample
32872
32873 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32874 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32875 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32876 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32877 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32878 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32879 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32880 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32881 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32882 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32883 depend on the language).
32884
32885 @node JIT Interface
32886 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32887 @cindex just-in-time compilation
32888 @cindex JIT compilation interface
32889
32890 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32891 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32892 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32893 performance while maintaining platform independence.
32894
32895 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32896 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32897 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32898 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32899 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32900 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32901
32902 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32903 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
32904 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32905 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32906 LLVM JIT.
32907
32908 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
32909 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32910 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
32911 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32912 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
32913 out about additional code.
32914
32915 @menu
32916 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
32917 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
32918 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
32919 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
32920 @end menu
32921
32922 @node Declarations
32923 @section JIT Declarations
32924
32925 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
32926 implement the interface:
32927
32928 @smallexample
32929 typedef enum
32930 @{
32931 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
32932 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
32933 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
32934 @} jit_actions_t;
32935
32936 struct jit_code_entry
32937 @{
32938 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
32939 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
32940 const char *symfile_addr;
32941 uint64_t symfile_size;
32942 @};
32943
32944 struct jit_descriptor
32945 @{
32946 uint32_t version;
32947 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
32948 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
32949 uint32_t action_flag;
32950 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
32951 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
32952 @};
32953
32954 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
32955 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
32956
32957 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
32958 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
32959 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
32960 @end smallexample
32961
32962 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
32963 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
32964 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
32965
32966 @node Registering Code
32967 @section Registering Code
32968
32969 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
32970
32971 @itemize @bullet
32972 @item
32973 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
32974 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
32975
32976 @item
32977 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
32978 file.
32979
32980 @item
32981 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
32982
32983 @item
32984 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
32985
32986 @item
32987 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
32988 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32989 @end itemize
32990
32991 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
32992 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
32993 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
32994 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
32995
32996 @node Unregistering Code
32997 @section Unregistering Code
32998
32999 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33000
33001 @itemize @bullet
33002 @item
33003 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33004
33005 @item
33006 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33007
33008 @item
33009 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33010 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33011 @end itemize
33012
33013 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33014 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33015
33016 @node Custom Debug Info
33017 @section Custom Debug Info
33018 @cindex custom JIT debug info
33019 @cindex JIT debug info reader
33020
33021 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33022 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33023 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
33024 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33025 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33026 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
33027 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
33028 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33029 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33030
33031 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33032 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33033 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33034 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33035 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
33036 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33037 compiler.
33038
33039 @menu
33040 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
33041 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
33042 @end menu
33043
33044 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33045 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33046 @kindex jit-reader-load
33047 @kindex jit-reader-unload
33048
33049 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33050 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33051
33052 @table @code
33053 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33054 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33055 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
33056 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33057 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33058 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33059 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
33060
33061 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33062 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33063 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33064 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33065 @code{jit-reader-load}.
33066
33067 @item jit-reader-unload
33068 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33069
33070 @end table
33071
33072 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33073 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33074 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33075
33076 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33077 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33078
33079 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33080 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
33081 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33082 the system include directory.
33083
33084 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
33085 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33086 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33087
33088 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33089 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33090
33091 @findex gdb_init_reader
33092 @smallexample
33093 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33094 @end smallexample
33095
33096 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33097
33098 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33099 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33100 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33101 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33102 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33103 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33104
33105 @smallexample
33106 struct gdb_reader_funcs
33107 @{
33108 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33109 int reader_version;
33110
33111 /* For use by the reader. */
33112 void *priv_data;
33113
33114 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33115 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33116 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33117 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33118 @};
33119 @end smallexample
33120
33121 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33122 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33123
33124 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33125 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33126 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33127 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33128 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33129 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33130 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33131 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33132 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33133 target's address space.
33134
33135 @node In-Process Agent
33136 @chapter In-Process Agent
33137 @cindex debugging agent
33138 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33139 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33140 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33141 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33142 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33143 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33144 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33145 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33146 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33147 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33148 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33149 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33150 behavior without interrupting it.
33151
33152 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33153 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33154 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33155 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33156 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33157 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33158 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33159 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33160 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33161
33162 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33163 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33164 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33165 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33166
33167 @anchor{Control Agent}
33168 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33169 debugging with the following commands:
33170
33171 @table @code
33172 @kindex set agent on
33173 @item set agent on
33174 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33175 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33176 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33177 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33178 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33179 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33180
33181 @kindex set agent off
33182 @item set agent off
33183 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33184 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33185
33186 @kindex show agent
33187 @item show agent
33188 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33189 the in-process agent.
33190 @end table
33191
33192 @menu
33193 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33194 @end menu
33195
33196 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33197 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33198 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33199
33200 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33201 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33202 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33203 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33204 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33205 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33206 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33207 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33208 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33209
33210 @menu
33211 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33212 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33213 @end menu
33214
33215 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33216 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33217 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33218
33219 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33220 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33221
33222 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33223 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33224 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33225 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33226
33227 @enumerate
33228 @item
33229 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33230 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33231 @item
33232 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33233 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33234 the other one.
33235 @end enumerate
33236
33237 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33238
33239 @enumerate
33240 @item
33241 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33242 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33243 @anchor{agent expression object}
33244 @item
33245 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33246 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33247 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33248 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33249 @item
33250 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33251 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33252
33253 @end enumerate
33254
33255 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33256 object:
33257
33258 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33259 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33260 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33261 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33262 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33263 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33264 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33265 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33266 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33267 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33268 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33269 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33270 memory address for collecting.
33271 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33272 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33273 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33274 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33275 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33276 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33277 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33278 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33279 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33280 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33281 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33282 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33283 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33284 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33285 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33286 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33287 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33288 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33289 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33290 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33291 @ref{agent expression object}
33292 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33293 @ref{agent expression object}
33294 @item actions @tab variable
33295 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33296 @end multitable
33297
33298 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33299 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33300 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33301
33302 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33303 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33304
33305 @table @samp
33306
33307 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33308 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33309 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33310 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33311 in IPA finally.
33312
33313 Replies:
33314 @table @samp
33315 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33316 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33317 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33318 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33319 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33320 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33321 @item E @var{NN}
33322 for an error
33323
33324 @end table
33325
33326 @item close
33327 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33328 is about to kill inferiors.
33329
33330 @item qTfSTM
33331 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33332 @item qTsSTM
33333 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33334 @item qTSTMat
33335 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33336 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33337 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33338
33339 Replies:
33340 @table @samp
33341 @item E @var{NN}
33342 for an error
33343 @end table
33344 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33345 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33346 @end table
33347
33348 @node GDB Bugs
33349 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33350 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33351 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33352
33353 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33354
33355 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33356 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33357 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33358 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33359
33360 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33361 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33362
33363 @menu
33364 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33365 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33366 @end menu
33367
33368 @node Bug Criteria
33369 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33370 @cindex bug criteria
33371
33372 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33373
33374 @itemize @bullet
33375 @cindex fatal signal
33376 @cindex debugger crash
33377 @cindex crash of debugger
33378 @item
33379 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33380 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33381
33382 @cindex error on valid input
33383 @item
33384 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33385 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33386 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33387
33388 @cindex invalid input
33389 @item
33390 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33391 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33392 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33393 for traditional practice''.
33394
33395 @item
33396 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33397 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33398 @end itemize
33399
33400 @node Bug Reporting
33401 @section How to Report Bugs
33402 @cindex bug reports
33403 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33404
33405 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33406 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33407 contact that organization first.
33408
33409 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33410 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33411 distribution.
33412 @c should add a web page ref...
33413
33414 @ifset BUGURL
33415 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33416 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33417 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33418 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33419 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33420 be used.
33421
33422 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33423 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33424 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33425 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33426
33427 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33428 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33429 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33430 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33431 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33432 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33433 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33434 bug reports to the mailing list.
33435 @end ifset
33436 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33437 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33438 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33439 @end ifclear
33440 @end ifset
33441
33442 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33443 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33444 fact or leave it out, state it!
33445
33446 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33447 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33448 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33449 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33450 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33451 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33452 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33453 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33454 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33455
33456 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33457 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33458 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33459 self-contained.
33460
33461 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33462 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33463 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33464 bugs properly.
33465
33466 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33467
33468 @itemize @bullet
33469 @item
33470 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33471 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33472 version}.
33473
33474 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33475 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33476
33477 @item
33478 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33479 version number.
33480
33481 @item
33482 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33483 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33484 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33485 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33486
33487 @item
33488 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33489 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33490
33491 @item
33492 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33493 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33494 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33495 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33496 those compilers.
33497
33498 @item
33499 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33500 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33501 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33502 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33503
33504 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33505 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33506
33507 @item
33508 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33509 reproduce the bug.
33510
33511 @item
33512 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33513 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33514
33515 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33516 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33517 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33518 a chance to make a mistake.
33519
33520 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33521 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33522 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33523 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33524 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33525 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33526 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33527 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33528
33529 @pindex script
33530 @cindex recording a session script
33531 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33532 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33533 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33534 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33535
33536 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33537 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33538
33539 @item
33540 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33541 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33542 it by context, not by line number.
33543
33544 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33545 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33546
33547 @end itemize
33548
33549 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33550
33551 @itemize @bullet
33552 @item
33553 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33554
33555 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33556 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33557 changes will not affect it.
33558
33559 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33560 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33561 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33562 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33563
33564 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33565 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33566 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33567 less time, and so on.
33568
33569 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33570 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33571
33572 @item
33573 A patch for the bug.
33574
33575 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33576 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33577 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33578 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33579
33580 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33581 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33582 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33583 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33584
33585 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33586 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33587 help us to understand.
33588
33589 @item
33590 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33591
33592 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33593 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33594 @end itemize
33595
33596 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33597 @c and consists of the two following files:
33598 @c rluser.texi
33599 @c hsuser.texi
33600 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33601 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33602 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33603 @include rluser.texi
33604 @include hsuser.texi
33605 @end ifclear
33606
33607 @node In Memoriam
33608 @appendix In Memoriam
33609
33610 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33611 contributors:
33612
33613 @table @code
33614 @item Fred Fish
33615 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33616 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33617 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33618
33619 @item Michael Snyder
33620 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33621 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33622 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33623 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33624 @end table
33625
33626 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33627 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33628
33629 @node Formatting Documentation
33630 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33631
33632 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33633 @cindex reference card
33634 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33635 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33636 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33637 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33638 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33639 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33640
33641 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33642 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33643
33644 @smallexample
33645 make refcard.dvi
33646 @end smallexample
33647
33648 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33649 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33650 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33651 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33652 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33653
33654 @cindex documentation
33655
33656 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33657 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33658 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33659 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33660 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33661 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33662
33663 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33664 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33665 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33666 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33667 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33668 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33669 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33670 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33671
33672 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33673 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33674 @code{makeinfo}.
33675
33676 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33677 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33678 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33679
33680 @smallexample
33681 cd gdb
33682 make gdb.info
33683 @end smallexample
33684
33685 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33686 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33687 Texinfo definitions file.
33688
33689 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33690 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33691 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33692 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33693 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33694 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33695 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33696
33697 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33698 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33699 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33700 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33701 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33702 directory.
33703
33704 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33705 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33706 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33707 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33708
33709 @smallexample
33710 make gdb.dvi
33711 @end smallexample
33712
33713 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33714
33715 @node Installing GDB
33716 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33717 @cindex installation
33718
33719 @menu
33720 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33721 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33722 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33723 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33724 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33725 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33726 @end menu
33727
33728 @node Requirements
33729 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33730 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33731
33732 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33733 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33734
33735 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33736 @table @asis
33737 @item ISO C90 compiler
33738 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33739 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33740
33741 @end table
33742
33743 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33744 @table @asis
33745 @item Expat
33746 @anchor{Expat}
33747 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33748 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33749 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33750 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33751 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33752 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33753
33754 Expat is used for:
33755
33756 @itemize @bullet
33757 @item
33758 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33759 @item
33760 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33761 @item
33762 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33763 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33764 @item
33765 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33766 @item
33767 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33768 @item
33769 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33770 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33771 @end itemize
33772
33773 @item zlib
33774 @cindex compressed debug sections
33775 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33776 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33777 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33778 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33779 information in such binaries.
33780
33781 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33782 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33783 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33784
33785 @item iconv
33786 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33787 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33788 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33789 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33790
33791 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33792 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33793 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33794 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33795
33796 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33797 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33798 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33799
33800 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33801 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33802 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33803 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33804 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33805 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33806 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33807 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33808 @end table
33809
33810 @node Running Configure
33811 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33812 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33813 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33814 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33815 build the @code{gdb} program.
33816 @iftex
33817 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33818 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33819 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33820 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33821 @end iftex
33822
33823 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33824 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33825 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33826
33827 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33828 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33829
33830 @table @code
33831 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33832 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33833
33834 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33835 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33836
33837 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33838 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33839
33840 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33841 @sc{gnu} include files
33842
33843 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33844 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33845
33846 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33847 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33848
33849 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33850 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33851
33852 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33853 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33854
33855 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33856 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33857 @end table
33858
33859 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33860 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33861 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33862
33863 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33864 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33865 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33866 argument.
33867
33868 For example:
33869
33870 @smallexample
33871 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33872 ./configure @var{host}
33873 make
33874 @end smallexample
33875
33876 @noindent
33877 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33878 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33879 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33880 correct value by examining your system.)
33881
33882 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33883 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33884 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33885 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33886
33887 @need 750
33888 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33889 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33890 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33891
33892 @smallexample
33893 sh configure @var{host}
33894 @end smallexample
33895
33896 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33897 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33898 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33899 @file{configure}
33900 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33901 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33902
33903 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33904 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
33905 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33906 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
33907 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33908 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33909 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33910 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
33911 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33912
33913 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
33914 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
33915 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
33916 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
33917 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
33918
33919 @node Separate Objdir
33920 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
33921
33922 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
33923 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
33924 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
33925 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
33926 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
33927 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
33928 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
33929 program specified there.
33930
33931 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
33932 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
33933 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
33934 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
33935 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
33936 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
33937
33938 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
33939 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
33940
33941 @smallexample
33942 @group
33943 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33944 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
33945 cd ../gdb-sun4
33946 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
33947 make
33948 @end group
33949 @end smallexample
33950
33951 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
33952 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
33953 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
33954 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
33955 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
33956 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
33957
33958 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
33959 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
33960 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
33961 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
33962 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33963
33964 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
33965 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
33966 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
33967 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
33968 You specify a cross-debugging target by
33969 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
33970
33971 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
33972 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
33973 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
33974
33975 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
33976 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
33977 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
33978 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
33979 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
33980
33981 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
33982 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
33983 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
33984 with each other.
33985
33986 @node Config Names
33987 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
33988
33989 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
33990 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
33991 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
33992 of information in the following pattern:
33993
33994 @smallexample
33995 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
33996 @end smallexample
33997
33998 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
33999 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34000 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34001
34002 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34003 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34004 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34005 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34006 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34007 abbreviations---for example:
34008
34009 @smallexample
34010 % sh config.sub i386-linux
34011 i386-pc-linux-gnu
34012 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
34013 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34014 % sh config.sub hp9k700
34015 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34016 % sh config.sub sun4
34017 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34018 % sh config.sub sun3
34019 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34020 % sh config.sub i986v
34021 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34022 @end smallexample
34023
34024 @noindent
34025 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34026 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34027
34028 @node Configure Options
34029 @section @file{configure} Options
34030
34031 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34032 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
34033 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
34034 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34035
34036 @smallexample
34037 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34038 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34039 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34040 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34041 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34042 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34043 @var{host}
34044 @end smallexample
34045
34046 @noindent
34047 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34048 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34049 @samp{--}.
34050
34051 @table @code
34052 @item --help
34053 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34054
34055 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
34056 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34057 @file{@var{dir}}.
34058
34059 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34060 Configure the source to install programs under directory
34061 @file{@var{dir}}.
34062
34063 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34064 @need 2000
34065 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34066 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34067 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34068 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34069 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
34070 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34071 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34072 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34073 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
34074 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34075 @var{dirname}.
34076
34077 @item --norecursion
34078 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34079 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34080
34081 @item --target=@var{target}
34082 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34083 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34084 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34085
34086 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34087
34088 @item @var{host} @dots{}
34089 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34090
34091 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34092 @end table
34093
34094 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34095 needed for special purposes only.
34096
34097 @node System-wide configuration
34098 @section System-wide configuration and settings
34099 @cindex system-wide init file
34100
34101 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34102 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34103 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34104
34105 Here is the corresponding configure option:
34106
34107 @table @code
34108 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34109 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34110 @var{file}.
34111 @end table
34112
34113 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34114 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34115
34116 @itemize @bullet
34117 @item
34118 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34119 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34120 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34121 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34122 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34123 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34124
34125 @item
34126 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34127 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34128 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34129 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34130 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34131 @end itemize
34132
34133 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34134 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34135 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34136 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34137 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34138 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34139 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34140 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34141 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34142 reread.
34143
34144 @menu
34145 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34146 @end menu
34147
34148 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34149 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34150 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34151
34152 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34153 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34154 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34155 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34156 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34157 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34158
34159 The following scripts are currently available:
34160 @itemize @bullet
34161
34162 @item @file{elinos.py}
34163 @pindex elinos.py
34164 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34165 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34166 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34167 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34168 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34169 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34170
34171 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34172 @pindex wrs-linux.py
34173 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34174 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34175 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34176 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34177
34178 @end itemize
34179
34180 @node Maintenance Commands
34181 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34182 @cindex maintenance commands
34183 @cindex internal commands
34184
34185 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34186 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34187 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34188 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34189 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34190
34191 @table @code
34192 @kindex maint agent
34193 @kindex maint agent-eval
34194 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34195 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34196 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34197 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34198 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34199 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34200 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34201 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34202 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34203 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34204 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34205 addition and return the sum.
34206 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34207 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34208
34209 @kindex maint agent-printf
34210 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34211 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34212 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34213 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34214 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34215
34216 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34217 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34218 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34219 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34220 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34221 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34222 is shown:
34223
34224 @table @code
34225 @item breakpoint
34226 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34227
34228 @item watchpoint
34229 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34230
34231 @item longjmp
34232 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34233 @code{longjmp} calls.
34234
34235 @item longjmp resume
34236 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34237
34238 @item until
34239 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34240
34241 @item finish
34242 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34243
34244 @item shlib events
34245 Shared library events.
34246
34247 @end table
34248
34249 @kindex maint info btrace
34250 @item maint info btrace
34251 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34252
34253 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34254 @item maint btrace packet-history
34255 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34256 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34257 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34258 recording format.
34259
34260 @table @code
34261 @item bts
34262 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34263 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34264
34265 @table @asis
34266 @item Block number
34267 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34268 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34269 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34270 @end table
34271
34272 @item pt
34273 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34274 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34275 information is printed:
34276
34277 @table @asis
34278 @item Packet number
34279 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34280 @item Trace offset
34281 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34282 @item Packet opcode and payload
34283 @end table
34284 @end table
34285
34286 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34287 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34288 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34289 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34290 needed.
34291
34292 @kindex maint btrace clear
34293 @item maint btrace clear
34294 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34295 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34296
34297 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34298 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34299 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34300 buffer.
34301
34302 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34303 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34304 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34305 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34306 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34307 packet history.
34308
34309 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34310 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34311 @cindex displaced stepping support
34312 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34313 @item set displaced-stepping
34314 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34315 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34316 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34317 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34318 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34319 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34320
34321 @table @code
34322 @item set displaced-stepping on
34323 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34324 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34325
34326 @item set displaced-stepping off
34327 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34328 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34329
34330 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34331 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34332 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34333 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34334 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34335 @end table
34336
34337 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34338 @item maint check-psymtabs
34339 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34340 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34341
34342 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34343 @item maint check-symtabs
34344 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34345
34346 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34347 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34348 Expand symbol tables.
34349 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34350 names matching @var{regexp}.
34351
34352 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34353 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34354 @cindex demangler crashes
34355 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34356 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34357 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34358 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34359 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34360 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34361 option to terminate the current session.
34362
34363 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34364 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34365 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34366
34367 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34368 @item maint cplus namespace
34369 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34370
34371 @kindex maint deprecate
34372 @kindex maint undeprecate
34373 @cindex deprecated commands
34374 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34375 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34376 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34377 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34378 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34379 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34380 the replacement as part of the warning.
34381
34382 @kindex maint dump-me
34383 @item maint dump-me
34384 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34385 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34386 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34387 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34388
34389 @kindex maint internal-error
34390 @kindex maint internal-warning
34391 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34392 @cindex demangler crashes
34393 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34394 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34395 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34396
34397 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34398 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34399 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34400 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34401 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34402 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34403 @value{GDBN} session.
34404
34405 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34406 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34407
34408 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34409
34410 @smallexample
34411 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34412 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34413 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34414 debugging may prove unreliable.
34415 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34416 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34417 (@value{GDBP})
34418 @end smallexample
34419
34420 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34421 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34422 @cindex demangler crashes
34423
34424 @kindex maint set internal-error
34425 @kindex maint show internal-error
34426 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34427 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34428 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34429 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34430 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34431 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34432 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34433 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34434 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34435 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34436 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34437 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34438 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34439 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34440 described in the table below.
34441
34442 @table @samp
34443 @item quit
34444 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34445 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34446
34447 @item corefile
34448 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34449 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34450 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34451 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34452 disabled.
34453 @end table
34454
34455 @kindex maint packet
34456 @item maint packet @var{text}
34457 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34458 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34459 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34460 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34461 checksum.
34462
34463 @kindex maint print architecture
34464 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34465 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34466 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34467
34468 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
34469 @item maint print c-tdesc
34470 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34471 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34472 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34473
34474 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34475 @item maint print dummy-frames
34476 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34477
34478 @smallexample
34479 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34480 @dots{}
34481 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34482 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34483 58 return (a + b);
34484 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34485 @dots{}
34486 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34487 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34488 (@value{GDBP})
34489 @end smallexample
34490
34491 Takes an optional file parameter.
34492
34493 @kindex maint print registers
34494 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34495 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34496 @kindex maint print register-groups
34497 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34498 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34499 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34500 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34501 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34502 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34503 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34504
34505 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34506 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34507 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34508 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34509 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34510 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34511 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34512 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34513
34514 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34515 write the information.
34516
34517 @kindex maint print reggroups
34518 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34519 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34520 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34521 information.
34522
34523 The register groups info looks like this:
34524
34525 @smallexample
34526 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34527 Group Type
34528 general user
34529 float user
34530 all user
34531 vector user
34532 system user
34533 save internal
34534 restore internal
34535 @end smallexample
34536
34537 @kindex flushregs
34538 @item flushregs
34539 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34540
34541 @kindex maint print objfiles
34542 @cindex info for known object files
34543 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34544 Print a dump of all known object files.
34545 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34546 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34547 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34548
34549 @kindex maint print user-registers
34550 @cindex user registers
34551 @item maint print user-registers
34552 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34553 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34554 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34555 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34556 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34557 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34558 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34559
34560 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34561 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34562 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34563 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34564 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34565 matching @var{regexp}.
34566 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34567 and the full path if known.
34568 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34569
34570 @kindex maint print statistics
34571 @cindex bcache statistics
34572 @item maint print statistics
34573 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34574 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34575 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34576 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34577 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34578 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34579 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34580 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34581 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34582 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34583 lengths.
34584
34585 @kindex maint print target-stack
34586 @cindex target stack description
34587 @item maint print target-stack
34588 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34589 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34590 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34591 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34592 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34593 address.
34594
34595 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34596 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34597
34598 @kindex maint print type
34599 @cindex type chain of a data type
34600 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34601 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34602 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34603 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34604 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34605 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34606
34607 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34608 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34609 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34610 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34611 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34612 information.
34613
34614 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34615 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34616 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34617 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34618 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34619 always see the disassembly form.
34620
34621 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34622
34623 @smallexample
34624 (gdb) info addr argc
34625 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34626 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34627 @end smallexample
34628
34629 For more information on these expressions, see
34630 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34631
34632 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34633 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34634 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34635 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34636 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34637
34638 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34639 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34640 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34641 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34642 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34643 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34644 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34645 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34646 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34647
34648 @kindex maint set profile
34649 @kindex maint show profile
34650 @cindex profiling GDB
34651 @item maint set profile
34652 @itemx maint show profile
34653 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34654
34655 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34656 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34657 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34658 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34659 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34660 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34661 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34662
34663 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34664 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34665
34666 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34667 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34668 @cindex hardware debug registers
34669 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34670 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34671 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34672 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34673 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34674 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34675 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34676
34677 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34678 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34679 @item maint set show-all-tib
34680 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34681 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34682 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34683 command.
34684
34685 @kindex maint set target-async
34686 @kindex maint show target-async
34687 @item maint set target-async
34688 @itemx maint show target-async
34689 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34690 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34691 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34692 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34693
34694 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
34695 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
34696 @item maint set target-non-stop
34697 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
34698
34699 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
34700 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
34701 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
34702 if supported by the target.
34703
34704 @table @code
34705 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
34706 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
34707 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
34708
34709 @item maint set target-non-stop on
34710 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
34711 does not indicate support.
34712
34713 @item maint set target-non-stop off
34714 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
34715 target supports it.
34716 @end table
34717
34718 @kindex maint set per-command
34719 @kindex maint show per-command
34720 @item maint set per-command
34721 @itemx maint show per-command
34722 @cindex resources used by commands
34723
34724 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34725 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34726
34727 @table @code
34728 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34729 @itemx maint show per-command space
34730 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34731 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34732 took, following the command's own output.
34733 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34734 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34735
34736 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34737 @itemx maint show per-command time
34738 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34739 for each command.
34740 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34741 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34742 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34743 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34744 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34745 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34746 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34747 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34748 spent by the program been debugged.
34749 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34750 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34751
34752 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34753 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34754 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34755 for each command.
34756 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34757
34758 @enumerate a
34759 @item
34760 number of symbol tables
34761 @item
34762 number of primary symbol tables
34763 @item
34764 number of blocks in the blockvector
34765 @end enumerate
34766 @end table
34767
34768 @kindex maint space
34769 @cindex memory used by commands
34770 @item maint space @var{value}
34771 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34772 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34773
34774 @kindex maint time
34775 @cindex time of command execution
34776 @item maint time @var{value}
34777 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34778 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34779
34780 @kindex maint translate-address
34781 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34782 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34783 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34784 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34785 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34786 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34787 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34788
34789 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34790 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34791 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34792
34793 @end table
34794
34795 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34796 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34797
34798 @table @code
34799 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34800 @kindex set watchdog
34801 @cindex watchdog timer
34802 @cindex timeout for commands
34803 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34804 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34805 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34806
34807 @item show watchdog
34808 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34809 @end table
34810
34811 @node Remote Protocol
34812 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34813
34814 @menu
34815 * Overview::
34816 * Packets::
34817 * Stop Reply Packets::
34818 * General Query Packets::
34819 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34820 * Tracepoint Packets::
34821 * Host I/O Packets::
34822 * Interrupts::
34823 * Notification Packets::
34824 * Remote Non-Stop::
34825 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34826 * Examples::
34827 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34828 * Library List Format::
34829 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34830 * Memory Map Format::
34831 * Thread List Format::
34832 * Traceframe Info Format::
34833 * Branch Trace Format::
34834 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34835 @end menu
34836
34837 @node Overview
34838 @section Overview
34839
34840 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34841 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34842 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34843 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34844
34845 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34846 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34847
34848 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34849 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34850 @cindex remote serial protocol
34851 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34852 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34853 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34854 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34855 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34856
34857 @smallexample
34858 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34859 @end smallexample
34860 @noindent
34861
34862 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34863 @noindent
34864 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34865 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34866 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34867
34868 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34869 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34870
34871 @smallexample
34872 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34873 @end smallexample
34874
34875 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34876 @noindent
34877 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34878 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34879 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34880
34881 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34882 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34883 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34884 retransmission):
34885
34886 @smallexample
34887 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34888 <- @code{+}
34889 @end smallexample
34890 @noindent
34891
34892 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34893 once a connection is established.
34894 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34895
34896 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34897 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
34898 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34899 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34900 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
34901 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34902 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34903
34904 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34905 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34906 exceptions).
34907
34908 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
34909 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
34910 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
34911 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
34912
34913 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
34914 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
34915 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
34916
34917 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
34918 @anchor{Binary Data}
34919 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
34920 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
34921 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
34922 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
34923 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
34924 binary data.
34925
34926 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
34927 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
34928 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
34929 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
34930 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
34931 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
34932 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
34933 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
34934 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
34935 (described next).
34936
34937 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
34938 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
34939 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
34940 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
34941 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
34942 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
34943 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
34944 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
34945 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
34946 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
34947 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
34948 3}} more times.
34949
34950 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
34951 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
34952 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
34953 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
34954 @samp{0*"00}.
34955
34956 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
34957 error number. That number is not well defined.
34958
34959 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
34960 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
34961 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
34962 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
34963 on that response.
34964
34965 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
34966 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
34967 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
34968 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
34969 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
34970 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
34971
34972 @node Packets
34973 @section Packets
34974
34975 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
34976 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
34977 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
34978 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
34979
34980 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
34981 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
34982 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
34983 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
34984 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
34985 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
34986 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
34987 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
34988 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
34989 @var{baz}.
34990
34991 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
34992 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
34993 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
34994 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
34995 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
34996 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
34997 pick any thread.
34998
34999 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35000 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35001 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35002 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35003 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35004 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35005 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35006 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
35007 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
35008 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35009 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35010 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35011 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35012
35013 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35014 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35015 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35016 more information.
35017
35018 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35019 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35020
35021 Here are the packet descriptions.
35022
35023 @table @samp
35024
35025 @item !
35026 @cindex @samp{!} packet
35027 @anchor{extended mode}
35028 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
35029 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35030 debugged.
35031
35032 Reply:
35033 @table @samp
35034 @item OK
35035 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
35036 @end table
35037
35038 @item ?
35039 @cindex @samp{?} packet
35040 @anchor{? packet}
35041 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
35042 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
35043 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35044
35045 Reply:
35046 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35047
35048 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35049 @cindex @samp{A} packet
35050 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35051 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35052 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35053
35054 Reply:
35055 @table @samp
35056 @item OK
35057 The arguments were set.
35058 @item E @var{NN}
35059 An error occurred.
35060 @end table
35061
35062 @item b @var{baud}
35063 @cindex @samp{b} packet
35064 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35065 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35066
35067 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
35068 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
35069 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35070
35071 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35072 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35073 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35074 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35075 of view, nothing actually happened.}
35076
35077 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35078 @cindex @samp{B} packet
35079 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35080 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35081
35082 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35083 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35084
35085 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
35086 @anchor{bc}
35087 @item bc
35088 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
35089 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35090
35091 Reply:
35092 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35093
35094 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
35095 @anchor{bs}
35096 @item bs
35097 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35098 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35099
35100 Reply:
35101 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35102
35103 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35104 @cindex @samp{c} packet
35105 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
35106 is omitted, resume at current address.
35107
35108 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35109 packet}.
35110
35111 Reply:
35112 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35113
35114 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35115 @cindex @samp{C} packet
35116 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35117 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35118
35119 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35120 packet}.
35121
35122 Reply:
35123 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35124
35125 @item d
35126 @cindex @samp{d} packet
35127 Toggle debug flag.
35128
35129 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35130 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35131
35132 @item D
35133 @itemx D;@var{pid}
35134 @cindex @samp{D} packet
35135 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35136 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35137 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35138
35139 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35140 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35141 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35142 big-endian hex string.
35143
35144 Reply:
35145 @table @samp
35146 @item OK
35147 for success
35148 @item E @var{NN}
35149 for an error
35150 @end table
35151
35152 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35153 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35154 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35155 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35156 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35157
35158 @item g
35159 @anchor{read registers packet}
35160 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35161 Read general registers.
35162
35163 Reply:
35164 @table @samp
35165 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35166 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35167 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35168 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35169 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35170 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
35171 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
35172
35173 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35174 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35175 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35176 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35177 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35178 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35179 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35180 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35181
35182 @smallexample
35183 -> @code{g}
35184 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35185 @end smallexample
35186
35187 @item E @var{NN}
35188 for an error.
35189 @end table
35190
35191 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35192 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35193 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35194 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35195
35196 Reply:
35197 @table @samp
35198 @item OK
35199 for success
35200 @item E @var{NN}
35201 for an error
35202 @end table
35203
35204 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35205 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35206 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35207 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35208 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35209 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35210 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35211 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35212 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35213
35214 Reply:
35215 @table @samp
35216 @item OK
35217 for success
35218 @item E @var{NN}
35219 for an error
35220 @end table
35221
35222 @c FIXME: JTC:
35223 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35224 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35225 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35226 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35227 @c described. For example:
35228 @c
35229 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35230 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35231 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35232 @c
35233 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35234 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35235 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35236
35237 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35238 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35239 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35240 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35241 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35242 step starting at that address.
35243
35244 @item I
35245 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35246 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35247 step packet}.
35248
35249 @item k
35250 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35251 Kill request.
35252
35253 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35254
35255 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35256 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35257
35258 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35259
35260 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35261 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35262 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35263
35264 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35265 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35266 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35267
35268 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35269 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35270 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35271 (@pxref{? packet}).
35272
35273 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35274 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35275 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35276 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35277 any particular boundary.
35278
35279 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35280 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35281 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35282 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35283 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35284 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35285 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35286 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35287
35288 Reply:
35289 @table @samp
35290 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35291 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35292 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35293 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35294 @item E @var{NN}
35295 @var{NN} is errno
35296 @end table
35297
35298 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35299 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35300 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35301 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35302 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35303
35304 Reply:
35305 @table @samp
35306 @item OK
35307 for success
35308 @item E @var{NN}
35309 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35310 written).
35311 @end table
35312
35313 @item p @var{n}
35314 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35315 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35316 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35317 register value is encoded.
35318
35319 Reply:
35320 @table @samp
35321 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35322 the register's value
35323 @item E @var{NN}
35324 for an error
35325 @item @w{}
35326 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35327 @end table
35328
35329 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35330 @anchor{write register packet}
35331 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35332 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35333 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35334 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35335
35336 Reply:
35337 @table @samp
35338 @item OK
35339 for success
35340 @item E @var{NN}
35341 for an error
35342 @end table
35343
35344 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35345 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35346 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35347 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35348 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35349 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35350
35351 @item r
35352 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35353 Reset the entire system.
35354
35355 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35356
35357 @item R @var{XX}
35358 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35359 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35360 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35361
35362 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35363
35364 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35365 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35366 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35367 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35368
35369 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35370 packet}.
35371
35372 Reply:
35373 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35374
35375 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35376 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35377 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35378 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35379 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35380
35381 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35382 packet}.
35383
35384 Reply:
35385 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35386
35387 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35388 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35389 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35390 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35391 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35392
35393 @item T @var{thread-id}
35394 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35395 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35396
35397 Reply:
35398 @table @samp
35399 @item OK
35400 thread is still alive
35401 @item E @var{NN}
35402 thread is dead
35403 @end table
35404
35405 @item v
35406 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35407 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35408
35409 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35410 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35411 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35412 The process ID is a
35413 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35414 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35415 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35416
35417 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35418 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35419 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35420 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35421 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35422 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35423 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35424 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35425
35426 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35427
35428 Reply:
35429 @table @samp
35430 @item E @var{nn}
35431 for an error
35432 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35433 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35434 @item OK
35435 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35436 @end table
35437
35438 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35439 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35440 @anchor{vCont packet}
35441 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35442 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
35443 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
35444 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
35445 in their current state in non-stop mode.
35446 Specifying multiple
35447 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
35448 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35449
35450 Currently supported actions are:
35451
35452 @table @samp
35453 @item c
35454 Continue.
35455 @item C @var{sig}
35456 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35457 @item s
35458 Step.
35459 @item S @var{sig}
35460 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35461 @item t
35462 Stop.
35463 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35464 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35465 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35466 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35467 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35468 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35469
35470 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35471 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35472 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35473 jumps to @var{start}).
35474
35475 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35476 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35477 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35478
35479 @end table
35480
35481 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35482 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35483 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35484
35485 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35486 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35487 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35488 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35489 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35490 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35491 as an implementation detail.
35492
35493 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35494 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
35495 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
35496 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
35497 @var{thread-id}.
35498
35499 Reply:
35500 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35501
35502 @item vCont?
35503 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35504 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35505
35506 Reply:
35507 @table @samp
35508 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35509 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35510 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35511 @item @w{}
35512 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35513 @end table
35514
35515 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
35516 @item vCtrlC
35517 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
35518 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
35519 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
35520 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
35521 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
35522 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
35523 variant.
35524
35525 Reply:
35526 @table @samp
35527 @item E @var{nn}
35528 for an error
35529 @item OK
35530 for success
35531 @end table
35532
35533 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35534 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35535 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
35536 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35537
35538 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35539 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35540 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35541 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35542 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35543 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35544 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35545 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35546 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35547 packet is received.
35548
35549 Reply:
35550 @table @samp
35551 @item OK
35552 for success
35553 @item E @var{NN}
35554 for an error
35555 @end table
35556
35557 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35558 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35559 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35560 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35561 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35562 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35563 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35564 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35565 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35566 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35567 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35568 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35569
35570
35571 Reply:
35572 @table @samp
35573 @item OK
35574 for success
35575 @item E.memtype
35576 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35577 @item E @var{NN}
35578 for an error
35579 @end table
35580
35581 @item vFlashDone
35582 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35583 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35584 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35585 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35586 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35587 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35588 request is completed.
35589
35590 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35591 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35592 @anchor{vKill packet}
35593 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35594 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35595 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35596 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35597
35598 Reply:
35599 @table @samp
35600 @item E @var{nn}
35601 for an error
35602 @item OK
35603 for success
35604 @end table
35605
35606 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35607 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35608 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35609 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35610 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35611 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35612 state.
35613
35614 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35615
35616 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35617
35618 Reply:
35619 @table @samp
35620 @item E @var{nn}
35621 for an error
35622 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35623 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35624 @end table
35625
35626 @item vStopped
35627 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35628 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35629
35630 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35631 @anchor{X packet}
35632 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35633 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35634 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35635 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35636 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35637
35638 Reply:
35639 @table @samp
35640 @item OK
35641 for success
35642 @item E @var{NN}
35643 for an error
35644 @end table
35645
35646 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35647 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35648 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35649 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35650 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35651 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35652 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35653
35654 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35655 separately.
35656
35657 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35658 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35659 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35660 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35661 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35662 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35663
35664 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35665 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35666 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35667 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35668 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
35669 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35670
35671 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35672 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35673 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
35674 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
35675 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35676 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
35677 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
35678 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
35679 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
35680 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
35681
35682 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35683 for how to best report a memory breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35684
35685 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35686 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35687
35688 @table @samp
35689
35690 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35691 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35692 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35693
35694 @end table
35695
35696 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35697 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35698 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35699 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35700 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35701 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35702 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35703
35704 @table @samp
35705
35706 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35707 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35708 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35709
35710 @end table
35711
35712 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
35713
35714 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35715 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35716 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35717 target, is not defined.}
35718
35719 Reply:
35720 @table @samp
35721 @item OK
35722 success
35723 @item @w{}
35724 not supported
35725 @item E @var{NN}
35726 for an error
35727 @end table
35728
35729 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35730 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35731 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35732 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35733 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35734 address @var{addr}.
35735
35736 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35737 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
35738 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35739
35740 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35741 movement.}
35742
35743 Reply:
35744 @table @samp
35745 @item OK
35746 success
35747 @item @w{}
35748 not supported
35749 @item E @var{NN}
35750 for an error
35751 @end table
35752
35753 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35754 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35755 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35756 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35757 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35758 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35759
35760 Reply:
35761 @table @samp
35762 @item OK
35763 success
35764 @item @w{}
35765 not supported
35766 @item E @var{NN}
35767 for an error
35768 @end table
35769
35770 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35771 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35772 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35773 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35774 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35775 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35776
35777 Reply:
35778 @table @samp
35779 @item OK
35780 success
35781 @item @w{}
35782 not supported
35783 @item E @var{NN}
35784 for an error
35785 @end table
35786
35787 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35788 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35789 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35790 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35791 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35792 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35793
35794 Reply:
35795 @table @samp
35796 @item OK
35797 success
35798 @item @w{}
35799 not supported
35800 @item E @var{NN}
35801 for an error
35802 @end table
35803
35804 @end table
35805
35806 @node Stop Reply Packets
35807 @section Stop Reply Packets
35808 @cindex stop reply packets
35809
35810 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35811 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35812 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35813 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35814 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35815 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35816 @value{GDBN} source code.
35817
35818 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35819 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35820 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35821 components.
35822
35823 @table @samp
35824
35825 @item S @var{AA}
35826 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35827 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35828 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35829
35830 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35831 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35832 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35833 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35834 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35835 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35836 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35837 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35838
35839 @itemize @bullet
35840 @item
35841 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35842 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35843 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35844 two-digit hex number.
35845
35846 @item
35847 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35848 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35849
35850 @item
35851 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35852 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35853
35854 @item
35855 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35856 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35857 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35858 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35859
35860 @item
35861 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35862 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35863 future.
35864 @end itemize
35865
35866 The currently defined stop reasons are:
35867
35868 @table @samp
35869 @item watch
35870 @itemx rwatch
35871 @itemx awatch
35872 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35873 hex.
35874
35875 @item syscall_entry
35876 @itemx syscall_return
35877 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
35878 syscall number, in hex.
35879
35880 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
35881 @item library
35882 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35883 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35884 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
35885
35886 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
35887 @item replaylog
35888 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35889 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35890 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
35891 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
35892 for more information.
35893
35894 @item swbreak
35895 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
35896 The packet indicates a memory breakpoint instruction was executed,
35897 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
35898 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
35899 part must be left empty.
35900
35901 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
35902 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
35903 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
35904 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
35905 address.
35906
35907 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35908 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35909 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35910 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35911 indicating support.
35912
35913 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
35914
35915 @item hwbreak
35916 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
35917 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
35918
35919 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
35920 apply.
35921
35922 @cindex fork events, remote reply
35923 @item fork
35924 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
35925 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35926 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35927 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35928 fork events.
35929
35930 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35931 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35932 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35933 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35934 indicating support.
35935
35936 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
35937 @item vfork
35938 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
35939 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35940 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35941 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35942 vfork events.
35943
35944 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35945 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35946 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35947 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35948 indicating support.
35949
35950 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
35951 @item vforkdone
35952 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
35953 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
35954 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
35955 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
35956 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
35957
35958 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35959 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35960 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35961 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35962 indicating support.
35963
35964 @cindex exec events, remote reply
35965 @item exec
35966 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
35967 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
35968 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
35969
35970 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35971 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35972 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35973 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35974 indicating support.
35975
35976 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
35977 @anchor{thread create event}
35978 @item create
35979 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
35980 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
35981 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
35982 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
35983 also the @samp{w} (@ref{thread exit event}) remote reply below.
35984
35985 @end table
35986
35987 @item W @var{AA}
35988 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35989 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
35990 applicable to certain targets.
35991
35992 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
35993 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
35994 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35995 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35996
35997 @item X @var{AA}
35998 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35999 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36000
36001 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36002 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36003 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36004 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36005
36006 @anchor{thread exit event}
36007 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
36008 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
36009
36010 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
36011 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
36012 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
36013
36014 @item N
36015 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
36016 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
36017 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
36018 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
36019 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
36020 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
36021 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
36022 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
36023 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
36024 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
36025 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
36026 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
36027 support.
36028
36029 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
36030 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
36031 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
36032 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
36033 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
36034
36035 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
36036 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36037 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
36038 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36039 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36040 system calls.
36041
36042 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36043 this very system call.
36044
36045 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36046 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
36047 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36048 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36049 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
36050 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36051
36052 @end table
36053
36054 @node General Query Packets
36055 @section General Query Packets
36056 @cindex remote query requests
36057
36058 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36059 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
36060 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36061 sending information to and from the stub.
36062
36063 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36064 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
36065 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36066 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
36067 conventions:
36068
36069 @itemize @bullet
36070 @item
36071 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36072 @item
36073 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36074 letter.
36075 @item
36076 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36077 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
36078 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36079 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36080 @end itemize
36081
36082 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36083 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36084 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
36085 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36086 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
36087 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36088 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36089 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36090 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36091 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36092 packet.}.
36093
36094 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36095 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36096 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
36097 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
36098 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36099
36100 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36101
36102 @table @samp
36103
36104 @item QAgent:1
36105 @itemx QAgent:0
36106 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36107 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36108
36109 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36110 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36111 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36112 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36113 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36114 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36115 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36116 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36117 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
36118 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36119 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36120
36121 @item qC
36122 @cindex current thread, remote request
36123 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
36124 Return the current thread ID.
36125
36126 Reply:
36127 @table @samp
36128 @item QC @var{thread-id}
36129 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36130 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36131 @item @r{(anything else)}
36132 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36133 @end table
36134
36135 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36136 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36137 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36138 @anchor{qCRC packet}
36139 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36140 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36141 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36142 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36143
36144 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36145 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36146 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36147 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36148 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36149 detect trailing zeros.
36150
36151 Reply:
36152 @table @samp
36153 @item E @var{NN}
36154 An error (such as memory fault)
36155 @item C @var{crc32}
36156 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36157 @end table
36158
36159 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36160 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36161 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36162 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36163 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36164 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36165 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36166 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36167 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36168 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36169 randomization.
36170
36171 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36172
36173 Reply:
36174 @table @samp
36175 @item OK
36176 The request succeeded.
36177
36178 @item E @var{nn}
36179 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36180
36181 @item @w{}
36182 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36183 by the stub.
36184 @end table
36185
36186 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36187 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36188 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36189 address space randomization.
36190
36191 @item qfThreadInfo
36192 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36193 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36194 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36195 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36196 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36197 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36198 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36199 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36200 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36201 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36202
36203 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36204
36205 Reply:
36206 @table @samp
36207 @item m @var{thread-id}
36208 A single thread ID
36209 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36210 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36211 @item l
36212 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36213 @end table
36214
36215 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36216 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36217 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36218 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36219 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36220 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36221 fields.
36222
36223 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36224 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36225 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36226 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36227 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36228
36229 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36230 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36231 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36232 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36233 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36234
36235 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36236 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36237
36238 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36239 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36240 information associated with the variable.)
36241
36242 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36243 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36244 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36245 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36246 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36247 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36248
36249 Reply:
36250 @table @samp
36251 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36252 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36253 local storage requested.
36254
36255 @item E @var{nn}
36256 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36257
36258 @item @w{}
36259 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36260 @end table
36261
36262 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36263 @cindex get thread information block address
36264 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36265 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36266
36267 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36268
36269 Reply:
36270 @table @samp
36271 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36272 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36273 thread information block.
36274
36275 @item E @var{nn}
36276 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36277 address could not be retrieved.
36278
36279 @item @w{}
36280 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36281 @end table
36282
36283 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36284 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36285 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36286 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36287 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36288 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36289 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36290
36291 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36292
36293 Reply:
36294 @table @samp
36295 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36296 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36297 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36298 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36299 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36300 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36301 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36302 @end table
36303
36304 @item qOffsets
36305 @cindex section offsets, remote request
36306 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36307 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36308 image.
36309
36310 Reply:
36311 @table @samp
36312 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36313 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36314 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36315 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36316 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36317 segments by the supplied offsets.
36318
36319 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36320 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36321 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36322
36323 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36324 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36325 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36326 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36327 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36328 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36329 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36330 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
36331 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36332 @end table
36333
36334 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36335 @cindex thread information, remote request
36336 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
36337 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36338 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36339 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36340
36341 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36342 (see below).
36343
36344 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36345
36346 @item QNonStop:1
36347 @itemx QNonStop:0
36348 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36349 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36350 @anchor{QNonStop}
36351 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36352 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36353
36354 Reply:
36355 @table @samp
36356 @item OK
36357 The request succeeded.
36358
36359 @item E @var{nn}
36360 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36361
36362 @item @w{}
36363 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36364 the stub.
36365 @end table
36366
36367 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36368 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36369 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
36370 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
36371
36372 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
36373 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
36374 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
36375 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36376 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
36377 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
36378 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
36379
36380 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
36381 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
36382 is listed, every system call should be reported.
36383
36384 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
36385 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
36386 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
36387 report the requested syscalls.
36388
36389 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
36390 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36391
36392 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
36393 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
36394 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
36395 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
36396
36397 Reply:
36398 @table @samp
36399 @item OK
36400 The request succeeded.
36401
36402 @item E @var{nn}
36403 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36404
36405 @item @w{}
36406 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
36407 the stub.
36408 @end table
36409
36410 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
36411 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
36412 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36413 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36414
36415 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36416 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
36417 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36418 @anchor{QPassSignals}
36419 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
36420 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36421 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36422 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
36423 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
36424 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
36425 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
36426 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
36427 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
36428
36429 Reply:
36430 @table @samp
36431 @item OK
36432 The request succeeded.
36433
36434 @item E @var{nn}
36435 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36436
36437 @item @w{}
36438 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
36439 the stub.
36440 @end table
36441
36442 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
36443 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
36444 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36445 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36446
36447 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36448 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
36449 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
36450 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
36451 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
36452 Others should be silently discarded.
36453
36454 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
36455 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
36456 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
36457 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
36458 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
36459 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
36460 signals.
36461
36462 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36463 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36464
36465 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36466 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36467 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
36468 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36469 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36470
36471 Reply:
36472 @table @samp
36473 @item OK
36474 The request succeeded.
36475
36476 @item E @var{nn}
36477 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36478
36479 @item @w{}
36480 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36481 by the stub.
36482 @end table
36483
36484 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36485 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36486 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36487 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36488
36489 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
36490 @item QThreadEvents:1
36491 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
36492 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
36493 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
36494
36495 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
36496 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
36497 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
36498 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
36499 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
36500 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
36501 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
36502 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
36503 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
36504 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36505
36506 Reply:
36507 @table @samp
36508 @item OK
36509 The request succeeded.
36510
36511 @item E @var{nn}
36512 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36513
36514 @item @w{}
36515 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
36516 the stub.
36517 @end table
36518
36519 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
36520 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
36521
36522 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
36523 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
36524 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36525 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36526 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36527 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36528 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36529 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36530 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36531
36532 Reply:
36533 @table @samp
36534 @item OK
36535 A command response with no output.
36536 @item @var{OUTPUT}
36537 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36538 @item E @var{NN}
36539 Indicate a badly formed request.
36540 @item @w{}
36541 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36542 @end table
36543
36544 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36545 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36546 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36547 packets.)
36548
36549 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36550 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36551 @ifnotinfo
36552 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36553 @end ifnotinfo
36554 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36555 @anchor{qSearch memory}
36556 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36557 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36558 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36559
36560 Reply:
36561 @table @samp
36562 @item 0
36563 The pattern was not found.
36564 @item 1,address
36565 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36566 @item E @var{NN}
36567 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36568 @item @w{}
36569 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36570 @end table
36571
36572 @item QStartNoAckMode
36573 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36574 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36575 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36576 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36577
36578 Reply:
36579 @table @samp
36580 @item OK
36581 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36582 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36583 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36584 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36585 @item @w{}
36586 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36587 @end table
36588
36589 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36590 @cindex supported packets, remote query
36591 @cindex features of the remote protocol
36592 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36593 @anchor{qSupported}
36594 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36595 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
36596 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36597 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36598 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36599 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36600 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
36601 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36602 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
36603 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
36604 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
36605 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36606 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36607 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36608
36609 Reply:
36610 @table @samp
36611 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36612 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36613 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36614 possible forms).
36615 @item @w{}
36616 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36617 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36618 @end table
36619
36620 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36621 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36622 are:
36623
36624 @table @samp
36625 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
36626 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36627 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
36628 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36629 @item @var{name}+
36630 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36631 need an associated value.
36632 @item @var{name}-
36633 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36634 @item @var{name}?
36635 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36636 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36637 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36638 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36639 @end table
36640
36641 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36642 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36643 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36644 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36645 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36646
36647 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36648 are defined:
36649
36650 @table @samp
36651 @item multiprocess
36652 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36653 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36654 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36655 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36656 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36657
36658 @item xmlRegisters
36659 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36660 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36661 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36662 description.
36663
36664 @item qRelocInsn
36665 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36666 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36667 instruction reply packet}).
36668
36669 @item swbreak
36670 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
36671 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36672
36673 @item hwbreak
36674 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
36675 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36676
36677 @item fork-events
36678 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
36679 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36680 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36681 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36682
36683 @item vfork-events
36684 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
36685 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36686 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36687 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36688
36689 @item exec-events
36690 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
36691 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36692 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36693 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36694
36695 @item vContSupported
36696 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
36697 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
36698 @end table
36699
36700 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36701 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36702 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36703 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
36704 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36705 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36706 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36707 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
36708 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36709 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36710 all the features it supports.
36711
36712 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36713 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36714
36715 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
36716 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
36717 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36718 form response.
36719
36720 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36721 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36722 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
36723 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36724
36725 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36726 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36727 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36728 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
36729 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36730
36731 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36732
36733 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36734 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36735 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36736 @item Feature Name
36737 @tab Value Required
36738 @tab Default
36739 @tab Probe Allowed
36740
36741 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36742 @tab Yes
36743 @tab @samp{-}
36744 @tab No
36745
36746 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36747 @tab No
36748 @tab @samp{-}
36749 @tab Yes
36750
36751 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36752 @tab No
36753 @tab @samp{-}
36754 @tab Yes
36755
36756 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36757 @tab No
36758 @tab @samp{-}
36759 @tab Yes
36760
36761 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
36762 @tab No
36763 @tab @samp{-}
36764 @tab Yes
36765
36766 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36767 @tab No
36768 @tab @samp{-}
36769 @tab Yes
36770
36771 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36772 @tab No
36773 @tab @samp{-}
36774 @tab Yes
36775
36776 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36777 @tab No
36778 @tab @samp{-}
36779 @tab Yes
36780
36781 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36782 @tab No
36783 @tab @samp{-}
36784 @tab No
36785
36786 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36787 @tab No
36788 @tab @samp{-}
36789 @tab Yes
36790
36791 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36792 @tab No
36793 @tab @samp{-}
36794 @tab Yes
36795
36796 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36797 @tab No
36798 @tab @samp{-}
36799 @tab Yes
36800
36801 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36802 @tab No
36803 @tab @samp{-}
36804 @tab Yes
36805
36806 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36807 @tab No
36808 @tab @samp{-}
36809 @tab Yes
36810
36811 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36812 @tab No
36813 @tab @samp{-}
36814 @tab Yes
36815
36816 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36817 @tab No
36818 @tab @samp{-}
36819 @tab Yes
36820
36821 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36822 @tab No
36823 @tab @samp{-}
36824 @tab Yes
36825
36826 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36827 @tab No
36828 @tab @samp{-}
36829 @tab Yes
36830
36831 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36832 @tab No
36833 @tab @samp{-}
36834 @tab Yes
36835
36836 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
36837 @tab Yes
36838 @tab @samp{-}
36839 @tab Yes
36840
36841 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
36842 @tab Yes
36843 @tab @samp{-}
36844 @tab Yes
36845
36846 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
36847 @tab Yes
36848 @tab @samp{-}
36849 @tab Yes
36850
36851 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
36852 @tab Yes
36853 @tab @samp{-}
36854 @tab Yes
36855
36856 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
36857 @tab Yes
36858 @tab @samp{-}
36859 @tab Yes
36860
36861 @item @samp{QNonStop}
36862 @tab No
36863 @tab @samp{-}
36864 @tab Yes
36865
36866 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
36867 @tab No
36868 @tab @samp{-}
36869 @tab Yes
36870
36871 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
36872 @tab No
36873 @tab @samp{-}
36874 @tab Yes
36875
36876 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
36877 @tab No
36878 @tab @samp{-}
36879 @tab Yes
36880
36881 @item @samp{multiprocess}
36882 @tab No
36883 @tab @samp{-}
36884 @tab No
36885
36886 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
36887 @tab No
36888 @tab @samp{-}
36889 @tab No
36890
36891 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
36892 @tab No
36893 @tab @samp{-}
36894 @tab No
36895
36896 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
36897 @tab No
36898 @tab @samp{-}
36899 @tab No
36900
36901 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
36902 @tab No
36903 @tab @samp{-}
36904 @tab No
36905
36906 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
36907 @tab No
36908 @tab @samp{-}
36909 @tab No
36910
36911 @item @samp{QAgent}
36912 @tab No
36913 @tab @samp{-}
36914 @tab No
36915
36916 @item @samp{QAllow}
36917 @tab No
36918 @tab @samp{-}
36919 @tab No
36920
36921 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
36922 @tab No
36923 @tab @samp{-}
36924 @tab No
36925
36926 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
36927 @tab No
36928 @tab @samp{-}
36929 @tab No
36930
36931 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
36932 @tab No
36933 @tab @samp{-}
36934 @tab No
36935
36936 @item @samp{tracenz}
36937 @tab No
36938 @tab @samp{-}
36939 @tab No
36940
36941 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
36942 @tab No
36943 @tab @samp{-}
36944 @tab No
36945
36946 @item @samp{swbreak}
36947 @tab No
36948 @tab @samp{-}
36949 @tab No
36950
36951 @item @samp{hwbreak}
36952 @tab No
36953 @tab @samp{-}
36954 @tab No
36955
36956 @item @samp{fork-events}
36957 @tab No
36958 @tab @samp{-}
36959 @tab No
36960
36961 @item @samp{vfork-events}
36962 @tab No
36963 @tab @samp{-}
36964 @tab No
36965
36966 @item @samp{exec-events}
36967 @tab No
36968 @tab @samp{-}
36969 @tab No
36970
36971 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
36972 @tab No
36973 @tab @samp{-}
36974 @tab No
36975
36976 @item @samp{no-resumed}
36977 @tab No
36978 @tab @samp{-}
36979 @tab No
36980
36981 @end multitable
36982
36983 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
36984
36985 @table @samp
36986 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
36987 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
36988 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
36989 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
36990 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
36991 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
36992 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
36993 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
36994 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
36995 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
36996
36997 @item qXfer:auxv:read
36998 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
36999 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
37000
37001 @item qXfer:btrace:read
37002 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37003 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
37004
37005 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
37006 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37007 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
37008
37009 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
37010 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
37011 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
37012
37013 @item qXfer:features:read
37014 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
37015 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
37016
37017 @item qXfer:libraries:read
37018 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
37019 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
37020
37021 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
37022 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37023 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37024
37025 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
37026 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
37027 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37028 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37029
37030 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
37031 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
37032 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
37033
37034 @item qXfer:sdata:read
37035 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
37036 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
37037
37038 @item qXfer:spu:read
37039 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
37040 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
37041
37042 @item qXfer:spu:write
37043 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
37044 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
37045
37046 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
37047 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
37048 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
37049
37050 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
37051 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
37052 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
37053
37054 @item qXfer:threads:read
37055 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37056 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
37057
37058 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
37059 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37060 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
37061
37062 @item qXfer:uib:read
37063 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37064 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
37065
37066 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
37067 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37068 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
37069
37070 @item QNonStop
37071 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
37072 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
37073
37074 @item QCatchSyscalls
37075 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37076 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
37077
37078 @item QPassSignals
37079 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37080 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
37081
37082 @item QStartNoAckMode
37083 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
37084 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
37085
37086 @item multiprocess
37087 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
37088 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
37089 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
37090 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37091 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37092 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37093 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37094 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37095 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
37096 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37097 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37098
37099 @item qXfer:osdata:read
37100 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37101 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37102
37103 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
37104 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37105 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37106 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37107
37108 @item ConditionalTracepoints
37109 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37110 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37111
37112 @item ReverseContinue
37113 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37114 (@pxref{bc}).
37115
37116 @item ReverseStep
37117 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37118 (@pxref{bs}).
37119
37120 @item TracepointSource
37121 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37122 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37123
37124 @item QAgent
37125 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37126
37127 @item QAllow
37128 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37129
37130 @item QDisableRandomization
37131 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37132
37133 @item StaticTracepoint
37134 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37135 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37136
37137 @item InstallInTrace
37138 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37139 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37140
37141 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
37142 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37143 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37144 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37145
37146 @item QTBuffer:size
37147 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37148 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37149
37150 @item tracenz
37151 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37152 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37153 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37154
37155 @item BreakpointCommands
37156 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37157 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37158 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37159
37160 @item Qbtrace:off
37161 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37162
37163 @item Qbtrace:bts
37164 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37165
37166 @item Qbtrace:pt
37167 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37168
37169 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37170 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37171
37172 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37173 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37174
37175 @item swbreak
37176 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37177 breakpoints.
37178
37179 @item hwbreak
37180 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37181 breakpoints.
37182
37183 @item fork-events
37184 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37185
37186 @item vfork-events
37187 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37188 and vforkdone events.
37189
37190 @item exec-events
37191 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37192
37193 @item vContSupported
37194 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37195 @samp{vCont?} packet.
37196
37197 @item QThreadEvents
37198 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37199
37200 @item no-resumed
37201 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37202
37203 @end table
37204
37205 @item qSymbol::
37206 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37207 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37208 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37209 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37210
37211 Reply:
37212 @table @samp
37213 @item OK
37214 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37215 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37216 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37217 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37218 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37219 below.
37220 @end table
37221
37222 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37223 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37224
37225 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37226 target has previously requested.
37227
37228 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
37229 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37230 will be empty.
37231
37232 Reply:
37233 @table @samp
37234 @item OK
37235 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37236 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37237 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37238 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37239 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37240 @end table
37241
37242 @item qTBuffer
37243 @itemx QTBuffer
37244 @itemx QTDisconnected
37245 @itemx QTDP
37246 @itemx QTDPsrc
37247 @itemx QTDV
37248 @itemx qTfP
37249 @itemx qTfV
37250 @itemx QTFrame
37251 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
37252
37253 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37254
37255 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37256 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37257 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37258 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37259 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37260 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
37261 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37262 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
37263 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
37264 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37265 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37266
37267 Reply:
37268 @table @samp
37269 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37270 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37271 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37272 the thread's attributes.
37273 @end table
37274
37275 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37276 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37277 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37278 packets.)
37279
37280 @item QTNotes
37281 @itemx qTP
37282 @itemx QTSave
37283 @itemx qTsP
37284 @itemx qTsV
37285 @itemx QTStart
37286 @itemx QTStop
37287 @itemx QTEnable
37288 @itemx QTDisable
37289 @itemx QTinit
37290 @itemx QTro
37291 @itemx qTStatus
37292 @itemx qTV
37293 @itemx qTfSTM
37294 @itemx qTsSTM
37295 @itemx qTSTMat
37296 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37297
37298 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37299 @cindex read special object, remote request
37300 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37301 @anchor{qXfer read}
37302 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37303 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
37304 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
37305 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37306 additional details about what data to access.
37307
37308 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
37309 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37310 formats, listed below.
37311
37312 @table @samp
37313 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37314 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37315 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
37316 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37317
37318 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37319 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37320
37321 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37322 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
37323
37324 Return a description of the current branch trace.
37325 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
37326 packet may have one of the following values:
37327
37328 @table @code
37329 @item all
37330 Returns all available branch trace.
37331
37332 @item new
37333 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
37334 the last read request.
37335
37336 @item delta
37337 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
37338 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
37339 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
37340 used to stitch traces together.
37341
37342 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
37343 @end table
37344
37345 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37346 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37347
37348 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37349 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
37350
37351 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
37352 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
37353
37354 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37355 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37356
37357 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37358 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
37359 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
37360 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
37361 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
37362 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
37363 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
37364
37365 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37366 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37367
37368 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37369 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
37370 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
37371 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
37372 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
37373
37374 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37375 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37376
37377 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37378 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
37379 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
37380 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37381 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37382
37383 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
37384 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
37385 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
37386
37387 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37388 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37389
37390 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37391 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
37392 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
37393 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
37394 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
37395 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
37396 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37397 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
37398
37399 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
37400 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
37401
37402 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37403 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37404
37405 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
37406 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
37407 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
37408 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
37409
37410 @table @code
37411 @item start=@var{address}
37412 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37413 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
37414 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
37415 chosen as the starting point.
37416
37417 @item prev=@var{address}
37418 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37419 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
37420 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
37421 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
37422 exists prior to the starting point.
37423
37424 @end table
37425
37426 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
37427 ignored.
37428
37429 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37430 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
37431 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
37432 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37433 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37434
37435 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37436 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37437
37438 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37439 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
37440
37441 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
37442 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
37443 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
37444 Action Lists}.
37445
37446 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37447 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37448 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37449
37450 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37451 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
37452 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
37453 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37454 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37455
37456 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37457 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37458 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37459
37460 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37461 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
37462 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37463 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
37464 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37465 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37466 in that context to be accessed.
37467
37468 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37469 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37470 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37471
37472 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37473 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
37474 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
37475 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37476 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37477
37478 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37479 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37480
37481 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37482 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37483
37484 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37485 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
37486 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37487
37488 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37489 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37490
37491 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37492 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37493
37494 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
37495 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37496
37497 This packet is not probed by default.
37498
37499 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37500 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37501 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
37502 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37503 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37504
37505 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37506 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37507
37508 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37509 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37510 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37511 @xref{Operating System Information}.
37512
37513 @end table
37514
37515 Reply:
37516 @table @samp
37517 @item m @var{data}
37518 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37519 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37520 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37521 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37522 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37523 request.
37524
37525 @item l @var{data}
37526 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37527 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37528 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37529
37530 @item l
37531 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37532 There is no more data to be read.
37533
37534 @item E00
37535 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37536
37537 @item E @var{nn}
37538 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37539 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37540
37541 @item @w{}
37542 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37543 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37544 @end table
37545
37546 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37547 @cindex write data into object, remote request
37548 @anchor{qXfer write}
37549 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37550 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37551 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
37552 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37553 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37554 to access.
37555
37556 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
37557 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37558 formats, listed below.
37559
37560 @table @samp
37561 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37562 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37563 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37564 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37565 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37566
37567 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37568 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37569 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37570
37571 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37572 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
37573 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37574 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37575 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37576 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37577 in that context to be accessed.
37578
37579 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37580 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37581 @end table
37582
37583 Reply:
37584 @table @samp
37585 @item @var{nn}
37586 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37587 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37588
37589 @item E00
37590 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37591
37592 @item E @var{nn}
37593 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37594 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37595
37596 @item @w{}
37597 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37598 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37599 @end table
37600
37601 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37602 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
37603 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37604 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37605 must respond with an empty packet.
37606
37607 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
37608 @cindex query attached, remote request
37609 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
37610 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
37611 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
37612 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
37613 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
37614 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
37615 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
37616
37617 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37618 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37619 the @code{quit} command.
37620
37621 Reply:
37622 @table @samp
37623 @item 1
37624 The remote server attached to an existing process.
37625 @item 0
37626 The remote server created a new process.
37627 @item E @var{NN}
37628 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37629 @end table
37630
37631 @item Qbtrace:bts
37632 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
37633
37634 Reply:
37635 @table @samp
37636 @item OK
37637 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37638 @item E.errtext
37639 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37640 @end table
37641
37642 @item Qbtrace:pt
37643 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
37644
37645 Reply:
37646 @table @samp
37647 @item OK
37648 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37649 @item E.errtext
37650 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37651 @end table
37652
37653 @item Qbtrace:off
37654 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
37655
37656 Reply:
37657 @table @samp
37658 @item OK
37659 Branch tracing has been disabled.
37660 @item E.errtext
37661 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37662 @end table
37663
37664 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
37665 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37666 btrace recording method in bts format.
37667
37668 Reply:
37669 @table @samp
37670 @item OK
37671 The ring buffer size has been set.
37672 @item E.errtext
37673 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37674 @end table
37675
37676 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
37677 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37678 btrace recording method in pt format.
37679
37680 Reply:
37681 @table @samp
37682 @item OK
37683 The ring buffer size has been set.
37684 @item E.errtext
37685 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37686 @end table
37687
37688 @end table
37689
37690 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37691 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37692
37693 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37694 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37695 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37696
37697 @menu
37698 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37699 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37700 @end menu
37701
37702 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37703 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37704
37705 @menu
37706 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37707 @end menu
37708
37709 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37710 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37711 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37712
37713 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37714
37715 @table @r
37716
37717 @item 2
37718 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37719
37720 @item 3
37721 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37722
37723 @item 4
37724 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37725
37726 @end table
37727
37728 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37729 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37730
37731 @menu
37732 * MIPS Register packet Format::
37733 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37734 @end menu
37735
37736 @node MIPS Register packet Format
37737 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37738 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37739
37740 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37741 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37742 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37743 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
37744 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
37745 most-significant -- least-significant.
37746
37747 @table @r
37748
37749 @item MIPS32
37750 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
37751 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
37752 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
37753
37754 @item MIPS64
37755 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
37756 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
37757 as @code{MIPS32}.
37758
37759 @end table
37760
37761 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
37762 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
37763 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
37764
37765 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37766
37767 @table @r
37768
37769 @item 2
37770 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
37771
37772 @item 3
37773 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37774
37775 @item 4
37776 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
37777
37778 @item 5
37779 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37780
37781 @end table
37782
37783 @node Tracepoint Packets
37784 @section Tracepoint Packets
37785 @cindex tracepoint packets
37786 @cindex packets, tracepoint
37787
37788 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
37789 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
37790
37791 @table @samp
37792
37793 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
37794 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
37795 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
37796 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
37797 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
37798 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
37799 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
37800 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
37801 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
37802 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
37803 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
37804 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
37805 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
37806 actions.
37807
37808 Replies:
37809 @table @samp
37810 @item OK
37811 The packet was understood and carried out.
37812 @item qRelocInsn
37813 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37814 @item @w{}
37815 The packet was not recognized.
37816 @end table
37817
37818 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
37819 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
37820 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
37821 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
37822 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
37823 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
37824 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
37825
37826 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
37827 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
37828 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
37829 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
37830 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
37831 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
37832 tracepoint actions.
37833
37834 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
37835 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
37836 following forms:
37837
37838 @table @samp
37839
37840 @item R @var{mask}
37841 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
37842 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
37843 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
37844 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
37845 not fit in a 32-bit word.
37846
37847 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
37848 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
37849 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
37850 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
37851 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
37852 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
37853 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
37854
37855 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37856 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
37857 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
37858 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37859 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37860 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37861 packet).
37862
37863 @end table
37864
37865 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
37866 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
37867 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
37868 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
37869 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
37870 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
37871 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
37872 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
37873
37874 Replies:
37875 @table @samp
37876 @item OK
37877 The packet was understood and carried out.
37878 @item qRelocInsn
37879 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37880 @item @w{}
37881 The packet was not recognized.
37882 @end table
37883
37884 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
37885 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
37886 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
37887 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
37888 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
37889 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
37890 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
37891 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
37892
37893 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
37894 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
37895 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
37896 fit in a single packet.
37897 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
37898 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
37899
37900 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
37901 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
37902 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
37903 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
37904
37905 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
37906 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
37907 query packets.
37908
37909 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
37910 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
37911 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
37912 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
37913 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
37914 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
37915 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
37916 be found.
37917
37918 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
37919 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
37920 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
37921 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
37922 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
37923 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
37924 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
37925 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
37926 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
37927 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
37928 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
37929 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
37930 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
37931 variable.
37932
37933 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
37934 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
37935 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
37936 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
37937 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
37938
37939 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
37940 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
37941 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
37942 one of the following forms:
37943
37944 @table @samp
37945 @item F @var{f}
37946 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
37947 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
37948 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
37949
37950 @item T @var{t}
37951 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
37952 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
37953
37954 @end table
37955
37956 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
37957 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37958 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
37959 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
37960
37961 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
37962 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37963 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
37964 is a hexadecimal number.
37965
37966 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
37967 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37968 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
37969 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
37970 numbers.
37971
37972 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
37973 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
37974 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
37975
37976 @item qTMinFTPILen
37977 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
37978 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
37979 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
37980 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
37981 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
37982 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
37983 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
37984 arrange for that.
37985
37986 Replies:
37987
37988 @table @samp
37989 @item 0
37990 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
37991 @item @var{length}
37992 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
37993 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
37994 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
37995 regardless of size.
37996 @item E
37997 An error has occurred.
37998 @item @w{}
37999 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
38000 @end table
38001
38002 @item QTStart
38003 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
38004 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
38005 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
38006 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38007 instruction reply packet}).
38008
38009 @item QTStop
38010 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
38011 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
38012
38013 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38014 @anchor{QTEnable}
38015 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
38016 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38017 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
38018 of data from it will resume.
38019
38020 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38021 @anchor{QTDisable}
38022 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
38023 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38024 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
38025 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
38026
38027 @item QTinit
38028 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
38029 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
38030
38031 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
38032 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
38033 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
38034 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
38035 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
38036
38037 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
38038 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
38039 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
38040 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
38041
38042 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
38043 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
38044 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
38045 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
38046 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
38047 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
38048
38049 @item qTStatus
38050 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
38051 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
38052
38053 The reply has the form:
38054
38055 @table @samp
38056
38057 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
38058 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
38059 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
38060 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
38061
38062 @end table
38063
38064 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
38065 explanations as one of the optional fields:
38066
38067 @table @samp
38068
38069 @item tnotrun:0
38070 No trace has been run yet.
38071
38072 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
38073 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
38074 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
38075 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
38076 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
38077
38078 @item tfull:0
38079 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
38080
38081 @item tdisconnected:0
38082 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
38083
38084 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
38085 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
38086
38087 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
38088 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
38089 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
38090 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38091 is hex encoded.
38092
38093 @item tunknown:0
38094 The trace stopped for some other reason.
38095
38096 @end table
38097
38098 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38099 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38100 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
38101 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38102 trace.
38103
38104 @table @samp
38105
38106 @item tframes:@var{n}
38107 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38108
38109 @item tcreated:@var{n}
38110 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38111 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38112
38113 @item tsize:@var{n}
38114 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38115
38116 @item tfree:@var{n}
38117 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38118
38119 @item circular:@var{n}
38120 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
38121 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38122 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38123 and may fill up.
38124
38125 @item disconn:@var{n}
38126 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
38127 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38128 that the trace run will stop.
38129
38130 @end table
38131
38132 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38133 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38134 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38135 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38136 address @var{addr}.
38137
38138 Replies:
38139 @table @samp
38140 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38141 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38142 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
38143 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
38144 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
38145
38146 @end table
38147
38148 @item qTV:@var{var}
38149 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38150 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38151 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38152
38153 Replies:
38154 @table @samp
38155 @item V@var{value}
38156 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
38157 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38158 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38159 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
38160 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38161 program is running.
38162
38163 @item U
38164 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
38165 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38166 was not collected.
38167 @end table
38168
38169 @item qTfP
38170 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38171 @itemx qTsP
38172 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38173 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38174 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38175 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
38176 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38177 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38178
38179 @item qTfV
38180 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38181 @itemx qTsV
38182 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38183 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38184 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38185 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
38186 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38187 trace state variables.
38188
38189 @item qTfSTM
38190 @itemx qTsSTM
38191 @anchor{qTfSTM}
38192 @anchor{qTsSTM}
38193 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38194 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38195 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38196 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38197 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38198 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
38199
38200 Reply:
38201 @table @samp
38202 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38203 A single marker
38204 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38205 a comma-separated list of markers
38206 @item l
38207 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38208 @item E @var{nn}
38209 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38210 @item @w{}
38211 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38212 stub.
38213 @end table
38214
38215 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38216 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38217
38218 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38219 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38220 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38221 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38222 @dfn{last}).
38223
38224 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38225 @anchor{qTSTMat}
38226 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38227 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38228 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
38229 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38230 tracepoint markers.
38231
38232 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
38233 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38234 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38235 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
38236 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38237 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38238
38239 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38240 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38241 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38242 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38243 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38244 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38245 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38246 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38247 available.
38248
38249 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38250 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38251 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38252
38253 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38254 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38255 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38256 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38257 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38258 use whatever size it prefers.
38259
38260 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38261 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38262 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
38263 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38264 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38265
38266 @end table
38267
38268 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38269 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38270 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38271 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
38272 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38273 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38274 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38275 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38276 it had executed in the original location.
38277
38278 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38279 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38280 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
38281 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
38282 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
38283 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
38284 format of the request is:
38285
38286 @table @samp
38287 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38288
38289 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38290 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38291 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38292 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38293 memory starting at @var{to}.
38294 @end table
38295
38296 Replies:
38297 @table @samp
38298 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38299 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
38300 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38301 @item E @var{NN}
38302 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38303 relocating the instruction.
38304 @end table
38305
38306 @node Host I/O Packets
38307 @section Host I/O Packets
38308 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38309 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38310
38311 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38312 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
38313 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38314 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38315 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
38316 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
38317 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38318 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38319 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38320 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38321
38322 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38323 its arguments. They have this format:
38324
38325 @table @samp
38326
38327 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38328 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38329 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38330 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38331 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
38332 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38333 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38334 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
38335 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38336
38337 @end table
38338
38339 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38340
38341 @table @samp
38342
38343 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38344 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38345 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
38346 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
38347 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
38348 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38349 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38350 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
38351 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38352 @var{attachment}.
38353
38354 @item @w{}
38355 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38356
38357 @end table
38358
38359 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
38360
38361 @table @samp
38362 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
38363 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
38364 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
38365 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
38366 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
38367 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
38368 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
38369
38370 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
38371 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
38372 -1 if an error occurs.
38373
38374 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
38375 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
38376 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
38377 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
38378 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
38379 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
38380 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
38381 @var{count} was zero.
38382
38383 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38384 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38385 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38386 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38387 some characters were escaped.
38388
38389 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
38390 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
38391 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
38392 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
38393 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
38394 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
38395 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
38396 error occurred.
38397
38398 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
38399 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
38400 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
38401 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
38402 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
38403 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
38404
38405 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
38406 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
38407 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
38408
38409 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
38410 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
38411 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
38412
38413 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38414 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38415 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38416 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38417 some characters were escaped.
38418
38419 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
38420 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
38421 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
38422 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
38423 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
38424 inferior(s).
38425
38426 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
38427 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
38428 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
38429 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
38430 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
38431 operation.
38432
38433 @end table
38434
38435 @node Interrupts
38436 @section Interrupts
38437 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
38438 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
38439
38440 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
38441 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
38442 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
38443 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
38444
38445 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
38446 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
38447 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
38448 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
38449 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
38450
38451 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
38452 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
38453 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
38454 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
38455 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
38456 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
38457 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
38458 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
38459
38460 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
38461 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
38462 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
38463
38464 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
38465 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
38466 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
38467 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
38468 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
38469 @code{0x03}.
38470
38471 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38472 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38473 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
38474 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38475 currently-executing threads and processes.
38476 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38477 running program, it should send one of the stop
38478 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38479 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38480 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38481 Interrupts received while the
38482 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
38483 it is resumed next time.
38484
38485 @node Notification Packets
38486 @section Notification Packets
38487 @cindex notification packets
38488 @cindex packets, notification
38489
38490 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38491 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
38492 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38493 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
38494 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38495 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38496 is not a problem.
38497
38498 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38499 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38500 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38501 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
38502 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
38503 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38504 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38505
38506 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38507 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38508
38509 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38510 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
38511 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38512 not they understand it.
38513
38514 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38515 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
38516 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38517 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38518 recipients.
38519
38520 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38521 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38522 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
38523 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38524 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38525
38526 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
38527 @table @samp
38528 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
38529 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
38530 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
38531 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
38532 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
38533 @item @var{ack}
38534 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
38535 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
38536 @end table
38537
38538 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
38539 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
38540
38541 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
38542 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
38543 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
38544 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
38545 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38546 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38547 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
38548 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38549 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
38550 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
38551
38552 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
38553 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
38554 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38555 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38556 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38557 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38558
38559 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
38560 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
38561 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
38562 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
38563 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
38564
38565 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
38566 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38567 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
38568 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
38569 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
38570 normally.
38571
38572 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
38573 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
38574 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
38575 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
38576 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
38577 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
38578 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
38579 the process shall be repeated.
38580
38581 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
38582 following example:
38583 @smallexample
38584 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
38585 @code{...}
38586 -> @code{vStopped}
38587 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
38588 -> @code{vStopped}
38589 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
38590 -> @code{vStopped}
38591 <- @code{OK}
38592 @end smallexample
38593
38594 The following notifications are defined:
38595 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
38596
38597 @item Notification
38598 @tab Ack
38599 @tab Event
38600 @tab Description
38601
38602 @item Stop
38603 @tab vStopped
38604 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38605 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38606 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38607 @value{GDBN}.
38608 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
38609
38610 @end multitable
38611
38612 @node Remote Non-Stop
38613 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
38614
38615 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
38616 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
38617 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
38618 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38619
38620 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
38621 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
38622 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
38623 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
38624 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
38625 probe the target state after a mode change.
38626
38627 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
38628 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
38629 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
38630 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
38631 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
38632 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
38633 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
38634 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
38635 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
38636 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
38637 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
38638
38639 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
38640 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
38641 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
38642 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
38643 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
38644 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
38645 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
38646 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
38647 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
38648 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
38649 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38650 @samp{OK}.
38651
38652 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
38653 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
38654 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
38655 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
38656 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
38657 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
38658 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
38659 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
38660 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
38661 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
38662 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
38663 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
38664 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
38665
38666 @node Packet Acknowledgment
38667 @section Packet Acknowledgment
38668
38669 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38670 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38671 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38672 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38673 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38674 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38675 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38676
38677 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38678 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38679 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38680 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
38681 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38682
38683 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38684 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
38685 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38686 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38687
38688 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38689 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38690 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38691 @pxref{qSupported}.
38692 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38693 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38694 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38695 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38696 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38697 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38698 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38699
38700 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38701 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38702 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38703 connection.
38704 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38705 new connection is established,
38706 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38707 for the current connection, once disabled.
38708
38709 @node Examples
38710 @section Examples
38711
38712 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
38713 does not get any direct output:
38714
38715 @smallexample
38716 -> @code{R00}
38717 <- @code{+}
38718 @emph{target restarts}
38719 -> @code{?}
38720 <- @code{+}
38721 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38722 -> @code{+}
38723 @end smallexample
38724
38725 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38726
38727 @smallexample
38728 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38729 <- @code{+}
38730 -> @code{s}
38731 <- @code{+}
38732 @emph{time passes}
38733 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38734 -> @code{+}
38735 -> @code{g}
38736 <- @code{+}
38737 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
38738 -> @code{+}
38739 @end smallexample
38740
38741 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38742 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38743 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38744
38745 @menu
38746 * File-I/O Overview::
38747 * Protocol Basics::
38748 * The F Request Packet::
38749 * The F Reply Packet::
38750 * The Ctrl-C Message::
38751 * Console I/O::
38752 * List of Supported Calls::
38753 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
38754 * Constants::
38755 * File-I/O Examples::
38756 @end menu
38757
38758 @node File-I/O Overview
38759 @subsection File-I/O Overview
38760 @cindex file-i/o overview
38761
38762 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
38763 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
38764 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
38765 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
38766 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
38767 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
38768
38769 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
38770 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
38771 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
38772 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
38773 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
38774
38775 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
38776 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38777 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
38778 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
38779 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
38780 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
38781 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
38782
38783 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
38784 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
38785 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
38786 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
38787 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
38788
38789 @smallexample
38790 (@value{GDBP}) continue
38791 <- target requests 'system call X'
38792 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
38793 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
38794 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
38795 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
38796 @end smallexample
38797
38798 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
38799 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
38800 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
38801 system are not supported by this protocol.
38802
38803 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
38804
38805 @node Protocol Basics
38806 @subsection Protocol Basics
38807 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
38808
38809 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
38810 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
38811 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
38812 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
38813 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
38814 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
38815 to call the appropriate host system call:
38816
38817 @itemize @bullet
38818 @item
38819 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
38820
38821 @item
38822 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
38823 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
38824 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
38825 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
38826
38827 @end itemize
38828
38829 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
38830
38831 @itemize @bullet
38832 @item
38833 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
38834 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
38835 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
38836 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
38837 packet.
38838
38839 @item
38840 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
38841 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
38842
38843 @item
38844 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
38845
38846 @item
38847 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
38848
38849 @item
38850 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
38851 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
38852 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
38853 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
38854 packet.
38855
38856 @end itemize
38857
38858 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
38859 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
38860
38861 @itemize @bullet
38862 @item
38863 Return value.
38864
38865 @item
38866 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
38867
38868 @item
38869 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
38870
38871 @end itemize
38872
38873 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
38874 the latest continue or step action.
38875
38876 @node The F Request Packet
38877 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
38878 @cindex file-i/o request packet
38879 @cindex @code{F} request packet
38880
38881 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
38882
38883 @table @samp
38884 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
38885
38886 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
38887 This is just the name of the function.
38888
38889 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
38890 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
38891 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
38892 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
38893 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
38894 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
38895 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
38896
38897 @end table
38898
38899
38900
38901 @node The F Reply Packet
38902 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
38903 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
38904 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
38905
38906 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
38907
38908 @table @samp
38909
38910 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
38911
38912 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
38913
38914 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
38915 representation.
38916 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
38917
38918 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
38919 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
38920 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
38921
38922 @smallexample
38923 F0,0,C
38924 @end smallexample
38925
38926 @noindent
38927 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
38928
38929 @smallexample
38930 F-1,4,C
38931 @end smallexample
38932
38933 @noindent
38934 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
38935
38936 @end table
38937
38938
38939 @node The Ctrl-C Message
38940 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
38941 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
38942
38943 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
38944 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
38945 the target should behave as if it had
38946 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
38947 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
38948 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
38949 packet.
38950
38951 It's important for the target to know in which
38952 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
38953
38954 @itemize @bullet
38955 @item
38956 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
38957
38958 @item
38959 The system call on the host has been finished.
38960
38961 @end itemize
38962
38963 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
38964 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
38965 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
38966 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
38967 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
38968 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
38969
38970 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
38971 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
38972 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
38973 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
38974 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
38975 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
38976 or the full action has been completed.
38977
38978 @node Console I/O
38979 @subsection Console I/O
38980 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
38981
38982 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
38983 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
38984 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
38985 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
38986 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
38987 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
38988 conditions is met:
38989
38990 @itemize @bullet
38991 @item
38992 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
38993 @code{read}
38994 system call is treated as finished.
38995
38996 @item
38997 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
38998 newline.
38999
39000 @item
39001 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
39002 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
39003
39004 @end itemize
39005
39006 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
39007 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
39008 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
39009 is stopped at the user's request.
39010
39011
39012 @node List of Supported Calls
39013 @subsection List of Supported Calls
39014 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
39015
39016 @menu
39017 * open::
39018 * close::
39019 * read::
39020 * write::
39021 * lseek::
39022 * rename::
39023 * unlink::
39024 * stat/fstat::
39025 * gettimeofday::
39026 * isatty::
39027 * system::
39028 @end menu
39029
39030 @node open
39031 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
39032 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
39033
39034 @table @asis
39035 @item Synopsis:
39036 @smallexample
39037 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
39038 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
39039 @end smallexample
39040
39041 @item Request:
39042 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
39043
39044 @noindent
39045 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39046
39047 @table @code
39048 @item O_CREAT
39049 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
39050 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
39051 are concerned.
39052
39053 @item O_EXCL
39054 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
39055 an error and open() fails.
39056
39057 @item O_TRUNC
39058 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
39059 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
39060 truncated to zero length.
39061
39062 @item O_APPEND
39063 The file is opened in append mode.
39064
39065 @item O_RDONLY
39066 The file is opened for reading only.
39067
39068 @item O_WRONLY
39069 The file is opened for writing only.
39070
39071 @item O_RDWR
39072 The file is opened for reading and writing.
39073 @end table
39074
39075 @noindent
39076 Other bits are silently ignored.
39077
39078
39079 @noindent
39080 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39081
39082 @table @code
39083 @item S_IRUSR
39084 User has read permission.
39085
39086 @item S_IWUSR
39087 User has write permission.
39088
39089 @item S_IRGRP
39090 Group has read permission.
39091
39092 @item S_IWGRP
39093 Group has write permission.
39094
39095 @item S_IROTH
39096 Others have read permission.
39097
39098 @item S_IWOTH
39099 Others have write permission.
39100 @end table
39101
39102 @noindent
39103 Other bits are silently ignored.
39104
39105
39106 @item Return value:
39107 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39108 occurred.
39109
39110 @item Errors:
39111
39112 @table @code
39113 @item EEXIST
39114 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39115
39116 @item EISDIR
39117 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39118
39119 @item EACCES
39120 The requested access is not allowed.
39121
39122 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39123 @var{pathname} was too long.
39124
39125 @item ENOENT
39126 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39127
39128 @item ENODEV
39129 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39130
39131 @item EROFS
39132 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39133 write access was requested.
39134
39135 @item EFAULT
39136 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39137
39138 @item ENOSPC
39139 No space on device to create the file.
39140
39141 @item EMFILE
39142 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
39143
39144 @item ENFILE
39145 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
39146 has been reached.
39147
39148 @item EINTR
39149 The call was interrupted by the user.
39150 @end table
39151
39152 @end table
39153
39154 @node close
39155 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
39156 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
39157
39158 @table @asis
39159 @item Synopsis:
39160 @smallexample
39161 int close(int fd);
39162 @end smallexample
39163
39164 @item Request:
39165 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39166
39167 @item Return value:
39168 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39169
39170 @item Errors:
39171
39172 @table @code
39173 @item EBADF
39174 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39175
39176 @item EINTR
39177 The call was interrupted by the user.
39178 @end table
39179
39180 @end table
39181
39182 @node read
39183 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
39184 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
39185
39186 @table @asis
39187 @item Synopsis:
39188 @smallexample
39189 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39190 @end smallexample
39191
39192 @item Request:
39193 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39194
39195 @item Return value:
39196 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39197 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
39198 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
39199
39200 @item Errors:
39201
39202 @table @code
39203 @item EBADF
39204 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39205 reading.
39206
39207 @item EFAULT
39208 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39209
39210 @item EINTR
39211 The call was interrupted by the user.
39212 @end table
39213
39214 @end table
39215
39216 @node write
39217 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
39218 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
39219
39220 @table @asis
39221 @item Synopsis:
39222 @smallexample
39223 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39224 @end smallexample
39225
39226 @item Request:
39227 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39228
39229 @item Return value:
39230 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39231 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
39232 is returned.
39233
39234 @item Errors:
39235
39236 @table @code
39237 @item EBADF
39238 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39239 writing.
39240
39241 @item EFAULT
39242 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39243
39244 @item EFBIG
39245 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39246 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39247
39248 @item ENOSPC
39249 No space on device to write the data.
39250
39251 @item EINTR
39252 The call was interrupted by the user.
39253 @end table
39254
39255 @end table
39256
39257 @node lseek
39258 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39259 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39260
39261 @table @asis
39262 @item Synopsis:
39263 @smallexample
39264 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39265 @end smallexample
39266
39267 @item Request:
39268 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39269
39270 @var{flag} is one of:
39271
39272 @table @code
39273 @item SEEK_SET
39274 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39275
39276 @item SEEK_CUR
39277 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39278 bytes.
39279
39280 @item SEEK_END
39281 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
39282 bytes.
39283 @end table
39284
39285 @item Return value:
39286 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
39287 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
39288 value of -1 is returned.
39289
39290 @item Errors:
39291
39292 @table @code
39293 @item EBADF
39294 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39295
39296 @item ESPIPE
39297 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39298
39299 @item EINVAL
39300 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
39301
39302 @item EINTR
39303 The call was interrupted by the user.
39304 @end table
39305
39306 @end table
39307
39308 @node rename
39309 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39310 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39311
39312 @table @asis
39313 @item Synopsis:
39314 @smallexample
39315 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39316 @end smallexample
39317
39318 @item Request:
39319 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39320
39321 @item Return value:
39322 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39323
39324 @item Errors:
39325
39326 @table @code
39327 @item EISDIR
39328 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
39329 directory.
39330
39331 @item EEXIST
39332 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
39333
39334 @item EBUSY
39335 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
39336 process.
39337
39338 @item EINVAL
39339 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
39340 of itself.
39341
39342 @item ENOTDIR
39343 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
39344 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
39345 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
39346
39347 @item EFAULT
39348 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
39349
39350 @item EACCES
39351 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39352
39353 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39354
39355 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
39356
39357 @item ENOENT
39358 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
39359
39360 @item EROFS
39361 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39362
39363 @item ENOSPC
39364 The device containing the file has no room for the new
39365 directory entry.
39366
39367 @item EINTR
39368 The call was interrupted by the user.
39369 @end table
39370
39371 @end table
39372
39373 @node unlink
39374 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
39375 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
39376
39377 @table @asis
39378 @item Synopsis:
39379 @smallexample
39380 int unlink(const char *pathname);
39381 @end smallexample
39382
39383 @item Request:
39384 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
39385
39386 @item Return value:
39387 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39388
39389 @item Errors:
39390
39391 @table @code
39392 @item EACCES
39393 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39394
39395 @item EPERM
39396 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
39397
39398 @item EBUSY
39399 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
39400 being used by another process.
39401
39402 @item EFAULT
39403 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39404
39405 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39406 @var{pathname} was too long.
39407
39408 @item ENOENT
39409 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39410
39411 @item ENOTDIR
39412 A component of the path is not a directory.
39413
39414 @item EROFS
39415 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39416
39417 @item EINTR
39418 The call was interrupted by the user.
39419 @end table
39420
39421 @end table
39422
39423 @node stat/fstat
39424 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
39425 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
39426 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
39427
39428 @table @asis
39429 @item Synopsis:
39430 @smallexample
39431 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
39432 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
39433 @end smallexample
39434
39435 @item Request:
39436 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
39437 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
39438
39439 @item Return value:
39440 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39441
39442 @item Errors:
39443
39444 @table @code
39445 @item EBADF
39446 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
39447
39448 @item ENOENT
39449 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
39450 path is an empty string.
39451
39452 @item ENOTDIR
39453 A component of the path is not a directory.
39454
39455 @item EFAULT
39456 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39457
39458 @item EACCES
39459 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39460
39461 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39462 @var{pathname} was too long.
39463
39464 @item EINTR
39465 The call was interrupted by the user.
39466 @end table
39467
39468 @end table
39469
39470 @node gettimeofday
39471 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39472 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39473
39474 @table @asis
39475 @item Synopsis:
39476 @smallexample
39477 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39478 @end smallexample
39479
39480 @item Request:
39481 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39482
39483 @item Return value:
39484 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39485
39486 @item Errors:
39487
39488 @table @code
39489 @item EINVAL
39490 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39491
39492 @item EFAULT
39493 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39494 @end table
39495
39496 @end table
39497
39498 @node isatty
39499 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39500 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39501
39502 @table @asis
39503 @item Synopsis:
39504 @smallexample
39505 int isatty(int fd);
39506 @end smallexample
39507
39508 @item Request:
39509 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39510
39511 @item Return value:
39512 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39513
39514 @item Errors:
39515
39516 @table @code
39517 @item EINTR
39518 The call was interrupted by the user.
39519 @end table
39520
39521 @end table
39522
39523 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
39524 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39525 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
39526 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39527 needed.
39528
39529
39530 @node system
39531 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
39532 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
39533
39534 @table @asis
39535 @item Synopsis:
39536 @smallexample
39537 int system(const char *command);
39538 @end smallexample
39539
39540 @item Request:
39541 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39542
39543 @item Return value:
39544 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39545 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39546 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39547 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
39548 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39549 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
39550 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39551
39552 @item Errors:
39553
39554 @table @code
39555 @item EINTR
39556 The call was interrupted by the user.
39557 @end table
39558
39559 @end table
39560
39561 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39562 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
39563 the host is simplified before it's returned
39564 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
39565 is discarded, and the return value consists
39566 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39567
39568 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39569 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39570 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39571
39572 @table @code
39573 @item set remote system-call-allowed
39574 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39575 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39576 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
39577
39578 @item show remote system-call-allowed
39579 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39580 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39581 protocol.
39582 @end table
39583
39584 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39585 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39586 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39587
39588 @menu
39589 * Integral Datatypes::
39590 * Pointer Values::
39591 * Memory Transfer::
39592 * struct stat::
39593 * struct timeval::
39594 @end menu
39595
39596 @node Integral Datatypes
39597 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39598 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39599
39600 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39601 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39602 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39603
39604 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39605 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39606
39607 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
39608
39609 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
39610 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
39611
39612 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
39613
39614 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
39615 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
39616 byte order.
39617
39618 @node Pointer Values
39619 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
39620 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
39621
39622 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
39623 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
39624 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
39625 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
39626
39627 @smallexample
39628 @code{1aaf/12}
39629 @end smallexample
39630
39631 @noindent
39632 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
39633 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
39634 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
39635 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
39636
39637 @smallexample
39638 @code{123456/d}
39639 @end smallexample
39640
39641 @node Memory Transfer
39642 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
39643 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
39644
39645 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
39646 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
39647 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
39648 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
39649 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39650 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
39651 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39652
39653
39654 @node struct stat
39655 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39656 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39657
39658 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39659 is defined as follows:
39660
39661 @smallexample
39662 struct stat @{
39663 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
39664 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
39665 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
39666 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
39667 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
39668 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
39669 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
39670 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
39671 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39672 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
39673 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
39674 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
39675 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
39676 @};
39677 @end smallexample
39678
39679 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39680 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39681 structure is of size 64 bytes.
39682
39683 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39684 range of values.
39685
39686 @table @code
39687
39688 @item st_dev
39689 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39690
39691 @item st_ino
39692 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39693
39694 @item st_mode
39695 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
39696 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39697
39698 @item st_uid
39699 @itemx st_gid
39700 @itemx st_rdev
39701 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39702
39703 @item st_atime
39704 @itemx st_mtime
39705 @itemx st_ctime
39706 These values have a host and file system dependent
39707 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39708 support exact timing values.
39709 @end table
39710
39711 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39712 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39713 continuing.
39714
39715 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39716 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39717 get truncated on the target.
39718
39719 @node struct timeval
39720 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39721 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39722
39723 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39724 is defined as follows:
39725
39726 @smallexample
39727 struct timeval @{
39728 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
39729 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39730 @};
39731 @end smallexample
39732
39733 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39734 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39735 structure is of size 8 bytes.
39736
39737 @node Constants
39738 @subsection Constants
39739 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39740
39741 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39742 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39743 values before and after the call as needed.
39744
39745 @menu
39746 * Open Flags::
39747 * mode_t Values::
39748 * Errno Values::
39749 * Lseek Flags::
39750 * Limits::
39751 @end menu
39752
39753 @node Open Flags
39754 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
39755 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
39756
39757 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
39758
39759 @smallexample
39760 O_RDONLY 0x0
39761 O_WRONLY 0x1
39762 O_RDWR 0x2
39763 O_APPEND 0x8
39764 O_CREAT 0x200
39765 O_TRUNC 0x400
39766 O_EXCL 0x800
39767 @end smallexample
39768
39769 @node mode_t Values
39770 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
39771 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
39772
39773 All values are given in octal representation.
39774
39775 @smallexample
39776 S_IFREG 0100000
39777 S_IFDIR 040000
39778 S_IRUSR 0400
39779 S_IWUSR 0200
39780 S_IXUSR 0100
39781 S_IRGRP 040
39782 S_IWGRP 020
39783 S_IXGRP 010
39784 S_IROTH 04
39785 S_IWOTH 02
39786 S_IXOTH 01
39787 @end smallexample
39788
39789 @node Errno Values
39790 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
39791 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
39792
39793 All values are given in decimal representation.
39794
39795 @smallexample
39796 EPERM 1
39797 ENOENT 2
39798 EINTR 4
39799 EBADF 9
39800 EACCES 13
39801 EFAULT 14
39802 EBUSY 16
39803 EEXIST 17
39804 ENODEV 19
39805 ENOTDIR 20
39806 EISDIR 21
39807 EINVAL 22
39808 ENFILE 23
39809 EMFILE 24
39810 EFBIG 27
39811 ENOSPC 28
39812 ESPIPE 29
39813 EROFS 30
39814 ENAMETOOLONG 91
39815 EUNKNOWN 9999
39816 @end smallexample
39817
39818 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
39819 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
39820
39821 @node Lseek Flags
39822 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
39823 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
39824
39825 @smallexample
39826 SEEK_SET 0
39827 SEEK_CUR 1
39828 SEEK_END 2
39829 @end smallexample
39830
39831 @node Limits
39832 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
39833 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
39834
39835 All values are given in decimal representation.
39836
39837 @smallexample
39838 INT_MIN -2147483648
39839 INT_MAX 2147483647
39840 UINT_MAX 4294967295
39841 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
39842 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
39843 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
39844 @end smallexample
39845
39846 @node File-I/O Examples
39847 @subsection File-I/O Examples
39848 @cindex file-i/o examples
39849
39850 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39851 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
39852
39853 @smallexample
39854 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
39855 @emph{request memory read from target}
39856 -> @code{m1234,6}
39857 <- XXXXXX
39858 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
39859 -> @code{F6}
39860 @end smallexample
39861
39862 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39863 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
39864
39865 @smallexample
39866 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39867 @emph{request memory write to target}
39868 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39869 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
39870 -> @code{F6}
39871 @end smallexample
39872
39873 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
39874 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
39875
39876 @smallexample
39877 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39878 -> @code{F-1,9}
39879 @end smallexample
39880
39881 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
39882 host is called:
39883
39884 @smallexample
39885 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39886 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
39887 <- @code{T02}
39888 @end smallexample
39889
39890 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
39891 host is called:
39892
39893 @smallexample
39894 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39895 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39896 <- @code{T02}
39897 @end smallexample
39898
39899 @node Library List Format
39900 @section Library List Format
39901 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39902
39903 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
39904 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
39905 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
39906 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
39907 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
39908 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
39909 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39910 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
39911 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
39912 are loaded.
39913
39914 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
39915 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
39916 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
39917 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
39918
39919 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
39920 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
39921 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
39922 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
39923 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
39924 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
39925
39926 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39927 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39928
39929 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
39930 offset, looks like this:
39931
39932 @smallexample
39933 <library-list>
39934 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
39935 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
39936 </library>
39937 </library-list>
39938 @end smallexample
39939
39940 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
39941 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
39942
39943 @smallexample
39944 <library-list>
39945 <library name="sharedlib.o">
39946 <section address="0x10000000"/>
39947 <section address="0x20000000"/>
39948 <section address="0x30000000"/>
39949 </library>
39950 </library-list>
39951 @end smallexample
39952
39953 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
39954
39955 @smallexample
39956 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
39957 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
39958 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39959 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
39960 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39961 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
39962 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39963 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
39964 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39965 @end smallexample
39966
39967 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
39968 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
39969 section for each library.
39970
39971 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39972 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39973 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39974
39975 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
39976 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
39977 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
39978 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
39979
39980 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
39981 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
39982 target, the following parameters are reported:
39983
39984 @itemize @minus
39985 @item
39986 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
39987 @code{struct link_map}.
39988 @item
39989 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
39990 (Thread Local Storage) access.
39991 @item
39992 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
39993 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
39994 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
39995 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
39996 @item
39997 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
39998 @end itemize
39999
40000 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
40001 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
40002 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
40003
40004 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40005 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40006
40007 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
40008 looks like this:
40009
40010 @smallexample
40011 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
40012 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
40013 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
40014 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
40015 l_ld="0x152350"/>
40016 </library-list-svr>
40017 @end smallexample
40018
40019 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
40020
40021 @smallexample
40022 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
40023 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
40024 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40025 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
40026 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
40027 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40028 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
40029 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
40030 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
40031 @end smallexample
40032
40033 @node Memory Map Format
40034 @section Memory Map Format
40035 @cindex memory map format
40036
40037 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
40038 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
40039 memory map.
40040
40041 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40042 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
40043 lists memory regions.
40044
40045 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40046 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
40047
40048 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40049
40050 @smallexample
40051 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40052 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
40053 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40054 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
40055 <memory-map>
40056 region...
40057 </memory-map>
40058 @end smallexample
40059
40060 Each region can be either:
40061
40062 @itemize
40063
40064 @item
40065 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
40066 bytes from there:
40067
40068 @smallexample
40069 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40070 @end smallexample
40071
40072
40073 @item
40074 A region of read-only memory:
40075
40076 @smallexample
40077 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40078 @end smallexample
40079
40080
40081 @item
40082 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
40083 bytes in length:
40084
40085 @smallexample
40086 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
40087 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
40088 </memory>
40089 @end smallexample
40090
40091 @end itemize
40092
40093 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40094 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40095 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40096
40097 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40098
40099 @smallexample
40100 <!-- ................................................... -->
40101 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40102 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40103 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
40104 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40105 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40106 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
40107 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
40108 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
40109 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40110 and its type, or device. -->
40111 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
40112 start CDATA #REQUIRED
40113 length CDATA #REQUIRED
40114 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
40115 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40116 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40117 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40118 @end smallexample
40119
40120 @node Thread List Format
40121 @section Thread List Format
40122 @cindex thread list format
40123
40124 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40125 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40126 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40127 the following structure:
40128
40129 @smallexample
40130 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40131 <threads>
40132 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40133 ... description ...
40134 </thread>
40135 </threads>
40136 @end smallexample
40137
40138 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40139 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
40140 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40141 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
40142 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
40143 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
40144 auxiliary information.
40145
40146 @node Traceframe Info Format
40147 @section Traceframe Info Format
40148 @cindex traceframe info format
40149
40150 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40151 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40152 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40153 collected in a traceframe.
40154
40155 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40156 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40157
40158 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40159 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40160
40161 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40162
40163 @smallexample
40164 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40165 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40166 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40167 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40168 <traceframe-info>
40169 block...
40170 </traceframe-info>
40171 @end smallexample
40172
40173 Each traceframe block can be either:
40174
40175 @itemize
40176
40177 @item
40178 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40179 @var{length} bytes from there:
40180
40181 @smallexample
40182 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40183 @end smallexample
40184
40185 @item
40186 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40187 collected:
40188
40189 @smallexample
40190 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40191 @end smallexample
40192
40193 @end itemize
40194
40195 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40196
40197 @smallexample
40198 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
40199 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40200
40201 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
40202 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
40203 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40204 <!ELEMENT tvar>
40205 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
40206 @end smallexample
40207
40208 @node Branch Trace Format
40209 @section Branch Trace Format
40210 @cindex branch trace format
40211
40212 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40213 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
40214 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40215 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40216
40217 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40218 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40219
40220 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40221 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40222
40223 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40224
40225 @smallexample
40226 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40227 <!DOCTYPE btrace
40228 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40229 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40230 <btrace>
40231 block...
40232 </btrace>
40233 @end smallexample
40234
40235 @itemize
40236
40237 @item
40238 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40239 and ending at @var{end}:
40240
40241 @smallexample
40242 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40243 @end smallexample
40244
40245 @end itemize
40246
40247 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40248
40249 @smallexample
40250 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
40251 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40252
40253 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
40254 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
40255 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
40256
40257 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40258
40259 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40260
40261 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40262 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
40263 family CDATA #REQUIRED
40264 model CDATA #REQUIRED
40265 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40266
40267 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40268 @end smallexample
40269
40270 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40271 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40272 @cindex branch trace configuration format
40273
40274 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40275 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40276 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40277
40278 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
40279 settings for that format. The following information is described:
40280
40281 @table @code
40282 @item bts
40283 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
40284 @table @code
40285 @item size
40286 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
40287 @end table
40288 @item pt
40289 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
40290 PT}) format.
40291 @table @code
40292 @item size
40293 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40294 @end table
40295 @end table
40296
40297 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40298 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40299
40300 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40301
40302 @smallexample
40303 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
40304 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40305
40306 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
40307 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40308
40309 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
40310 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40311 @end smallexample
40312
40313 @include agentexpr.texi
40314
40315 @node Target Descriptions
40316 @appendix Target Descriptions
40317 @cindex target descriptions
40318
40319 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40320 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40321 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
40322 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40323 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
40324 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40325 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
40326
40327 @itemize @bullet
40328 @item
40329 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
40330 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
40331 @item
40332 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
40333 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
40334 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
40335 @item
40336 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
40337 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
40338 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
40339 @end itemize
40340
40341 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
40342 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
40343 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
40344 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
40345 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
40346
40347 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40348 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
40349
40350 @menu
40351 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
40352 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
40353 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
40354 descriptions.
40355 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
40356 @end menu
40357
40358 @node Retrieving Descriptions
40359 @section Retrieving Descriptions
40360
40361 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
40362 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
40363 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
40364 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
40365 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
40366 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
40367 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
40368 Format}.
40369
40370 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
40371 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
40372 specify a file are:
40373
40374 @table @code
40375 @cindex set tdesc filename
40376 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
40377 Read the target description from @var{path}.
40378
40379 @cindex unset tdesc filename
40380 @item unset tdesc filename
40381 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
40382 will use the description supplied by the current target.
40383
40384 @cindex show tdesc filename
40385 @item show tdesc filename
40386 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
40387 @end table
40388
40389
40390 @node Target Description Format
40391 @section Target Description Format
40392 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
40393
40394 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
40395 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
40396 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
40397 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
40398 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
40399 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
40400 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
40401
40402 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
40403 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
40404 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
40405 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
40406 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
40407
40408 Here is a simple target description:
40409
40410 @smallexample
40411 <target version="1.0">
40412 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
40413 </target>
40414 @end smallexample
40415
40416 @noindent
40417 This minimal description only says that the target uses
40418 the x86-64 architecture.
40419
40420 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
40421 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
40422 are explained further below.
40423
40424 @smallexample
40425 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40426 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
40427 <target version="1.0">
40428 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
40429 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
40430 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
40431 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
40432 </target>
40433 @end smallexample
40434
40435 @noindent
40436 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
40437 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
40438 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
40439 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
40440 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
40441 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
40442 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
40443 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
40444 the version mismatch.
40445
40446 @subsection Inclusion
40447 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
40448 @cindex XInclude
40449 @ifnotinfo
40450 @cindex <xi:include>
40451 @end ifnotinfo
40452
40453 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
40454 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
40455 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
40456 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
40457 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
40458
40459 @smallexample
40460 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
40461 @end smallexample
40462
40463 @noindent
40464 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
40465 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
40466 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
40467 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
40468 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
40469 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
40470 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
40471 original description.
40472
40473 @subsection Architecture
40474 @cindex <architecture>
40475
40476 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
40477
40478 @smallexample
40479 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
40480 @end smallexample
40481
40482 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40483 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40484
40485 @subsection OS ABI
40486 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
40487
40488 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40489 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40490
40491 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
40492
40493 @smallexample
40494 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
40495 @end smallexample
40496
40497 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40498 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40499
40500 @subsection Compatible Architecture
40501 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
40502
40503 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40504 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40505
40506 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40507
40508 @smallexample
40509 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40510 @end smallexample
40511
40512 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40513 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40514
40515 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40516 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40517 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
40518 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40519 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40520 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
40521 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40522
40523 @smallexample
40524 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40525 <compatible>spu</compatible>
40526 @end smallexample
40527
40528 @subsection Features
40529 @cindex <feature>
40530
40531 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40532 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40533 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
40534 has this form:
40535
40536 @smallexample
40537 <feature name="@var{name}">
40538 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40539 @var{reg}@dots{}
40540 </feature>
40541 @end smallexample
40542
40543 @noindent
40544 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
40545 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40546 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40547 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40548
40549 @subsection Types
40550
40551 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40552 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40553 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40554 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40555 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
40556
40557 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40558 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40559 Types must be defined before they are used.
40560
40561 @cindex <vector>
40562 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40563 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40564 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40565 @var{count}:
40566
40567 @smallexample
40568 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40569 @end smallexample
40570
40571 @cindex <union>
40572 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40573 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
40574 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40575 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40576
40577 @smallexample
40578 <union id="@var{id}">
40579 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40580 @dots{}
40581 </union>
40582 @end smallexample
40583
40584 @cindex <struct>
40585 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40586 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
40587 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
40588 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
40589 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
40590 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
40591 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
40592 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
40593
40594 @smallexample
40595 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40596 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
40597 @dots{}
40598 </struct>
40599 @end smallexample
40600
40601 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
40602 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
40603
40604 @smallexample
40605 <struct id="@var{id}">
40606 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40607 @dots{}
40608 </struct>
40609 @end smallexample
40610
40611 @cindex <flags>
40612 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
40613 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
40614 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
40615 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
40616 are supported.
40617
40618 @smallexample
40619 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40620 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
40621 @dots{}
40622 </flags>
40623 @end smallexample
40624
40625 @subsection Registers
40626 @cindex <reg>
40627
40628 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
40629
40630 @smallexample
40631 <reg name="@var{name}"
40632 bitsize="@var{size}"
40633 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
40634 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
40635 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
40636 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
40637 @end smallexample
40638
40639 @noindent
40640 The components are as follows:
40641
40642 @table @var
40643
40644 @item name
40645 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
40646
40647 @item bitsize
40648 The register's size, in bits.
40649
40650 @item regnum
40651 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
40652 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
40653 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
40654 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
40655 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
40656 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
40657 in order of increasing register number.
40658
40659 @item save-restore
40660 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
40661 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
40662 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
40663 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
40664 ABI.
40665
40666 @item type
40667 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
40668 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
40669 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
40670 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
40671 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
40672 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
40673
40674 @item group
40675 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
40676 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
40677 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40678 in @code{info registers}.
40679
40680 @end table
40681
40682 @node Predefined Target Types
40683 @section Predefined Target Types
40684 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40685
40686 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40687 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
40688 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40689 types. The currently supported types are:
40690
40691 @table @code
40692
40693 @item int8
40694 @itemx int16
40695 @itemx int32
40696 @itemx int64
40697 @itemx int128
40698 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40699
40700 @item uint8
40701 @itemx uint16
40702 @itemx uint32
40703 @itemx uint64
40704 @itemx uint128
40705 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40706
40707 @item code_ptr
40708 @itemx data_ptr
40709 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
40710 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
40711 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
40712 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
40713 may be marked as data pointers.
40714
40715 @item ieee_single
40716 Single precision IEEE floating point.
40717
40718 @item ieee_double
40719 Double precision IEEE floating point.
40720
40721 @item arm_fpa_ext
40722 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
40723
40724 @item i387_ext
40725 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
40726
40727 @item i386_eflags
40728 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
40729
40730 @item i386_mxcsr
40731 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
40732
40733 @end table
40734
40735 @node Standard Target Features
40736 @section Standard Target Features
40737 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
40738
40739 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
40740 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
40741 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
40742 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
40743 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
40744 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
40745 can recognize them.
40746
40747 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
40748 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
40749 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
40750 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
40751 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
40752 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
40753 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
40754 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
40755
40756 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
40757 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
40758 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
40759
40760 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
40761 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
40762 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
40763 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
40764
40765 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
40766 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
40767 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
40768
40769 @menu
40770 * AArch64 Features::
40771 * ARM Features::
40772 * i386 Features::
40773 * MicroBlaze Features::
40774 * MIPS Features::
40775 * M68K Features::
40776 * Nios II Features::
40777 * PowerPC Features::
40778 * S/390 and System z Features::
40779 * TIC6x Features::
40780 @end menu
40781
40782
40783 @node AArch64 Features
40784 @subsection AArch64 Features
40785 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
40786
40787 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
40788 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
40789 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40790
40791 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
40792 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
40793 and @samp{fpcr}.
40794
40795 @node ARM Features
40796 @subsection ARM Features
40797 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
40798
40799 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
40800 ARM targets.
40801 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
40802 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40803
40804 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
40805 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
40806 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
40807 and @samp{xpsr}.
40808
40809 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
40810 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
40811
40812 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
40813 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
40814 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
40815 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
40816
40817 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
40818 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
40819 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
40820 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
40821 halves of the double-precision registers.
40822
40823 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
40824 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
40825 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
40826 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
40827 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
40828 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
40829
40830 @node i386 Features
40831 @subsection i386 Features
40832 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
40833
40834 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
40835 targets. It should describe the following registers:
40836
40837 @itemize @minus
40838 @item
40839 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
40840 @item
40841 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
40842 @item
40843 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
40844 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
40845 @item
40846 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
40847 @item
40848 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
40849 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
40850 @end itemize
40851
40852 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
40853
40854 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
40855 describe registers:
40856
40857 @itemize @minus
40858 @item
40859 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
40860 @item
40861 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
40862 @item
40863 @samp{mxcsr}
40864 @end itemize
40865
40866 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
40867 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
40868 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
40869
40870 @itemize @minus
40871 @item
40872 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
40873 @item
40874 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
40875 @end itemize
40876
40877 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
40878 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
40879
40880 @itemize @minus
40881 @item
40882 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
40883 @item
40884 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
40885 @end itemize
40886
40887 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
40888 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
40889
40890 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
40891 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
40892 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
40893
40894 @itemize @minus
40895 @item
40896 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40897 @end itemize
40898
40899 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
40900
40901 @itemize @minus
40902 @item
40903 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40904 @end itemize
40905
40906 It should
40907 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
40908
40909 @itemize @minus
40910 @item
40911 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
40912 @item
40913 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
40914 @end itemize
40915
40916 It should
40917 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
40918
40919 @itemize @minus
40920 @item
40921 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40922 @end itemize
40923
40924 @node MicroBlaze Features
40925 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
40926 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
40927
40928 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
40929 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40930 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
40931 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
40932 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
40933
40934 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
40935 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
40936
40937 @node MIPS Features
40938 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
40939 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
40940
40941 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
40942 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
40943 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
40944 on the target.
40945
40946 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
40947 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
40948 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40949
40950 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
40951 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
40952 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
40953 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40954
40955 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
40956 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
40957 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
40958 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40959
40960 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
40961 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
40962 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
40963
40964 @node M68K Features
40965 @subsection M68K Features
40966 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
40967
40968 @table @code
40969 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
40970 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
40971 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
40972 One of those features must be always present.
40973 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
40974 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
40975 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
40976 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
40977
40978 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
40979 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
40980 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
40981 @samp{fpiaddr}.
40982 @end table
40983
40984 @node Nios II Features
40985 @subsection Nios II Features
40986 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
40987
40988 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
40989 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
40990 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
40991 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
40992 @samp{mpuacc}).
40993
40994 @node PowerPC Features
40995 @subsection PowerPC Features
40996 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
40997
40998 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
40999 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41000 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
41001 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41002
41003 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
41004 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
41005
41006 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
41007 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
41008 and @samp{vrsave}.
41009
41010 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
41011 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
41012 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
41013 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
41014 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
41015 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
41016
41017 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
41018 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
41019 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
41020 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
41021 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
41022 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
41023 user.
41024
41025 @node S/390 and System z Features
41026 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
41027 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
41028 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
41029
41030 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
41031 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
41032 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
41033 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
41034 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
41035 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
41036 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
41037 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
41038 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
41039
41040 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
41041 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
41042 @samp{fpc}.
41043
41044 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
41045 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
41046
41047 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
41048 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
41049 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
41050 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
41051 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
41052 32-bit wide.
41053
41054 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
41055 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
41056 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
41057
41058 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
41059 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
41060 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
41061 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
41062 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
41063 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
41064 @samp{v31}.
41065
41066 @node TIC6x Features
41067 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
41068 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
41069 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
41070 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
41071 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
41072 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
41073
41074 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
41075 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
41076 through @samp{B31}.
41077
41078 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
41079 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
41080
41081 @node Operating System Information
41082 @appendix Operating System Information
41083 @cindex operating system information
41084
41085 @menu
41086 * Process list::
41087 @end menu
41088
41089 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
41090 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
41091 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
41092 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
41093 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
41094 on a different aspect of target.
41095
41096 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
41097 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
41098 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
41099 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
41100
41101 @node Process list
41102 @appendixsection Process list
41103 @cindex operating system information, process list
41104
41105 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
41106 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
41107 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
41108 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
41109
41110 An example document is:
41111
41112 @smallexample
41113 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41114 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
41115 <osdata type="processes">
41116 <item>
41117 <column name="pid">1</column>
41118 <column name="user">root</column>
41119 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
41120 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
41121 </item>
41122 </osdata>
41123 @end smallexample
41124
41125 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
41126 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
41127 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
41128 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
41129 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
41130 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
41131 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
41132
41133 @node Trace File Format
41134 @appendix Trace File Format
41135 @cindex trace file format
41136
41137 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
41138 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
41139
41140 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
41141 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
41142 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
41143 in the future.
41144
41145 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
41146 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
41147 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
41148 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
41149 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
41150 of this section.
41151
41152 @table @code
41153 @item R @var{size}
41154 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
41155 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
41156 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
41157 a single trace file.
41158
41159 @item status @var{status}
41160 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
41161 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
41162 file.
41163
41164 @item tp @var{payload}
41165 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41166 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
41167 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41168 reply packets.
41169
41170 @item tsv @var{payload}
41171 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41172 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
41173 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41174 reply packets.
41175
41176 @item tdesc @var{payload}
41177 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
41178 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
41179 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
41180 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
41181 file. Includes are not allowed.
41182
41183 @end table
41184
41185 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
41186 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
41187 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
41188 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
41189 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
41190 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
41191 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
41192 endianness.
41193
41194 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
41195
41196 @table @code
41197 @item R @var{bytes}
41198 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
41199 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
41200 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
41201
41202 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
41203 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
41204 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
41205 @var{length} bytes.
41206
41207 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
41208 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
41209 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
41210
41211 @end table
41212
41213 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
41214 of blocks.
41215
41216 @node Index Section Format
41217 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
41218 @cindex .gdb_index section format
41219 @cindex index section format
41220
41221 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
41222 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
41223 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
41224 description.
41225
41226 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
41227 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
41228 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
41229 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
41230 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
41231 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
41232
41233 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
41234
41235 @enumerate
41236 @item
41237 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
41238 unless otherwise noted:
41239
41240 @enumerate
41241 @item
41242 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
41243 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
41244 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
41245 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
41246 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
41247 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
41248 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
41249
41250 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
41251 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
41252 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
41253 currently not flagged as deprecated.
41254
41255 @item
41256 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
41257
41258 @item
41259 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
41260 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
41261 to the next offset.
41262
41263 @item
41264 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
41265
41266 @item
41267 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
41268
41269 @item
41270 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
41271 @end enumerate
41272
41273 @item
41274 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
41275 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
41276 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
41277 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
41278 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
41279 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
41280 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
41281 CU indices.
41282
41283 @item
41284 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
41285 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
41286 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
41287 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
41288
41289 @item
41290 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
41291 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
41292
41293 @enumerate
41294 @item
41295 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
41296
41297 @item
41298 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
41299 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
41300
41301 @item
41302 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
41303 @end enumerate
41304
41305 @item
41306 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
41307 the hash table is always a power of 2.
41308
41309 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
41310 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
41311 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
41312 constant pool.
41313
41314 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
41315 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
41316 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
41317
41318 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
41319 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
41320 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
41321 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
41322 index version:
41323
41324 @table @asis
41325 @item Version 4
41326 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
41327
41328 @item Versions 5 to 7
41329 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
41330 @end table
41331
41332 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
41333
41334 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
41335 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
41336 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
41337 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
41338 collision.
41339
41340 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
41341 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
41342 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
41343 the code.
41344
41345 @item
41346 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
41347 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
41348 strings.
41349
41350 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
41351 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
41352 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
41353 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
41354 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
41355 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
41356
41357 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
41358 @end enumerate
41359
41360 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
41361 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
41362 CU index+attributes value for each use.
41363
41364 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
41365 (bit 0 = LSB):
41366
41367 @table @asis
41368
41369 @item Bits 0-23
41370 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
41371 @item Bits 24-27
41372 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
41373 @item Bits 28-30
41374 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
41375
41376 @table @asis
41377 @item 0
41378 This value is reserved and should not be used.
41379 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
41380 with previous versions of the index.
41381 @item 1
41382 The symbol is a type.
41383 @item 2
41384 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
41385 @item 3
41386 The symbol is a function.
41387 @item 4
41388 Any other kind of symbol.
41389 @item 5,6,7
41390 These values are reserved.
41391 @end table
41392
41393 @item Bit 31
41394 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
41395
41396 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
41397 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
41398 @value{GDBN} sources.
41399
41400 @end table
41401
41402 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
41403 global/static attributes in the index.
41404
41405 @smallexample
41406 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
41407 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
41408 switch (die->tag)
41409 @{
41410 case DW_TAG_typedef:
41411 case DW_TAG_base_type:
41412 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
41413 kind = TYPE;
41414 is_static = 1;
41415 break;
41416 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
41417 kind = VARIABLE;
41418 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41419 break;
41420 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
41421 kind = FUNCTION;
41422 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
41423 break;
41424 case DW_TAG_constant:
41425 kind = VARIABLE;
41426 is_static = ! is_external;
41427 break;
41428 case DW_TAG_variable:
41429 kind = VARIABLE;
41430 is_static = ! is_external;
41431 break;
41432 case DW_TAG_namespace:
41433 kind = TYPE;
41434 is_static = 0;
41435 break;
41436 case DW_TAG_class_type:
41437 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
41438 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
41439 case DW_TAG_union_type:
41440 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
41441 kind = TYPE;
41442 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41443 break;
41444 default:
41445 assert (0);
41446 @}
41447 @end smallexample
41448
41449 @node Man Pages
41450 @appendix Manual pages
41451 @cindex Man pages
41452
41453 @menu
41454 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
41455 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
41456 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
41457 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
41458 @end menu
41459
41460 @node gdb man
41461 @heading gdb man
41462
41463 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
41464
41465 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
41466 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
41467 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
41468 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
41469 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
41470 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
41471 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
41472 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
41473 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
41474 @c man end
41475
41476 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
41477 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
41478 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
41479 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
41480
41481 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
41482 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
41483
41484 @itemize @bullet
41485 @item
41486 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
41487
41488 @item
41489 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
41490
41491 @item
41492 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
41493
41494 @item
41495 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
41496 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
41497 @end itemize
41498
41499 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
41500 Modula-2.
41501
41502 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
41503 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
41504 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
41505 by using the command @code{help}.
41506
41507 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
41508 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
41509 executable program as the argument:
41510
41511 @smallexample
41512 gdb program
41513 @end smallexample
41514
41515 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
41516
41517 @smallexample
41518 gdb program core
41519 @end smallexample
41520
41521 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
41522 to debug a running process:
41523
41524 @smallexample
41525 gdb program 1234
41526 gdb -p 1234
41527 @end smallexample
41528
41529 @noindent
41530 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
41531 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
41532 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
41533
41534 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
41535
41536 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
41537 @table @env
41538 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
41539 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
41540
41541 @item run [@var{arglist}]
41542 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
41543
41544 @item bt
41545 Backtrace: display the program stack.
41546
41547 @item print @var{expr}
41548 Display the value of an expression.
41549
41550 @item c
41551 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
41552
41553 @item next
41554 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
41555 function calls in the line.
41556
41557 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41558 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
41559
41560 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41561 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
41562
41563 @item step
41564 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
41565 function calls in the line.
41566
41567 @item help [@var{name}]
41568 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
41569 about using @value{GDBN}.
41570
41571 @item quit
41572 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
41573 @end table
41574
41575 @ifset man
41576 For full details on @value{GDBN},
41577 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41578 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
41579 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
41580 @end ifset
41581 @c man end
41582
41583 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
41584 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
41585 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
41586 encountered with no
41587 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
41588 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
41589 Many options have
41590 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
41591 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
41592 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
41593 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
41594 more usual convention.)
41595
41596 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
41597 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
41598 option is used.
41599
41600 @table @env
41601 @item -help
41602 @itemx -h
41603 List all options, with brief explanations.
41604
41605 @item -symbols=@var{file}
41606 @itemx -s @var{file}
41607 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
41608
41609 @item -write
41610 Enable writing into executable and core files.
41611
41612 @item -exec=@var{file}
41613 @itemx -e @var{file}
41614 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
41615 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
41616 dump.
41617
41618 @item -se=@var{file}
41619 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
41620 file.
41621
41622 @item -core=@var{file}
41623 @itemx -c @var{file}
41624 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
41625
41626 @item -command=@var{file}
41627 @itemx -x @var{file}
41628 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
41629
41630 @item -ex @var{command}
41631 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
41632
41633 @item -directory=@var{directory}
41634 @itemx -d @var{directory}
41635 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
41636
41637 @item -nh
41638 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
41639
41640 @item -nx
41641 @itemx -n
41642 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
41643
41644 @item -quiet
41645 @itemx -q
41646 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
41647 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
41648
41649 @item -batch
41650 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
41651 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
41652 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
41653 commands in the command files.
41654
41655 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
41656 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
41657 more useful, the message
41658
41659 @smallexample
41660 Program exited normally.
41661 @end smallexample
41662
41663 @noindent
41664 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
41665 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
41666
41667 @item -cd=@var{directory}
41668 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
41669 instead of the current directory.
41670
41671 @item -fullname
41672 @itemx -f
41673 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
41674 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
41675 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
41676 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
41677 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
41678 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
41679 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
41680 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
41681
41682 @item -b @var{bps}
41683 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
41684 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
41685
41686 @item -tty=@var{device}
41687 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
41688 @end table
41689 @c man end
41690
41691 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
41692 @ifset man
41693 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41694 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41695 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41696
41697 @smallexample
41698 info gdb
41699 @end smallexample
41700
41701 @noindent
41702 should give you access to the complete manual.
41703
41704 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41705 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41706 @end ifset
41707 @c man end
41708
41709 @node gdbserver man
41710 @heading gdbserver man
41711
41712 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
41713 @format
41714 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
41715 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41716
41717 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41718
41719 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41720 @c man end
41721 @end format
41722
41723 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
41724 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
41725 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
41726
41727 @ifclear man
41728 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
41729 @end ifclear
41730 @ifset man
41731 Usage (server (target) side):
41732 @end ifset
41733
41734 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
41735 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
41736 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
41737 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
41738
41739 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
41740 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
41741 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
41742
41743 @smallexample
41744 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
41745 @end smallexample
41746
41747 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
41748
41749 @smallexample
41750 @ifset man
41751 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
41752 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
41753 @end ifset
41754 @ifclear man
41755 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
41756 @end ifclear
41757 @end smallexample
41758
41759 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
41760 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
41761 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
41762
41763 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
41764
41765 @smallexample
41766 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
41767 @end smallexample
41768
41769 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
41770 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
41771 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
41772 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
41773 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
41774 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
41775 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
41776 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
41777 print an error message and exit.
41778
41779 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
41780 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
41781
41782 @smallexample
41783 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41784 @end smallexample
41785
41786 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41787 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41788
41789 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41790 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
41791 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
41792 the program you want to debug.
41793
41794 @smallexample
41795 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41796 @end smallexample
41797
41798 @ifclear man
41799 @subheading Usage (host side)
41800 @end ifclear
41801 @ifset man
41802 Usage (host side):
41803 @end ifset
41804
41805 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
41806 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
41807 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
41808 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
41809 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
41810 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
41811 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
41812 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
41813 descriptor. For example:
41814
41815 @smallexample
41816 @ifset man
41817 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
41818 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
41819 @end ifset
41820 @ifclear man
41821 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
41822 @end ifclear
41823 @end smallexample
41824
41825 @noindent
41826 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
41827
41828 @smallexample
41829 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
41830 @end smallexample
41831
41832 @noindent
41833 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
41834 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
41835 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
41836 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
41837 `Connection refused'.
41838
41839 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
41840 described in
41841 @ifset man
41842 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
41843 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
41844 @end ifset
41845 @ifclear man
41846 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
41847 @end ifclear
41848 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
41849
41850 @smallexample
41851 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
41852 @end smallexample
41853
41854 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
41855 case.
41856 @c man end
41857
41858 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
41859 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
41860
41861 @itemize @bullet
41862
41863 @item
41864 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
41865
41866 @smallexample
41867 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41868 @end smallexample
41869
41870 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
41871 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
41872 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
41873 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
41874 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
41875 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
41876 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41877
41878 @item
41879 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
41880 program:
41881
41882 @smallexample
41883 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41884 @end smallexample
41885
41886 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
41887 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
41888 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
41889 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41890
41891 @item
41892 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
41893
41894 @smallexample
41895 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41896 @end smallexample
41897
41898 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
41899 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
41900 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
41901 debug several processes in the same session.
41902 @end itemize
41903
41904 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
41905
41906 @table @env
41907
41908 @item --help
41909 List all options, with brief explanations.
41910
41911 @item --version
41912 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
41913
41914 @item --attach
41915 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
41916
41917 @smallexample
41918 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41919 @end smallexample
41920
41921 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41922 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41923
41924 @item --multi
41925 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41926 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
41927 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
41928 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
41929
41930 @smallexample
41931 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41932 @end smallexample
41933
41934 @item --debug
41935 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
41936 process.
41937 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41938 the developers.
41939
41940 @item --remote-debug
41941 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
41942 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41943 the developers.
41944
41945 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
41946 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
41947 of debugging output.
41948 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
41949
41950 @item --wrapper
41951 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
41952 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
41953 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
41954 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
41955
41956 @item --once
41957 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
41958 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
41959 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
41960 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
41961
41962 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
41963
41964 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
41965 @c QDisableRandomization.
41966
41967 @end table
41968 @c man end
41969
41970 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
41971 @ifset man
41972 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41973 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41974 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41975
41976 @smallexample
41977 info gdb
41978 @end smallexample
41979
41980 should give you access to the complete manual.
41981
41982 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41983 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41984 @end ifset
41985 @c man end
41986
41987 @node gcore man
41988 @heading gcore
41989
41990 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
41991
41992 @format
41993 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
41994 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
41995 @c man end
41996 @end format
41997
41998 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
41999 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
42000 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
42001 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
42002 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
42003 running without any change.
42004 @c man end
42005
42006 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
42007 @table @env
42008 @item -o @var{filename}
42009 The optional argument
42010 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
42011 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
42012 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
42013 @end table
42014 @c man end
42015
42016 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
42017 @ifset man
42018 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42019 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42020 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42021
42022 @smallexample
42023 info gdb
42024 @end smallexample
42025
42026 @noindent
42027 should give you access to the complete manual.
42028
42029 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42030 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42031 @end ifset
42032 @c man end
42033
42034 @node gdbinit man
42035 @heading gdbinit
42036
42037 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
42038
42039 @format
42040 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
42041 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42042 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42043 @end ifset
42044
42045 ~/.gdbinit
42046
42047 ./.gdbinit
42048 @c man end
42049 @end format
42050
42051 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
42052 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
42053 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
42054 described in
42055 @ifset man
42056 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
42057 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
42058 @end ifset
42059 @ifclear man
42060 @ref{Sequences}.
42061 @end ifclear
42062
42063 Please read more in
42064 @ifset man
42065 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
42066 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
42067 @end ifset
42068 @ifclear man
42069 @ref{Startup}.
42070 @end ifclear
42071
42072 @table @env
42073 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42074 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42075 @end ifset
42076 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42077 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
42078 @end ifclear
42079 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42080 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
42081 See more in
42082 @ifset man
42083 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
42084 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
42085 @end ifset
42086 @ifclear man
42087 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
42088 @end ifclear
42089
42090 @item ~/.gdbinit
42091 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42092 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
42093
42094 @item ./.gdbinit
42095 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
42096 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
42097 See more in
42098 @ifset man
42099 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
42100 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
42101 @end ifset
42102 @ifclear man
42103 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
42104 @end ifclear
42105 @end table
42106 @c man end
42107
42108 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
42109 @ifset man
42110 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
42111
42112 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42113 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42114 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42115
42116 @smallexample
42117 info gdb
42118 @end smallexample
42119
42120 should give you access to the complete manual.
42121
42122 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42123 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42124 @end ifset
42125 @c man end
42126
42127 @include gpl.texi
42128
42129 @node GNU Free Documentation License
42130 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
42131 @include fdl.texi
42132
42133 @node Concept Index
42134 @unnumbered Concept Index
42135
42136 @printindex cp
42137
42138 @node Command and Variable Index
42139 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
42140
42141 @printindex fn
42142
42143 @tex
42144 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
42145 % meantime:
42146 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
42147 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
42148 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
42149 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
42150 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
42151 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
42152 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
42153 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
42154 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
42155 \page\colophon
42156 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
42157 @end tex
42158
42159 @bye
This page took 1.017223 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.